Implement all-stop on top of a target running non-stop mode
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1239 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1240 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1241 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1242 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1243 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1244
1245 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1246 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1247 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1248 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1249 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1250 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1251
1252 @item -write
1253 @cindex @code{--write}
1254 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1255 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1256 (@pxref{Patching}).
1257
1258 @item -statistics
1259 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1260 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1261 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1262
1263 @item -version
1264 @cindex @code{--version}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1266 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1267
1268 @item -configuration
1269 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1271 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1272 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1273
1274 @end table
1275
1276 @node Startup
1277 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1278 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1279
1280 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1281
1282 @enumerate
1283 @item
1284 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1285 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1286
1287 @item
1288 @cindex init file
1289 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1290 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1292 that file.
1293
1294 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1295 @item
1296 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1297 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1298 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1302 @item
1303 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1304 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1305 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1306 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1307 gets loaded.
1308
1309 @item
1310 Processes command line options and operands.
1311
1312 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1313 @item
1314 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1315 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1316 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1317 This is only done if the current directory is
1318 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1319 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1320 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1321 @value{GDBN}.
1322
1323 @item
1324 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1325 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1326 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1327 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1328
1329 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1330 you must do something like the following:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1334 @end smallexample
1335
1336 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1337 off too late.
1338
1339 @item
1340 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1341 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1342 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1346 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1347 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1348 @end enumerate
1349
1350 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1351 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1352 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1353 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1354 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1355 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1356
1357 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1358 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1359
1360 @cindex init file name
1361 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1362 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1363 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1364 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1365 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1366 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1367 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1368 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1369
1370
1371 @node Quitting GDB
1372 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1373 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1374 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1375
1376 @table @code
1377 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1378 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1379 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1380 @itemx q
1381 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1382 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1383 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1384 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1385 error code.
1386 @end table
1387
1388 @cindex interrupt
1389 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1390 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1391 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1392 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1393 until a time when it is safe.
1394
1395 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1396 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1397 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1398
1399 @node Shell Commands
1400 @section Shell Commands
1401
1402 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1403 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1404 just use the @code{shell} command.
1405
1406 @table @code
1407 @kindex shell
1408 @kindex !
1409 @cindex shell escape
1410 @item shell @var{command-string}
1411 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1412 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1413 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1414 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1415 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1416 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1417 @end table
1418
1419 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1420 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1421 @value{GDBN}:
1422
1423 @table @code
1424 @kindex make
1425 @cindex calling make
1426 @item make @var{make-args}
1427 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1428 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1429 @end table
1430
1431 @node Logging Output
1432 @section Logging Output
1433 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1434 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1435
1436 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1437 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1438
1439 @table @code
1440 @kindex set logging
1441 @item set logging on
1442 Enable logging.
1443 @item set logging off
1444 Disable logging.
1445 @cindex logging file name
1446 @item set logging file @var{file}
1447 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1448 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1449 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1450 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1451 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1453 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1454 @kindex show logging
1455 @item show logging
1456 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1457 @end table
1458
1459 @node Commands
1460 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1461
1462 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1463 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1464 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1465 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1466 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1467
1468 @menu
1469 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1470 * Completion:: Command completion
1471 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1472 @end menu
1473
1474 @node Command Syntax
1475 @section Command Syntax
1476
1477 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1478 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1479 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1480 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1481 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1482 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1483
1484 @cindex abbreviation
1485 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1486 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1487 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1488 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1489 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1490 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1491 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1492
1493 @cindex repeating commands
1494 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1495 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1496 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1497 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1498 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1499 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1500 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1501
1502 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1503 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1504 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1505
1506 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1507 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1508 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1509 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1510 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1511
1512 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1513 @cindex comment
1514 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1515 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1516 Files,,Command Files}).
1517
1518 @cindex repeating command sequences
1519 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1520 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1521 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1522 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1523 for editing.
1524
1525 @node Completion
1526 @section Command Completion
1527
1528 @cindex completion
1529 @cindex word completion
1530 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1531 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1532 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1533 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1534
1535 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1536 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1537 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1538 enter it). For example, if you type
1539
1540 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1541 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1542 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1543 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1544 @smallexample
1545 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1546 @end smallexample
1547
1548 @noindent
1549 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1550 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1551
1552 @smallexample
1553 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1554 @end smallexample
1555
1556 @noindent
1557 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1558 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1559 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1560 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1561 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1562 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1563
1564 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1565 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1566 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1567 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1568 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1569 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1570 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1571 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1572 example:
1573
1574 @smallexample
1575 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1576 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1577 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1578 make_abs_section make_function_type
1579 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1580 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1581 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1583 @end smallexample
1584
1585 @noindent
1586 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1587 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1588 command.
1589
1590 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1591 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1592 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1593 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1594 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1595
1596 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1597 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1598 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1602 main
1603 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1604 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1605 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1610
1611 @table @code
1612 @kindex set max-completions
1613 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1614 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1615 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1616 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1617 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1618 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1619 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1620 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1621 completion slow.
1622 @kindex show max-completions
1623 @item show max-completions
1624 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1625 during completion.
1626 @end table
1627
1628 @cindex quotes in commands
1629 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1630 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1631 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1632 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1633 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1634 @value{GDBN} commands.
1635
1636 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1637 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1638 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1639 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1640 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1641 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1642 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1643 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1644 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1645 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1646 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1650 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1651 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1652 @end smallexample
1653
1654 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1655 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1656 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1657 place:
1658
1659 @smallexample
1660 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1661 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1662 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @noindent
1666 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1667 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1668 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1669
1670 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1671 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1672 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1673 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1674
1675 @cindex completion of structure field names
1676 @cindex structure field name completion
1677 @cindex completion of union field names
1678 @cindex union field name completion
1679 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1680 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1681 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1682 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1683 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1684 left-hand-side:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1688 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1689 to_data to_isatty to_write
1690 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1691 to_flush to_read
1692 @end smallexample
1693
1694 @noindent
1695 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1696 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1697 follows:
1698
1699 @smallexample
1700 struct ui_file
1701 @{
1702 int *magic;
1703 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1704 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1705 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1706 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1707 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1708 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1709 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1710 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1711 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1712 void *to_data;
1713 @}
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716
1717 @node Help
1718 @section Getting Help
1719 @cindex online documentation
1720 @kindex help
1721
1722 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1723 using the command @code{help}.
1724
1725 @table @code
1726 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1727 @item help
1728 @itemx h
1729 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1730 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1731
1732 @smallexample
1733 (@value{GDBP}) help
1734 List of classes of commands:
1735
1736 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1737 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1738 data -- Examining data
1739 files -- Specifying and examining files
1740 internals -- Maintenance commands
1741 obscure -- Obscure features
1742 running -- Running the program
1743 stack -- Examining the stack
1744 status -- Status inquiries
1745 support -- Support facilities
1746 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1747 stopping the program
1748 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1749
1750 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1751 commands in that class.
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1758
1759 @item help @var{class}
1760 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1761 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1762 help display for the class @code{status}:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1766 Status inquiries.
1767
1768 List of commands:
1769
1770 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1771 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1772 info -- Generic command for showing things
1773 about the program being debugged
1774 show -- Generic command for showing things
1775 about the debugger
1776
1777 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1778 documentation.
1779 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1780 (@value{GDBP})
1781 @end smallexample
1782
1783 @item help @var{command}
1784 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1785 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1786
1787 @kindex apropos
1788 @item apropos @var{args}
1789 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1790 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1791 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1792
1793 @smallexample
1794 apropos alias
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 results in:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 @c @group
1802 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1803 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1804 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1805 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1806 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1807 @c @end group
1808 @end smallexample
1809
1810 @kindex complete
1811 @item complete @var{args}
1812 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1813 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1814 command you want completed. For example:
1815
1816 @smallexample
1817 complete i
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @noindent results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @group
1824 if
1825 ignore
1826 info
1827 inspect
1828 @end group
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1832 @end table
1833
1834 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1835 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1836 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1837 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1838 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1839 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1840 Index}.
1841
1842 @c @group
1843 @table @code
1844 @kindex info
1845 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1846 @item info
1847 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1848 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1849 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1850 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1851 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1852 @w{@code{help info}}.
1853
1854 @kindex set
1855 @item set
1856 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1857 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1858 @code{set prompt $}.
1859
1860 @kindex show
1861 @item show
1862 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1863 @value{GDBN} itself.
1864 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1865 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1866 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1867 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1868
1869 @kindex info set
1870 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1871 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1872 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1873 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1874 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1875 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1876 @end table
1877 @c @end group
1878
1879 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1880 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1881
1882 @table @code
1883 @kindex show version
1884 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1885 @item show version
1886 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1887 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1888 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1889 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1890 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1891 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1892 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1893 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1894 @value{GDBN}.
1895
1896 @kindex show copying
1897 @kindex info copying
1898 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1899 @item show copying
1900 @itemx info copying
1901 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show warranty
1904 @kindex info warranty
1905 @item show warranty
1906 @itemx info warranty
1907 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1908 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1909
1910 @kindex show configuration
1911 @item show configuration
1912 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1913 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1914 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1915 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1916 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1917 your report.
1918
1919 @end table
1920
1921 @node Running
1922 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1923
1924 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it.
1926
1927 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1928 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1929 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1930 kill a child process.
1931
1932 @menu
1933 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1934 * Starting:: Starting your program
1935 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1936 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1937
1938 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1939 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1940 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1941 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1942
1943 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1944 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1945 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1946 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1947 @end menu
1948
1949 @node Compilation
1950 @section Compiling for Debugging
1951
1952 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1953 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1954 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1955 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1956 and addresses in the executable code.
1957
1958 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1959 the compiler.
1960
1961 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1962 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1963 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1964 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1965 executables containing debugging information.
1966
1967 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1968 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1969 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1970 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1971 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1972
1973 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1974 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1975 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1976
1977 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1978 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1979 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1980 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1981 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1982 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1983
1984 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1985 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1986 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1987
1988 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1989 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1990 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1991 format in @value{GDBN}.
1992
1993 @need 2000
1994 @node Starting
1995 @section Starting your Program
1996 @cindex starting
1997 @cindex running
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex run
2001 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2002 @item run
2003 @itemx r
2004 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2005 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2006 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2007 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2008 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2009
2010 @end table
2011
2012 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2013 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2014 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2015 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2016 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2017 message like this one:
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2021 Try "help target" or "continue".
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2026 first (@pxref{load}).
2027
2028 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2029 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2030 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2031 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2032 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2033 divided into four categories:
2034
2035 @table @asis
2036 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2037 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2038 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2039 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2040 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2041 the arguments.
2042 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2043 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2044 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2045 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2046 below for details).
2047
2048 @item The @emph{environment.}
2049 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2050 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2051 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2052 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2053
2054 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2055 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2056 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2057 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2060 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2061 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2062 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2063 set a different device for your program.
2064 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2065
2066 @cindex pipes
2067 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2068 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2069 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2070 wrong program.
2071 @end table
2072
2073 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2074 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2075 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2076 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2077 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2078
2079 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2080 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2081 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2082 your current breakpoints.
2083
2084 @table @code
2085 @kindex start
2086 @item start
2087 @cindex run to main procedure
2088 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2089 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2090 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2091 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2092 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2093 procedure, depending on the language used.
2094
2095 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2096 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2097 the @samp{run} command.
2098
2099 @cindex elaboration phase
2100 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2101 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2102 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2103 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2104 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2105 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2106 will remain to halt execution.
2107
2108 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2109 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2110 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2111 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2112 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2113
2114 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2115 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2116 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2117 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2118 elaboration code before running your program.
2119
2120 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2121 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2122 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2123 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2124 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2125 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2126 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2127 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2128 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2129 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2130 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2131 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2132
2133 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2134 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2135 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2136 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2137
2138 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2139 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2140 environment:
2141
2142 @smallexample
2143 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2144 (@value{GDBP}) run
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2148 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2149
2150 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2151 @item set startup-with-shell
2152 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2153 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2154 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2155 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2156 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2157 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2158 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2159 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2160 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2161 startup failures such as:
2162
2163 @smallexample
2164 (@value{GDBP}) run
2165 Starting program: ./a.out
2166 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2171 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2172 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2173 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2174 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2175 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2176
2177 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2178 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2179 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2180 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2181 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2182 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2183
2184 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2185 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2186 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2187 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2188 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2189 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2190
2191 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2192 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2193 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2194
2195 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2196 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) run
2200 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2204 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2205
2206 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2207 @code{target native} command. For example,
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2211 (@value{GDBP}) run
2212 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2213 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2214 (@value{GDBP}) run
2215 Starting program: ./a.out
2216 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2220 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2221 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2222 disconnect.
2223
2224 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2225 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2226 proc}, @code{info os}.
2227
2228 @kindex set disable-randomization
2229 @item set disable-randomization
2230 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2231 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2232 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2233 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2234 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2235
2236 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2237 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2238
2239 @smallexample
2240 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2241 @end smallexample
2242
2243 @item set disable-randomization off
2244 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2245 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2246 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2247 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2248 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2249 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2250
2251 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2252 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2253 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2254 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2255 a code at its expected addresses.
2256
2257 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2258 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2259 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2260 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2261 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2262 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2263 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2264 a randomly chosen address.
2265
2266 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2267 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2268 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2269 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2270 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2271
2272 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2273 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2274
2275 @item show disable-randomization
2276 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2277 the virtual address space of the started program.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Arguments
2282 @section Your Program's Arguments
2283
2284 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2285 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2286 @code{run} command.
2287 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2288 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2289 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2290 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2291 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2292
2293 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2294 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2295 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2296 the program, not by the shell.
2297
2298 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2299 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set args
2303 @item set args
2304 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2305 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2306 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2307 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2308 it again without arguments.
2309
2310 @kindex show args
2311 @item show args
2312 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2313 @end table
2314
2315 @node Environment
2316 @section Your Program's Environment
2317
2318 @cindex environment (of your program)
2319 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2320 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2321 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2322 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2323 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2324 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2325 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex path
2329 @item path @var{directory}
2330 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2331 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2332 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2333 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2334 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2335 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2336 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2337
2338 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2339 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2340 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2341 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2342 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2343 @var{directory} to the search path.
2344 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2345 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2346
2347 @kindex show paths
2348 @item show paths
2349 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2350 environment variable).
2351
2352 @kindex show environment
2353 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2354 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2355 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2356 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2357 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2358
2359 @kindex set environment
2360 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2361 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2362 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2363 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2364 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2365 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2366 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2367 null value.
2368 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2369 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2370
2371 For example, this command:
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 set env USER = foo
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2379 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2380 are not actually required.)
2381
2382 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2383 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2384 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2385 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2386 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2387
2388 @kindex unset environment
2389 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2390 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2391 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2392 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2393 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2394 @end table
2395
2396 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2397 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2398 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2399 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2400 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2401 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2402 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2403 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2404 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2405 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2406
2407 @node Working Directory
2408 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2409
2410 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2411 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2412 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2413 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2414 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2415 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2416
2417 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2418 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2419 Specify Files}.
2420
2421 @table @code
2422 @kindex cd
2423 @cindex change working directory
2424 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2425 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2426 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2427
2428 @kindex pwd
2429 @item pwd
2430 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2434 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2435 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2436 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2437 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2438 current working directory of the debuggee.
2439
2440 @node Input/Output
2441 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2442
2443 @cindex redirection
2444 @cindex i/o
2445 @cindex terminal
2446 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2447 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2448 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2449 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2450 running your program.
2451
2452 @table @code
2453 @kindex info terminal
2454 @item info terminal
2455 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2456 program is using.
2457 @end table
2458
2459 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2460 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2461
2462 @smallexample
2463 run > outfile
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2468
2469 @kindex tty
2470 @cindex controlling terminal
2471 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2472 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2473 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2474 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2475 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2476
2477 @smallexample
2478 tty /dev/ttyb
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2483 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2484 that as their controlling terminal.
2485
2486 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2487 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2488 terminal.
2489
2490 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2491 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2492 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2493 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2494
2495 @cindex inferior tty
2496 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2497 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2498 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2499 program.
2500
2501 @table @code
2502 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2503 @kindex set inferior-tty
2504 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2505
2506 @item show inferior-tty
2507 @kindex show inferior-tty
2508 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2509 @end table
2510
2511 @node Attach
2512 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2513 @kindex attach
2514 @cindex attach
2515
2516 @table @code
2517 @item attach @var{process-id}
2518 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2519 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2520 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2521 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2522 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2523
2524 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2525 executing the command.
2526 @end table
2527
2528 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2529 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2530 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2531 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2532
2533 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2534 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2535 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2536 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2537 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2538 Specify Files}.
2539
2540 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2541 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2542 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2543 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2544 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2545 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2546 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2547
2548 @table @code
2549 @kindex detach
2550 @item detach
2551 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2552 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2553 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2554 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2555 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2556 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2557 executing the command.
2558 @end table
2559
2560 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2561 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2562 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2563 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2564 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2565 Messages}).
2566
2567 @node Kill Process
2568 @section Killing the Child Process
2569
2570 @table @code
2571 @kindex kill
2572 @item kill
2573 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2574 @end table
2575
2576 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2577 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2578 is running.
2579
2580 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2581 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2582 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2583 outside the debugger.
2584
2585 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2586 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2587 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2588 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2589 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2590 breakpoint settings).
2591
2592 @node Inferiors and Programs
2593 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2594
2595 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2596 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2597 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2598 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2599 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2600 from multiple executables.
2601
2602 @cindex inferior
2603 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2604 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2605 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2606 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2607 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2608 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2609 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2610 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2611 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2612 threads running in it.
2613
2614 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2615 inferiors}}:
2616
2617 @table @code
2618 @kindex info inferiors
2619 @item info inferiors
2620 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2621
2622 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2623
2624 @enumerate
2625 @item
2626 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2627
2628 @item
2629 the target system's inferior identifier
2630
2631 @item
2632 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2633
2634 @end enumerate
2635
2636 @noindent
2637 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2638 indicates the current inferior.
2639
2640 For example,
2641 @end table
2642 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2643
2644 @smallexample
2645 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2646 Num Description Executable
2647 2 process 2307 hello
2648 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2649 @end smallexample
2650
2651 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2652
2653 @table @code
2654 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2655 @item inferior @var{infno}
2656 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2657 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2658 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2659 @end table
2660
2661
2662 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2663 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2664 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2665 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2666 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2667 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex add-inferior
2671 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2672 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2673 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2674 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2675 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2676 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2677
2678 @kindex clone-inferior
2679 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2680 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2681 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2682 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2683 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2684
2685 @smallexample
2686 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2687 Num Description Executable
2688 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2689 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2690 Added inferior 2.
2691 1 inferiors added.
2692 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2693 Num Description Executable
2694 2 <null> helloworld
2695 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2696 @end smallexample
2697
2698 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2699
2700 @kindex remove-inferiors
2701 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2702 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2703 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2704 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2705
2706 @end table
2707
2708 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2709 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2710 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2711 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2712
2713 @table @code
2714 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2715 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2716 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2717 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2718 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2719 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2720
2721 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2722 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2723 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2724 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2725 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2726 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2727 @end table
2728
2729 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2730 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2731 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2732 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2733
2734
2735 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2736 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2737
2738 @table @code
2739 @kindex set print inferior-events
2740 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2741 @item set print inferior-events
2742 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2743 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2744 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2745 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2746 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2747 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2748
2749 @kindex show print inferior-events
2750 @item show print inferior-events
2751 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2752 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2753 @end table
2754
2755 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2756 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2757 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2758
2759
2760 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2761 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2762 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2763 info program-spaces}} command.
2764
2765 @table @code
2766 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2767 @item maint info program-spaces
2768 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2769 @value{GDBN}.
2770
2771 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2772
2773 @enumerate
2774 @item
2775 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2776
2777 @item
2778 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2779 the @code{file} command.
2780
2781 @end enumerate
2782
2783 @noindent
2784 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2785 indicates the current program space.
2786
2787 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2788 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2789 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2790
2791 @smallexample
2792 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2793 Id Executable
2794 2 goodbye
2795 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2796 * 1 hello
2797 @end smallexample
2798
2799 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2800 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2801 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2802 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2803 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2804
2805 @smallexample
2806 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2807 Id Executable
2808 * 1 vfork-test
2809 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2810 @end smallexample
2811
2812 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2813 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2814 @end table
2815
2816 @node Threads
2817 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2818
2819 @cindex threads of execution
2820 @cindex multiple threads
2821 @cindex switching threads
2822 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2823 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2824 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2825 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2826 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2827 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2828 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2829
2830 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2831 programs:
2832
2833 @itemize @bullet
2834 @item automatic notification of new threads
2835 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2836 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2837 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2838 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2839 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2840 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2841 messages on thread start and exit.
2842 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2843 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2844 isn't compatible with the program.
2845 @end itemize
2846
2847 @quotation
2848 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2849 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2850 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2851 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2852 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2853 like this:
2854
2855 @smallexample
2856 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2857 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2858 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2859 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2860 @end smallexample
2861 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2862 @c doesn't support threads"?
2863 @end quotation
2864
2865 @cindex focus of debugging
2866 @cindex current thread
2867 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2868 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2869 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2870 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2871 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2872
2873 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2874 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2875 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2876 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2877 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2878 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2879 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2880 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2881 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2882 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2883
2884 @smallexample
2885 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2886 @end smallexample
2887
2888 @noindent
2889 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2890 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2891 further qualifier.
2892
2893 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2894 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2895 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2896 @c program?
2897 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2898 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2899 @c threads ab initio?
2900
2901 @cindex thread number
2902 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2903 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2904 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2905
2906 @table @code
2907 @kindex info threads
2908 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2909 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2910 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2911 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2912 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2913
2914 @enumerate
2915 @item
2916 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2917
2918 @item
2919 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2920
2921 @item
2922 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2923 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2924 program itself.
2925
2926 @item
2927 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2928 @end enumerate
2929
2930 @noindent
2931 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2932 indicates the current thread.
2933
2934 For example,
2935 @end table
2936 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2937
2938 @smallexample
2939 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2940 Id Target Id Frame
2941 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2942 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2943 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2944 at threadtest.c:68
2945 @end smallexample
2946
2947 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2948 Solaris-specific command:
2949
2950 @table @code
2951 @item maint info sol-threads
2952 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2953 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2954 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2955 @end table
2956
2957 @table @code
2958 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2959 @item thread @var{threadno}
2960 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2961 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2962 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2963 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2964 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2965
2966 @smallexample
2967 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2968 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2969 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2970 8 printf ("hello\n");
2971 @end smallexample
2972
2973 @noindent
2974 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2975 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2976 threads.
2977
2978 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2979 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2980 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2981 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2982 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2983 information on convenience variables.
2984
2985 @kindex thread apply
2986 @cindex apply command to several threads
2987 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
2988 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2989 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2990 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2991 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2992 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2993 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply
2994 a command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
2995 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
2996 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
2997
2998
2999 @kindex thread name
3000 @cindex name a thread
3001 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3002 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3003 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3004 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3005
3006 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3007 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3008 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3009 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3010 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3011
3012 @kindex thread find
3013 @cindex search for a thread
3014 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3015 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3016 matches the supplied regular expression.
3017
3018 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3019 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3020 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3021 is the LWP id.
3022
3023 @smallexample
3024 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3025 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3026 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3027 Id Target Id Frame
3028 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3029 @end smallexample
3030
3031 @kindex set print thread-events
3032 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3033 @item set print thread-events
3034 @itemx set print thread-events on
3035 @itemx set print thread-events off
3036 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3037 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3038 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3039 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3040 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3041
3042 @kindex show print thread-events
3043 @item show print thread-events
3044 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3045 have started and exited.
3046 @end table
3047
3048 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3049 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3050 programs with multiple threads.
3051
3052 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3053 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3054
3055 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3056 @table @code
3057 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3058 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3059 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3060 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3061 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3062 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3063 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3064 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3065 macro.
3066
3067 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3068 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3069 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3070 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3071 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3072 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3073
3074 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3075 refers to the default system directories that are
3076 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3077 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3078 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3079
3080 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3081 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3082 was loaded in the inferior process.
3083
3084 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3085 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3086 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3087 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3088 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3089 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3090 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3091
3092 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3093 only on some platforms.
3094
3095 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3096 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3097 Display current libthread_db search path.
3098
3099 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3100 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3101 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3102 @item set debug libthread-db
3103 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3104 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3105 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3106 @end table
3107
3108 @node Forks
3109 @section Debugging Forks
3110
3111 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3112 @cindex multiple processes
3113 @cindex processes, multiple
3114 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3115 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3116 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3117 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3118 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3119 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3120 will cause it to terminate.
3121
3122 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3123 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3124 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3125 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3126 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3127 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3128 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3129 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3130 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3131 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3132
3133 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3134 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3135 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3136 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3137
3138 The fork debugging commands are supported in both native mode and when
3139 connected to @code{gdbserver} using @kbd{target extended-remote}.
3140
3141 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3142 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3143
3144 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3145 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3146
3147 @table @code
3148 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3149 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3150 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3151 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3152 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3153
3154 @table @code
3155 @item parent
3156 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3157 unimpeded. This is the default.
3158
3159 @item child
3160 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3161 unimpeded.
3162
3163 @end table
3164
3165 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3166 @item show follow-fork-mode
3167 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3168 @end table
3169
3170 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3171 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3172 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3173
3174 @table @code
3175 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3176 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3177 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3178 retain debugger control over them both.
3179
3180 @table @code
3181 @item on
3182 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3183 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3184 independently. This is the default.
3185
3186 @item off
3187 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3188 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3189 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3190 is held suspended.
3191
3192 @end table
3193
3194 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3195 @item show detach-on-fork
3196 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3197 @end table
3198
3199 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3200 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3201 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3202 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3203 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3204 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3205
3206 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3207 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3208 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3209 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3210 and Programs}.
3211
3212 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3213 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3214 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3215 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3216 the child process's @code{main}.
3217
3218 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3219 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3220
3221 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3222 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3223 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3224 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3225 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3226 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3227 command.
3228
3229 @table @code
3230 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3231 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3232
3233 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3234 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3235
3236 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3237
3238 @table @code
3239 @item new
3240 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3241 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3242 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3243 original inferior.
3244
3245 For example:
3246
3247 @smallexample
3248 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3249 (gdb) info inferior
3250 Id Description Executable
3251 * 1 <null> prog1
3252 (@value{GDBP}) run
3253 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3254 Program exited normally.
3255 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3256 Id Description Executable
3257 * 2 <null> prog2
3258 1 <null> prog1
3259 @end smallexample
3260
3261 @item same
3262 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3263 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3264 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3265 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3266 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3267
3268 For example:
3269
3270 @smallexample
3271 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3272 Id Description Executable
3273 * 1 <null> prog1
3274 (@value{GDBP}) run
3275 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3276 Program exited normally.
3277 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3278 Id Description Executable
3279 * 1 <null> prog2
3280 @end smallexample
3281
3282 @end table
3283 @end table
3284
3285 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3286 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3287 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3288
3289 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3290 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3291
3292 @cindex checkpoint
3293 @cindex restart
3294 @cindex bookmark
3295 @cindex snapshot of a process
3296 @cindex rewind program state
3297
3298 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3299 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3300 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3301 later.
3302
3303 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3304 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3305 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3306 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3307 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3308
3309 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3310 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3311 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3312 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3313 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3314 start again from there.
3315
3316 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3317 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3318
3319 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3320
3321 @table @code
3322 @kindex checkpoint
3323 @item checkpoint
3324 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3325 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3326 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3327
3328 @kindex info checkpoints
3329 @item info checkpoints
3330 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3331 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3332 listed:
3333
3334 @table @code
3335 @item Checkpoint ID
3336 @item Process ID
3337 @item Code Address
3338 @item Source line, or label
3339 @end table
3340
3341 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3342 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3343 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3344 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3345 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3346 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3347 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3348
3349 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3350 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3351 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3352 the debugger.
3353
3354 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3355 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3356 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3357
3358 @end table
3359
3360 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3361 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3362 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3363 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3364 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3365 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3366 previously read data can be read again.
3367
3368 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3369 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3370 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3371 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3372 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3373 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3374
3375 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3376 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3377 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3378 different execution path this time.
3379
3380 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3381 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3382 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3383 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3384 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3385 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3386 potentially pose a problem.
3387
3388 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3389
3390 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3391 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3392 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3393 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3394 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3395 next.
3396
3397 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3398 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3399 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3400 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3401 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3402
3403 @node Stopping
3404 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3405
3406 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3407 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3408 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3409
3410 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3411 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3412 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3413 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3414 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3415 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3416 explicitly request this information at any time.
3417
3418 @table @code
3419 @kindex info program
3420 @item info program
3421 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3422 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3423 @end table
3424
3425 @menu
3426 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3427 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3428 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3429 Skipping over functions and files
3430 * Signals:: Signals
3431 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3432 @end menu
3433
3434 @node Breakpoints
3435 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3436
3437 @cindex breakpoints
3438 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3439 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3440 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3441 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3442 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3443 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3444 program.
3445
3446 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3447 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3448 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3449 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3450 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3451 call).
3452
3453 @cindex watchpoints
3454 @cindex data breakpoints
3455 @cindex memory tracing
3456 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3457 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3458 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3459 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3460 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3461 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3462 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3463 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3464 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3465 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3466 same commands.
3467
3468 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3469 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3470 Automatic Display}.
3471
3472 @cindex catchpoints
3473 @cindex breakpoint on events
3474 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3475 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3476 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3477 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3478 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3479 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3480 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3481
3482 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3483 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3484 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3485 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3486 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3487 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3488 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3489 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3490 enable it again.
3491
3492 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3493 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3494 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3495 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3496 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3497 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3498 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3499
3500 @menu
3501 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3502 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3503 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3504 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3505 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3506 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3507 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3508 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3509 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3510 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3511 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3512 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3513 @end menu
3514
3515 @node Set Breaks
3516 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3517
3518 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3519 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3520 @c
3521 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3522
3523 @kindex break
3524 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3525 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3526 @cindex latest breakpoint
3527 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3528 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3529 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3530 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3531 convenience variables.
3532
3533 @table @code
3534 @item break @var{location}
3535 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3536 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3537 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3538 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3539 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3540
3541 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3542 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3543 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3544 that situation.
3545
3546 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3547 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3548 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3549
3550 @item break
3551 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3552 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3553 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3554 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3555 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3556 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3557 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3558 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3559 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3560 inside loops.
3561
3562 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3563 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3564 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3565 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3566 existed when your program stopped.
3567
3568 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3569 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3570 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3571 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3572 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3573 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3574 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3575
3576 @kindex tbreak
3577 @item tbreak @var{args}
3578 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3579 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3580 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3581 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3582
3583 @kindex hbreak
3584 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3585 @item hbreak @var{args}
3586 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3587 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3588 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3589 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3590 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3591 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3592 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3593 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3594 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3595 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3596 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3597 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3598 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3599 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3600 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3601 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3602 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3603 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3604
3605 @kindex thbreak
3606 @item thbreak @var{args}
3607 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3608 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3609 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3610 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3611 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3612 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3613 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3614 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3615
3616 @kindex rbreak
3617 @cindex regular expression
3618 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3619 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3620 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3621 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3622 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3623 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3624 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3625 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3626 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3627
3628 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3629 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3630 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3631 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3632 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3633 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3634
3635 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3636 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3637 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3638 classes.
3639
3640 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3641 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3642 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3643
3644 @smallexample
3645 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3646 @end smallexample
3647
3648 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3649 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3650 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3651 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3652 every function in a given file:
3653
3654 @smallexample
3655 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3656 @end smallexample
3657
3658 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3659 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3660
3661 @kindex info breakpoints
3662 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3663 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3664 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3665 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3666 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3667 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3668 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3669
3670 @table @emph
3671 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3672 @item Type
3673 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3674 @item Disposition
3675 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3676 @item Enabled or Disabled
3677 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3678 that are not enabled.
3679 @item Address
3680 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3681 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3682 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3683 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3684 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3685 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3686 @item What
3687 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3688 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3689 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3690 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3691 @end table
3692
3693 @noindent
3694 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3695 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3696 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3697 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3698 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3699 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3700
3701 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3702 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3703 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3704 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3705
3706 @noindent
3707 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3708 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3709 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3710 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3711 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3712
3713 @noindent
3714 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3715 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3716 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3717 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3718 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3719 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3720
3721 @noindent
3722 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3723 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3724
3725 @end table
3726
3727 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3728 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3729 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3730 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3731
3732 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3733 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3734 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3735 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3736
3737 @itemize @bullet
3738 @item
3739 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3740
3741 @item
3742 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3743 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3744
3745 @item
3746 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3747 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3748
3749 @item
3750 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3751 several places where that function is inlined.
3752 @end itemize
3753
3754 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3755 the relevant locations.
3756
3757 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3758 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3759 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3760 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3761 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3762 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3763 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3764
3765 For example:
3766
3767 @smallexample
3768 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3769 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3770 stop only if i==1
3771 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3772 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3773 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3774 @end smallexample
3775
3776 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3777 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3778 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3779 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3780 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3781 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3782 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3783 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3784 that belong to that breakpoint.
3785
3786 @cindex pending breakpoints
3787 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3788 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3789 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3790 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3791 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3792 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3793 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3794 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3795 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3796 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3797 is not yet resolved.
3798
3799 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3800 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3801 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3802 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3803 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3804 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3805
3806 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3807 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3808 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3809 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3810
3811 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3812 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3813 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3814
3815 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3816 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3817 address specification to an address:
3818
3819 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3820 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3821 @table @code
3822 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3823 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3824 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3825
3826 @item set breakpoint pending on
3827 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3828 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3829
3830 @item set breakpoint pending off
3831 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3832 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3833 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3834
3835 @item show breakpoint pending
3836 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3837 @end table
3838
3839 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3840 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3841 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3842
3843 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3844 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3845 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3846 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3847 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3848 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3849 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3850 breakpoints.
3851
3852 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3853
3854 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3855 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3856 @table @code
3857 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3858 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3859 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3860 breakpoint must be used.
3861
3862 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3863 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3864 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3865 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3866 @end table
3867
3868 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3869 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3870 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3871 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3872 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3873 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3874 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3875 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3876 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3877
3878 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3879 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3880 @table @code
3881 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3882 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3883 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3884 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3885
3886 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3887 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3888 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3889 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3890 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3891 @end table
3892
3893 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3894 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3895 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3896
3897 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3898 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3899
3900 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3901
3902 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3903 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3904 @table @code
3905 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3906 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3907 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3908 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3909 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3910
3911 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3912 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3913 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3914 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3915 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3916 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3917 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3918 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3919 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3920 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3921 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3922 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3923 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3924
3925 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3926 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3927 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3928 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3929 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3930 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3931 @end table
3932
3933
3934 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3935 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3936 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3937 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3938 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3939 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3940 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3941 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3942
3943
3944 @node Set Watchpoints
3945 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3946
3947 @cindex setting watchpoints
3948 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3949 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3950 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3951 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3952 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3953
3954 @itemize @bullet
3955 @item
3956 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3957
3958 @item
3959 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3960 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3961 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3962
3963 @item
3964 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3965 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3966 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3967 @end itemize
3968
3969 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3970 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3971 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3972 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3973 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3974 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3975 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3976 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3977 the expression changes.
3978
3979 @cindex software watchpoints
3980 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3981 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3982 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3983 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3984 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3985 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3986 culprit.)
3987
3988 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3989 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3990 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3991
3992 @table @code
3993 @kindex watch
3994 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3995 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3996 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3997 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3998 to watch the value of a single variable:
3999
4000 @smallexample
4001 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4002 @end smallexample
4003
4004 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
4005 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4006 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4007 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4008 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4009 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4010
4011 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4012 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4013 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4014 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4015 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4016 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4017 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4018 error.
4019
4020 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4021 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4022 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4023 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4024 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4025 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4026 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4027 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4028 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4029 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4030 Examples:
4031
4032 @smallexample
4033 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4034 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4035 @end smallexample
4036
4037 @kindex rwatch
4038 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4039 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4040 by the program.
4041
4042 @kindex awatch
4043 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4044 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4045 or written into by the program.
4046
4047 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4048 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4049 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4050 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4051 @end table
4052
4053 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4054 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4055 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4056 a never-changing value:
4057
4058 @smallexample
4059 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4060 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4061 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4062 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4063 @end smallexample
4064
4065 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4066 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4067 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4068 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4069 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4070 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4071
4072 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4073 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4074 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4075 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4076 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4077 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4078 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4079 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4080
4081 @table @code
4082 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4083 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4084 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4085
4086 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4087 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4088 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4089 @end table
4090
4091 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4092 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4093 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4094
4095 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4096
4097 @smallexample
4098 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4099 @end smallexample
4100
4101 @noindent
4102 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4103
4104 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4105 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4106 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4107 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4108 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4109 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4110 will print a message like this:
4111
4112 @smallexample
4113 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4114 @end smallexample
4115
4116 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4117 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4118 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4119 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4120 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4121 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4122 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4123 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4124
4125 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4126 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4127 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4128 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4129 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4130 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4131
4132 @smallexample
4133 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4134 @end smallexample
4135
4136 @noindent
4137 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4138
4139 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4140 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4141 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4142 expression with separately allocated resources.
4143
4144 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4145 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4146 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4147
4148 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4149 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4150 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4151 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4152 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4153 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4154 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4155 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4156 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4157
4158 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4159 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4160 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4161 watched expression from every thread.
4162
4163 @quotation
4164 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4165 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4166 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4167 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4168 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4169 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4170 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4171 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4172 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4173 @end quotation
4174
4175 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4176
4177 @node Set Catchpoints
4178 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4179 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4180 @cindex exception handlers
4181 @cindex event handling
4182
4183 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4184 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4185 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4186
4187 @table @code
4188 @kindex catch
4189 @item catch @var{event}
4190 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4191
4192 @table @code
4193 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4194 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4195 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4196 @kindex catch throw
4197 @kindex catch rethrow
4198 @kindex catch catch
4199 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4200 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4201
4202 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4203 regular expression will be caught.
4204
4205 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4206 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4207 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4208 exception being thrown.
4209
4210 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4211 @value{GDBN}:
4212
4213 @itemize @bullet
4214 @item
4215 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4216 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4217 supported.
4218
4219 @item
4220 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4221 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4222 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4223 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4224 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4225 built.
4226
4227 @item
4228 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4229 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4230
4231 @item
4232 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4233 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4234 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4235 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4236
4237 @item
4238 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4239 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4240 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4241 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4242 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4243 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4244 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4245 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4246 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4247
4248 @item
4249 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4250
4251 @item
4252 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4253 @end itemize
4254
4255 @item exception
4256 @kindex catch exception
4257 @cindex Ada exception catching
4258 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4259 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4260 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4261 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4262 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4263
4264 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4265 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4266 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4267 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4268 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4269 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4270 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4271 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4272
4273 @item exception unhandled
4274 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4275 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4276
4277 @item assert
4278 @kindex catch assert
4279 A failed Ada assertion.
4280
4281 @item exec
4282 @kindex catch exec
4283 @cindex break on fork/exec
4284 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4285 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4286
4287 @item syscall
4288 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4289 @kindex catch syscall
4290 @cindex break on a system call.
4291 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4292 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4293 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4294 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4295 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4296 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4297 will be caught.
4298
4299 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4300 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4301 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4302 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4303
4304 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4305 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4306 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4307 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4308
4309 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4310 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4311 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4312 available choices.
4313
4314 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4315 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4316 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4317 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4318 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4319 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4320 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4321 behind the OS upgrades).
4322
4323 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4324 arguments to it:
4325
4326 @smallexample
4327 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4328 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4329 (@value{GDBP}) r
4330 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4331
4332 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4333 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4334 (@value{GDBP}) c
4335 Continuing.
4336
4337 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4338 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4339 (@value{GDBP})
4340 @end smallexample
4341
4342 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4343
4344 @smallexample
4345 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4346 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4347 (@value{GDBP}) r
4348 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4349
4350 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4351 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4352 (@value{GDBP}) c
4353 Continuing.
4354
4355 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4356 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4357 (@value{GDBP})
4358 @end smallexample
4359
4360 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4361 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4362 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4363
4364 @smallexample
4365 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4366 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4367 (@value{GDBP}) r
4368 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4369
4370 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4371 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4372 (@value{GDBP}) c
4373 Continuing.
4374
4375 Program exited normally.
4376 (@value{GDBP})
4377 @end smallexample
4378
4379 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4380 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4381 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4382 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4383
4384 @smallexample
4385 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4386 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4387 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4388 (@value{GDBP})
4389 @end smallexample
4390
4391 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4392 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4393 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4394 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4395 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4396 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4397
4398 @smallexample
4399 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4400 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4401 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4402 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4403 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4404 (@value{GDBP})
4405 @end smallexample
4406
4407 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4408
4409 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4410 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4411
4412 @smallexample
4413 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4414 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4415 @end smallexample
4416
4417 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4418
4419 @item fork
4420 @kindex catch fork
4421 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4422 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4423
4424 @item vfork
4425 @kindex catch vfork
4426 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4427 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4428
4429 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4430 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4431 @kindex catch load
4432 @kindex catch unload
4433 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4434 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4435 matches one of the affected libraries.
4436
4437 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4438 @kindex catch signal
4439 The delivery of a signal.
4440
4441 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4442 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4443 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4444
4445 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4446 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4447 signal names.
4448
4449 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4450 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4451 will be caught.
4452
4453 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4454 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4455 catchpoint.
4456
4457 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4458 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4459 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4460 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4461 commands.
4462
4463 @end table
4464
4465 @item tcatch @var{event}
4466 @kindex tcatch
4467 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4468 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4469
4470 @end table
4471
4472 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4473
4474
4475 @node Delete Breaks
4476 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4477
4478 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4479 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4480 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4481 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4482 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4483 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4484
4485 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4486 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4487 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4488 their breakpoint numbers.
4489
4490 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4491 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4492 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4493
4494 @table @code
4495 @kindex clear
4496 @item clear
4497 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4498 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4499 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4500 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4501
4502 @item clear @var{location}
4503 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4504 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4505 most useful ones are listed below:
4506
4507 @table @code
4508 @item clear @var{function}
4509 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4510 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4511
4512 @item clear @var{linenum}
4513 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4514 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4515 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4516 @end table
4517
4518 @cindex delete breakpoints
4519 @kindex delete
4520 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4521 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4522 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4523 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4524 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4525 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4526 @end table
4527
4528 @node Disabling
4529 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4530
4531 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4532 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4533 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4534 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4535 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4536
4537 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4538 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4539 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4540 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4541 do not know which numbers to use.
4542
4543 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4544 affects all of its locations.
4545
4546 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4547 different states of enablement:
4548
4549 @itemize @bullet
4550 @item
4551 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4552 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4553 @item
4554 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4555 @item
4556 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4557 disabled.
4558 @item
4559 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4560 N times, then becomes disabled.
4561 @item
4562 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4563 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4564 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4565 @end itemize
4566
4567 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4568 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4569
4570 @table @code
4571 @kindex disable
4572 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4573 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4574 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4575 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4576 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4577 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4578 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4579
4580 @kindex enable
4581 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4582 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4583 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4584
4585 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4586 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4587 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4588
4589 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4590 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4591 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4592 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4593 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4594 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4595 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4596
4597 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4598 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4599 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4600 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4601 @end table
4602
4603 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4604 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4605 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4606 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4607 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4608 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4609 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4610 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4611 Stepping}.)
4612
4613 @node Conditions
4614 @subsection Break Conditions
4615 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4616 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4617
4618 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4619 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4620 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4621 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4622 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4623 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4624 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4625 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4626
4627 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4628 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4629 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4630 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4631 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4632
4633 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4634 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4635 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4636 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4637 one.
4638
4639 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4640 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4641 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4642 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4643 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4644 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4645 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4646 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4647 conditions for the
4648 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4649 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4650
4651 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4652 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4653 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4654 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4655 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4656 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4657
4658 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4659 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4660 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4661 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4662 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4663
4664 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4665 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4666 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4667 with the @code{condition} command.
4668
4669 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4670 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4671 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4672 catchpoint.
4673
4674 @table @code
4675 @kindex condition
4676 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4677 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4678 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4679 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4680 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4681 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4682 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4683 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4684 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4685 prints an error message:
4686
4687 @smallexample
4688 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4689 @end smallexample
4690
4691 @noindent
4692 @value{GDBN} does
4693 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4694 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4695 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4696
4697 @item condition @var{bnum}
4698 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4699 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4700 @end table
4701
4702 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4703 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4704 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4705 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4706 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4707 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4708 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4709 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4710 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4711 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4712 your program reaches it.
4713
4714 @table @code
4715 @kindex ignore
4716 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4717 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4718 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4719 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4720 takes no action.
4721
4722 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4723 a count of zero.
4724
4725 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4726 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4727 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4728 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4729
4730 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4731 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4732 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4733
4734 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4735 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4736 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4737 Variables}.
4738 @end table
4739
4740 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4741
4742
4743 @node Break Commands
4744 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4745
4746 @cindex breakpoint commands
4747 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4748 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4749 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4750 enable other breakpoints.
4751
4752 @table @code
4753 @kindex commands
4754 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4755 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4756 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4757 @itemx end
4758 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4759 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4760 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4761
4762 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4763 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4764
4765 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4766 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4767 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4768 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4769 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4770 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4771 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4772 Expressions}).
4773 @end table
4774
4775 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4776 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4777
4778 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4779 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4780 that resumes execution.
4781
4782 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4783 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4784 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4785 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4786 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4787
4788 @kindex silent
4789 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4790 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4791 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4792 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4793 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4794 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4795
4796 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4797 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4798 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4799
4800 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4801 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4802
4803 @smallexample
4804 break foo if x>0
4805 commands
4806 silent
4807 printf "x is %d\n",x
4808 cont
4809 end
4810 @end smallexample
4811
4812 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4813 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4814 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4815 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4816 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4817 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4818 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4819
4820 @smallexample
4821 break 403
4822 commands
4823 silent
4824 set x = y + 4
4825 cont
4826 end
4827 @end smallexample
4828
4829 @node Dynamic Printf
4830 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4831
4832 @cindex dynamic printf
4833 @cindex dprintf
4834 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4835 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4836 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4837 having to recompile it.
4838
4839 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4840 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4841 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4842 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4843 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4844 redirects to files and so forth.
4845
4846 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4847 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4848 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4849 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4850 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4851 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4852 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4853
4854 @table @code
4855 @kindex dprintf
4856 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4857 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4858 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4859 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4860
4861 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4862 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4863 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4864 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4865 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4866 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4867
4868 @item gdb
4869 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4870 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4871
4872 @item call
4873 @kindex dprintf-style call
4874 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4875 @code{printf}).
4876
4877 @item agent
4878 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4879 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4880 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4881 support running commands on the target.
4882
4883 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4884 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4885 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4886 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4887 command.
4888
4889 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4890 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4891 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4892 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4893 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4894 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4895
4896 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4897 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4898 you could do the following:
4899
4900 @example
4901 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4902 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4903 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4904 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4905 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4906 (gdb) info break
4907 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4908 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4909 continue
4910 (gdb)
4911 @end example
4912
4913 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4914 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4915 the variable settings.
4916
4917 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4918 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4919 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4920 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4921 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4922 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4923
4924 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4925 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4926 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4927
4928 @end table
4929
4930 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4931 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4932 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4933 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4934 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4935 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4936
4937 @node Save Breakpoints
4938 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4939
4940 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4941 breakpoints}} command.
4942
4943 @table @code
4944 @kindex save breakpoints
4945 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4946 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4947 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4948 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4949 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4950 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4951 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4952 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4953 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4954 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4955 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4956 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4957 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4958 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4959 that can no longer be recreated.
4960 @end table
4961
4962 @node Static Probe Points
4963 @subsection Static Probe Points
4964
4965 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4966 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
4967 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4968 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4969 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
4970
4971 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
4972 ELF-compatible systems:
4973
4974 @itemize @bullet
4975
4976 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4977 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
4978 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4979 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
4980 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
4981 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
4982 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4983 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
4984
4985 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
4986 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
4987 C@t{++} languages.
4988 @end itemize
4989
4990 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4991 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
4992 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
4993 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
4994 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
4995 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
4996 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
4997 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
4998 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
4999
5000 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5001 probes}, with optional arguments:
5002
5003 @table @code
5004 @kindex info probes
5005 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5006 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5007 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5008 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5009
5010 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5011 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5012 probes from all providers are listed.
5013
5014 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5015 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5016 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5017
5018 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5019 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5020 given, all object files are considered.
5021
5022 @item info probes all
5023 List the available static probes, from all types.
5024 @end table
5025
5026 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5027 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5028 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5029 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5030 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5031
5032 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5033 commands, with optional arguments:
5034
5035 @table @code
5036 @kindex enable probes
5037 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5038 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5039 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5040 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5041
5042 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5043 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5044 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5045
5046 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5047 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5048 given, all object files are considered.
5049
5050 @kindex disable probes
5051 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5052 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5053 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5054 @end table
5055
5056 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5057 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5058 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5059 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5060 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5061 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5062 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5063 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5064 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5065 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5066 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5067 at the current probe point.
5068
5069 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5070 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5071 an error message.
5072
5073
5074 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5075 @node Error in Breakpoints
5076 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5077
5078 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5079 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5080
5081 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5082 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5083 @smallexample
5084 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5085 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5086 @end smallexample
5087
5088 @noindent
5089 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5090 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5091 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5092
5093 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5094 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5095
5096 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5097 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5098 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5099
5100 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5101 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5102 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5103 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5104
5105 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5106 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5107 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5108 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5109 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5110 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5111 first in the bundle.
5112
5113 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5114 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5115 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5116 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5117 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5118 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5119 is hit.
5120
5121 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5122 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5123
5124 @smallexample
5125 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5126 @end smallexample
5127
5128 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5129 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5130 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5131 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5132 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5133 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5134 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5135 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5136
5137 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5138 adjusted breakpoints:
5139
5140 @smallexample
5141 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5142 to 0x00010410.
5143 @end smallexample
5144
5145 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5146 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5147 frequently than expected.
5148
5149 @node Continuing and Stepping
5150 @section Continuing and Stepping
5151
5152 @cindex stepping
5153 @cindex continuing
5154 @cindex resuming execution
5155 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5156 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5157 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5158 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5159 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5160 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5161 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5162 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5163 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5164 handlers}).)
5165
5166 @table @code
5167 @kindex continue
5168 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5169 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5170 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5171 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5172 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5173 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5174 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5175 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5176 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5177 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5178
5179 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5180 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5181 @code{continue} is ignored.
5182
5183 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5184 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5185 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5186 @code{continue}.
5187 @end table
5188
5189 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5190 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5191 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5192 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5193
5194 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5195 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5196 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5197 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5198 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5199 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5200
5201 @table @code
5202 @kindex step
5203 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5204 @item step
5205 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5206 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5207 abbreviated @code{s}.
5208
5209 @quotation
5210 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5211 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5212 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5213 @c distinction here.
5214 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5215 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5216 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5217 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5218 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5219 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5220 below.
5221 @end quotation
5222
5223 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5224 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5225 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5226 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5227 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5228 called within the line.
5229
5230 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5231 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5232 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5233 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5234 was any debugging information about the routine.
5235
5236 @item step @var{count}
5237 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5238 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5239 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5240
5241 @kindex next
5242 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5243 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5244 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5245 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5246 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5247 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5248 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5249 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5250
5251 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5252
5253
5254 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5255 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5256 @c
5257 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5258 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5259 @c function are executed without stopping.
5260
5261 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5262 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5263 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5264
5265 @kindex set step-mode
5266 @item set step-mode
5267 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5268 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5269 @itemx set step-mode on
5270 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5271 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5272 information rather than stepping over it.
5273
5274 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5275 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5276 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5277
5278 @item set step-mode off
5279 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5280 debug information. This is the default.
5281
5282 @item show step-mode
5283 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5284 source line debug information.
5285
5286 @kindex finish
5287 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5288 @item finish
5289 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5290 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5291 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5292
5293 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5294 ,Returning from a Function}).
5295
5296 @kindex until
5297 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5298 @cindex run until specified location
5299 @item until
5300 @itemx u
5301 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5302 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5303 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5304 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5305 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5306 than the address of the jump.
5307
5308 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5309 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5310 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5311 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5312 through the next iteration.
5313
5314 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5315 stack frame.
5316
5317 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5318 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5319 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5320 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5321 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5322
5323 @smallexample
5324 (@value{GDBP}) f
5325 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5326 206 expand_input();
5327 (@value{GDBP}) until
5328 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5329 @end smallexample
5330
5331 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5332 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5333 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5334 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5335 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5336 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5337 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5338
5339 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5340 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5341 argument.
5342
5343 @item until @var{location}
5344 @itemx u @var{location}
5345 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5346 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5347 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5348 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5349 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5350 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5351 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5352 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5353 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5354 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5355 invocations have returned.
5356
5357 @smallexample
5358 94 int factorial (int value)
5359 95 @{
5360 96 if (value > 1) @{
5361 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5362 98 @}
5363 99 return (value);
5364 100 @}
5365 @end smallexample
5366
5367
5368 @kindex advance @var{location}
5369 @item advance @var{location}
5370 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5371 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5372 @ref{Specify Location}.
5373 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5374 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5375 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5376 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5377
5378
5379 @kindex stepi
5380 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5381 @item stepi
5382 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5383 @itemx si
5384 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5385
5386 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5387 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5388 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5389 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5390
5391 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5392
5393 @need 750
5394 @kindex nexti
5395 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5396 @item nexti
5397 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5398 @itemx ni
5399 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5400 proceed until the function returns.
5401
5402 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5403
5404 @end table
5405
5406 @anchor{range stepping}
5407 @cindex range stepping
5408 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5409 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5410 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5411 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5412 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5413 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5414 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5415 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5416 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5417 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5418 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5419 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5420 if necessary:
5421
5422 @table @code
5423 @kindex set range-stepping
5424 @kindex show range-stepping
5425 @item set range-stepping
5426 @itemx show range-stepping
5427 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5428
5429 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5430 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5431 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5432 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5433 default is @code{on}.
5434
5435 @end table
5436
5437 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5438 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5439 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5440
5441 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5442 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5443 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5444
5445 For example, consider the following C function:
5446
5447 @smallexample
5448 101 int func()
5449 102 @{
5450 103 foo(boring());
5451 104 bar(boring());
5452 105 @}
5453 @end smallexample
5454
5455 @noindent
5456 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5457 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5458 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5459 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5460
5461 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5462 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5463 is called from many places.
5464
5465 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5466 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5467 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5468 @code{foo}.
5469
5470 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5471 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5472
5473 @table @code
5474 @kindex skip function
5475 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5476 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5477 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5478 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5479 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5480
5481 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5482 will be skipped.
5483
5484 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5485 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5486
5487 @kindex skip file
5488 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5489 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5490 will be skipped over when stepping.
5491
5492 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5493 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5494 @end table
5495
5496 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5497 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5498
5499 @table @code
5500 @kindex info skip
5501 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5502 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5503 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5504 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5505
5506 @table @emph
5507 @item Identifier
5508 A number identifying this skip.
5509 @item Type
5510 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5511 @item Enabled or Disabled
5512 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5513 @item Address
5514 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5515 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5516 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5517 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5518 address here.
5519 @item What
5520 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5521 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5522 where it is defined.
5523 @end table
5524
5525 @kindex skip delete
5526 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5527 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5528 skips.
5529
5530 @kindex skip enable
5531 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5532 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5533 skips.
5534
5535 @kindex skip disable
5536 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5537 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5538 skips.
5539
5540 @end table
5541
5542 @node Signals
5543 @section Signals
5544 @cindex signals
5545
5546 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5547 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5548 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5549 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5550 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5551 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5552 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5553 requested an alarm).
5554
5555 @cindex fatal signals
5556 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5557 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5558 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5559 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5560 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5561 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5562
5563 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5564 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5565 signal.
5566
5567 @cindex handling signals
5568 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5569 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5570 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5571 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5572 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5573
5574 @table @code
5575 @kindex info signals
5576 @kindex info handle
5577 @item info signals
5578 @itemx info handle
5579 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5580 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5581 the defined types of signals.
5582
5583 @item info signals @var{sig}
5584 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5585
5586 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5587
5588 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5589 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5590 for details about this command.
5591
5592 @kindex handle
5593 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5594 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5595 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5596 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5597 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5598 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5599 say what change to make.
5600 @end table
5601
5602 @c @group
5603 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5604 Their full names are:
5605
5606 @table @code
5607 @item nostop
5608 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5609 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5610
5611 @item stop
5612 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5613 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5614
5615 @item print
5616 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5617
5618 @item noprint
5619 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5620 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5621
5622 @item pass
5623 @itemx noignore
5624 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5625 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5626 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5627
5628 @item nopass
5629 @itemx ignore
5630 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5631 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5632 @end table
5633 @c @end group
5634
5635 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5636 program until you
5637 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5638 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5639 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5640 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5641 program sees that signal when you continue.
5642
5643 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5644 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5645 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5646 erroneous signals.
5647
5648 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5649 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5650 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5651 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5652 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5653 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5654 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5655 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5656 Program a Signal}.
5657
5658 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5659 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5660
5661 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5662 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5663 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5664 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5665 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5666 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5667 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5668 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5669 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5670 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5671 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5672 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5673 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5674
5675 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5676
5677 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5678 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5679 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5680 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5681
5682 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5683 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5684 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5685 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5686
5687 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5688 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5689
5690 @smallexample
5691 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5692 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5693 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5694 (@value{GDBP}) c
5695 Continuing.
5696
5697 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5698 main () sigusr1.c:28
5699 28 p = 0;
5700 (@value{GDBP}) si
5701 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5702 9 @{
5703 @end smallexample
5704
5705 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5706 program to receive the signal first:
5707
5708 @smallexample
5709 (@value{GDBP}) n
5710 28 p = 0;
5711 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5712 (@value{GDBP}) si
5713 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5714 9 @{
5715 (@value{GDBP})
5716 @end smallexample
5717
5718 @cindex extra signal information
5719 @anchor{extra signal information}
5720
5721 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5722 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5723 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5724 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5725 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5726 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5727 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5728 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5729 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5730 system header.
5731
5732 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5733 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5734
5735 @smallexample
5736 @group
5737 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5738 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5739 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5740 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5741 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5742 type = struct @{
5743 int si_signo;
5744 int si_errno;
5745 int si_code;
5746 union @{
5747 int _pad[28];
5748 struct @{...@} _kill;
5749 struct @{...@} _timer;
5750 struct @{...@} _rt;
5751 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5752 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5753 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5754 @} _sifields;
5755 @}
5756 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5757 type = struct @{
5758 void *si_addr;
5759 @}
5760 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5761 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5762 @end group
5763 @end smallexample
5764
5765 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5766
5767 @node Thread Stops
5768 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5769
5770 @cindex stopped threads
5771 @cindex threads, stopped
5772
5773 @cindex continuing threads
5774 @cindex threads, continuing
5775
5776 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5777 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5778 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5779 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5780 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5781 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5782 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5783 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5784 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5785
5786 @menu
5787 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5788 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5789 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5790 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5791 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5792 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5793 @end menu
5794
5795 @node All-Stop Mode
5796 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5797
5798 @cindex all-stop mode
5799
5800 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5801 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5802 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5803 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5804 underfoot.
5805
5806 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5807 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5808 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5809
5810 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5811 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5812 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5813 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5814 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5815 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5816 stops.
5817
5818 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5819 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5820 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5821 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5822
5823 @cindex automatic thread selection
5824 @cindex switching threads automatically
5825 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5826 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5827 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5828 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5829 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5830 thread.
5831
5832 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5833 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5834
5835 @table @code
5836 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5837 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5838 @cindex lock scheduler
5839 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5840 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5841 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5842 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5843 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5844 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5845 Other threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
5846 completely free to run when you use commands
5847 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5848 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5849 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5850
5851 @item show scheduler-locking
5852 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5853 @end table
5854
5855 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5856 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5857 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5858 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5859 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5860 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5861 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5862 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5863 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5864 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5865 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5866 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5867 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5868 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5869
5870 @table @code
5871 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5872 @item set schedule-multiple
5873 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5874 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5875 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5876 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5877 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5878 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5879
5880 @item show schedule-multiple
5881 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5882 multiple processes.
5883 @end table
5884
5885 @node Non-Stop Mode
5886 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5887
5888 @cindex non-stop mode
5889
5890 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5891 @c with more details.
5892
5893 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5894 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5895 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5896 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5897 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5898 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5899
5900 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5901 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5902 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5903 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5904 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5905 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5906 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5907 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5908 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5909 independently and simultaneously.
5910
5911 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5912 or attach to your program:
5913
5914 @smallexample
5915 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5916 set pagination off
5917
5918 # Finally, turn it on!
5919 set non-stop on
5920 @end smallexample
5921
5922 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5923
5924 @table @code
5925 @kindex set non-stop
5926 @item set non-stop on
5927 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5928 @item set non-stop off
5929 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5930 @kindex show non-stop
5931 @item show non-stop
5932 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5933 @end table
5934
5935 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5936 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5937 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5938 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5939 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5940 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5941 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5942 default.
5943
5944 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5945 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5946 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5947
5948 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5949 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5950 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5951 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5952 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5953
5954 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5955 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5956 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5957 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5958 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5959
5960 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5961
5962 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5963 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5964 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5965 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5966 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5967 previously current thread.
5968
5969 @node Background Execution
5970 @subsection Background Execution
5971
5972 @cindex foreground execution
5973 @cindex background execution
5974 @cindex asynchronous execution
5975 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5976
5977 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5978 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5979 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5980 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5981 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5982 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5983
5984 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5985 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5986
5987 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5988 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5989 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5990 are:
5991
5992 @table @code
5993 @kindex run&
5994 @item run
5995 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5996
5997 @item attach
5998 @kindex attach&
5999 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6000
6001 @item step
6002 @kindex step&
6003 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6004
6005 @item stepi
6006 @kindex stepi&
6007 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6008
6009 @item next
6010 @kindex next&
6011 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6012
6013 @item nexti
6014 @kindex nexti&
6015 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6016
6017 @item continue
6018 @kindex continue&
6019 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6020
6021 @item finish
6022 @kindex finish&
6023 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6024
6025 @item until
6026 @kindex until&
6027 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6028
6029 @end table
6030
6031 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6032 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6033 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6034 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6035 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6036 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6037
6038 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6039 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6040
6041 @table @code
6042 @kindex interrupt
6043 @item interrupt
6044 @itemx interrupt -a
6045
6046 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6047 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6048 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6049 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6050 @end table
6051
6052 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6053 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6054
6055 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6056 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6057 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6058
6059 @table @code
6060 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6061 @cindex thread breakpoints
6062 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
6063 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
6064 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
6065 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6066 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6067 specify some source line.
6068
6069 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
6070 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6071 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{threadno} specifier
6072 is one of the numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6073 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6074
6075 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
6076 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6077 program.
6078
6079 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6080 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
6081 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6082
6083 @smallexample
6084 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6085 @end smallexample
6086
6087 @end table
6088
6089 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6090 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6091 thread list. For example:
6092
6093 @smallexample
6094 (@value{GDBP}) c
6095 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6096 @end smallexample
6097
6098 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6099 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6100 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6101 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6102 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6103 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6104 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6105 command.
6106
6107 @node Interrupted System Calls
6108 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6109
6110 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6111 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6112 @cindex premature return from system calls
6113 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6114 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6115 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6116 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6117 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6118 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6119 stop execution.
6120
6121 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6122 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6123 style anyways.
6124
6125 For example, do not write code like this:
6126
6127 @smallexample
6128 sleep (10);
6129 @end smallexample
6130
6131 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6132 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6133
6134 Instead, write this:
6135
6136 @smallexample
6137 int unslept = 10;
6138 while (unslept > 0)
6139 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6140 @end smallexample
6141
6142 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6143 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6144 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6145 @value{GDBN}.
6146
6147 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6148 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6149 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6150 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6151
6152 @node Observer Mode
6153 @subsection Observer Mode
6154
6155 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6156 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6157 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6158 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6159 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6160
6161 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6162 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6163 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6164 mode.
6165
6166 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6167 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6168 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6169 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6170 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6171
6172 @table @code
6173
6174 @kindex observer
6175 @item set observer on
6176 @itemx set observer off
6177 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6178 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6179 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6180 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6181
6182 @item show observer
6183 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6184
6185 @kindex may-write-registers
6186 @item set may-write-registers on
6187 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6188 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6189 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6190 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6191
6192 @item show may-write-registers
6193 Show the current permission to write registers.
6194
6195 @kindex may-write-memory
6196 @item set may-write-memory on
6197 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6198 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6199 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6200 defaults to @code{on}.
6201
6202 @item show may-write-memory
6203 Show the current permission to write memory.
6204
6205 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6206 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6207 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6208 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6209 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6210 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6211
6212 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6213 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6214
6215 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6216 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6217 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6218 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6219 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6220 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6221 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6222
6223 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6224 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6225
6226 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6227 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6228 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6229 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6230 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6231 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6232 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6233
6234 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6235 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6236
6237 @kindex may-interrupt
6238 @item set may-interrupt on
6239 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6240 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6241 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6242 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6243 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6244
6245 @item show may-interrupt
6246 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6247
6248 @end table
6249
6250 @node Reverse Execution
6251 @chapter Running programs backward
6252 @cindex reverse execution
6253 @cindex running programs backward
6254
6255 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6256 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6257 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6258 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6259
6260 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6261 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6262 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6263 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6264 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6265 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6266
6267 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6268 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6269 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6270 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6271 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6272 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6273 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6274 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6275 prior values@footnote{
6276 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6277 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6278 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6279
6280 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6281 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6282 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6283 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6284 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6285 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6286 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6287 }.
6288
6289 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6290 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6291
6292 @table @code
6293 @kindex reverse-continue
6294 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6295 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6296 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6297 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6298 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6299 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6300 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6301
6302 @kindex reverse-step
6303 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6304 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6305 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6306 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6307
6308 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6309 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6310 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6311 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6312 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6313 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6314
6315 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6316 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6317
6318 @kindex reverse-stepi
6319 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6320 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6321 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6322 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6323 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6324 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6325 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6326
6327 @kindex reverse-next
6328 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6329 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6330 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6331 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6332 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6333 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6334 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6335 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6336 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6337 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6338
6339 @kindex reverse-nexti
6340 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6341 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6342 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6343 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6344 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6345 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6346 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6347 frame) is reached.
6348
6349 @kindex reverse-finish
6350 @item reverse-finish
6351 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6352 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6353 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6354 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6355
6356 @kindex set exec-direction
6357 @item set exec-direction
6358 Set the direction of target execution.
6359 @item set exec-direction reverse
6360 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6361 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6362 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6363 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6364 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6365 @item set exec-direction forward
6366 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6367 This is the default.
6368 @end table
6369
6370
6371 @node Process Record and Replay
6372 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6373 @cindex process record and replay
6374 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6375
6376 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6377 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6378 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6379
6380 @cindex replay mode
6381 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6382 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6383 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6384 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6385 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6386 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6387 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6388 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6389 execution log.
6390
6391 @cindex record mode
6392 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6393 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6394 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6395 for future replay.
6396
6397 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6398 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6399 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6400 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6401 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6402 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6403
6404 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6405 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6406 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6407 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6408
6409 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6410 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6411
6412 @table @code
6413 @kindex target record
6414 @kindex target record-full
6415 @kindex target record-btrace
6416 @kindex record
6417 @kindex record full
6418 @kindex record btrace
6419 @kindex record btrace bts
6420 @kindex record btrace pt
6421 @kindex record bts
6422 @kindex record pt
6423 @kindex rec
6424 @kindex rec full
6425 @kindex rec btrace
6426 @kindex rec btrace bts
6427 @kindex rec btrace pt
6428 @kindex rec bts
6429 @kindex rec pt
6430 @item record @var{method}
6431 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6432 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6433 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6434 recording methods are available:
6435
6436 @table @code
6437 @item full
6438 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6439 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6440 execution.
6441
6442 @item btrace @var{format}
6443 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6444 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6445 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6446 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6447 execution.
6448
6449 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6450 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6451 formats are available:
6452
6453 @table @code
6454 @item bts
6455 @cindex branch trace store
6456 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6457 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6458 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6459
6460 @item pt
6461 @cindex Intel(R) Processor Trace
6462 Use the @dfn{Intel(R) Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6463 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6464 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6465
6466 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6467 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6468 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6469
6470 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6471 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6472 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6473 buffer-size with care.
6474 @end table
6475
6476 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6477 @end table
6478
6479 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6480 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6481 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6482 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6483
6484 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6485 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6486 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6487 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6488 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6489
6490 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6491 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6492 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6493 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6494 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6495 does not support these two modes.
6496
6497 @kindex record stop
6498 @kindex rec s
6499 @item record stop
6500 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6501 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6502 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6503
6504 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6505 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6506 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6507 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6508 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6509
6510 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6511 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6512 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6513 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6514 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6515
6516 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6517 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6518
6519 @kindex record goto
6520 @item record goto
6521 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6522 ways to specify the location to go to:
6523
6524 @table @code
6525 @item record goto begin
6526 @itemx record goto start
6527 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6528
6529 @item record goto end
6530 Go to the end of the execution log.
6531
6532 @item record goto @var{n}
6533 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6534 @end table
6535
6536 @kindex record save
6537 @item record save @var{filename}
6538 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6539 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6540 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6541
6542 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6543
6544 @kindex record restore
6545 @item record restore @var{filename}
6546 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6547 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6548
6549 @kindex set record full
6550 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6551 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6552 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6553 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6554
6555 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6556 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6557 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6558 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6559 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6560 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6561 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6562 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6563
6564 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6565 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6566 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6567
6568 @kindex show record full
6569 @item show record full insn-number-max
6570 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6571 recording method.
6572
6573 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6574 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6575 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6576 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6577 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6578 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6579 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6580 oldest one to be deleted.
6581
6582 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6583 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6584
6585 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6586 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6587
6588 @item set record full memory-query
6589 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6590 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6591 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6592 case.
6593
6594 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6595 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6596 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6597 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6598 results.
6599
6600 @item show record full memory-query
6601 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6602
6603 @kindex set record btrace
6604 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6605 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6606 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6607 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6608 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6609 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6610 You can use the following command for that:
6611
6612 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6613 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6614 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6615 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6616 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6617 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6618 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6619 position.
6620
6621 @kindex show record btrace
6622 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6623 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6624
6625 @kindex set record btrace bts
6626 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6627 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6628 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6629 format. Default is 64KB.
6630
6631 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6632 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6633 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6634 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6635 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6636 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6637 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6638
6639 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6640 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6641
6642 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6643 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6644
6645 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6646 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6647 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6648
6649 @kindex set record btrace pt
6650 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6651 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6652 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel(R)
6653 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6654
6655 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6656 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6657 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel(R) Processor Trace
6658 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6659 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6660 actual buffer size for each thread.
6661
6662 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6663 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6664
6665 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6666 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6667
6668 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6669 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6670 tracing in Intel(R) Processor Trace format.
6671
6672 @kindex info record
6673 @item info record
6674 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6675 method:
6676
6677 @table @code
6678 @item full
6679 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6680 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6681
6682 @itemize @bullet
6683 @item
6684 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6685 @item
6686 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6687 @item
6688 Highest recorded instruction number.
6689 @item
6690 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6691 @item
6692 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6693 @item
6694 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6695 @end itemize
6696
6697 @item btrace
6698 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6699
6700 @itemize @bullet
6701 @item
6702 Recording format.
6703 @item
6704 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6705 @item
6706 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6707 instructions.
6708 @item
6709 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6710 @end itemize
6711
6712 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6713 @itemize @bullet
6714 @item
6715 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6716 @end itemize
6717
6718 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6719 @itemize @bullet
6720 @item
6721 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6722 @end itemize
6723 @end table
6724
6725 @kindex record delete
6726 @kindex rec del
6727 @item record delete
6728 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6729 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6730 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6731 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6732
6733 @kindex record instruction-history
6734 @kindex rec instruction-history
6735 @item record instruction-history
6736 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6737 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6738 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6739 are printed in execution order.
6740
6741 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
6742 feature is not available for all recording formats.
6743
6744 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6745 disassemble:
6746
6747 @table @code
6748 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6749 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6750 @var{insn}.
6751
6752 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6753 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6754 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6755 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6756 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6757 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6758
6759 @item record instruction-history
6760 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6761
6762 @item record instruction-history -
6763 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6764
6765 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6766 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6767 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6768 number @var{end} is included.
6769 @end table
6770
6771 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6772
6773 @kindex set record
6774 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6775 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6776 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6777 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6778 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6779
6780 @kindex show record
6781 @item show record instruction-history-size
6782 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6783 instruction-history} command.
6784
6785 @kindex record function-call-history
6786 @kindex rec function-call-history
6787 @item record function-call-history
6788 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6789 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6790 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6791 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6792 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6793 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6794 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6795 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6796 given together.
6797
6798 @smallexample
6799 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6800 1 void foo (void)
6801 2 @{
6802 3 @}
6803 4
6804 5 void bar (void)
6805 6 @{
6806 7 ...
6807 8 foo ();
6808 9 ...
6809 10 @}
6810 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6811 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6812 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6813 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6814 @end smallexample
6815
6816 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6817 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6818 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6819 to print:
6820
6821 @table @code
6822 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6823 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6824
6825 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6826 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6827 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6828 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6829 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6830
6831 @item record function-call-history
6832 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6833
6834 @item record function-call-history -
6835 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6836
6837 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6838 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6839 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6840 @end table
6841
6842 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6843
6844 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6845 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6846 Define how many lines to print in the
6847 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6848 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6849
6850 @item show record function-call-history-size
6851 Show how many lines to print in the
6852 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6853 @end table
6854
6855
6856 @node Stack
6857 @chapter Examining the Stack
6858
6859 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6860 stopped and how it got there.
6861
6862 @cindex call stack
6863 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6864 is generated.
6865 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6866 the arguments of the call,
6867 and the local variables of the function being called.
6868 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6869 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6870 stack}.
6871
6872 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6873 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6874
6875 @cindex selected frame
6876 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6877 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6878 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6879 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6880 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6881 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6882
6883 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6884 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6885 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6886
6887 @menu
6888 * Frames:: Stack frames
6889 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6890 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6891 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6892 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6893
6894 @end menu
6895
6896 @node Frames
6897 @section Stack Frames
6898
6899 @cindex frame, definition
6900 @cindex stack frame
6901 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6902 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6903 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6904 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6905 which the function is executing.
6906
6907 @cindex initial frame
6908 @cindex outermost frame
6909 @cindex innermost frame
6910 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6911 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6912 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6913 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6914 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6915 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6916 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6917 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6918
6919 @cindex frame pointer
6920 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6921 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6922 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6923 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6924 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6925 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6926
6927 @cindex frame number
6928 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6929 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6930 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6931 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6932 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6933
6934 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6935 @c underflow problems.
6936 @cindex frameless execution
6937 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6938 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6939 @smallexample
6940 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6941 @end smallexample
6942 generates functions without a frame.)
6943 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6944 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6945 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6946 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6947 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6948 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6949 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6950
6951 @table @code
6952 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6953 @cindex current stack frame
6954 @item frame @r{[}@var{framespec}@r{]}
6955 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6956 and to print the stack frame you select. The @var{framespec} may be either the
6957 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6958 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6959
6960 @kindex select-frame
6961 @cindex selecting frame silently
6962 @item select-frame
6963 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6964 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6965 @code{frame}.
6966 @end table
6967
6968 @node Backtrace
6969 @section Backtraces
6970
6971 @cindex traceback
6972 @cindex call stack traces
6973 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6974 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6975 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6976 stack.
6977
6978 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6979 @table @code
6980 @kindex backtrace
6981 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6982 @item backtrace
6983 @itemx bt
6984 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6985 frames in the stack.
6986
6987 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6988 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6989
6990 @item backtrace @var{n}
6991 @itemx bt @var{n}
6992 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6993
6994 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6995 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6996 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6997
6998 @item backtrace full
6999 @itemx bt full
7000 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7001 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7002 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7003 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7004
7005 @item backtrace no-filters
7006 @itemx bt no-filters
7007 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7008 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7009 @itemx bt no-filters full
7010 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7011 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7012 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7013 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7014 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7015 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7016 support.
7017 @end table
7018
7019 @kindex where
7020 @kindex info stack
7021 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7022 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7023
7024 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7025 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7026 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7027 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7028 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7029 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7030 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7031 multi-threaded program.
7032
7033 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7034 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7035 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7036 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7037 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7038 line number.
7039
7040 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7041 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7042
7043 @smallexample
7044 @group
7045 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7046 at builtin.c:993
7047 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7048 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7049 at macro.c:71
7050 (More stack frames follow...)
7051 @end group
7052 @end smallexample
7053
7054 @noindent
7055 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7056 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7057 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7058
7059 @noindent
7060 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7061 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7062 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7063 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7064 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7065
7066 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7067 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7068 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7069 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7070 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7071 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7072 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7073 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7074 such a backtrace might look like:
7075
7076 @smallexample
7077 @group
7078 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7079 at builtin.c:993
7080 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7081 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7082 at macro.c:71
7083 (More stack frames follow...)
7084 @end group
7085 @end smallexample
7086
7087 @noindent
7088 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7089 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7090
7091 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7092 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7093 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7094
7095 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7096 @cindex program entry point
7097 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7098 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7099 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7100 @code{main}@footnote{
7101 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7102 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7103 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7104 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7105 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7106 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7107
7108 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7109 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7110
7111 @table @code
7112 @item set backtrace past-main
7113 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7114 @kindex set backtrace
7115 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7116
7117 @item set backtrace past-main off
7118 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7119 default.
7120
7121 @item show backtrace past-main
7122 @kindex show backtrace
7123 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7124
7125 @item set backtrace past-entry
7126 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7127 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7128 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7129 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7130
7131 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7132 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7133 application. This is the default.
7134
7135 @item show backtrace past-entry
7136 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7137
7138 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7139 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7140 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7141 @cindex backtrace limit
7142 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7143 or zero means unlimited levels.
7144
7145 @item show backtrace limit
7146 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7147 @end table
7148
7149 You can control how file names are displayed.
7150
7151 @table @code
7152 @item set filename-display
7153 @itemx set filename-display relative
7154 @cindex filename-display
7155 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7156
7157 @item set filename-display basename
7158 Display only basename of a filename.
7159
7160 @item set filename-display absolute
7161 Display an absolute filename.
7162
7163 @item show filename-display
7164 Show the current way to display filenames.
7165 @end table
7166
7167 @node Frame Filter Management
7168 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7169 @cindex managing frame filters
7170
7171 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7172 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7173
7174 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7175 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7176
7177 @table @code
7178 @kindex info frame-filter
7179 @item info frame-filter
7180 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7181 their name, priority and enabled status.
7182
7183 @kindex disable frame-filter
7184 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7185 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7186 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7187 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7188 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7189 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7190 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7191 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7192 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7193 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7194 may be enabled again later.
7195
7196 @kindex enable frame-filter
7197 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7198 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7199 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7200 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7201 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7202 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7203 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7204 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7205 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7206
7207 Example:
7208
7209 @smallexample
7210 (gdb) info frame-filter
7211
7212 global frame-filters:
7213 Priority Enabled Name
7214 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7215 100 Yes Reverse
7216
7217 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7218 Priority Enabled Name
7219 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7220
7221 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7222 Priority Enabled Name
7223 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7224
7225 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7226 (gdb) info frame-filter
7227
7228 global frame-filters:
7229 Priority Enabled Name
7230 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7231 100 Yes Reverse
7232
7233 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7234 Priority Enabled Name
7235 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7236
7237 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7238 Priority Enabled Name
7239 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7240
7241 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7242 (gdb) info frame-filter
7243
7244 global frame-filters:
7245 Priority Enabled Name
7246 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7247 100 Yes Reverse
7248
7249 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7250 Priority Enabled Name
7251 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7252
7253 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7254 Priority Enabled Name
7255 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7256 @end smallexample
7257
7258 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7259 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7260 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7261 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7262 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7263 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7264 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7265
7266 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7267 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7268 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7269 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7270 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7271 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7272 dictionary resides.
7273
7274 Example:
7275
7276 @smallexample
7277 (gdb) info frame-filter
7278
7279 global frame-filters:
7280 Priority Enabled Name
7281 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7282 100 Yes Reverse
7283
7284 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7285 Priority Enabled Name
7286 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7287
7288 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7289 Priority Enabled Name
7290 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7291
7292 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7293 (gdb) info frame-filter
7294
7295 global frame-filters:
7296 Priority Enabled Name
7297 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7298 50 Yes Reverse
7299
7300 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7301 Priority Enabled Name
7302 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7303
7304 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7305 Priority Enabled Name
7306 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7307 @end smallexample
7308 @end table
7309
7310 @node Selection
7311 @section Selecting a Frame
7312
7313 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7314 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7315 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7316 of the stack frame just selected.
7317
7318 @table @code
7319 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7320 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7321 @item frame @var{n}
7322 @itemx f @var{n}
7323 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7324 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7325 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7326 @code{main}.
7327
7328 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7329 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7330 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7331 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7332 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7333 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7334 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7335 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7336
7337 @kindex up
7338 @item up @var{n}
7339 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7340 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7341 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7342
7343 @kindex down
7344 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7345 @item down @var{n}
7346 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7347 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7348 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7349 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7350 @end table
7351
7352 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7353 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7354 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7355 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7356
7357 @need 1000
7358 For example:
7359
7360 @smallexample
7361 @group
7362 (@value{GDBP}) up
7363 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7364 at env.c:10
7365 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7366 @end group
7367 @end smallexample
7368
7369 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7370 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7371 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7372 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7373 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7374 for details.
7375
7376 @table @code
7377 @kindex down-silently
7378 @kindex up-silently
7379 @item up-silently @var{n}
7380 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7381 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7382 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7383 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7384 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7385 distracting.
7386 @end table
7387
7388 @node Frame Info
7389 @section Information About a Frame
7390
7391 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7392 stack frame.
7393
7394 @table @code
7395 @item frame
7396 @itemx f
7397 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7398 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7399 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7400 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7401 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7402
7403 @kindex info frame
7404 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7405 @item info frame
7406 @itemx info f
7407 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7408 including:
7409
7410 @itemize @bullet
7411 @item
7412 the address of the frame
7413 @item
7414 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7415 @item
7416 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7417 @item
7418 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7419 @item
7420 the address of the frame's arguments
7421 @item
7422 the address of the frame's local variables
7423 @item
7424 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7425 @item
7426 which registers were saved in the frame
7427 @end itemize
7428
7429 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7430 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7431 the usual conventions.
7432
7433 @item info frame @var{addr}
7434 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7435 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7436 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7437 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7438 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7439 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7440
7441 @kindex info args
7442 @item info args
7443 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7444
7445 @item info locals
7446 @kindex info locals
7447 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7448 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7449 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7450
7451 @end table
7452
7453
7454 @node Source
7455 @chapter Examining Source Files
7456
7457 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7458 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7459 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7460 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7461 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7462 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7463 source files by explicit command.
7464
7465 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7466 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7467 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7468
7469 @menu
7470 * List:: Printing source lines
7471 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7472 * Edit:: Editing source files
7473 * Search:: Searching source files
7474 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7475 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7476 @end menu
7477
7478 @node List
7479 @section Printing Source Lines
7480
7481 @kindex list
7482 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7483 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7484 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7485 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7486 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7487
7488 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7489
7490 @table @code
7491 @item list @var{linenum}
7492 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7493 current source file.
7494
7495 @item list @var{function}
7496 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7497 @var{function}.
7498
7499 @item list
7500 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7501 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7502 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7503 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7504 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7505
7506 @item list -
7507 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7508 @end table
7509
7510 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7511 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7512 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7513
7514 @table @code
7515 @kindex set listsize
7516 @item set listsize @var{count}
7517 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7518 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7519 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7520 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7521
7522 @kindex show listsize
7523 @item show listsize
7524 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7525 @end table
7526
7527 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7528 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7529 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7530 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7531 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7532
7533 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7534 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
7535 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7536 to specify some source line.
7537
7538 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7539
7540 @table @code
7541 @item list @var{linespec}
7542 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
7543
7544 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7545 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7546 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
7547 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
7548 the same source file as the first linespec.
7549
7550 @item list ,@var{last}
7551 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7552
7553 @item list @var{first},
7554 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7555
7556 @item list +
7557 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7558
7559 @item list -
7560 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7561
7562 @item list
7563 As described in the preceding table.
7564 @end table
7565
7566 @node Specify Location
7567 @section Specifying a Location
7568 @cindex specifying location
7569 @cindex linespec
7570
7571 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7572 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7573 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
7574 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
7575
7576 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
7577 @value{GDBN} understands:
7578
7579 @table @code
7580 @item @var{linenum}
7581 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7582
7583 @item -@var{offset}
7584 @itemx +@var{offset}
7585 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7586 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7587 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7588 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7589 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7590 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7591 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7592 linespec.
7593
7594 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7595 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7596 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7597 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7598 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7599 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7600 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7601
7602 @item @var{function}
7603 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7604 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7605
7606 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7607 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7608
7609 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7610 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7611 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7612 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7613 functions in different source files.
7614
7615 @item @var{label}
7616 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
7617 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
7618 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
7619 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
7620 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7621
7622 @item *@var{address}
7623 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
7624 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
7625 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
7626 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7627 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7628 source files.
7629
7630 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7631 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7632 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7633 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
7634 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
7635 of @var{address}:
7636
7637 @table @code
7638 @item @var{expression}
7639 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7640
7641 @item @var{funcaddr}
7642 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7643 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7644 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7645 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7646 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7647 (although the Pascal form also works).
7648
7649 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7650 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7651
7652 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7653 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7654 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7655 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7656 functions with identical names in different source files.
7657 @end table
7658
7659 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7660 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7661 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7662 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7663 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7664 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7665
7666 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7667 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7668 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7669 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7670 each one of those probes.
7671
7672 @end table
7673
7674
7675 @node Edit
7676 @section Editing Source Files
7677 @cindex editing source files
7678
7679 @kindex edit
7680 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7681 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7682 The editing program of your choice
7683 is invoked with the current line set to
7684 the active line in the program.
7685 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7686 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7687
7688 @table @code
7689 @item edit @var{location}
7690 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7691 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7692 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7693 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7694 command most commonly used:
7695
7696 @table @code
7697 @item edit @var{number}
7698 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7699
7700 @item edit @var{function}
7701 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7702 @end table
7703
7704 @end table
7705
7706 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7707 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7708 @footnote{
7709 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7710 following command-line syntax:
7711 @smallexample
7712 ex +@var{number} file
7713 @end smallexample
7714 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7715 the file where to start editing.}.
7716 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7717 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7718 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7719 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7720 @smallexample
7721 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7722 export EDITOR
7723 gdb @dots{}
7724 @end smallexample
7725 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7726 @smallexample
7727 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7728 gdb @dots{}
7729 @end smallexample
7730
7731 @node Search
7732 @section Searching Source Files
7733 @cindex searching source files
7734
7735 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7736 regular expression.
7737
7738 @table @code
7739 @kindex search
7740 @kindex forward-search
7741 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7742 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7743 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7744 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7745 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7746 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7747 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7748 @code{fo}.
7749
7750 @kindex reverse-search
7751 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7752 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7753 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7754 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7755 this command as @code{rev}.
7756 @end table
7757
7758 @node Source Path
7759 @section Specifying Source Directories
7760
7761 @cindex source path
7762 @cindex directories for source files
7763 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7764 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7765 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7766 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7767 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7768 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7769 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7770
7771 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7772 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7773 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7774 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7775 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7776 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7777 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7778 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7779 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7780 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7781 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7782
7783 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7784 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7785 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7786 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7787 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7788 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7789
7790 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7791 source files.
7792
7793 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7794 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7795 each line is in the file.
7796
7797 @kindex directory
7798 @kindex dir
7799 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7800 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7801 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7802
7803 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7804 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7805
7806 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7807 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7808 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7809 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7810 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7811 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7812 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7813 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7814 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7815 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7816 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7817 name to look up the sources.
7818
7819 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7820 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7821 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7822 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7823 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7824 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7825 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7826 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7827
7828 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7829 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7830 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7831 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7832 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7833 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7834 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7835
7836 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7837 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7838 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7839 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7840 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7841 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7842 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7843 command.
7844
7845 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7846 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7847 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7848 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7849 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7850 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7851 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7852
7853 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7854 @cindex default source path substitution
7855 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7856 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7857 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7858 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7859 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7860 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7861 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7862 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7863 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7864 together.
7865
7866 @table @code
7867 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7868 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7869 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7870 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7871 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7872 part of absolute file names) or
7873 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7874 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7875
7876 @kindex cdir
7877 @kindex cwd
7878 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7879 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7880 @cindex compilation directory
7881 @cindex current directory
7882 @cindex working directory
7883 @cindex directory, current
7884 @cindex directory, compilation
7885 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7886 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7887 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7888 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7889 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7890 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7891
7892 @item directory
7893 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7894
7895 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7896 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7897
7898 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7899 @kindex set directories
7900 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7901 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7902
7903 @item show directories
7904 @kindex show directories
7905 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7906
7907 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7908 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7909 @kindex set substitute-path
7910 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7911 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7912 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7913
7914 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7915 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7916
7917 @smallexample
7918 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7919 @end smallexample
7920
7921 @noindent
7922 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7923 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7924 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7925
7926 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7927 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7928 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7929 the substitution.
7930
7931 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7932
7933 @smallexample
7934 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7935 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7936 @end smallexample
7937
7938 @noindent
7939 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7940 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7941 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7942 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7943
7944
7945 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7946 @kindex unset substitute-path
7947 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7948 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7949 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7950
7951 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7952
7953 @item show substitute-path [path]
7954 @kindex show substitute-path
7955 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7956 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7957
7958 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7959 rules.
7960
7961 @end table
7962
7963 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7964 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7965 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7966
7967 @enumerate
7968 @item
7969 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7970
7971 @item
7972 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7973 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7974 directories in one command.
7975 @end enumerate
7976
7977 @node Machine Code
7978 @section Source and Machine Code
7979 @cindex source line and its code address
7980
7981 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7982 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7983 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7984 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7985 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7986 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7987 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7988 well as hex.
7989
7990 @table @code
7991 @kindex info line
7992 @item info line @var{linespec}
7993 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7994 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7995 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7996 @end table
7997
7998 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7999 the object code for the first line of function
8000 @code{m4_changequote}:
8001
8002 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8003 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8004 @smallexample
8005 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8006 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8007 @end smallexample
8008
8009 @noindent
8010 @cindex code address and its source line
8011 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8012 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
8013 @smallexample
8014 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8015 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8016 @end smallexample
8017
8018 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8019 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8020 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8021 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8022 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8023 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8024 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8025 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8026 Variables}).
8027
8028 @table @code
8029 @kindex disassemble
8030 @cindex assembly instructions
8031 @cindex instructions, assembly
8032 @cindex machine instructions
8033 @cindex listing machine instructions
8034 @item disassemble
8035 @itemx disassemble /m
8036 @itemx disassemble /r
8037 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8038 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8039 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
8040 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
8041 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8042 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8043 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8044 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8045 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8046 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8047
8048 @table @code
8049 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8050 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8051 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8052 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8053 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8054 @end table
8055
8056 @noindent
8057 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8058 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8059
8060 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8061 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8062
8063 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8064 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8065 @end table
8066
8067 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8068 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8069
8070 @smallexample
8071 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8072 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8073 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8074 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8075 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8076 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8077 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8078 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8079 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8080 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8081 End of assembler dump.
8082 @end smallexample
8083
8084 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
8085 program is stopped just after function prologue:
8086
8087 @smallexample
8088 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8089 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8090 5 @{
8091 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8092 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8093 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8094 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8095 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8096
8097 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8098 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8099 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8100
8101 7 return 0;
8102 8 @}
8103 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8104 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8105 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8106
8107 End of assembler dump.
8108 @end smallexample
8109
8110 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8111
8112 @smallexample
8113 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8114 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8115 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8116 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8117 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8118 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8119 End of assembler dump.
8120 @end smallexample
8121
8122 Addresses cannot be specified as a linespec (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8123 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8124 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8125 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8126
8127 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8128 mnemonics or other syntax.
8129
8130 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8131 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8132 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8133 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8134 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8135
8136 @table @code
8137 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8138 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8139 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8140 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8141 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8142 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8143
8144 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8145 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8146 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8147 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8148
8149 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8150 @item show disassembly-flavor
8151 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8152 @end table
8153
8154 @table @code
8155 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8156 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8157 @item set disassemble-next-line
8158 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8159 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8160 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8161 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8162 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8163 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8164 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8165 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8166 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8167 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8168 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8169 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8170 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8171 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8172 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8173 instruction.
8174 @end table
8175
8176
8177 @node Data
8178 @chapter Examining Data
8179
8180 @cindex printing data
8181 @cindex examining data
8182 @kindex print
8183 @kindex inspect
8184 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8185 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8186 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8187 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8188 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8189 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8190
8191 @table @code
8192 @item print @var{expr}
8193 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8194 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8195 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8196 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8197 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8198 Formats}.
8199
8200 @item print
8201 @itemx print /@var{f}
8202 @cindex reprint the last value
8203 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8204 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8205 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8206 @end table
8207
8208 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8209 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8210 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8211
8212 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8213 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8214 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8215 Table}.
8216
8217 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8218 @kindex explore
8219 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8220 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8221 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8222 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8223 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8224 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8225 embedded in the higher level data types.
8226
8227 @table @code
8228 @item explore @var{arg}
8229 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8230 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8231 @end table
8232
8233 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8234 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8235 C program as
8236
8237 @smallexample
8238 struct SimpleStruct
8239 @{
8240 int i;
8241 double d;
8242 @};
8243
8244 struct ComplexStruct
8245 @{
8246 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8247 int arr[10];
8248 @};
8249 @end smallexample
8250
8251 @noindent
8252 followed by variable declarations as
8253
8254 @smallexample
8255 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8256 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8257 @end smallexample
8258
8259 @noindent
8260 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8261 @code{explore} command as follows.
8262
8263 @smallexample
8264 (gdb) explore cs
8265 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8266 the following fields:
8267
8268 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8269 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8270
8271 Enter the field number of choice:
8272 @end smallexample
8273
8274 @noindent
8275 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8276 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8277 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8278 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8279 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8280 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8281 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8282 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8283
8284 @smallexample
8285 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8286 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8287 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8288 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8289
8290 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8291 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8292
8293 Press enter to return to parent value:
8294 @end smallexample
8295
8296 @noindent
8297 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8298 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8299 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8300 to explore.
8301
8302 @smallexample
8303 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8304 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8305
8306 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8307
8308 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8309
8310 Press enter to return to parent value:
8311 @end smallexample
8312
8313 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8314 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8315 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8316 level data structure).
8317
8318 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8319 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8320 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8321 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8322 same example as above, your can explore the type
8323 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8324 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8325
8326 @smallexample
8327 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8328 @end smallexample
8329
8330 @noindent
8331 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8332 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8333 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8334 example.
8335
8336 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8337 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8338 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8339 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8340 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8341
8342 @table @code
8343 @item explore value @var{expr}
8344 @cindex explore value
8345 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8346 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8347 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8348 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8349 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8350
8351 @item explore type @var{arg}
8352 @cindex explore type
8353 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8354 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8355 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8356 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8357 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8358 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8359 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8360 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8361 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8362 @end table
8363
8364 @menu
8365 * Expressions:: Expressions
8366 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8367 * Variables:: Program variables
8368 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8369 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8370 * Memory:: Examining memory
8371 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8372 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8373 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8374 * Value History:: Value history
8375 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8376 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8377 * Registers:: Registers
8378 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8379 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8380 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8381 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8382 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8383 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8384 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8385 character set than GDB does
8386 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8387 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8388 @end menu
8389
8390 @node Expressions
8391 @section Expressions
8392
8393 @cindex expressions
8394 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8395 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8396 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8397 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8398 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8399 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8400 @ref{Compilation}.
8401
8402 @cindex arrays in expressions
8403 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8404 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8405 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8406 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8407 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8408 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8409
8410 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8411 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8412 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8413 languages.
8414
8415 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8416 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8417
8418 @cindex casts, in expressions
8419 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8420 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8421 at that address in memory.
8422 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8423
8424 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8425 to programming languages:
8426
8427 @table @code
8428 @item @@
8429 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8430 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8431
8432 @item ::
8433 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8434 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8435
8436 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8437 @cindex type casting memory
8438 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8439 @cindex casts, to view memory
8440 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8441 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8442 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8443 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8444 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8445 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8446 @end table
8447
8448 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8449 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8450 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8451
8452 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8453 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8454 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8455 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8456 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8457 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8458 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8459
8460 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8461 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8462 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8463 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8464 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8465 as well.
8466
8467 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8468 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8469 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8470 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8471 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8472 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8473 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8474 choices.
8475
8476 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8477 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8478 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8479
8480 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8481 @smallexample
8482 @group
8483 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8484 [0] cancel
8485 [1] all
8486 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8487 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8488 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8489 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8490 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8491 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8492 > 2 4 6
8493 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8494 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8495 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8496 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8497 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8498 breakpoints.
8499 (@value{GDBP})
8500 @end group
8501 @end smallexample
8502
8503 @table @code
8504 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8505 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8506 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8507
8508 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8509 is ambiguous.
8510
8511 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8512 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8513 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8514 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8515 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8516 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8517 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8518 in the use of the menu.
8519
8520 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8521 when an ambiguity is detected.
8522
8523 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8524 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8525
8526 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8527 @item show multiple-symbols
8528 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8529 @end table
8530
8531 @node Variables
8532 @section Program Variables
8533
8534 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8535 in your program.
8536
8537 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8538 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8539
8540 @itemize @bullet
8541 @item
8542 global (or file-static)
8543 @end itemize
8544
8545 @noindent or
8546
8547 @itemize @bullet
8548 @item
8549 visible according to the scope rules of the
8550 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8551 @end itemize
8552
8553 @noindent This means that in the function
8554
8555 @smallexample
8556 foo (a)
8557 int a;
8558 @{
8559 bar (a);
8560 @{
8561 int b = test ();
8562 bar (b);
8563 @}
8564 @}
8565 @end smallexample
8566
8567 @noindent
8568 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8569 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8570 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8571 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8572
8573 @cindex variable name conflict
8574 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8575 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8576 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8577 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8578 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8579 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8580 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8581
8582 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8583 @ifnotinfo
8584 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8585 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8586 @end ifnotinfo
8587 @smallexample
8588 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8589 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8590 @end smallexample
8591
8592 @noindent
8593 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8594 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8595 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8596 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8597
8598 @smallexample
8599 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8600 @end smallexample
8601
8602 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8603 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8604 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8605 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8606 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8607
8608 @smallexample
8609 void
8610 foo (int a)
8611 @{
8612 if (a < 10)
8613 bar (a);
8614 else
8615 process (a); /* Stop here */
8616 @}
8617
8618 int
8619 bar (int a)
8620 @{
8621 foo (a + 5);
8622 @}
8623 @end smallexample
8624
8625 @noindent
8626 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8627 here is what you might see
8628 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8629
8630 @smallexample
8631 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8632 $1 = 10
8633 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8634 $2 = 5
8635 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8636 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8637 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8638 $3 = 5
8639 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8640 $4 = 0
8641 @end smallexample
8642
8643 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8644 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8645 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8646 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8647 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8648
8649 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8650 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8651 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8652 @code{some_global}.
8653
8654 @smallexample
8655 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8656 $1 = 23
8657 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8658 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8659 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8660 $2 = 27
8661 @end smallexample
8662
8663 @cindex wrong values
8664 @cindex variable values, wrong
8665 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8666 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8667 @quotation
8668 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8669 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8670 scope, and just before exit.
8671 @end quotation
8672 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8673 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8674 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8675 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8676 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8677 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8678 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8679 variable definitions may be gone.
8680
8681 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8682 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8683 when compiling.
8684
8685 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8686 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8687 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8688 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8689 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8690 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8691 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8692
8693 @smallexample
8694 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8695 @end smallexample
8696
8697 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8698 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8699 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8700 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8701 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8702
8703 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8704 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8705 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8706 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8707
8708 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8709 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8710 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8711 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8712 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8713
8714 @smallexample
8715 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8716 29 i++;
8717 (gdb) next
8718 30 e (i);
8719 (gdb) print i
8720 $1 = 31
8721 (gdb) print i@@entry
8722 $2 = 30
8723 @end smallexample
8724
8725 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8726 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8727 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8728 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8729 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8730 For program code
8731
8732 @smallexample
8733 char var0[] = "A";
8734 signed char var1[] = "A";
8735 @end smallexample
8736
8737 You get during debugging
8738 @smallexample
8739 (gdb) print var0
8740 $1 = "A"
8741 (gdb) print var1
8742 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8743 @end smallexample
8744
8745 @node Arrays
8746 @section Artificial Arrays
8747
8748 @cindex artificial array
8749 @cindex arrays
8750 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8751 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8752 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8753 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8754 program.
8755
8756 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8757 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8758 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8759 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8760 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8761 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8762 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8763 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8764 example. If a program says
8765
8766 @smallexample
8767 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8768 @end smallexample
8769
8770 @noindent
8771 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8772
8773 @smallexample
8774 p *array@@len
8775 @end smallexample
8776
8777 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8778 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8779 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8780 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8781 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8782
8783 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8784 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8785 The value need not be in memory:
8786 @smallexample
8787 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8788 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8789 @end smallexample
8790
8791 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8792 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8793 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8794 @smallexample
8795 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8796 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8797 @end smallexample
8798
8799 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8800 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8801 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8802 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8803 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8804 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8805 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8806 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8807 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8808 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8809
8810 @smallexample
8811 set $i = 0
8812 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8813 @key{RET}
8814 @key{RET}
8815 @dots{}
8816 @end smallexample
8817
8818 @node Output Formats
8819 @section Output Formats
8820
8821 @cindex formatted output
8822 @cindex output formats
8823 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8824 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8825 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8826 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8827 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8828
8829 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8830 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8831 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8832 letters supported are:
8833
8834 @table @code
8835 @item x
8836 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8837 hexadecimal.
8838
8839 @item d
8840 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8841
8842 @item u
8843 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8844
8845 @item o
8846 Print as integer in octal.
8847
8848 @item t
8849 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8850 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8851 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8852 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8853
8854 @item a
8855 @cindex unknown address, locating
8856 @cindex locate address
8857 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8858 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8859 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8860
8861 @smallexample
8862 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8863 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8864 @end smallexample
8865
8866 @noindent
8867 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8868 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8869
8870 @item c
8871 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8872 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8873 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8874 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8875
8876 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8877 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8878 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8879 data.
8880
8881 @item f
8882 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8883 using typical floating point syntax.
8884
8885 @item s
8886 @cindex printing strings
8887 @cindex printing byte arrays
8888 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8889 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8890 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8891 natural types.
8892
8893 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8894 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8895 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8896 array.
8897
8898 @item z
8899 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
8900 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
8901 to the size of the integer type.
8902
8903 @item r
8904 @cindex raw printing
8905 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8906 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8907 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8908 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8909 pretty-printer which might exist.
8910 @end table
8911
8912 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8913
8914 @smallexample
8915 p/x $pc
8916 @end smallexample
8917
8918 @noindent
8919 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8920 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8921
8922 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8923 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8924 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8925
8926 @node Memory
8927 @section Examining Memory
8928
8929 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8930 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8931
8932 @cindex examining memory
8933 @table @code
8934 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8935 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8936 @itemx x @var{addr}
8937 @itemx x
8938 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8939 @end table
8940
8941 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8942 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8943 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8944 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8945 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8946
8947 @table @r
8948 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8949 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8950 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8951 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8952 @c 4.1.2.
8953
8954 @item @var{f}, the display format
8955 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8956 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8957 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8958 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8959 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8960
8961 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8962 The unit size is any of
8963
8964 @table @code
8965 @item b
8966 Bytes.
8967 @item h
8968 Halfwords (two bytes).
8969 @item w
8970 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8971 @item g
8972 Giant words (eight bytes).
8973 @end table
8974
8975 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8976 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8977 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8978 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8979 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8980 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8981 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8982 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8983 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8984 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8985 be altered.
8986
8987 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8988 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8989 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8990 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8991 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8992 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8993 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8994 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8995 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8996 a value from memory).
8997 @end table
8998
8999 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9000 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9001 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9002 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9003 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9004
9005 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9006 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9007 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9008 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9009 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9010
9011 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9012 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9013 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9014 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9015 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9016 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9017 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9018 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9019 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9020
9021 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9022 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9023 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9024 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9025 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9026 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9027 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9028
9029 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9030 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9031
9032 @smallexample
9033 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9034 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9035 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9036 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9037 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9038 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9039 @end smallexample
9040
9041 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9042 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9043 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9044 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9045 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9046 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9047 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9048 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9049 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9050
9051 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9052 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9053 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9054
9055 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9056 @cindex addressable memory unit
9057 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9058 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9059 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9060 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9061 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9062 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9063 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9064 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9065 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9066
9067 @cindex remote memory comparison
9068 @cindex target memory comparison
9069 @cindex verify remote memory image
9070 @cindex verify target memory image
9071 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9072 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9073 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9074 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9075 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9076 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9077
9078 @table @code
9079 @kindex compare-sections
9080 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9081 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9082 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9083 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9084 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9085 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9086
9087 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9088 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9089 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9090 @end table
9091
9092 @node Auto Display
9093 @section Automatic Display
9094 @cindex automatic display
9095 @cindex display of expressions
9096
9097 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9098 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9099 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9100 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9101 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9102 The automatic display looks like this:
9103
9104 @smallexample
9105 2: foo = 38
9106 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9107 @end smallexample
9108
9109 @noindent
9110 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9111 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9112 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9113 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9114 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9115 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9116
9117 @table @code
9118 @kindex display
9119 @item display @var{expr}
9120 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9121 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9122
9123 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9124
9125 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9126 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9127 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9128 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9129 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9130
9131 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9132 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9133 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9134 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9135 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9136 @end table
9137
9138 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9139 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9140 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9141
9142 @table @code
9143 @kindex delete display
9144 @kindex undisplay
9145 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9146 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9147 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9148 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9149 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9150 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9151 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9152
9153 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9154 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9155
9156 @kindex disable display
9157 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9158 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9159 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9160 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9161 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9162 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9163 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9164 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9165
9166 @kindex enable display
9167 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9168 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9169 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9170 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9171 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9172 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9173 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9174
9175 @item display
9176 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9177 done when your program stops.
9178
9179 @kindex info display
9180 @item info display
9181 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9182 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9183 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9184 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9185 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9186 @end table
9187
9188 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9189 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9190 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9191 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9192 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9193 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9194 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9195 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9196 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9197 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9198 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9199
9200 @node Print Settings
9201 @section Print Settings
9202
9203 @cindex format options
9204 @cindex print settings
9205 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9206 and symbols are printed.
9207
9208 @noindent
9209 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9210
9211 @table @code
9212 @kindex set print
9213 @item set print address
9214 @itemx set print address on
9215 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9216 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9217 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9218 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9219 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9220 @code{set print address on}:
9221
9222 @smallexample
9223 @group
9224 (@value{GDBP}) f
9225 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9226 at input.c:530
9227 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9228 @end group
9229 @end smallexample
9230
9231 @item set print address off
9232 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9233 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9234
9235 @smallexample
9236 @group
9237 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9238 (@value{GDBP}) f
9239 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9240 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9241 @end group
9242 @end smallexample
9243
9244 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9245 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9246 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9247 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9248
9249 @kindex show print
9250 @item show print address
9251 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9252 @end table
9253
9254 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9255 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9256 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9257 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9258 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9259 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9260 it prints a symbolic address:
9261
9262 @table @code
9263 @item set print symbol-filename on
9264 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9265 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9266 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9267 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9268
9269 @item set print symbol-filename off
9270 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9271 default.
9272
9273 @item show print symbol-filename
9274 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9275 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9276 @end table
9277
9278 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9279 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9280 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9281
9282 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9283 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9284
9285 @table @code
9286 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9287 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9288 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9289 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9290 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9291 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9292 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9293 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9294
9295 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9296 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9297 symbolic address.
9298 @end table
9299
9300 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9301 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9302 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9303 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9304 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9305 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9306 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9307 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9308
9309 @smallexample
9310 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9311 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9312 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9313 @end smallexample
9314
9315 @quotation
9316 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9317 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9318 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9319 @end quotation
9320
9321 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9322 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9323
9324 @table @code
9325 @item set print symbol on
9326 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9327 one exists.
9328
9329 @item set print symbol off
9330 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9331 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9332 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9333
9334 @item show print symbol
9335 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9336 address.
9337 @end table
9338
9339 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9340
9341 @table @code
9342 @item set print array
9343 @itemx set print array on
9344 @cindex pretty print arrays
9345 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9346 but uses more space. The default is off.
9347
9348 @item set print array off
9349 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9350
9351 @item show print array
9352 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9353 arrays.
9354
9355 @cindex print array indexes
9356 @item set print array-indexes
9357 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9358 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9359 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9360 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9361
9362 @item set print array-indexes off
9363 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9364
9365 @item show print array-indexes
9366 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9367 arrays.
9368
9369 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9370 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9371 @cindex number of array elements to print
9372 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9373 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9374 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9375 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9376 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9377 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9378 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9379 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9380
9381 @item show print elements
9382 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9383 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9384
9385 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9386 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9387 @cindex printing frame argument values
9388 @cindex print all frame argument values
9389 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9390 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9391 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9392 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9393 values are:
9394
9395 @table @code
9396 @item all
9397 The values of all arguments are printed.
9398
9399 @item scalars
9400 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9401 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9402 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9403 only scalar arguments are shown:
9404
9405 @smallexample
9406 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9407 at frame-args.c:23
9408 @end smallexample
9409
9410 @item none
9411 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9412 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9413
9414 @smallexample
9415 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9416 at frame-args.c:23
9417 @end smallexample
9418 @end table
9419
9420 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9421 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9422 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9423 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9424 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9425 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9426 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9427 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9428 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9429 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9430
9431 @item show print frame-arguments
9432 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9433
9434 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9435 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9436
9437 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9438 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9439 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9440 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9441 This is the default.
9442
9443 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9444 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9445
9446 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9447 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9448 @kindex set print entry-values
9449 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9450 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9451 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9452 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9453 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9454
9455 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9456 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9457 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9458 @code{no} setting.
9459
9460 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9461 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9462 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9463 this information.
9464
9465 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9466
9467 @table @code
9468 @item no
9469 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9470 point.
9471 @smallexample
9472 #0 equal (val=5)
9473 #0 different (val=6)
9474 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9475 #0 born (val=10)
9476 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9477 @end smallexample
9478
9479 @item only
9480 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9481 values are never printed.
9482 @smallexample
9483 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9484 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9485 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9486 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9487 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9488 @end smallexample
9489
9490 @item preferred
9491 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9492 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9493 value for such parameter.
9494 @smallexample
9495 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9496 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9497 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9498 #0 born (val=10)
9499 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9500 @end smallexample
9501
9502 @item if-needed
9503 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9504 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9505 parameter.
9506 @smallexample
9507 #0 equal (val=5)
9508 #0 different (val=6)
9509 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9510 #0 born (val=10)
9511 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9512 @end smallexample
9513
9514 @item both
9515 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9516 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9517 optimizations.
9518 @smallexample
9519 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9520 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9521 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9522 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9523 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9524 @end smallexample
9525
9526 @item compact
9527 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9528 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9529 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9530 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9531 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9532 @smallexample
9533 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9534 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9535 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9536 #0 born (val=10)
9537 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9538 @end smallexample
9539
9540 @item default
9541 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9542 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9543 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9544 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9545 @smallexample
9546 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9547 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9548 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9549 #0 born (val=10)
9550 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9551 @end smallexample
9552 @end table
9553
9554 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9555 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9556
9557 @item show print entry-values
9558 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9559 entry.
9560
9561 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9562 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9563 @cindex repeated array elements
9564 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9565 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9566 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9567 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9568 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9569 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9570 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9571 is 10.
9572
9573 @item show print repeats
9574 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9575 elements.
9576
9577 @item set print null-stop
9578 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9579 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9580 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9581 contain only short strings.
9582 The default is off.
9583
9584 @item show print null-stop
9585 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9586 @sc{null} character.
9587
9588 @item set print pretty on
9589 @cindex print structures in indented form
9590 @cindex indentation in structure display
9591 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9592 per line, like this:
9593
9594 @smallexample
9595 @group
9596 $1 = @{
9597 next = 0x0,
9598 flags = @{
9599 sweet = 1,
9600 sour = 1
9601 @},
9602 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9603 @}
9604 @end group
9605 @end smallexample
9606
9607 @item set print pretty off
9608 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9609
9610 @smallexample
9611 @group
9612 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9613 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9614 @end group
9615 @end smallexample
9616
9617 @noindent
9618 This is the default format.
9619
9620 @item show print pretty
9621 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9622
9623 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9624 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9625 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9626 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9627 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9628 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9629 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9630 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9631
9632 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9633 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9634 international character sets, and is the default.
9635
9636 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9637 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9638
9639 @item set print union on
9640 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9641 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9642 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9643
9644 @item set print union off
9645 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9646 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9647 instead.
9648
9649 @item show print union
9650 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9651 structures and other unions.
9652
9653 For example, given the declarations
9654
9655 @smallexample
9656 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9657 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9658 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9659 Bug_forms;
9660
9661 struct thing @{
9662 Species it;
9663 union @{
9664 Tree_forms tree;
9665 Bug_forms bug;
9666 @} form;
9667 @};
9668
9669 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9670 @end smallexample
9671
9672 @noindent
9673 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9674
9675 @smallexample
9676 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9677 @end smallexample
9678
9679 @noindent
9680 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9681
9682 @smallexample
9683 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9684 @end smallexample
9685
9686 @noindent
9687 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9688 and in Pascal.
9689 @end table
9690
9691 @need 1000
9692 @noindent
9693 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9694
9695 @table @code
9696 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9697 @item set print demangle
9698 @itemx set print demangle on
9699 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9700 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9701 linkage. The default is on.
9702
9703 @item show print demangle
9704 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9705
9706 @item set print asm-demangle
9707 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9708 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9709 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9710 The default is off.
9711
9712 @item show print asm-demangle
9713 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9714 or demangled form.
9715
9716 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9717 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9718 @kindex set demangle-style
9719 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9720 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9721 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9722
9723 @table @code
9724 @item auto
9725 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9726 This is the default.
9727
9728 @item gnu
9729 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9730
9731 @item hp
9732 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9733
9734 @item lucid
9735 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9736
9737 @item arm
9738 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9739 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9740 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9741 require further enhancement to permit that.
9742
9743 @end table
9744 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9745
9746 @item show demangle-style
9747 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9748
9749 @item set print object
9750 @itemx set print object on
9751 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9752 @cindex display derived types
9753 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9754 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9755 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9756 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9757 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9758 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9759 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9760
9761 @item set print object off
9762 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9763 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9764
9765 @item show print object
9766 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9767
9768 @item set print static-members
9769 @itemx set print static-members on
9770 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9771 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9772
9773 @item set print static-members off
9774 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9775
9776 @item show print static-members
9777 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9778
9779 @item set print pascal_static-members
9780 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9781 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9782 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9783 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9784
9785 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9786 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9787
9788 @item show print pascal_static-members
9789 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9790
9791 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9792 @item set print vtbl
9793 @itemx set print vtbl on
9794 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9795 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9796 @cindex VTBL display
9797 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9798 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9799 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9800
9801 @item set print vtbl off
9802 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9803
9804 @item show print vtbl
9805 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9806 @end table
9807
9808 @node Pretty Printing
9809 @section Pretty Printing
9810
9811 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9812 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9813 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9814
9815 @menu
9816 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9817 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9818 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9819 @end menu
9820
9821 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9822 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9823
9824 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9825 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9826 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9827
9828 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9829 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9830 pretty-printers with their names.
9831 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9832 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9833 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9834 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9835
9836 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9837 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9838 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9839 do anything special.
9840
9841 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9842
9843 @itemize @bullet
9844 @item
9845 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9846 all inferiors.
9847
9848 @item
9849 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9850 when debugging that program.
9851 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9852
9853 @item
9854 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9855 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9856 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9857 @end itemize
9858
9859 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9860 pretty-printers are selected,
9861
9862 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9863 for new types.
9864
9865 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9866 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9867
9868 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9869
9870 @smallexample
9871 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9872 $1 = @{
9873 static npos = 4294967295,
9874 _M_dataplus = @{
9875 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9876 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9877 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9878 @},
9879 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9880 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9881 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9882 @}
9883 @}
9884 @end smallexample
9885
9886 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9887
9888 @smallexample
9889 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9890 $2 = "abcd"
9891 @end smallexample
9892
9893 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9894 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9895 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9896
9897 @table @code
9898 @kindex info pretty-printer
9899 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9900 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9901 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9902
9903 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9904 whose pretty-printers to list.
9905 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9906 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9907 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9908 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9909 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9910
9911 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9912 to list.
9913
9914 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9915 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9916 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9917 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9918
9919 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9920 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9921 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9922 @end table
9923
9924 Example:
9925
9926 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9927 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9928 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9929 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9930
9931 @smallexample
9932 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9933 library1.so:
9934 foo
9935 library2.so:
9936 bar
9937 bar1
9938 bar2
9939 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9940 library2.so:
9941 bar
9942 bar1
9943 bar2
9944 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9945 1 printer disabled
9946 2 of 3 printers enabled
9947 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9948 library1.so:
9949 foo [disabled]
9950 library2.so:
9951 bar
9952 bar1
9953 bar2
9954 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9955 1 printer disabled
9956 1 of 3 printers enabled
9957 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9958 library1.so:
9959 foo [disabled]
9960 library2.so:
9961 bar
9962 bar1 [disabled]
9963 bar2
9964 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9965 1 printer disabled
9966 0 of 3 printers enabled
9967 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9968 library1.so:
9969 foo [disabled]
9970 library2.so:
9971 bar [disabled]
9972 bar1 [disabled]
9973 bar2
9974 @end smallexample
9975
9976 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9977 as can each individual subprinter.
9978
9979 @node Value History
9980 @section Value History
9981
9982 @cindex value history
9983 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9984 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9985 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9986 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9987 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9988 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9989 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9990 symbol table.
9991
9992 @cindex @code{$}
9993 @cindex @code{$$}
9994 @cindex history number
9995 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9996 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9997 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9998 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9999 history number.
10000
10001 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10002 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10003 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10004 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10005 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10006 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10007 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10008
10009 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10010 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10011
10012 @smallexample
10013 p *$
10014 @end smallexample
10015
10016 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10017 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10018
10019 @smallexample
10020 p *$.next
10021 @end smallexample
10022
10023 @noindent
10024 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10025 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10026
10027 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10028 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10029
10030 @smallexample
10031 print x
10032 set x=5
10033 @end smallexample
10034
10035 @noindent
10036 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10037 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10038
10039 @table @code
10040 @kindex show values
10041 @item show values
10042 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10043 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10044 values} does not change the history.
10045
10046 @item show values @var{n}
10047 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10048
10049 @item show values +
10050 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10051 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10052 @end table
10053
10054 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10055 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10056
10057 @node Convenience Vars
10058 @section Convenience Variables
10059
10060 @cindex convenience variables
10061 @cindex user-defined variables
10062 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10063 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10064 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10065 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10066 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10067
10068 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10069 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10070 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10071 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10072 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10073
10074 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10075 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10076 For example:
10077
10078 @smallexample
10079 set $foo = *object_ptr
10080 @end smallexample
10081
10082 @noindent
10083 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10084 @code{object_ptr}.
10085
10086 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10087 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10088 value with another assignment at any time.
10089
10090 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10091 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10092 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10093 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10094
10095 @table @code
10096 @kindex show convenience
10097 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10098 @item show convenience
10099 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10100 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10101 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10102
10103 @kindex init-if-undefined
10104 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10105 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10106 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10107 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10108 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10109 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10110 override default values used in a command script.
10111
10112 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10113 any side-effects do not occur.
10114 @end table
10115
10116 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10117 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10118 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10119
10120 @smallexample
10121 set $i = 0
10122 print bar[$i++]->contents
10123 @end smallexample
10124
10125 @noindent
10126 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10127
10128 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10129 values likely to be useful.
10130
10131 @table @code
10132 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10133 @item $_
10134 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10135 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10136 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10137 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10138 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10139 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10140 to the type of @code{$__}.
10141
10142 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10143 @item $__
10144 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10145 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10146 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10147
10148 @item $_exitcode
10149 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10150 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10151 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10152 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10153
10154 @item $_exitsignal
10155 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10156 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10157 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10158 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10159
10160 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10161 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10162 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10163 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10164 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10165
10166 @smallexample
10167 #include <signal.h>
10168
10169 int
10170 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10171 @{
10172 raise (SIGALRM);
10173 return 0;
10174 @}
10175 @end smallexample
10176
10177 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10178 or signalled would be:
10179
10180 @smallexample
10181 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10182 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10183 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10184 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10185 >echo The program has exited\n
10186 >else
10187 >echo The program has signalled\n
10188 >end
10189 >end
10190 (@value{GDBP}) run
10191 Starting program:
10192
10193 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10194 The program no longer exists.
10195 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10196 The program has signalled
10197 @end smallexample
10198
10199 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10200 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10201 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10202 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10203
10204 @smallexample
10205 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10206 The program has exited
10207 @end smallexample
10208
10209 @item $_exception
10210 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10211 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10212
10213 @item $_probe_argc
10214 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10215 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10216
10217 @item $_sdata
10218 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10219 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10220 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10221 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10222 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10223
10224 @item $_siginfo
10225 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10226 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10227 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10228 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10229 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10230
10231 @item $_tlb
10232 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10233 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10234 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10235 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10236 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10237 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10238
10239 @end table
10240
10241 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10242 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10243 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10244
10245 @node Convenience Funs
10246 @section Convenience Functions
10247
10248 @cindex convenience functions
10249 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10250 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10251 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10252 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10253 @value{GDBN}.
10254
10255 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10256 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10257
10258 @table @code
10259
10260 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10261 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10262 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10263 returns zero.
10264
10265 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10266 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10267 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10268 it is @code{void}:
10269
10270 @smallexample
10271 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10272 $1 = void
10273 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10274 $2 = 1
10275 (@value{GDBP}) run
10276 Starting program: ./a.out
10277 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10278 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10279 $3 = 0
10280 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10281 $4 = 0
10282 @end smallexample
10283
10284 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10285 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10286 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10287 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10288 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10289 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10290 anymore.
10291
10292 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10293 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10294
10295 @smallexample
10296 void
10297 foo (void)
10298 @{
10299 @}
10300 @end smallexample
10301
10302 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10303
10304 @smallexample
10305 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10306 $1 = void
10307 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10308 $2 = 1
10309 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10310 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10311 $3 = void
10312 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10313 $4 = 1
10314 @end smallexample
10315
10316 @end table
10317
10318 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10319 @code{Python} support.
10320
10321 @table @code
10322
10323 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10324 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10325 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10326 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10327 Otherwise it returns zero.
10328
10329 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10330 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10331 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10332 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10333 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10334 regular expression support.
10335
10336 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10337 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10338 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10339 Otherwise it returns zero.
10340
10341 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10342 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10343 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10344
10345 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10346 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10347 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10348 Otherwise it returns zero.
10349
10350 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10351 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10352 The default is 1.
10353
10354 Example:
10355
10356 @smallexample
10357 (gdb) backtrace
10358 #0 bottom_func ()
10359 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10360 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10361 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10362 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10363 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10364 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10365 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10366 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10367 $1 = 1
10368 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10369 $1 = 1
10370 @end smallexample
10371
10372 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10373 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10374 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10375 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10376
10377 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10378 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10379 The default is 1.
10380
10381 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10382 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10383 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10384 Otherwise it returns zero.
10385
10386 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10387 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10388 The default is 1.
10389
10390 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10391 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10392 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10393 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10394
10395 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10396 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10397 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10398 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10399
10400 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10401 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10402 The default is 1.
10403
10404 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10405 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10406 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10407 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10408
10409 @end table
10410
10411 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10412 convenience functions.
10413
10414 @table @code
10415 @item help function
10416 @kindex help function
10417 @cindex show all convenience functions
10418 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10419 @end table
10420
10421 @node Registers
10422 @section Registers
10423
10424 @cindex registers
10425 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10426 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10427 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10428 your machine.
10429
10430 @table @code
10431 @kindex info registers
10432 @item info registers
10433 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10434 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10435
10436 @kindex info all-registers
10437 @cindex floating point registers
10438 @item info all-registers
10439 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10440 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10441
10442 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10443 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10444 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10445 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10446 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10447 @end table
10448
10449 @anchor{standard registers}
10450 @cindex stack pointer register
10451 @cindex program counter register
10452 @cindex process status register
10453 @cindex frame pointer register
10454 @cindex standard registers
10455 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10456 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10457 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10458 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10459 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10460 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10461 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10462 you could print the program counter in hex with
10463
10464 @smallexample
10465 p/x $pc
10466 @end smallexample
10467
10468 @noindent
10469 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10470
10471 @smallexample
10472 x/i $pc
10473 @end smallexample
10474
10475 @noindent
10476 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10477 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10478 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10479 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10480 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10481 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10482 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10483
10484 @smallexample
10485 set $sp += 4
10486 @end smallexample
10487
10488 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10489 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10490 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10491 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10492 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10493 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10494 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10495
10496 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10497 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10498 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10499 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10500 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10501 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10502 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10503
10504 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10505 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10506 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10507 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10508 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10509 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10510 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10511 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10512 prints the data in both formats.
10513
10514 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10515 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10516 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10517 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10518 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10519 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10520 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10521
10522 @smallexample
10523 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10524 $1 = @{
10525 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10526 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10527 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10528 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10529 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10530 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10531 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10532 @}
10533 @end smallexample
10534
10535 @noindent
10536 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10537 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10538 value to a @code{struct} member:
10539
10540 @smallexample
10541 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10542 @end smallexample
10543
10544 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10545 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10546 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10547 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10548 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10549 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10550
10551 @cindex caller-saved registers
10552 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10553 @cindex volatile registers
10554 @cindex <not saved> values
10555 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10556 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10557 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10558 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10559 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10560 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10561 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10562 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10563 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10564 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10565 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10566 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10567 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10568 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10569 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10570 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10571 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10572 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10573 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10574 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10575 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10576 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10577 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10578
10579 @node Floating Point Hardware
10580 @section Floating Point Hardware
10581 @cindex floating point
10582
10583 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10584 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10585
10586 @table @code
10587 @kindex info float
10588 @item info float
10589 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10590 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10591 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10592 the ARM and x86 machines.
10593 @end table
10594
10595 @node Vector Unit
10596 @section Vector Unit
10597 @cindex vector unit
10598
10599 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10600 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10601
10602 @table @code
10603 @kindex info vector
10604 @item info vector
10605 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10606 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10607 @end table
10608
10609 @node OS Information
10610 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10611 @cindex OS information
10612
10613 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10614 you debug your program.
10615
10616 @cindex auxiliary vector
10617 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10618 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10619 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10620 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10621 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10622 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10623 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10624 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10625 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10626 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10627 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10628 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10629
10630 @table @code
10631 @kindex info auxv
10632 @item info auxv
10633 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10634 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10635 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10636 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10637 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10638 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10639 an unrecognized tag.
10640 @end table
10641
10642 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10643 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10644 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10645 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10646 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10647 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10648 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10649
10650 @table @code
10651 @kindex info os
10652 @item info os @var{infotype}
10653
10654 Display OS information of the requested type.
10655
10656 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10657
10658 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10659 @table @code
10660 @kindex info os cpus
10661 @item cpus
10662 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
10663 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
10664 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
10665 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
10666 kernel initialization.
10667
10668 @kindex info os files
10669 @item files
10670 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10671 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10672 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10673 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10674
10675 @kindex info os modules
10676 @item modules
10677 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10678 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10679 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10680 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10681 in memory.
10682
10683 @kindex info os msg
10684 @item msg
10685 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10686 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10687 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10688 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10689 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10690 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10691 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10692 the message queue was last changed.
10693
10694 @kindex info os processes
10695 @item processes
10696 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10697 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10698 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10699 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10700 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10701 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10702
10703 @kindex info os procgroups
10704 @item procgroups
10705 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10706 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10707 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10708 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10709 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10710 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10711 and the process group leader is listed first.
10712
10713 @kindex info os semaphores
10714 @item semaphores
10715 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10716 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10717 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10718 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10719 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10720
10721 @kindex info os shm
10722 @item shm
10723 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10724 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10725 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10726 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10727 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10728 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10729 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10730
10731 @kindex info os sockets
10732 @item sockets
10733 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10734 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10735 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10736 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10737 connection.
10738
10739 @kindex info os threads
10740 @item threads
10741 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10742 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10743 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10744 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10745 process is not listed.
10746 @end table
10747
10748 @item info os
10749 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10750 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10751 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10752 types, this command will report an error.
10753 @end table
10754
10755 @node Memory Region Attributes
10756 @section Memory Region Attributes
10757 @cindex memory region attributes
10758
10759 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10760 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10761 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10762 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10763 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10764 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10765 user can override the fetched regions.
10766
10767 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10768 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10769 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10770 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10771 all memory.
10772
10773 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10774 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10775
10776 @table @code
10777 @kindex mem
10778 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10779 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10780 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10781 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10782 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10783 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10784
10785 @item mem auto
10786 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10787 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10788
10789 @kindex delete mem
10790 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10791 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10792 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10793
10794 @kindex disable mem
10795 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10796 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10797 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10798 It may be enabled again later.
10799
10800 @kindex enable mem
10801 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10802 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10803
10804 @kindex info mem
10805 @item info mem
10806 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10807 for each region:
10808
10809 @table @emph
10810 @item Memory Region Number
10811 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10812 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10813 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10814
10815 @item Lo Address
10816 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10817
10818 @item Hi Address
10819 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10820
10821 @item Attributes
10822 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10823 @end table
10824 @end table
10825
10826
10827 @subsection Attributes
10828
10829 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10830 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10831 write accesses to a memory region.
10832
10833 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10834 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10835 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10836
10837 @table @code
10838 @item ro
10839 Memory is read only.
10840 @item wo
10841 Memory is write only.
10842 @item rw
10843 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10844 @end table
10845
10846 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10847 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10848 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10849 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10850 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10851
10852 @table @code
10853 @item 8
10854 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10855 @item 16
10856 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10857 @item 32
10858 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
10859 @item 64
10860 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
10861 @end table
10862
10863 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
10864 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10865 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
10866 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
10867 @c
10868 @c @table @code
10869 @c @item hwbreak
10870 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
10871 @c @item swbreak (default)
10872 @c @end table
10873
10874 @subsubsection Data Cache
10875 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
10876 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
10877 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
10878 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
10879 registers.
10880
10881 @table @code
10882 @item cache
10883 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
10884 @item nocache
10885 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
10886 @end table
10887
10888 @subsection Memory Access Checking
10889 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
10890 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
10891 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
10892 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
10893
10894 @table @code
10895 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
10896 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
10897 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
10898 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
10899 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
10900 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
10901 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
10902 The default value is @code{on}.
10903 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
10904 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
10905 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
10906 @end table
10907
10908
10909 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
10910 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10911 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
10912 @c
10913 @c @table @code
10914 @c @item verify
10915 @c @item noverify (default)
10916 @c @end table
10917
10918 @node Dump/Restore Files
10919 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
10920 @cindex dump/restore files
10921 @cindex append data to a file
10922 @cindex dump data to a file
10923 @cindex restore data from a file
10924
10925 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
10926 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
10927 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
10928 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
10929 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
10930 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
10931 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
10932
10933 @table @code
10934
10935 @kindex dump
10936 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10937 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10938 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10939 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
10940
10941 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
10942 @table @code
10943 @item binary
10944 Raw binary form.
10945 @item ihex
10946 Intel hex format.
10947 @item srec
10948 Motorola S-record format.
10949 @item tekhex
10950 Tektronix Hex format.
10951 @item verilog
10952 Verilog Hex format.
10953 @end table
10954
10955 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
10956 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
10957 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
10958 form.
10959
10960 @kindex append
10961 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10962 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10963 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10964 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
10965 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
10966
10967 @kindex restore
10968 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
10969 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
10970 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
10971 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
10972 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
10973
10974 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
10975 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
10976 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
10977 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
10978 from that location.
10979
10980 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
10981 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
10982 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
10983 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
10984
10985 @end table
10986
10987 @node Core File Generation
10988 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
10989 @cindex dump core from inferior
10990
10991 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
10992 image of a running process and its process status (register values
10993 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
10994 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
10995 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
10996 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
10997 the post-mortem debugging mode.
10998
10999 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11000 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11001 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11002
11003 @table @code
11004 @kindex gcore
11005 @kindex generate-core-file
11006 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11007 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11008 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11009 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11010 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11011 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11012
11013 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11014 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11015
11016 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11017 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11018 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11019
11020 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11021 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11022 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11023 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11024 Enable or disable the use of the file
11025 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11026 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11027 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11028 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11029
11030 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11031 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11032 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11033 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11034 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11035 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11036 about the bits that can be set in the
11037 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11038 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11039
11040 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11041 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11042 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11043 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11044 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11045 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11046 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11047 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11048 @end table
11049
11050 @node Character Sets
11051 @section Character Sets
11052 @cindex character sets
11053 @cindex charset
11054 @cindex translating between character sets
11055 @cindex host character set
11056 @cindex target character set
11057
11058 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11059 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11060 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11061 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11062 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11063 @dfn{target character set}.
11064
11065 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11066 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11067 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11068 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11069 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11070 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11071 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11072 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11073 character and string literals in expressions.
11074
11075 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11076 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11077 target-charset} command, described below.
11078
11079 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11080 support:
11081
11082 @table @code
11083 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11084 @kindex set target-charset
11085 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11086 list of supported target character sets, type
11087 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11088
11089 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11090 @kindex set host-charset
11091 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11092
11093 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11094 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11095 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11096 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11097 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11098
11099 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11100 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11101 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11102
11103 @item set charset @var{charset}
11104 @kindex set charset
11105 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11106 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11107 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11108 for both host and target.
11109
11110 @item show charset
11111 @kindex show charset
11112 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11113
11114 @item show host-charset
11115 @kindex show host-charset
11116 Show the name of the current host character set.
11117
11118 @item show target-charset
11119 @kindex show target-charset
11120 Show the name of the current target character set.
11121
11122 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11123 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11124 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11125 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11126 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11127 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11128
11129 @item show target-wide-charset
11130 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11131 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11132 @end table
11133
11134 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11135 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11136 @file{charset-test.c}:
11137
11138 @smallexample
11139 #include <stdio.h>
11140
11141 char ascii_hello[]
11142 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11143 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11144 char ibm1047_hello[]
11145 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11146 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11147
11148 main ()
11149 @{
11150 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11151 @}
11152 @end smallexample
11153
11154 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11155 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11156 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11157
11158 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11159
11160 @smallexample
11161 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11162 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11163 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11164 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11165 @dots{}
11166 (@value{GDBP})
11167 @end smallexample
11168
11169 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11170 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11171 strings:
11172
11173 @smallexample
11174 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11175 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11176 (@value{GDBP})
11177 @end smallexample
11178
11179 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11180 initial character set:
11181 @smallexample
11182 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11183 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11184 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11185 (@value{GDBP})
11186 @end smallexample
11187
11188 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11189 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11190 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11191 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11192 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11193
11194 @smallexample
11195 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11196 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11197 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11198 $2 = 72 'H'
11199 (@value{GDBP})
11200 @end smallexample
11201
11202 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11203 literals you use in expressions:
11204
11205 @smallexample
11206 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11207 $3 = 43 '+'
11208 (@value{GDBP})
11209 @end smallexample
11210
11211 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11212 character.
11213
11214 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11215 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11216 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11217
11218 @smallexample
11219 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11220 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11221 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11222 $5 = 200 '\310'
11223 (@value{GDBP})
11224 @end smallexample
11225
11226 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11227 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11228
11229 @smallexample
11230 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11231 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11232 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11233 @end smallexample
11234
11235 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11236 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11237 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11238 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11239 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11240
11241 @smallexample
11242 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11243 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11244 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11245 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11246 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11247 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11248 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11249 $7 = 72 '\110'
11250 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11251 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11252 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11253 $9 = 200 'H'
11254 (@value{GDBP})
11255 @end smallexample
11256
11257 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11258 string literals you use in expressions:
11259
11260 @smallexample
11261 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11262 $10 = 78 '+'
11263 (@value{GDBP})
11264 @end smallexample
11265
11266 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11267 character.
11268
11269 @node Caching Target Data
11270 @section Caching Data of Targets
11271 @cindex caching data of targets
11272
11273 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11274 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11275 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11276 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11277 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11278 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11279 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11280 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11281 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11282 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11283 is executing.
11284 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11285 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11286 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11287 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11288 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11289 in the code segment.
11290 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11291 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11292
11293 @table @code
11294 @kindex set remotecache
11295 @item set remotecache on
11296 @itemx set remotecache off
11297 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11298 with old scripts.
11299
11300 @kindex show remotecache
11301 @item show remotecache
11302 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11303
11304 @kindex set stack-cache
11305 @item set stack-cache on
11306 @itemx set stack-cache off
11307 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11308 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11309
11310 @kindex show stack-cache
11311 @item show stack-cache
11312 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11313
11314 @kindex set code-cache
11315 @item set code-cache on
11316 @itemx set code-cache off
11317 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11318 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11319 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11320
11321 @kindex show code-cache
11322 @item show code-cache
11323 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11324 accesses.
11325
11326 @kindex info dcache
11327 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11328 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11329 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11330 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11331 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11332 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11333
11334 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11335 printed in hex.
11336
11337 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11338 @cindex dcache size
11339 @kindex set dcache size
11340 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11341
11342 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11343 @cindex dcache line-size
11344 @kindex set dcache line-size
11345 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11346 Must be a power of 2.
11347
11348 @item show dcache size
11349 @kindex show dcache size
11350 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11351
11352 @item show dcache line-size
11353 @kindex show dcache line-size
11354 Show default size of dcache lines.
11355
11356 @end table
11357
11358 @node Searching Memory
11359 @section Search Memory
11360 @cindex searching memory
11361
11362 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11363 @code{find} command.
11364
11365 @table @code
11366 @kindex find
11367 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11368 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11369 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11370 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11371 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11372 @end table
11373
11374 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11375 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11376
11377 @table @r
11378 @item @var{s}, search query size
11379 The size of each search query value.
11380
11381 @table @code
11382 @item b
11383 bytes
11384 @item h
11385 halfwords (two bytes)
11386 @item w
11387 words (four bytes)
11388 @item g
11389 giant words (eight bytes)
11390 @end table
11391
11392 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11393 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11394 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11395
11396 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11397 value's type in the current language.
11398 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11399 pattern as a mixture of types.
11400 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11401 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11402 which is typically four bytes.
11403
11404 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11405 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11406 @end table
11407
11408 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11409 (@code{"}).
11410 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11411 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11412
11413 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11414 number of matches found.
11415
11416 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11417 @samp{$_}.
11418 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11419
11420 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11421
11422 @smallexample
11423 void
11424 hello ()
11425 @{
11426 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11427 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11428 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11429 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11430 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11431 @}
11432 @end smallexample
11433
11434 @noindent
11435 you get during debugging:
11436
11437 @smallexample
11438 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11439 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11440 1 pattern found
11441 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11442 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11443 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11444 2 patterns found
11445 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11446 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11447 1 pattern found
11448 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11449 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11450 1 pattern found
11451 (gdb) print $numfound
11452 $1 = 1
11453 (gdb) print $_
11454 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11455 @end smallexample
11456
11457 @node Optimized Code
11458 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11459 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11460 @cindex debugging optimized code
11461
11462 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11463 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11464 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11465 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11466 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11467 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11468 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11469
11470 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11471 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11472 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11473 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11474
11475 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11476 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11477 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11478 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11479 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11480 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11481
11482 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11483 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11484 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11485 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11486 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11487
11488 @menu
11489 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11490 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11491 @end menu
11492
11493 @node Inline Functions
11494 @section Inline Functions
11495 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11496
11497 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11498 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11499 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11500 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11501 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11502 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11503 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11504 @code{info frame} command.
11505
11506 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11507 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11508 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11509 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11510 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11511 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11512 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11513 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11514 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11515 local variables in the caller.
11516
11517 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11518 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11519 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11520 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11521 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11522 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11523 instructions are executed.
11524
11525 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11526 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11527 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11528 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11529
11530 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11531 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11532
11533 @itemize @bullet
11534 @item
11535 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11536 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11537 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11538 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11539 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11540 or inside the inlined function instead.
11541
11542 @item
11543 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11544 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11545 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11546 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11547
11548 @end itemize
11549
11550 @node Tail Call Frames
11551 @section Tail Call Frames
11552 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11553
11554 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11555 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11556 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11557 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11558 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11559
11560 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11561 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11562 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11563 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11564 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11565 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11566 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11567
11568 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11569 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11570 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11571 this information.
11572
11573 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11574 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11575
11576 @smallexample
11577 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11578 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11579 (gdb) info frame
11580 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11581 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11582 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11583 source language c++.
11584 Arglist at unknown address.
11585 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11586 @end smallexample
11587
11588 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11589 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11590 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11591 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11592 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11593 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11594
11595 @table @code
11596 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11597 @item set debug entry-values
11598 @kindex set debug entry-values
11599 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11600 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11601 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11602 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11603 result.
11604
11605 @item show debug entry-values
11606 @kindex show debug entry-values
11607 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11608 values at function entry and tail calls.
11609 @end table
11610
11611 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11612 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11613 reference by variable @code{x}):
11614
11615 @smallexample
11616 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11617 void (*x) (void) = c;
11618 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11619 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11620 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11621
11622 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11623 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11624 a () at t.c:3
11625 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11626 (gdb) bt
11627 #0 a () at t.c:3
11628 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11629 @end smallexample
11630
11631 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11632
11633 @smallexample
11634 int i;
11635 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11636 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11637 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11638 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11639 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11640 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11641 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11642 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11643
11644 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11645 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11646 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11647 (gdb) bt
11648 #0 f () at t.c:2
11649 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11650 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11651 @end smallexample
11652
11653 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11654 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11655
11656 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11657 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11658 @set ARROW @click{}
11659 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11660 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11661 @end ifset
11662 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11663 @set ARROW ->
11664 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11665 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11666 @end ifclear
11667
11668 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11669 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11670 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11671
11672 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11673 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11674 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11675 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11676 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11677 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11678
11679 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11680 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11681 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11682 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11683 omitted.
11684
11685 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11686 entry may fail:
11687
11688 @smallexample
11689 int v;
11690 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11691 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11692 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11693 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11694 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11695 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11696
11697 (gdb) bt
11698 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11699 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11700 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11701 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11702 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11703 @end smallexample
11704
11705 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11706 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11707 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11708 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11709 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11710
11711 @node Macros
11712 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11713
11714 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11715 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11716 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11717 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11718 where it was defined.
11719
11720 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11721 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11722 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11723 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11724
11725 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11726 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11727 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11728 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11729 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11730 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11731 see @ref{List}.
11732
11733 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11734 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11735 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11736
11737 @table @code
11738
11739 @kindex macro expand
11740 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11741 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11742 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11743 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11744 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11745 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11746 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11747 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11748 it can be any string of tokens.
11749
11750 @kindex macro exp1
11751 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11752 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11753 @cindex expand macro once
11754 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11755 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11756 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11757 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11758 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11759 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11760 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11761 can be any string of tokens.
11762
11763 @kindex info macro
11764 @cindex macro definition, showing
11765 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11766 @cindex macros, from debug info
11767 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11768 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11769 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11770 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11771 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11772 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11773
11774 @kindex info macros
11775 @item info macros @var{linespec}
11776 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11777 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
11778 command-line where those definitions were established.
11779
11780 @kindex macro define
11781 @cindex user-defined macros
11782 @cindex defining macros interactively
11783 @cindex macros, user-defined
11784 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11785 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11786 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11787 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11788 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11789 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11790 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11791 @var{arglist}.
11792
11793 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11794 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11795 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11796 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11797 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11798
11799 @kindex macro undef
11800 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11801 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11802 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11803 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11804 in the program being debugged.
11805
11806 @kindex macro list
11807 @item macro list
11808 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11809 @end table
11810
11811 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11812 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11813 show our source files:
11814
11815 @smallexample
11816 $ cat sample.c
11817 #include <stdio.h>
11818 #include "sample.h"
11819
11820 #define M 42
11821 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11822
11823 main ()
11824 @{
11825 #define N 28
11826 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11827 #undef N
11828 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11829 #define N 1729
11830 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11831 @}
11832 $ cat sample.h
11833 #define Q <
11834 $
11835 @end smallexample
11836
11837 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11838 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11839 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11840 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11841 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11842 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11843 information.
11844
11845 @smallexample
11846 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11847 $
11848 @end smallexample
11849
11850 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11851
11852 @smallexample
11853 $ gdb -nw sample
11854 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11855 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11856 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11857 (@value{GDBP})
11858 @end smallexample
11859
11860 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
11861 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
11862 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
11863
11864 @smallexample
11865 (@value{GDBP}) list main
11866 3
11867 4 #define M 42
11868 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11869 6
11870 7 main ()
11871 8 @{
11872 9 #define N 28
11873 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11874 11 #undef N
11875 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11876 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
11877 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
11878 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11879 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
11880 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
11881 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
11882 #define Q <
11883 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
11884 expands to: (42 + 1)
11885 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
11886 expands to: once (M + 1)
11887 (@value{GDBP})
11888 @end smallexample
11889
11890 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
11891 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
11892 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
11893 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
11894
11895 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
11896 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
11897
11898 @smallexample
11899 (@value{GDBP}) break main
11900 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
11901 (@value{GDBP}) run
11902 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
11903
11904 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
11905 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11906 (@value{GDBP})
11907 @end smallexample
11908
11909 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
11910
11911 @smallexample
11912 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11913 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
11914 #define N 28
11915 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11916 expands to: 28 < 42
11917 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11918 $1 = 1
11919 (@value{GDBP})
11920 @end smallexample
11921
11922 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
11923 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
11924 thereof) in force at each point:
11925
11926 @smallexample
11927 (@value{GDBP}) next
11928 Hello, world!
11929 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11930 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11931 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
11932 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
11933 (@value{GDBP}) next
11934 We're so creative.
11935 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11936 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11937 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
11938 #define N 1729
11939 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11940 expands to: 1729 < 42
11941 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11942 $2 = 0
11943 (@value{GDBP})
11944 @end smallexample
11945
11946 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
11947 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
11948 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
11949 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
11950
11951 @smallexample
11952 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
11953 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
11954 -D__STDC__=1
11955 (@value{GDBP})
11956 @end smallexample
11957
11958
11959 @node Tracepoints
11960 @chapter Tracepoints
11961 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
11962 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
11963
11964 @cindex tracepoints
11965 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
11966 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
11967 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
11968 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
11969 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
11970 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
11971 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
11972
11973 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
11974 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
11975 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
11976 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
11977 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
11978 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
11979 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
11980 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
11981 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
11982 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
11983 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
11984
11985 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
11986 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
11987 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
11988 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
11989 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
11990 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
11991 Packets}.
11992
11993 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
11994 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
11995 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
11996
11997 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
11998
11999 @menu
12000 * Set Tracepoints::
12001 * Analyze Collected Data::
12002 * Tracepoint Variables::
12003 * Trace Files::
12004 @end menu
12005
12006 @node Set Tracepoints
12007 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12008
12009 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12010 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12011 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12012 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12013 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12014 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12015 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12016
12017 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12018 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12019 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12020 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12021 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12022 tracepoint was hit.
12023
12024 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12025 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12026 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12027 either.
12028
12029 @cindex fast tracepoints
12030 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12031 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12032 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12033
12034 @cindex static tracepoints
12035 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12036 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12037 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12038 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12039 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12040 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12041 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12042 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12043 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12044 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12045 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12046 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12047 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12048 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12049 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12050 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12051 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12052 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12053 static tracepoint marker.
12054
12055 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12056 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12057
12058 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12059 conditions and actions.
12060
12061 @menu
12062 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12063 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12064 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12065 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12066 * Trace State Variables::
12067 * Tracepoint Actions::
12068 * Listing Tracepoints::
12069 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12070 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12071 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12072 @end menu
12073
12074 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12075 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12076
12077 @table @code
12078 @cindex set tracepoint
12079 @kindex trace
12080 @item trace @var{location}
12081 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12082 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
12083 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
12084 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
12085 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
12086 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
12087 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12088 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12089 in tracing}).
12090 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12091 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12092 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12093 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12094 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12095 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12096 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12097 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12098 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12099 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12100 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12101 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12102
12103 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12104
12105 @smallexample
12106 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12107
12108 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12109
12110 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12111
12112 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12113
12114 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12115 @end smallexample
12116
12117 @noindent
12118 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12119
12120 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12121 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12122 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12123 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12124 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12125 information on tracepoint conditions.
12126
12127 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12128 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12129 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12130 @kindex ftrace
12131 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12132 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12133 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12134 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12135 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12136 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12137 message.
12138
12139 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12140 @code{trace}.
12141
12142 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12143 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12144 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12145 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12146 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12147 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12148 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12149 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12150
12151 @example
12152 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12153 @end example
12154
12155 @noindent
12156 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12157 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12158
12159 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12160 @cindex set static tracepoint
12161 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12162 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12163 @kindex strace
12164 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12165 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12166 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12167 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12168 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12169
12170 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12171 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12172 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12173 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12174 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12175 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12176 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12177 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12178 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12179 tracing engine:
12180
12181 @smallexample
12182 main ()
12183 @{
12184 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12185 @}
12186 @end smallexample
12187
12188 @noindent
12189 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12190 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12191
12192 @smallexample
12193 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12194 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12195 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12196 Data: "str %s"
12197 [etc...]
12198 @end smallexample
12199
12200 @noindent
12201 so you may probe the marker above with:
12202
12203 @smallexample
12204 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12205 @end smallexample
12206
12207 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12208 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12209 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12210 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12211 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12212 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12213 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12214 the @samp{Data:} field.
12215
12216 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12217 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12218 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12219
12220 @vindex $tpnum
12221 @cindex last tracepoint number
12222 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12223 @cindex tracepoint number
12224 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12225 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12226
12227 @kindex delete tracepoint
12228 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12229 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12230 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12231 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12232 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12233
12234 Examples:
12235
12236 @smallexample
12237 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12238
12239 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12240 @end smallexample
12241
12242 @noindent
12243 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12244 @end table
12245
12246 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12247 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12248
12249 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12250
12251 @table @code
12252 @kindex disable tracepoint
12253 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12254 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12255 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12256 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12257 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12258 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12259 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12260 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12261 next trace experiment.
12262
12263 @kindex enable tracepoint
12264 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12265 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12266 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12267 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12268 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12269 next time a trace experiment is run.
12270 @end table
12271
12272 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12273 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12274
12275 @table @code
12276 @kindex passcount
12277 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12278 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12279 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12280 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12281 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12282 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12283 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12284 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12285 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12286 user.
12287
12288 Examples:
12289
12290 @smallexample
12291 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12292 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12293
12294 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12295 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12296 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12297 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12298 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12299 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12300 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12301 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12302 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12303 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12304 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12305 @end smallexample
12306 @end table
12307
12308 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12309 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12310 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12311 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12312
12313 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12314 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12315 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12316 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12317 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12318 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12319 is true.
12320
12321 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12322 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12323 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12324 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12325 just as with breakpoints.
12326
12327 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12328 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12329 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12330 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12331 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12332 accesses, and so forth.
12333
12334 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12335 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12336 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12337 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12338 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12339 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12340 search through.
12341
12342 @smallexample
12343 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12344 @end smallexample
12345
12346 @node Trace State Variables
12347 @subsection Trace State Variables
12348 @cindex trace state variables
12349
12350 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12351 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12352 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12353 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12354 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12355 integers.
12356
12357 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12358 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12359 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12360 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12361
12362 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12363 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12364 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12365 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12366 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12367 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12368 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12369 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12370 variable with the same name.
12371
12372 @table @code
12373
12374 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12375 @kindex tvariable
12376 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12377 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12378 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12379 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12380 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12381 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12382 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12383 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12384 value. The default initial value is 0.
12385
12386 @item info tvariables
12387 @kindex info tvariables
12388 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12389 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12390 currently running.
12391
12392 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12393 @kindex delete tvariable
12394 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12395 are specified.
12396
12397 @end table
12398
12399 @node Tracepoint Actions
12400 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12401
12402 @table @code
12403 @kindex actions
12404 @cindex tracepoint actions
12405 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12406 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12407 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12408 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12409 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12410 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12411 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12412 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12413 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12414 @code{while-stepping}.
12415
12416 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12417 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12418 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12419
12420 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12421 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12422 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12423
12424 @smallexample
12425 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12426
12427 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12428
12429 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12430 @end smallexample
12431
12432 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12433 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12434 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12435 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12436 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12437 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12438 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12439 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12440
12441 @smallexample
12442 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12443 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12444 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12445 > collect bar,baz
12446 > collect $regs
12447 > while-stepping 12
12448 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12449 > end
12450 end
12451 @end smallexample
12452
12453 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12454 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12455 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12456 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12457 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12458 special arguments are supported:
12459
12460 @table @code
12461 @item $regs
12462 Collect all registers.
12463
12464 @item $args
12465 Collect all function arguments.
12466
12467 @item $locals
12468 Collect all local variables.
12469
12470 @item $_ret
12471 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12472 of a backtrace.
12473
12474 @item $_probe_argc
12475 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12476 tracepoint is located.
12477 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12478
12479 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12480 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12481 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12482 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12483
12484 @item $_sdata
12485 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12486 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12487 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12488 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12489 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12490 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12491 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12492 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12493 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12494
12495 @smallexample
12496 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12497 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12498 @end smallexample
12499
12500 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12501 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12502 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12503 @value{GDBN}.
12504 @end table
12505
12506 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12507 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12508 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12509
12510 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12511 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12512 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12513 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12514 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12515 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12516 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12517 @samp{mystr}.
12518
12519 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12520 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12521
12522 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12523 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12524 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12525 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12526 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12527 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12528 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12529 action were used.
12530
12531 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12532 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12533 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12534 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12535 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12536 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12537
12538 @smallexample
12539 > while-stepping 12
12540 > collect $regs, myglobal
12541 > end
12542 >
12543 @end smallexample
12544
12545 @noindent
12546 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12547 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12548 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12549 @code{stepping}.
12550
12551 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12552 @kindex set default-collect
12553 @cindex default collection action
12554 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12555 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12556 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12557 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12558 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12559 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12560
12561 @item show default-collect
12562 @kindex show default-collect
12563 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12564 tracepoint hit.
12565
12566 @end table
12567
12568 @node Listing Tracepoints
12569 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12570
12571 @table @code
12572 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12573 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12574 @cindex information about tracepoints
12575 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12576 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12577 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12578 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12579 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12580 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12581
12582 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12583 tracing:
12584
12585 @itemize @bullet
12586 @item
12587 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12588
12589 @item
12590 the state about installed on target of each location
12591 @end itemize
12592
12593 @smallexample
12594 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12595 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12596 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12597 while-stepping 20
12598 collect globfoo, $regs
12599 end
12600 collect globfoo2
12601 end
12602 pass count 1200
12603 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12604 collect $eip
12605 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12606 installed on target
12607 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12608 installed on target
12609 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12610 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12611 not installed on target
12612 (@value{GDBP})
12613 @end smallexample
12614
12615 @noindent
12616 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12617 @end table
12618
12619 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12620 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12621
12622 @table @code
12623 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12624 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12625 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12626 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12627 program.
12628
12629 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12630
12631 @table @emph
12632 @item Count
12633 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12634 stable identifier.
12635 @item ID
12636 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12637 @item Enabled or Disabled
12638 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12639 that are not enabled.
12640 @item Address
12641 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12642 @item What
12643 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12644 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12645 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12646 will be left blank.
12647 @end table
12648
12649 @noindent
12650 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12651
12652 @table @emph
12653 @item Data
12654 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12655 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12656 marker call.
12657 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12658 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12659 @end table
12660
12661 @smallexample
12662 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12663 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12664 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12665 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12666 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12667 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12668 Data: str %s
12669 (@value{GDBP})
12670 @end smallexample
12671 @end table
12672
12673 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12674 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12675
12676 @table @code
12677 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12678 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12679 @cindex collected data discarded
12680 @item tstart
12681 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12682 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12683 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12684 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12685 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12686 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12687 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12688 information, and so forth.
12689
12690 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12691 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12692 @item tstop
12693 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12694 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12695 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12696 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12697 needs to be stopped quickly.
12698
12699 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12700 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12701 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12702
12703 @kindex tstatus
12704 @cindex status of trace data collection
12705 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12706 @item tstatus
12707 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12708 collection.
12709 @end table
12710
12711 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12712
12713 @smallexample
12714 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12716 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12717 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12718 > while-stepping 11
12719 > collect $regs
12720 > end
12721 > end
12722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12723 [time passes @dots{}]
12724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12725 @end smallexample
12726
12727 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12728 @cindex disconnected tracing
12729 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12730 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12731 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12732 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12733 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12734 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12735 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12736 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12737
12738 @table @code
12739 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12740 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12741 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12742 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12743 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12744 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12745 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12746 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12747
12748 @item show disconnected-tracing
12749 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12750 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12751
12752 @end table
12753
12754 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12755 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12756 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12757 it will continue after reconnection.
12758
12759 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12760 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12761 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12762 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12763 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12764 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12765 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12766 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12767 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12768 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12769
12770 @cindex circular trace buffer
12771 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12772 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12773 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12774 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12775 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12776 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12777 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12778 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12779 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12780 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12781 the next run.
12782
12783 @table @code
12784 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12785 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12786 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12787 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12788 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12789 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12790 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12791
12792 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12793 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12794 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12795 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12796 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12797 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12798
12799 @end table
12800
12801 @table @code
12802 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12803 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12804 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12805 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12806 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12807 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12808 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12809 likes. This is also the default.
12810
12811 @item show trace-buffer-size
12812 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12813 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12814 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12815 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12816 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12817 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12818 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12819 @end table
12820
12821 @table @code
12822 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12823 @kindex set trace-user
12824
12825 @item show trace-user
12826 @kindex show trace-user
12827
12828 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12829 @kindex set trace-notes
12830 Set the trace run's notes.
12831
12832 @item show trace-notes
12833 @kindex show trace-notes
12834 Show the trace run's notes.
12835
12836 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12837 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12838 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12839 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12840 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12841
12842 @item show trace-stop-notes
12843 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12844 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12845
12846 @end table
12847
12848 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12849 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12850
12851 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12852 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12853 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12854 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12855 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12856 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12857 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12858 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
12859 mentioned here.
12860
12861 @itemize @bullet
12862
12863 @item
12864 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
12865 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
12866 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
12867 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
12868 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
12869 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
12870 cannot be collected either.
12871
12872 @item
12873 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
12874 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
12875 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
12876 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
12877 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
12878 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
12879 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
12880 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
12881 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
12882 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
12883
12884 @item
12885 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
12886 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
12887 in a misleading way.
12888
12889 @item
12890 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
12891 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
12892 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
12893 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
12894 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
12895 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
12896 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
12897 by @code{ptr}.
12898
12899 @item
12900 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
12901 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
12902 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
12903 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
12904 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
12905 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
12906 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
12907 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
12908 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
12909 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
12910 invalid address.
12911
12912 @item
12913 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
12914 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
12915 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
12916 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
12917 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
12918 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
12919 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
12920 it to zero.
12921
12922 @end itemize
12923
12924 @node Analyze Collected Data
12925 @section Using the Collected Data
12926
12927 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
12928 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
12929 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
12930 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
12931 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
12932 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
12933 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
12934 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
12935 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
12936 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
12937 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
12938 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
12939 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
12940 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
12941 the buffer will fail.
12942
12943 @menu
12944 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
12945 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
12946 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
12947 @end menu
12948
12949 @node tfind
12950 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
12951
12952 @kindex tfind
12953 @cindex select trace snapshot
12954 @cindex find trace snapshot
12955 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
12956 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
12957 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
12958 snapshot is selected.
12959
12960 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
12961
12962 @table @code
12963 @item tfind start
12964 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
12965 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
12966
12967 @item tfind none
12968 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
12969
12970 @item tfind end
12971 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
12972
12973 @item tfind
12974 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
12975
12976 @item tfind -
12977 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
12978 retracing earlier steps.
12979
12980 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
12981 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
12982 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
12983 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
12984 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
12985
12986 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
12987 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
12988 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
12989 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
12990 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
12991
12992 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12993 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
12994 addresses (exclusive).
12995
12996 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12997 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
12998 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
12999
13000 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13001 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13002 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13003 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13004 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13005 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13006 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13007 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13008 @end table
13009
13010 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13011 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13012 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13013 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13014 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13015 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13016 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13017 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13018 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13019 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13020 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13021 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13022 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13023 tracepoint as the current one.
13024
13025 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13026 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13027 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13028 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13029 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13030
13031 @smallexample
13032 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13033 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13034 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13035 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13036 > tfind
13037 > end
13038
13039 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13040 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13041 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13042 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13043 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13044 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13045 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13046 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13047 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13048 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13049 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13050 @end smallexample
13051
13052 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13053 the buffer:
13054
13055 @smallexample
13056 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13057 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13058 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13059 > tfind line
13060 > end
13061
13062 Frame 0, X = 1
13063 Frame 7, X = 2
13064 Frame 13, X = 255
13065 @end smallexample
13066
13067 @node tdump
13068 @subsection @code{tdump}
13069 @kindex tdump
13070 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13071 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13072
13073 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13074 the current trace snapshot.
13075
13076 @smallexample
13077 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13078 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13079 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13080 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13081 > end
13082
13083 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13084
13085 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13086 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13087 at gdb_test.c:444
13088 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13089
13090 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13091 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13092 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13093 d1 0x18 24
13094 d2 0x80 128
13095 d3 0x33 51
13096 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13097 d5 0x22 34
13098 d6 0xe0 224
13099 d7 0x380035 3670069
13100 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13101 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13102 a2 0x100 256
13103 a3 0x322000 3284992
13104 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13105 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13106 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13107 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13108 ps 0x0 0
13109 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13110 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13111 fpstatus 0x0 0
13112 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13113 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13114 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13115 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13116 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13117 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13118 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13119 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13120 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13121
13122 (@value{GDBP})
13123 @end smallexample
13124
13125 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13126 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13127 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13128 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13129
13130 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13131 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13132 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13133 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13134 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13135 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13136 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13137 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13138 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13139 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13140
13141 @node save tracepoints
13142 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13143 @kindex save tracepoints
13144 @kindex save-tracepoints
13145 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13146
13147 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13148 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13149 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13150 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13151 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13152 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13153
13154 @node Tracepoint Variables
13155 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13156 @cindex tracepoint variables
13157 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13158
13159 @table @code
13160 @vindex $trace_frame
13161 @item (int) $trace_frame
13162 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13163 snapshot is selected.
13164
13165 @vindex $tracepoint
13166 @item (int) $tracepoint
13167 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13168
13169 @vindex $trace_line
13170 @item (int) $trace_line
13171 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13172
13173 @vindex $trace_file
13174 @item (char []) $trace_file
13175 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13176
13177 @vindex $trace_func
13178 @item (char []) $trace_func
13179 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13180 @end table
13181
13182 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13183 use @code{output} instead.
13184
13185 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13186 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13187 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13188 which are managed by the target.
13189
13190 @smallexample
13191 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13192
13193 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13194 > output $trace_file
13195 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13196 > tfind
13197 > end
13198 @end smallexample
13199
13200 @node Trace Files
13201 @section Using Trace Files
13202 @cindex trace files
13203
13204 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13205 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13206 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13207 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13208 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13209
13210 @table @code
13211
13212 @kindex tsave
13213 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13214 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13215 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13216 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13217 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13218 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13219 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13220 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13221 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13222 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13223 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13224 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
13225 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13226 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13227 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13228
13229 @kindex target tfile
13230 @kindex tfile
13231 @kindex target ctf
13232 @kindex ctf
13233 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13234 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13235 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13236 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13237 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13238 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13239 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13240 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13241 the host.
13242
13243 @smallexample
13244 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13245 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13246 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13247 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13248 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13249 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13250 i = 0
13251 a = 0
13252 b = 1 '\001'
13253 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13254 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13255 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13256 $1 = 1
13257 @end smallexample
13258
13259 @end table
13260
13261 @node Overlays
13262 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13263 @cindex overlays
13264
13265 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13266 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13267 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13268 use overlays.
13269
13270 @menu
13271 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13272 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13273 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13274 mapped by asking the inferior.
13275 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13276 @end menu
13277
13278 @node How Overlays Work
13279 @section How Overlays Work
13280 @cindex mapped overlays
13281 @cindex unmapped overlays
13282 @cindex load address, overlay's
13283 @cindex mapped address
13284 @cindex overlay area
13285
13286 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13287 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13288 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13289 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13290 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13291
13292 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13293 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13294 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13295 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13296 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13297 largest overlay as well.
13298
13299 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13300 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13301 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13302 there.
13303
13304 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13305 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13306 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13307
13308 @smallexample
13309 @group
13310 Data Instruction Larger
13311 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13312 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13313 | | | | | |
13314 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13315 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13316 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13317 | and heap | | | | | |
13318 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13319 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13320 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13321 | | | | | |
13322 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13323 address | | | | | |
13324 | overlay | <-' | | |
13325 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13326 | | <---. | | load address
13327 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13328 | | | |
13329 +-----------+ | |
13330 +-----------+
13331 | |
13332 +-----------+
13333
13334 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13335 @end group
13336 @end smallexample
13337
13338 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13339 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13340 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13341 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13342 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13343 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13344 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13345 program and the overlay area.
13346
13347 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13348 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13349 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13350 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13351 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13352 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13353 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13354
13355 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13356 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13357 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13358
13359 @itemize @bullet
13360
13361 @item
13362 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13363 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13364 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13365 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13366
13367 @item
13368 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13369 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13370 your program's performance.
13371
13372 @item
13373 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13374 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13375 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13376 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13377 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13378 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13379 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13380
13381 @item
13382 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13383 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13384 instruction and data spaces.
13385
13386 @end itemize
13387
13388 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13389 improved in many ways:
13390
13391 @itemize @bullet
13392
13393 @item
13394 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13395 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13396 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13397 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13398 area in the usual way.
13399
13400 @item
13401 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13402 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13403
13404 @item
13405 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13406 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13407 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13408 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13409 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13410 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13411 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13412
13413 @end itemize
13414
13415
13416 @node Overlay Commands
13417 @section Overlay Commands
13418
13419 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13420 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13421 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13422 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13423 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13424 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13425
13426 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13427 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13428
13429 @table @code
13430 @item overlay off
13431 @kindex overlay
13432 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13433 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13434 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13435 overlay support is disabled.
13436
13437 @item overlay manual
13438 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13439 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13440 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13441 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13442 commands described below.
13443
13444 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13445 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13446 @cindex map an overlay
13447 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13448 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13449 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13450 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13451 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13452 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13453
13454 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13455 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13456 @cindex unmap an overlay
13457 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13458 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13459 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13460 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13461
13462 @item overlay auto
13463 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13464 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13465 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13466 Overlay Debugging}.
13467
13468 @item overlay load-target
13469 @itemx overlay load
13470 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13471 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13472 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13473 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13474 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13475 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13476
13477 @item overlay list-overlays
13478 @itemx overlay list
13479 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13480 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13481 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13482
13483 @end table
13484
13485 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13486 of the function the address falls in:
13487
13488 @smallexample
13489 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13490 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13491 @end smallexample
13492 @noindent
13493 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13494 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13495 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13496 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13497
13498 @smallexample
13499 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13500 No sections are mapped.
13501 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13502 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13503 @end smallexample
13504 @noindent
13505 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13506 name normally:
13507
13508 @smallexample
13509 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13510 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13511 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13512 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13513 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13514 @end smallexample
13515
13516 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13517 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13518 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13519 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13520 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13521
13522 @itemize @bullet
13523 @item
13524 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13525 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13526 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13527 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13528 @item
13529 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13530 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13531 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13532 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13533 breakpoints properly.
13534 @end itemize
13535
13536
13537 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13538 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13539 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13540
13541 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13542 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13543 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13544 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13545 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13546 current state of the overlays.
13547
13548 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13549 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13550
13551 @table @asis
13552
13553 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13554 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13555
13556 @smallexample
13557 struct
13558 @{
13559 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13560 unsigned long vma;
13561
13562 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13563 unsigned long size;
13564
13565 /* The overlay's load address. */
13566 unsigned long lma;
13567
13568 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13569 zero otherwise. */
13570 unsigned long mapped;
13571 @}
13572 @end smallexample
13573
13574 @item @code{_novlys}:
13575 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13576 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13577
13578 @end table
13579
13580 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13581 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13582 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13583 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13584 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13585 currently mapped.
13586
13587 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13588 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13589 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13590 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13591 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13592 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13593 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13594 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13595 are not being executed.
13596
13597 @node Overlay Sample Program
13598 @section Overlay Sample Program
13599 @cindex overlay example program
13600
13601 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13602 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13603 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13604 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13605 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13606 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13607 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13608
13609 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13610 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13611 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13612 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13613
13614 @table @file
13615 @item overlays.c
13616 The main program file.
13617 @item ovlymgr.c
13618 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13619 @item foo.c
13620 @itemx bar.c
13621 @itemx baz.c
13622 @itemx grbx.c
13623 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13624 @item d10v.ld
13625 @itemx m32r.ld
13626 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13627 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13628 @end table
13629
13630 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13631 cross-compiler like this:
13632
13633 @smallexample
13634 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13635 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13636 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13637 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13638 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13639 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13640 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13641 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13642 @end smallexample
13643
13644 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13645 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13646 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13647
13648
13649 @node Languages
13650 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13651 @cindex languages
13652
13653 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13654 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13655 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13656 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13657 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13658 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13659
13660 @cindex working language
13661 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13662 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13663 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13664 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13665 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13666 language}.
13667
13668 @menu
13669 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13670 * Show:: Displaying the language
13671 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13672 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13673 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13674 @end menu
13675
13676 @node Setting
13677 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13678
13679 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13680 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13681 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13682 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13683 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13684 are printed, etc.
13685
13686 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13687 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13688 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13689 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13690 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13691 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13692 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13693 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13694 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13695 Displaying the Language}.
13696
13697 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13698 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13699 another language. In that case, make the
13700 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13701 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13702 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13703
13704 @menu
13705 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13706 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13707 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13708 @end menu
13709
13710 @node Filenames
13711 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13712
13713 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13714 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13715
13716 @table @file
13717 @item .ada
13718 @itemx .ads
13719 @itemx .adb
13720 @itemx .a
13721 Ada source file.
13722
13723 @item .c
13724 C source file
13725
13726 @item .C
13727 @itemx .cc
13728 @itemx .cp
13729 @itemx .cpp
13730 @itemx .cxx
13731 @itemx .c++
13732 C@t{++} source file
13733
13734 @item .d
13735 D source file
13736
13737 @item .m
13738 Objective-C source file
13739
13740 @item .f
13741 @itemx .F
13742 Fortran source file
13743
13744 @item .mod
13745 Modula-2 source file
13746
13747 @item .s
13748 @itemx .S
13749 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13750 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13751 @end table
13752
13753 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13754 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13755
13756 @node Manually
13757 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13758
13759 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13760 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13761 your program.
13762
13763 @kindex set language
13764 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13765 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13766 a language, such as
13767 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13768 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13769
13770 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13771 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13772 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13773 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13774 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13775 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13776 command such as:
13777
13778 @smallexample
13779 print a = b + c
13780 @end smallexample
13781
13782 @noindent
13783 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13784 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13785 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13786 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13787
13788 @node Automatically
13789 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13790
13791 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13792 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13793 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13794 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13795 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13796 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13797 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13798 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13799 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13800
13801 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13802 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13803 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13804 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13805 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13806
13807 @node Show
13808 @section Displaying the Language
13809
13810 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13811 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13812
13813 @table @code
13814 @item show language
13815 @anchor{show language}
13816 @kindex show language
13817 Display the current working language. This is the
13818 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13819 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13820
13821 @item info frame
13822 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13823 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13824 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13825 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13826 information listed here.
13827
13828 @item info source
13829 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13830 Display the source language of this source file.
13831 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13832 information listed here.
13833 @end table
13834
13835 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13836 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13837 with a language explicitly:
13838
13839 @table @code
13840 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13841 @kindex set extension-language
13842 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13843 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13844
13845 @item info extensions
13846 @kindex info extensions
13847 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13848 @end table
13849
13850 @node Checks
13851 @section Type and Range Checking
13852
13853 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13854 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13855 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13856 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13857 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13858 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
13859 errors when your program is running.
13860
13861 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
13862 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
13863 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
13864 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
13865
13866 @menu
13867 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
13868 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
13869 @end menu
13870
13871 @cindex type checking
13872 @cindex checks, type
13873 @node Type Checking
13874 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
13875
13876 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
13877 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
13878 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
13879 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
13880
13881 @smallexample
13882 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
13883
13884 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
13885 $1 = 2
13886 @exdent but
13887 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
13888 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
13889 @end smallexample
13890
13891 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
13892 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
13893
13894 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13895 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
13896 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
13897 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
13898 expressions like the second example above.
13899
13900 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
13901 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
13902 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
13903 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
13904 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
13905 little sense to evaluate anyway.
13906
13907 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
13908
13909 @kindex set check type
13910 @kindex show check type
13911 @table @code
13912 @item set check type on
13913 @itemx set check type off
13914 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
13915 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
13916 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
13917
13918 @item show check type
13919 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
13920 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
13921 @end table
13922
13923 @cindex range checking
13924 @cindex checks, range
13925 @node Range Checking
13926 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
13927
13928 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
13929 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
13930 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
13931 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
13932 not exceed the bounds of the array.
13933
13934 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13935 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
13936 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
13937 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
13938
13939 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
13940 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
13941 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
13942 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
13943 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
13944 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
13945
13946 @smallexample
13947 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
13948 @end smallexample
13949
13950 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
13951 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
13952 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
13953
13954 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
13955
13956 @kindex set check range
13957 @kindex show check range
13958 @table @code
13959 @item set check range auto
13960 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
13961 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
13962 each language.
13963
13964 @item set check range on
13965 @itemx set check range off
13966 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
13967 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
13968 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
13969 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
13970
13971 @item set check range warn
13972 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
13973 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
13974 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
13975 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
13976 systems).
13977
13978 @item show range
13979 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
13980 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
13981 @end table
13982
13983 @node Supported Languages
13984 @section Supported Languages
13985
13986 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
13987 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
13988 @c This is false ...
13989 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
13990 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
13991 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
13992 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
13993 language.
13994
13995 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
13996 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
13997 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
13998 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
13999 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14000 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14001 language reference or tutorial.
14002
14003 @menu
14004 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14005 * D:: D
14006 * Go:: Go
14007 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14008 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14009 * Fortran:: Fortran
14010 * Pascal:: Pascal
14011 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14012 * Ada:: Ada
14013 @end menu
14014
14015 @node C
14016 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14017
14018 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14019 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14020
14021 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14022 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14023 together.
14024
14025 @cindex C@t{++}
14026 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14027 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14028 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14029 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14030 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14031 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14032 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14033
14034 @menu
14035 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14036 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14037 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14038 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14039 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14040 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14041 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14042 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14043 @end menu
14044
14045 @node C Operators
14046 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14047
14048 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14049
14050 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14051 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14052 often defined on groups of types.
14053
14054 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14055
14056 @itemize @bullet
14057
14058 @item
14059 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14060 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14061
14062 @item
14063 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14064 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14065
14066 @item
14067 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14068
14069 @item
14070 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14071
14072 @end itemize
14073
14074 @noindent
14075 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14076 in order of increasing precedence:
14077
14078 @table @code
14079 @item ,
14080 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14081 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14082 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14083
14084 @item =
14085 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14086 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14087
14088 @item @var{op}=
14089 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14090 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14091 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14092 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14093 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14094
14095 @item ?:
14096 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14097 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14098 should be of an integral type.
14099
14100 @item ||
14101 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14102
14103 @item &&
14104 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14105
14106 @item |
14107 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14108
14109 @item ^
14110 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14111
14112 @item &
14113 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14114
14115 @item ==@r{, }!=
14116 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14117 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14118
14119 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14120 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14121 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14122 and non-zero for true.
14123
14124 @item <<@r{, }>>
14125 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14126
14127 @item @@
14128 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14129
14130 @item +@r{, }-
14131 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14132 pointer types.
14133
14134 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14135 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14136 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14137 integral types.
14138
14139 @item ++@r{, }--
14140 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14141 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14142 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14143 operation takes place.
14144
14145 @item *
14146 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14147 @code{++}.
14148
14149 @item &
14150 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14151
14152 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14153 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14154 to examine the address
14155 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14156 stored.
14157
14158 @item -
14159 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14160 precedence as @code{++}.
14161
14162 @item !
14163 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14164 @code{++}.
14165
14166 @item ~
14167 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14168 @code{++}.
14169
14170
14171 @item .@r{, }->
14172 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14173 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14174 pointer based on the stored type information.
14175 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14176
14177 @item .*@r{, }->*
14178 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14179
14180 @item []
14181 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14182 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14183
14184 @item ()
14185 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14186
14187 @item ::
14188 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14189 and @code{class} types.
14190
14191 @item ::
14192 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14193 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14194 above.
14195 @end table
14196
14197 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14198 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14199 predefined meaning.
14200
14201 @node C Constants
14202 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14203
14204 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14205
14206 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14207 following ways:
14208
14209 @itemize @bullet
14210 @item
14211 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14212 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14213 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14214 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14215 @code{long} value.
14216
14217 @item
14218 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14219 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14220 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14221 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14222 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14223 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14224 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14225 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14226 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14227 constant.
14228
14229 @item
14230 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14231 integral equivalents.
14232
14233 @item
14234 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14235 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14236 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14237 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14238 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14239 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14240 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14241 @samp{\n} for newline.
14242
14243 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14244 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14245 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14246 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14247
14248 @item
14249 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14250 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14251 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14252 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14253 characters.
14254
14255 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14256 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14257 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14258
14259 @item
14260 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14261 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14262
14263 @item
14264 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14265 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14266 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14267 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14268 @end itemize
14269
14270 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14271 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14272
14273 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14274 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14275
14276 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14277 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14278 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14279 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14280 @quotation
14281 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14282 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14283 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14284 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14285 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14286 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14287 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14288 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14289 @end quotation
14290
14291 @enumerate
14292
14293 @cindex member functions
14294 @item
14295 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14296
14297 @smallexample
14298 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14299 @end smallexample
14300
14301 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14302 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14303 @item
14304 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14305 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14306 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14307 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14308 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14309
14310 @cindex call overloaded functions
14311 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14312 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14313 @item
14314 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14315 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14316 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14317 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14318 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14319 default arguments.
14320
14321 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14322 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14323 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14324 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14325 number of function arguments.
14326
14327 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14328 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14329 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14330
14331 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14332 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14333 @smallexample
14334 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14335 @end smallexample
14336
14337 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14338 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14339
14340 @cindex reference declarations
14341 @item
14342 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14343 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14344 dereferenced.
14345
14346 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14347 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14348 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14349 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14350 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14351
14352 @item
14353 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14354 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14355 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14356 necessary, for example in an expression like
14357 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14358 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14359 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14360
14361 @item
14362 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14363 specification.
14364 @end enumerate
14365
14366 @node C Defaults
14367 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14368
14369 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14370
14371 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14372 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14373 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14374 selects the working language.
14375
14376 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14377 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14378 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14379 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14380 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14381 for further details.
14382
14383 @node C Checks
14384 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14385
14386 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14387
14388 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14389 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14390 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14391 constants to pointers.
14392
14393 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14394 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14395 that is not itself an array.
14396
14397 @node Debugging C
14398 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14399
14400 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14401 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14402 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14403 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14404
14405 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14406 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14407 ,Expressions}.
14408
14409 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14410 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14411
14412 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14413
14414 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14415 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14416
14417 @table @code
14418 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14419 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14420 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14421 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14422 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14423 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14424
14425 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14426 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14427 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14428 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14429 classes.
14430 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14431
14432 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14433 @item catch throw
14434 @itemx catch rethrow
14435 @itemx catch catch
14436 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14437 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14438
14439 @cindex inheritance
14440 @item ptype @var{typename}
14441 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14442 @var{typename}.
14443 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14444
14445 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14446 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14447 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14448 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14449 multiple inheritance is in use.
14450
14451 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14452 @item demangle @var{name}
14453 Demangle @var{name}.
14454 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14455
14456 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14457 @item set print demangle
14458 @itemx show print demangle
14459 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14460 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14461 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14462 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14463 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14464
14465 @item set print object
14466 @itemx show print object
14467 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14468 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14469
14470 @item set print vtbl
14471 @itemx show print vtbl
14472 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14473 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14474 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14475 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14476
14477 @kindex set overload-resolution
14478 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14479 @item set overload-resolution on
14480 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14481 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14482 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14483 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14484 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14485 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14486
14487 @item set overload-resolution off
14488 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14489 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14490 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14491 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14492 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14493 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14494 argument types.
14495
14496 @kindex show overload-resolution
14497 @item show overload-resolution
14498 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14499
14500 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14501 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14502 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14503 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14504 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14505 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14506 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14507 @end table
14508
14509 @node Decimal Floating Point
14510 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14511 @cindex decimal floating point format
14512
14513 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14514 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14515 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14516 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14517
14518 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14519 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14520 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14521 configured target.
14522
14523 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14524 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14525 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14526
14527 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14528 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14529 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14530
14531 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14532 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14533 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14534
14535 @node D
14536 @subsection D
14537
14538 @cindex D
14539 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14540 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14541 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14542
14543 @node Go
14544 @subsection Go
14545
14546 @cindex Go (programming language)
14547 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14548 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14549
14550 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14551
14552 @table @code
14553 @cindex current Go package
14554 @item The current Go package
14555 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14556 specifying global variables and functions.
14557
14558 For example, given the program:
14559
14560 @example
14561 package main
14562 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14563 func main () @{
14564 // ...
14565 @}
14566 @end example
14567
14568 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14569
14570 @example
14571 (gdb) p myglob
14572 (gdb) p main.myglob
14573 @end example
14574
14575 @cindex builtin Go types
14576 @item Builtin Go types
14577 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14578 as a string.
14579
14580 @cindex builtin Go functions
14581 @item Builtin Go functions
14582 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14583 function and handles it internally.
14584
14585 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14586 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14587 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14588 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14589 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14590 @end table
14591
14592 @node Objective-C
14593 @subsection Objective-C
14594
14595 @cindex Objective-C
14596 This section provides information about some commands and command
14597 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14598 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14599 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14600
14601 @menu
14602 * Method Names in Commands::
14603 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14604 @end menu
14605
14606 @node Method Names in Commands
14607 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14608
14609 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14610 names as line specifications:
14611
14612 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14613 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14614 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14615 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14616 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14617 @itemize
14618 @item @code{clear}
14619 @item @code{break}
14620 @item @code{info line}
14621 @item @code{jump}
14622 @item @code{list}
14623 @end itemize
14624
14625 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14626
14627 @smallexample
14628 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14629 @end smallexample
14630
14631 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14632 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14633 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14634 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14635 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14636 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14637 debugged, enter:
14638
14639 @smallexample
14640 break -[Fruit create]
14641 @end smallexample
14642
14643 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14644 enter:
14645
14646 @smallexample
14647 list +[NSText initialize]
14648 @end smallexample
14649
14650 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14651 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14652 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14653 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14654
14655 @smallexample
14656 break create
14657 @end smallexample
14658
14659 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14660 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14661 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14662 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14663 none apply.
14664
14665 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14666 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14667
14668 @smallexample
14669 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14670 @end smallexample
14671
14672 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14673 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14674 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14675 @kindex print-object
14676 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14677
14678 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14679
14680 @smallexample
14681 print -[@var{object} hash]
14682 @end smallexample
14683
14684 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14685 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14686 @noindent
14687 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14688 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14689 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14690 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14691 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14692 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14693
14694 @node OpenCL C
14695 @subsection OpenCL C
14696
14697 @cindex OpenCL C
14698 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14699
14700 @menu
14701 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14702 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14703 * OpenCL C Operators::
14704 @end menu
14705
14706 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14707 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14708
14709 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14710 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14711 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14712 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14713 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14714
14715 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14716 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14717
14718 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14719 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14720 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14721 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14722
14723 @node OpenCL C Operators
14724 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14725
14726 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14727 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14728 vector data types.
14729
14730 @node Fortran
14731 @subsection Fortran
14732 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14733
14734 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14735 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14736
14737 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14738 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14739 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14740 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14741 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14742 underscore.
14743
14744 @menu
14745 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14746 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14747 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14748 @end menu
14749
14750 @node Fortran Operators
14751 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14752
14753 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14754
14755 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14756 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14757 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14758
14759 @table @code
14760 @item **
14761 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14762 of the second one.
14763
14764 @item :
14765 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14766 represent a section of array.
14767
14768 @item %
14769 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14770 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14771 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14772 union type.
14773 @end table
14774
14775 @node Fortran Defaults
14776 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14777
14778 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14779
14780 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14781 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14782 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14783 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14784
14785 @node Special Fortran Commands
14786 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14787
14788 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14789
14790 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14791 such as displaying common blocks.
14792
14793 @table @code
14794 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14795 @kindex info common
14796 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14797 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14798 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14799 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14800 printed.
14801 @end table
14802
14803 @node Pascal
14804 @subsection Pascal
14805
14806 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14807 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14808 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14809 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14810 syntax.
14811
14812 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14813 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14814 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14815
14816 @node Modula-2
14817 @subsection Modula-2
14818
14819 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14820
14821 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14822 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14823 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14824 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14825 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14826 table.
14827
14828 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14829 @menu
14830 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14831 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14832 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14833 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14834 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14835 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14836 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14837 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14838 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14839 @end menu
14840
14841 @node M2 Operators
14842 @subsubsection Operators
14843 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14844
14845 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14846 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14847 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14848 following definitions hold:
14849
14850 @itemize @bullet
14851
14852 @item
14853 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14854 their subranges.
14855
14856 @item
14857 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14858
14859 @item
14860 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
14861
14862 @item
14863 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
14864 @var{type}}.
14865
14866 @item
14867 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
14868
14869 @item
14870 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
14871
14872 @item
14873 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
14874 @end itemize
14875
14876 @noindent
14877 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
14878 increasing precedence:
14879
14880 @table @code
14881 @item ,
14882 Function argument or array index separator.
14883
14884 @item :=
14885 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
14886 @var{value}.
14887
14888 @item <@r{, }>
14889 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
14890 types.
14891
14892 @item <=@r{, }>=
14893 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
14894 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
14895 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
14896
14897 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
14898 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
14899 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
14900 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
14901 comment character.
14902
14903 @item IN
14904 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
14905 Same precedence as @code{<}.
14906
14907 @item OR
14908 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14909
14910 @item AND@r{, }&
14911 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14912
14913 @item @@
14914 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14915
14916 @item +@r{, }-
14917 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
14918 and difference on set types.
14919
14920 @item *
14921 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
14922 on set types.
14923
14924 @item /
14925 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
14926 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
14927
14928 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
14929 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
14930 precedence as @code{*}.
14931
14932 @item -
14933 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
14934
14935 @item ^
14936 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
14937
14938 @item NOT
14939 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
14940 @code{^}.
14941
14942 @item .
14943 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
14944 precedence as @code{^}.
14945
14946 @item []
14947 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
14948
14949 @item ()
14950 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
14951 as @code{^}.
14952
14953 @item ::@r{, }.
14954 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
14955 @end table
14956
14957 @quotation
14958 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
14959 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
14960 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
14961 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
14962 @end quotation
14963
14964
14965 @node Built-In Func/Proc
14966 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
14967 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
14968
14969 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
14970 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
14971
14972 @table @var
14973
14974 @item a
14975 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
14976
14977 @item c
14978 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
14979
14980 @item i
14981 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
14982
14983 @item m
14984 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
14985 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
14986 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
14987
14988 @item n
14989 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
14990
14991 @item r
14992 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
14993
14994 @item t
14995 represents a type.
14996
14997 @item v
14998 represents a variable.
14999
15000 @item x
15001 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15002 explanation of the function for details.
15003 @end table
15004
15005 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15006
15007 @table @code
15008 @item ABS(@var{n})
15009 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15010
15011 @item CAP(@var{c})
15012 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15013 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15014
15015 @item CHR(@var{i})
15016 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15017
15018 @item DEC(@var{v})
15019 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15020
15021 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15022 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15023 new value.
15024
15025 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15026 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15027 set.
15028
15029 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15030 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15031
15032 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15033 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15034
15035 @item INC(@var{v})
15036 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15037
15038 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15039 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15040 new value.
15041
15042 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15043 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15044 there. Returns the new set.
15045
15046 @item MAX(@var{t})
15047 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15048
15049 @item MIN(@var{t})
15050 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15051
15052 @item ODD(@var{i})
15053 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15054
15055 @item ORD(@var{x})
15056 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15057 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15058 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15059 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15060
15061 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15062 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15063 variable or a type.
15064
15065 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15066 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15067
15068 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15069 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15070 variable or a type.
15071
15072 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15073 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15074 @end table
15075
15076 @quotation
15077 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15078 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15079 an error.
15080 @end quotation
15081
15082 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15083 @node M2 Constants
15084 @subsubsection Constants
15085
15086 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15087 ways:
15088
15089 @itemize @bullet
15090
15091 @item
15092 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15093 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15094 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15095 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15096
15097 @item
15098 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15099 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15100 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15101 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15102 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15103 digits.
15104
15105 @item
15106 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15107 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15108 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15109 followed by a @samp{C}.
15110
15111 @item
15112 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15113 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15114 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15115 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15116 sequences.
15117
15118 @item
15119 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15120
15121 @item
15122 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15123 @code{FALSE}.
15124
15125 @item
15126 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15127
15128 @item
15129 Set constants are not yet supported.
15130 @end itemize
15131
15132 @node M2 Types
15133 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15134 @cindex Modula-2 types
15135
15136 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15137 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15138 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15139 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15140 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15141 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15142
15143 The first example contains the following section of code:
15144
15145 @smallexample
15146 VAR
15147 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15148 r: [20..40] ;
15149 @end smallexample
15150
15151 @noindent
15152 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15153 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15154
15155 @smallexample
15156 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15157 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15158 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15159 SET OF CHAR
15160 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15161 21
15162 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15163 [20..40]
15164 @end smallexample
15165
15166 @noindent
15167 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15168
15169 @smallexample
15170 VAR
15171 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15172 @end smallexample
15173
15174 @noindent
15175 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15176
15177 @smallexample
15178 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15179 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15180 @end smallexample
15181
15182 @noindent
15183 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15184 expressions using the debugger.
15185
15186 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15187 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15188
15189 @smallexample
15190 VAR
15191 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15192 @end smallexample
15193
15194 @smallexample
15195 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15196 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15197 @end smallexample
15198
15199 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15200 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15201 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15202 above.
15203
15204 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15205
15206 @smallexample
15207 TYPE
15208 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15209 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15210 VAR
15211 s: t ;
15212 BEGIN
15213 s := blue ;
15214 @end smallexample
15215
15216 @noindent
15217 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15218 and value of a variable.
15219
15220 @smallexample
15221 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15222 $1 = blue
15223 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15224 type = [blue..yellow]
15225 @end smallexample
15226
15227 @noindent
15228 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15229 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15230 their @code{C} counterparts.
15231
15232 @smallexample
15233 VAR
15234 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15235 BEGIN
15236 s[1] := 1 ;
15237 @end smallexample
15238
15239 @smallexample
15240 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15241 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15242 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15243 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15244 @end smallexample
15245
15246 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15247 pointer types as shown in this example:
15248
15249 @smallexample
15250 VAR
15251 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15252 BEGIN
15253 NEW(s) ;
15254 s^[1] := 1 ;
15255 @end smallexample
15256
15257 @noindent
15258 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15259
15260 @smallexample
15261 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15262 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15263 @end smallexample
15264
15265 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15266 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15267 types:
15268
15269 @smallexample
15270 TYPE
15271 foo = RECORD
15272 f1: CARDINAL ;
15273 f2: CHAR ;
15274 f3: myarray ;
15275 END ;
15276
15277 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15278 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15279 VAR
15280 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15281 @end smallexample
15282
15283 @noindent
15284 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15285 below.
15286
15287 @smallexample
15288 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15289 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15290 f1 : CARDINAL;
15291 f2 : CHAR;
15292 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15293 END
15294 @end smallexample
15295
15296 @node M2 Defaults
15297 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15298 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15299
15300 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15301 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15302 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15303 selected the working language.
15304
15305 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15306 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15307 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15308 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15309
15310 @node Deviations
15311 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15312 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15313
15314 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15315 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15316
15317 @itemize @bullet
15318 @item
15319 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15320 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15321 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15322 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15323 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15324 returned a pointer.)
15325
15326 @item
15327 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15328 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15329 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15330 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15331
15332 @item
15333 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15334 argument.
15335
15336 @item
15337 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15338 @end itemize
15339
15340 @node M2 Checks
15341 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15342 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15343
15344 @quotation
15345 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15346 range checking.
15347 @end quotation
15348 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15349
15350 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15351
15352 @itemize @bullet
15353 @item
15354 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15355 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15356
15357 @item
15358 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15359 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15360 @end itemize
15361
15362 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15363 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15364
15365 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15366 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15367
15368 @node M2 Scope
15369 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15370 @cindex scope
15371 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15372 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15373 @ifinfo
15374 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15375 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15376 @end ifinfo
15377 @ifnotinfo
15378 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15379 @end ifnotinfo
15380
15381 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15382 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15383 similar syntax:
15384
15385 @smallexample
15386
15387 @var{module} . @var{id}
15388 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15389 @end smallexample
15390
15391 @noindent
15392 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15393 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15394 identifier within your program, except another module.
15395
15396 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15397 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15398 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15399 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15400
15401 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15402 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15403 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15404 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15405 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15406 @var{module}.
15407
15408 @node GDB/M2
15409 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15410
15411 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15412 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15413 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15414 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15415 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15416 analogue in Modula-2.
15417
15418 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15419 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15420 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15421 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15422 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15423 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15424
15425 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15426 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15427 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15428
15429 @node Ada
15430 @subsection Ada
15431 @cindex Ada
15432
15433 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15434 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15435 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15436 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15437 to be difficult.
15438
15439
15440 @cindex expressions in Ada
15441 @menu
15442 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15443 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15444 in @value{GDBN}.
15445 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15446 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15447 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15448 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15449 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15450 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15451 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15452 Profile
15453 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15454 @end menu
15455
15456 @node Ada Mode Intro
15457 @subsubsection Introduction
15458 @cindex Ada mode, general
15459
15460 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15461 syntax, with some extensions.
15462 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15463
15464 @itemize @bullet
15465 @item
15466 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15467 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15468 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15469 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15470
15471 @item
15472 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15473 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15474
15475 @item
15476 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15477 @end itemize
15478
15479 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15480 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15481 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15482 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15483 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15484
15485 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15486 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15487 was translated from an Ada source file.
15488
15489 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15490 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15491 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15492 middle (to allow based literals).
15493
15494 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15495 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15496 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15497 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15498 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15499 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15500
15501 @node Omissions from Ada
15502 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15503 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15504
15505 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15506
15507 @itemize @bullet
15508 @item
15509 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15510
15511 @itemize @minus
15512 @item
15513 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15514 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15515
15516 @item
15517 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15518
15519 @item
15520 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15521
15522 @item
15523 @t{'Tag}.
15524
15525 @item
15526 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15527 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15528
15529 @item
15530 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15531 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15532
15533 @item
15534 @t{'Address}.
15535 @end itemize
15536
15537 @item
15538 The names in
15539 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15540 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15541 not currently available.
15542
15543 @item
15544 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15545 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15546 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15547 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15548 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15549 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15550 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15551 indeterminate values.
15552
15553 @item
15554 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15555 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15556 are not implemented.
15557
15558 @item
15559 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15560 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15561 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15562 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15563 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15564
15565 @smallexample
15566 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15567 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15568 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15569 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15570 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15571 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15572 @end smallexample
15573
15574 Changing a
15575 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15576 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15577 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15578 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15579 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15580 declared to have a type such as:
15581
15582 @smallexample
15583 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15584 Id : Integer;
15585 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15586 end record;
15587 @end smallexample
15588
15589 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15590 assignments:
15591
15592 @smallexample
15593 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15594 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15595 @end smallexample
15596
15597 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15598 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15599 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15600 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15601 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15602 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15603 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15604 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15605
15606 @item
15607 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15608
15609 @item
15610 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15611 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15612 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15613 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15614 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15615 the proper resolution.
15616
15617 @item
15618 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15619
15620 @item
15621 Entry calls are not implemented.
15622
15623 @item
15624 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15625 formats are not supported.
15626
15627 @item
15628 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15629
15630 @item
15631 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15632 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15633 context.
15634 Should your program
15635 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15636 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15637 @end itemize
15638
15639 @node Additions to Ada
15640 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15641 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15642
15643 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15644 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15645
15646 @itemize @bullet
15647 @item
15648 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15649 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15650 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15651 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15652 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15653 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15654 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15655 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15656
15657 @item
15658 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15659 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15660 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15661
15662 @item
15663 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15664 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15665
15666 @item
15667 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15668 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15669 @end itemize
15670
15671 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15672 additions specific to Ada:
15673
15674 @itemize @bullet
15675 @item
15676 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15677 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15678
15679 @smallexample
15680 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15681 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15682 @end smallexample
15683
15684 @item
15685 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15686 the value of its right-hand operand.
15687 This allows, for example,
15688 complex conditional breaks:
15689
15690 @smallexample
15691 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15692 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15693 @end smallexample
15694
15695 @item
15696 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15697 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15698 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15699 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15700 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15701 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15702 in strings. For example,
15703 @smallexample
15704 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15705 @end smallexample
15706 @noindent
15707 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15708 after each period.
15709
15710 @item
15711 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15712 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15713 to write
15714
15715 @smallexample
15716 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15717 @end smallexample
15718
15719 @item
15720 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15721 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15722 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15723 of 3 might print as
15724
15725 @smallexample
15726 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15727 @end smallexample
15728
15729 @noindent
15730 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15731 clause.
15732
15733 @item
15734 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15735 multi-character subsequence of
15736 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15737 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15738 in place of @t{a'length}.
15739
15740 @item
15741 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15742 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15743 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15744 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15745 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15746 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15747 For example,
15748 @smallexample
15749 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15750 @end smallexample
15751
15752 @item
15753 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15754 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15755 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15756 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15757 object.
15758
15759 @end itemize
15760
15761 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15762 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15763
15764 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15765 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15766 before reaching the main procedure.
15767 As defined in the Ada Reference
15768 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15769 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15770 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15771 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15772
15773 @node Ada Exceptions
15774 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15775
15776 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15777
15778 @table @code
15779 @kindex info exceptions
15780 @item info exceptions
15781 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15782 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15783 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15784 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15785 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15786 @end table
15787
15788 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15789 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15790 argument.
15791
15792 @smallexample
15793 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15794 All defined Ada exceptions:
15795 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15796 program_error: 0x613d20
15797 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15798 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15799 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15800 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15801 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15802 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15803 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15804 @end smallexample
15805
15806 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15807 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15808
15809 @node Ada Tasks
15810 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15811 @cindex Ada, tasking
15812
15813 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15814 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15815
15816 @table @code
15817 @kindex info tasks
15818 @item info tasks
15819 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15820
15821
15822 @smallexample
15823 @iftex
15824 @leftskip=0.5cm
15825 @end iftex
15826 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15827 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15828 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15829 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15830 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15831 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15832
15833 @end smallexample
15834
15835 @noindent
15836 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15837 task currently being inspected.
15838
15839 @table @asis
15840 @item ID
15841 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15842
15843 @item TID
15844 The Ada task ID.
15845
15846 @item P-ID
15847 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
15848
15849 @item Pri
15850 The base priority of the task.
15851
15852 @item State
15853 Current state of the task.
15854
15855 @table @code
15856 @item Unactivated
15857 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
15858 executing.
15859
15860 @item Runnable
15861 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
15862 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
15863
15864 @item Terminated
15865 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
15866 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
15867 terminated themselves.
15868
15869 @item Child Activation Wait
15870 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
15871
15872 @item Accept Statement
15873 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
15874
15875 @item Waiting on entry call
15876 The task is waiting on an entry call.
15877
15878 @item Async Select Wait
15879 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
15880 select statement.
15881
15882 @item Delay Sleep
15883 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
15884 alternative open.
15885
15886 @item Child Termination Wait
15887 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
15888 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
15889 waiting on a terminate Phase.
15890
15891 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
15892 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
15893 finish terminating.
15894
15895 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
15896 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
15897 @end table
15898
15899 @item Name
15900 Name of the task in the program.
15901
15902 @end table
15903
15904 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
15905 @item info task @var{taskno}
15906 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
15907 the following example:
15908 @smallexample
15909 @iftex
15910 @leftskip=0.5cm
15911 @end iftex
15912 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15913 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15914 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15915 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
15916 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
15917 Ada Task: 0x807c468
15918 Name: task_1
15919 Thread: 0x807f378
15920 Parent: 1 (main_task)
15921 Base Priority: 15
15922 State: Runnable
15923 @end smallexample
15924
15925 @item task
15926 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
15927 @cindex current Ada task ID
15928 This command prints the ID of the current task.
15929
15930 @smallexample
15931 @iftex
15932 @leftskip=0.5cm
15933 @end iftex
15934 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15935 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15936 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15937 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15938 (@value{GDBP}) task
15939 [Current task is 2]
15940 @end smallexample
15941
15942 @item task @var{taskno}
15943 @cindex Ada task switching
15944 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
15945 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
15946 from the current task to the given task.
15947
15948 @smallexample
15949 @iftex
15950 @leftskip=0.5cm
15951 @end iftex
15952 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15953 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15954 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15955 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15956 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
15957 [Switching to task 1]
15958 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15959 (@value{GDBP}) bt
15960 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15961 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
15962 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
15963 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
15964 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
15965 @end smallexample
15966
15967 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
15968 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
15969 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
15970 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
15971 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
15972 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
15973 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
15974 @var{linespec} argument specifies source lines, as described
15975 in @ref{Specify Location}.
15976
15977 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
15978 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
15979 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
15980 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
15981 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
15982
15983 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
15984 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
15985 program.
15986
15987 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
15988 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
15989 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
15990
15991 For example,
15992
15993 @smallexample
15994 @iftex
15995 @leftskip=0.5cm
15996 @end iftex
15997 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15998 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15999 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16000 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16001 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16002 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16003 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16004 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16005 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16006 Continuing.
16007 task # 1 running
16008 task # 2 running
16009
16010 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16011 15 flush;
16012 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16013 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16014 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16015 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16016 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16017 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16018 @end smallexample
16019 @end table
16020
16021 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16022 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16023 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16024
16025 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16026 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16027 the platform being used.
16028 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16029 switching is not supported.
16030
16031 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16032 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16033 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16034 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16035 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16036 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16037
16038 @node Ravenscar Profile
16039 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16040 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16041
16042 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16043 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16044 requirements.
16045
16046 @table @code
16047 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16048 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16049 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16050 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16051 Profile. This is the default.
16052
16053 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16054 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16055 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16056 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16057 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16058 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16059 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16060
16061 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16062 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16063 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16064 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16065
16066 @end table
16067
16068 @node Ada Glitches
16069 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16070 @cindex Ada, problems
16071
16072 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16073 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16074 @value{GDBN},
16075 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16076 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16077
16078 @itemize @bullet
16079 @item
16080 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16081 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16082
16083 @item
16084 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16085 argument lists are treated as positional).
16086
16087 @item
16088 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16089
16090 @item
16091 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16092 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16093 the host machine.
16094
16095 @item
16096 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16097 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16098 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16099 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16100 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16101 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16102 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16103 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16104 you can usually resolve the confusion
16105 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16106 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16107 @end itemize
16108
16109 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16110 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16111 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16112 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16113 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16114 enabled.
16115
16116 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16117 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16118 @table @code
16119
16120 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16121 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16122 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16123 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16124 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16125 This is the default.
16126
16127 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16128 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16129 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16130 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16131 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16132 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16133 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16134
16135 @end table
16136
16137 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16138 @cindex GNAT encoding
16139 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16140 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16141 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16142 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16143 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16144 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16145
16146 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16147 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16148 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16149 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16150 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16151 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16152 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16153 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16154
16155 @table @code
16156
16157 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16158 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16159 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16160 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16161
16162 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16163 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16164 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16165
16166 @end table
16167
16168 @node Unsupported Languages
16169 @section Unsupported Languages
16170
16171 @cindex unsupported languages
16172 @cindex minimal language
16173 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16174 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16175 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16176 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16177 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16178 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16179
16180 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16181 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16182 language.
16183
16184 @node Symbols
16185 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16186
16187 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16188 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16189 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16190 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16191 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16192 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16193 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16194
16195 @cindex symbol names
16196 @cindex names of symbols
16197 @cindex quoting names
16198 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16199 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16200 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16201 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16202 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16203 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16204 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16205 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16206
16207 @smallexample
16208 p 'foo.c'::x
16209 @end smallexample
16210
16211 @noindent
16212 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16213
16214 @table @code
16215 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16216 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16217 @kindex set case-sensitive
16218 @item set case-sensitive on
16219 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16220 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16221 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16222 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16223 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16224 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16225 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16226 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16227 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16228 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16229 case-insensitive matches.
16230
16231 @kindex show case-sensitive
16232 @item show case-sensitive
16233 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16234 lookups.
16235
16236 @kindex set print type methods
16237 @item set print type methods
16238 @itemx set print type methods on
16239 @itemx set print type methods off
16240 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16241 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16242 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16243 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16244 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16245 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16246
16247 @kindex show print type methods
16248 @item show print type methods
16249 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16250 classes.
16251
16252 @kindex set print type typedefs
16253 @item set print type typedefs
16254 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16255 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16256
16257 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16258 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16259 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16260 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16261 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16262 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16263 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16264 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16265 types.
16266
16267 @kindex show print type typedefs
16268 @item show print type typedefs
16269 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16270 printing classes.
16271
16272 @kindex info address
16273 @cindex address of a symbol
16274 @item info address @var{symbol}
16275 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16276 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16277 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16278 is always stored.
16279
16280 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16281 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16282 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16283
16284 @kindex info symbol
16285 @cindex symbol from address
16286 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16287 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16288 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16289 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16290 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16291
16292 @smallexample
16293 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16294 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16295 @end smallexample
16296
16297 @noindent
16298 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16299 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16300
16301 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16302 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16303
16304 @smallexample
16305 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16306 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16307 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16308 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16309 @end smallexample
16310
16311 @kindex demangle
16312 @cindex demangle
16313 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16314 Demangle @var{name}.
16315 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16316 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16317
16318 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16319 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16320
16321 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16322 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16323
16324 @kindex whatis
16325 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16326 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16327 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16328 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16329
16330 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16331 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16332 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16333
16334 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16335 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16336 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16337 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16338 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16339 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16340 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16341 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16342 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16343
16344 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16345 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16346 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16347 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16348 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16349 unroll it.
16350
16351 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16352 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16353 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16354
16355 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16356 Available flags are:
16357
16358 @table @code
16359 @item r
16360 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16361 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16362 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16363
16364 @item m
16365 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16366
16367 @item M
16368 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16369 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16370
16371 @item t
16372 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16373 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16374 names are substituted when printing other types.
16375
16376 @item T
16377 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16378 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16379 @end table
16380
16381 @kindex ptype
16382 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16383 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16384 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16385 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16386
16387 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16388 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16389 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16390 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16391 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16392 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16393 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16394 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16395
16396 For example, for this variable declaration:
16397
16398 @smallexample
16399 typedef double real_t;
16400 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16401 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16402 complex_t var;
16403 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16404 @end smallexample
16405
16406 @noindent
16407 the two commands give this output:
16408
16409 @smallexample
16410 @group
16411 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16412 type = complex_t
16413 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16414 type = struct complex @{
16415 real_t real;
16416 double imag;
16417 @}
16418 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16419 type = struct complex
16420 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16421 type = struct complex
16422 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16423 type = struct complex @{
16424 real_t real;
16425 double imag;
16426 @}
16427 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16428 type = real_t *
16429 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16430 type = double *
16431 @end group
16432 @end smallexample
16433
16434 @noindent
16435 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16436 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16437
16438 @cindex incomplete type
16439 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16440 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16441 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16442 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16443 given these declarations:
16444
16445 @smallexample
16446 struct foo;
16447 struct foo *fooptr;
16448 @end smallexample
16449
16450 @noindent
16451 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16452
16453 @smallexample
16454 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16455 $1 = <incomplete type>
16456 @end smallexample
16457
16458 @noindent
16459 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16460 completely specified.
16461
16462 @kindex info types
16463 @item info types @var{regexp}
16464 @itemx info types
16465 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16466 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16467 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16468 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16469 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16470 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16471 name is @code{value}.
16472
16473 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16474 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16475 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16476
16477 @kindex info type-printers
16478 @item info type-printers
16479 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16480 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16481 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16482 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16483 type printers.
16484
16485 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16486
16487 @kindex enable type-printer
16488 @kindex disable type-printer
16489 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16490 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16491 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16492
16493 @kindex info scope
16494 @cindex local variables
16495 @item info scope @var{location}
16496 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16497 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16498 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16499 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16500 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16501
16502 @smallexample
16503 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16504 Scope for command_line_handler:
16505 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16506 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16507 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16508 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16509 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16510 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16511 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16512 @end smallexample
16513
16514 @noindent
16515 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16516 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16517 collect}.
16518
16519 @kindex info source
16520 @item info source
16521 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16522 the function containing the current point of execution:
16523 @itemize @bullet
16524 @item
16525 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16526 @item
16527 the directory it was compiled in,
16528 @item
16529 its length, in lines,
16530 @item
16531 which programming language it is written in,
16532 @item
16533 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
16534 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
16535 @item
16536 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16537 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16538 @item
16539 whether the debugging information includes information about
16540 preprocessor macros.
16541 @end itemize
16542
16543
16544 @kindex info sources
16545 @item info sources
16546 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16547 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16548 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16549
16550 @kindex info functions
16551 @item info functions
16552 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16553
16554 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16555 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16556 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16557 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16558 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16559 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16560 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16561 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16562
16563 @kindex info variables
16564 @item info variables
16565 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16566 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16567
16568 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16569 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16570 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16571 @var{regexp}.
16572
16573 @kindex info classes
16574 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16575 @item info classes
16576 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16577 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16578 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16579 expression.
16580
16581 @kindex info selectors
16582 @item info selectors
16583 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16584 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16585 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16586 expression.
16587
16588 @ignore
16589 This was never implemented.
16590 @kindex info methods
16591 @item info methods
16592 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16593 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16594 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16595 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16596 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16597 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16598 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16599 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16600 @end ignore
16601
16602 @cindex opaque data types
16603 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16604 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16605 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16606 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16607 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16608 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16609 another source file. The default is on.
16610
16611 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16612 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16613
16614 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16615 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16616 is printed as follows:
16617 @smallexample
16618 @{<no data fields>@}
16619 @end smallexample
16620
16621 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16622 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16623 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16624
16625 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16626 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16627 @item set print symbol-loading
16628 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16629 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16630 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16631 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16632 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16633 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16634 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16635 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16636 can be annoying.
16637 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16638 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16639 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16640 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16641
16642 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16643 @item show print symbol-loading
16644 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16645 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16646
16647 @kindex maint print symbols
16648 @cindex symbol dump
16649 @kindex maint print psymbols
16650 @cindex partial symbol dump
16651 @kindex maint print msymbols
16652 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16653 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16654 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16655 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16656 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16657 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16658 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16659 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16660 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16661 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16662 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16663 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16664 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16665 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16666 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16667 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16668 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16669 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16670
16671 @kindex maint info symtabs
16672 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16673 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16674 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16675 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16676 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16677 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16678 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16679
16680 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16681 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16682 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16683 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16684 structure in more detail. For example:
16685
16686 @smallexample
16687 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16688 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16689 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16690 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16691 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16692 readin no
16693 fullname (null)
16694 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16695 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16696 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16697 dependencies (none)
16698 @}
16699 @}
16700 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16701 (@value{GDBP})
16702 @end smallexample
16703 @noindent
16704 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16705 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16706 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16707 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16708 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16709
16710 @smallexample
16711 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16712 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16713 line 1574.
16714 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16715 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16716 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16717 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16718 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16719 dirname (null)
16720 fullname (null)
16721 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16722 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16723 debugformat DWARF 2
16724 @}
16725 @}
16726 (@value{GDBP})
16727 @end smallexample
16728
16729 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
16730 @cindex symbol cache size
16731 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
16732 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
16733 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
16734 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
16735 with different sizes.
16736
16737 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
16738 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
16739 Show the size of the symbol cache.
16740
16741 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
16742 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
16743 @item maint print symbol-cache
16744 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
16745 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
16746
16747 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16748 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
16749 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16750 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
16751 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
16752
16753 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
16754 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
16755 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
16756 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
16757 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
16758 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
16759
16760 @end table
16761
16762 @node Altering
16763 @chapter Altering Execution
16764
16765 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16766 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16767 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16768 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16769 program.
16770
16771 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16772 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16773 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16774
16775 @menu
16776 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16777 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16778 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16779 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16780 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16781 * Patching:: Patching your program
16782 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
16783 @end menu
16784
16785 @node Assignment
16786 @section Assignment to Variables
16787
16788 @cindex assignment
16789 @cindex setting variables
16790 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16791 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16792
16793 @smallexample
16794 print x=4
16795 @end smallexample
16796
16797 @noindent
16798 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16799 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16800 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16801 information on operators in supported languages.
16802
16803 @kindex set variable
16804 @cindex variables, setting
16805 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16806 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16807 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16808 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16809 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16810
16811 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16812 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16813 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16814 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16815 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16816 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16817 command @code{set width}:
16818
16819 @smallexample
16820 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16821 type = double
16822 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16823 $4 = 13
16824 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16825 Invalid syntax in expression.
16826 @end smallexample
16827
16828 @noindent
16829 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16830 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16831
16832 @smallexample
16833 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16834 @end smallexample
16835
16836 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16837 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16838 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16839 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16840 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16841 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16842
16843 @smallexample
16844 @group
16845 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
16846 type = double
16847 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16848 $1 = 1
16849 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
16850 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16851 $2 = 1
16852 (@value{GDBP}) r
16853 The program being debugged has been started already.
16854 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
16855 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
16856 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
16857 Invalid bfd target.
16858 (@value{GDBP}) show g
16859 The current BFD target is "=4".
16860 @end group
16861 @end smallexample
16862
16863 @noindent
16864 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
16865 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
16866 @code{g}, use
16867
16868 @smallexample
16869 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
16870 @end smallexample
16871
16872 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
16873 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
16874 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
16875 same length or shorter.
16876 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
16877 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
16878
16879 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
16880 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
16881 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
16882 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
16883 and representation in memory), and
16884
16885 @smallexample
16886 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
16887 @end smallexample
16888
16889 @noindent
16890 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
16891
16892 @node Jumping
16893 @section Continuing at a Different Address
16894
16895 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
16896 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
16897 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
16898
16899 @table @code
16900 @kindex jump
16901 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
16902 @item jump @var{linespec}
16903 @itemx j @var{linespec}
16904 @itemx jump @var{location}
16905 @itemx j @var{location}
16906 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
16907 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
16908 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
16909 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
16910 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
16911 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16912
16913 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
16914 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
16915 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
16916 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
16917 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
16918 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
16919 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
16920 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
16921 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
16922 @end table
16923
16924 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
16925 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
16926 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
16927 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
16928 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
16929 example,
16930
16931 @smallexample
16932 set $pc = 0x485
16933 @end smallexample
16934
16935 @noindent
16936 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
16937 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
16938 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
16939
16940 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
16941 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
16942 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
16943 detail.
16944
16945 @c @group
16946 @node Signaling
16947 @section Giving your Program a Signal
16948 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
16949
16950 @table @code
16951 @kindex signal
16952 @item signal @var{signal}
16953 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
16954 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
16955 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
16956 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16957
16958 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
16959 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
16960 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16961 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
16962 signal.
16963
16964 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
16965 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
16966 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
16967 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
16968 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
16969 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
16970 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
16971 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
16972
16973 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
16974 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
16975 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
16976 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
16977 passes the signal directly to your program.
16978
16979 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
16980 after executing the command.
16981
16982 @kindex queue-signal
16983 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
16984 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
16985 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
16986 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
16987 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16988 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
16989 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
16990 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
16991 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
16992
16993 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
16994 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
16995 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
16996 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16997 @code{continue} command.
16998
16999 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17000 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17001 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17002 (@pxref{Signals}).
17003 @end table
17004 @c @end group
17005
17006 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17007 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17008
17009 @node Returning
17010 @section Returning from a Function
17011
17012 @table @code
17013 @cindex returning from a function
17014 @kindex return
17015 @item return
17016 @itemx return @var{expression}
17017 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17018 command. If you give an
17019 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17020 value.
17021 @end table
17022
17023 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17024 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17025 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17026 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17027
17028 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17029 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17030 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17031 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17032 of functions.
17033
17034 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17035 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17036 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17037 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17038 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17039
17040 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17041 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17042 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17043 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17044 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17045 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17046 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17047 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17048 assignment into the right register(s).
17049
17050 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17051 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17052 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17053 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17054 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17055 into a @code{long long int}:
17056
17057 @smallexample
17058 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17059 29 return 31;
17060 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17061 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17062 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17063 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17064 (@value{GDBP})
17065 @end smallexample
17066
17067 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17068 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17069 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17070 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17071 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17072 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17073 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17074 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17075
17076 @smallexample
17077 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17078 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17079 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17080 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17081 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17082 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17083 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17084 (@value{GDBP})
17085 @end smallexample
17086
17087 @node Calling
17088 @section Calling Program Functions
17089
17090 @table @code
17091 @cindex calling functions
17092 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17093 @item print @var{expr}
17094 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17095 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17096 debugged.
17097
17098 @kindex call
17099 @item call @var{expr}
17100 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17101 returned values.
17102
17103 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17104 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17105 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17106 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17107 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17108 value history.
17109 @end table
17110
17111 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17112 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17113 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17114 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17115
17116 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17117 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17118 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17119 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17120 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17121 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17122 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17123 in that case is controlled by the
17124 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17125
17126 @table @code
17127 @item set unwindonsignal
17128 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17129 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17130 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17131 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17132 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17133 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17134 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17135 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17136 received.
17137
17138 @item show unwindonsignal
17139 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17140 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17141 @value{GDBN}.
17142
17143 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17144 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17145 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17146 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17147 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17148 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17149 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17150 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17151 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17152 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17153
17154 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17155 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17156 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17157 @value{GDBN}.
17158
17159 @end table
17160
17161 @cindex weak alias functions
17162 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17163 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17164 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17165 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17166 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17167 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17168 function instead.
17169
17170 @node Patching
17171 @section Patching Programs
17172
17173 @cindex patching binaries
17174 @cindex writing into executables
17175 @cindex writing into corefiles
17176
17177 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17178 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17179 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17180 patching your program's binary.
17181
17182 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17183 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17184 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17185 repairs.
17186
17187 @table @code
17188 @kindex set write
17189 @item set write on
17190 @itemx set write off
17191 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17192 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17193 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17194
17195 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17196 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17197 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17198
17199 @item show write
17200 @kindex show write
17201 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17202 as well as reading.
17203 @end table
17204
17205 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17206 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17207 @cindex injecting code
17208 @cindex writing into executables
17209 @cindex compiling code
17210
17211 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17212 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17213 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17214 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17215
17216 @table @code
17217 @kindex compile code
17218 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17219 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17220 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17221 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17222 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17223 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17224 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17225 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17226 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17227 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17228 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17229 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17230
17231 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17232 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17233 E.g.:
17234
17235 @smallexample
17236 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17237 @end smallexample
17238
17239 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17240 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17241 from actual source code. E.g.:
17242
17243 @smallexample
17244 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17245 @end smallexample
17246
17247 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17248 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17249 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17250 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17251 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17252 editor.
17253
17254 @smallexample
17255 compile code
17256 >printf ("hello\n");
17257 >printf ("world\n");
17258 >end
17259 @end smallexample
17260
17261 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17262 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17263 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17264 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17265 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17266 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17267 inferior symbols otherwise.
17268
17269 @kindex compile file
17270 @item compile file @var{filename}
17271 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17272 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17273
17274 @smallexample
17275 compile file /home/user/example.c
17276 @end smallexample
17277 @end table
17278
17279 @table @code
17280 @item compile print @var{expr}
17281 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17282 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17283 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
17284 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17285 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17286 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17287 Formats}.
17288
17289 @item compile print
17290 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
17291 @cindex reprint the last value
17292 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17293 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17294 command without any text following the command. This will start the
17295 multiple-line editor.
17296 @end table
17297
17298 @noindent
17299 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17300
17301 @table @code
17302 @anchor{set debug compile}
17303 @item set debug compile
17304 @cindex compile command debugging info
17305 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17306 injecting the code. The default is off.
17307
17308 @item show debug compile
17309 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17310 compiling and injecting the code.
17311 @end table
17312
17313 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17314
17315 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17316 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17317 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17318 injecting process.
17319
17320 @noindent
17321 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17322
17323 @table @asis
17324 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17325 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17326 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17327 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17328
17329 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17330 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17331 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17332 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17333 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17334 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17335 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17336 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17337
17338 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17339 @end table
17340
17341 @noindent
17342 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17343
17344 @table @code
17345 @item set compile-args
17346 @cindex compile command options override
17347 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17348 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17349 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17350 compilation.
17351
17352 @item show compile-args
17353 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17354 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17355 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17356 @end table
17357
17358 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17359
17360 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17361 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17362 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17363
17364 @table @asis
17365 @item C code examples and caveats
17366 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17367 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17368 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17369 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17370 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17371
17372 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17373 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17374 much like any other normal debugging session.
17375
17376 @smallexample
17377 void function1 (void)
17378 @{
17379 int i = 42;
17380 printf ("function 1\n");
17381 @}
17382
17383 void function2 (void)
17384 @{
17385 int j = 12;
17386 function1 ();
17387 @}
17388
17389 int main(void)
17390 @{
17391 int k = 6;
17392 int *p;
17393 function2 ();
17394 return 0;
17395 @}
17396 @end smallexample
17397
17398 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17399 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17400 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17401
17402 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
17403 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
17404 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
17405 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
17406 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
17407
17408 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
17409 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
17410 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
17411 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
17412 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
17413 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
17414 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
17415 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
17416 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
17417 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
17418
17419 @smallexample
17420 compile code k = 3;
17421 @end smallexample
17422
17423 @noindent
17424 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
17425 something else in the example program changes it, or another
17426 @code{compile} command changes it.
17427
17428 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
17429 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
17430 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
17431 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
17432 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
17433
17434 @smallexample
17435 compile code j = 3;
17436 @end smallexample
17437
17438 @noindent
17439 will result in a compilation error message.
17440
17441 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
17442 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
17443 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
17444
17445 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
17446 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
17447 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
17448 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
17449
17450 @smallexample
17451 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
17452 @end smallexample
17453
17454 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
17455 command has completed:
17456
17457 @smallexample
17458 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
17459 @end smallexample
17460
17461 @noindent
17462 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
17463 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
17464 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
17465 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
17466 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
17467
17468 @smallexample
17469 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
17470 @end smallexample
17471
17472 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
17473 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
17474 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
17475 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
17476 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
17477 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
17478 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
17479 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
17480
17481 @smallexample
17482 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
17483 @end smallexample
17484
17485 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
17486 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
17487 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
17488 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
17489 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
17490 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
17491 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
17492
17493 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
17494 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
17495 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
17496 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
17497 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
17498 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
17499
17500 @smallexample
17501 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
17502 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17503 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
17504 Compilation failed.
17505 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17506 42
17507 @end smallexample
17508
17509 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
17510 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
17511 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
17512 will print to the console.
17513 @end table
17514
17515 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
17516
17517 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
17518 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
17519 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
17520 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
17521 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
17522 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
17523 target architecture and operating system.
17524
17525 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
17526 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
17527 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
17528 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
17529 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
17530 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
17531 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
17532
17533 @node GDB Files
17534 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
17535
17536 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
17537 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
17538 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
17539 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
17540
17541 @menu
17542 * Files:: Commands to specify files
17543 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
17544 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
17545 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
17546 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
17547 * Data Files:: GDB data files
17548 @end menu
17549
17550 @node Files
17551 @section Commands to Specify Files
17552
17553 @cindex symbol table
17554 @cindex core dump file
17555
17556 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
17557 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
17558 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
17559 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
17560
17561 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
17562 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
17563 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
17564 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
17565 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
17566 new files are useful.
17567
17568 @table @code
17569 @cindex executable file
17570 @kindex file
17571 @item file @var{filename}
17572 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
17573 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
17574 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
17575 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
17576 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
17577 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
17578 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
17579 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
17580
17581 @cindex unlinked object files
17582 @cindex patching object files
17583 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
17584 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
17585 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
17586 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
17587 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
17588 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
17589 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
17590 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
17591
17592 @item file
17593 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
17594 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
17595
17596 @kindex exec-file
17597 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17598 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
17599 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
17600 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
17601 discard information on the executable file.
17602
17603 @kindex symbol-file
17604 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17605 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
17606 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
17607 table and program to run from the same file.
17608
17609 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
17610 program's symbol table.
17611
17612 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
17613 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
17614 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
17615 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
17616 @value{GDBN}.
17617
17618 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
17619 executing it once.
17620
17621 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
17622 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
17623 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
17624 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
17625 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
17626 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
17627 optimized code.
17628
17629 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
17630 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
17631 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
17632 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
17633 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
17634
17635 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
17636 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
17637 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
17638 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
17639 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
17640 Warnings and Messages}.)
17641
17642 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
17643 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
17644 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
17645 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
17646 in stabs format.
17647
17648 @kindex readnow
17649 @cindex reading symbols immediately
17650 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
17651 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17652 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17653 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
17654 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
17655 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
17656 entire symbol table available.
17657
17658 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
17659 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
17660 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
17661 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
17662 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
17663 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
17664 @c files.
17665
17666 @kindex core-file
17667 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17668 @itemx core
17669 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
17670 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
17671 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
17672 executable file itself for other parts.
17673
17674 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
17675 to be used.
17676
17677 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
17678 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
17679 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
17680 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
17681 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
17682
17683 @kindex add-symbol-file
17684 @cindex dynamic linking
17685 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
17686 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
17687 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
17688 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
17689 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
17690 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
17691 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
17692 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
17693 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
17694 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
17695 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
17696 @var{address} as an expression.
17697
17698 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
17699 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
17700 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
17701 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
17702
17703 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
17704
17705 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
17706 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
17707 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
17708 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
17709 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
17710 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
17711 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
17712 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
17713 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
17714
17715 @itemize @bullet
17716 @item
17717 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
17718 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
17719 @item
17720 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
17721 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
17722 @item
17723 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
17724 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
17725 @end itemize
17726
17727 @noindent
17728 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
17729 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
17730 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
17731 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
17732 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
17733 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
17734 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
17735 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
17736 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
17737 way.
17738
17739 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17740
17741 @kindex remove-symbol-file
17742 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
17743 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
17744 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
17745 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
17746 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
17747
17748 @smallexample
17749 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
17750 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
17751 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
17752 (y or n) y
17753 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
17754 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
17755 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
17756 (gdb)
17757 @end smallexample
17758
17759
17760 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17761
17762 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
17763 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
17764 @cindex load symbols from memory
17765 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
17766 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
17767 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
17768 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
17769 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
17770 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
17771 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
17772 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
17773 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
17774
17775 @kindex section
17776 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
17777 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
17778 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
17779 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
17780 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
17781 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
17782 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
17783 their addresses.
17784
17785 @kindex info files
17786 @kindex info target
17787 @item info files
17788 @itemx info target
17789 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
17790 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
17791 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
17792 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
17793 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
17794 current ones.
17795
17796 @kindex maint info sections
17797 @item maint info sections
17798 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
17799 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
17800 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
17801 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
17802 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
17803 may be arbitrarily combined):
17804
17805 @table @code
17806 @item ALLOBJ
17807 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
17808 @item @var{sections}
17809 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
17810 @item @var{section-flags}
17811 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
17812 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
17813 @table @code
17814 @item ALLOC
17815 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17816 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17817 @item LOAD
17818 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17819 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
17820 @item RELOC
17821 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
17822 @item READONLY
17823 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
17824 @item CODE
17825 Section contains executable code only.
17826 @item DATA
17827 Section contains data only (no executable code).
17828 @item ROM
17829 Section will reside in ROM.
17830 @item CONSTRUCTOR
17831 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
17832 @item HAS_CONTENTS
17833 Section is not empty.
17834 @item NEVER_LOAD
17835 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
17836 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
17837 A notification to the linker that the section contains
17838 COFF shared library information.
17839 @item IS_COMMON
17840 Section contains common symbols.
17841 @end table
17842 @end table
17843 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
17844 @cindex read-only sections
17845 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
17846 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
17847 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
17848 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
17849 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
17850 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
17851 enhancement to debugging performance.
17852
17853 The default is off.
17854
17855 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
17856 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
17857 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
17858 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
17859
17860 @item show trust-readonly-sections
17861 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
17862 @end table
17863
17864 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
17865 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
17866 name and remembers it that way.
17867
17868 @cindex shared libraries
17869 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
17870 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
17871 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
17872
17873 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
17874 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
17875
17876 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
17877 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
17878 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
17879 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
17880 debugging a core file).
17881
17882 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
17883 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
17884
17885 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
17886 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
17887 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
17888
17889 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
17890 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
17891 particularly large or there are many of them.
17892
17893 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
17894 commands:
17895
17896 @table @code
17897 @kindex set auto-solib-add
17898 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
17899 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
17900 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
17901 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
17902 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
17903 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
17904 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
17905
17906 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
17907 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
17908 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
17909 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
17910 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
17911 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
17912 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
17913 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
17914 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
17915
17916 @kindex show auto-solib-add
17917 @item show auto-solib-add
17918 Display the current autoloading mode.
17919 @end table
17920
17921 @cindex load shared library
17922 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
17923 command:
17924
17925 @table @code
17926 @kindex info sharedlibrary
17927 @kindex info share
17928 @item info share @var{regex}
17929 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17930 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
17931 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
17932 all shared libraries that are loaded.
17933
17934 @kindex info dll
17935 @item info dll @var{regex}
17936 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
17937
17938 @kindex sharedlibrary
17939 @kindex share
17940 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17941 @itemx share @var{regex}
17942 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
17943 Unix regular expression.
17944 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
17945 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
17946 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
17947 loaded.
17948
17949 @item nosharedlibrary
17950 @kindex nosharedlibrary
17951 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
17952 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
17953 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
17954 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
17955 discarded.
17956 @end table
17957
17958 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
17959 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
17960 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
17961 Catchpoints}).
17962
17963 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
17964 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
17965 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
17966 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
17967
17968 @table @code
17969 @item set stop-on-solib-events
17970 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
17971 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
17972 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
17973 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
17974 shared library.
17975
17976 @item show stop-on-solib-events
17977 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
17978 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
17979 library events happen.
17980 @end table
17981
17982 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
17983 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
17984 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
17985 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
17986 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
17987 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
17988 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
17989 not.
17990
17991 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
17992 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
17993 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
17994 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
17995 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
17996
17997 @table @code
17998 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
17999 @cindex system root, alternate
18000 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18001 @kindex set sysroot
18002 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18003 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18004 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18005 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18006 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18007 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18008 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18009 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18010 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18011 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18012 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18013 @var{path}.
18014
18015 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18016 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18017 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18018 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18019 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18020 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18021 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18022 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18023 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18024 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18025 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18026 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18027 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18028 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18029
18030 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18031 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18032 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18033 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18034 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18035
18036 @smallexample
18037 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18038 @end smallexample
18039
18040 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18041 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18042 system:
18043
18044 @smallexample
18045 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18046 @end smallexample
18047
18048 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18049 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18050 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18051 colons:
18052
18053 @smallexample
18054 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18055 @end smallexample
18056
18057 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18058 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18059 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18060 @samp{z}):
18061
18062 @smallexample
18063 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18064 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18065 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18066 @end smallexample
18067
18068 @noindent
18069 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18070 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18071 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18072
18073 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18074 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18075
18076 @smallexample
18077 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18078 @end smallexample
18079
18080 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18081 if you don't want or need to.
18082
18083 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18084 sysroot}.
18085
18086 @cindex default system root
18087 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18088 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18089 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18090 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18091 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18092 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18093 location.
18094
18095 @kindex show sysroot
18096 @item show sysroot
18097 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18098
18099 @kindex set solib-search-path
18100 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18101 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18102 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18103 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18104 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18105 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18106 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18107 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18108 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18109 of shared library symbols.
18110
18111 @kindex show solib-search-path
18112 @item show solib-search-path
18113 Display the current shared library search path.
18114
18115 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18116 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18117 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18118 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18119 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18120
18121 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18122 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18123 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18124 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18125 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18126 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18127 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18128 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18129 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18130 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18131 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18132 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18133 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18134 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18135 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18136 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18137 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18138 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18139 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18140 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18141 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18142 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18143
18144 @table @code
18145 @item unix
18146 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18147 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18148 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18149 the forward slash.
18150
18151 @item dos-based
18152 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18153 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18154 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18155 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18156 considered directory separators.
18157
18158 @item auto
18159 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18160 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18161 This is the default.
18162 @end table
18163 @end table
18164
18165 @cindex file name canonicalization
18166 @cindex base name differences
18167 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18168 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18169 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18170 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18171 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18172 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18173 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18174 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18175 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18176 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18177 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18178 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18179 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18180 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18181 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18182
18183 @table @code
18184 @item set basenames-may-differ
18185 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18186 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18187
18188 @item show basenames-may-differ
18189 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18190 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18191 @end table
18192
18193 @node Separate Debug Files
18194 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18195 @cindex separate debugging information files
18196 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18197 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18198 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18199 @cindex global debugging information directories
18200 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18201 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18202
18203 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18204 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18205 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18206 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18207 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18208 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18209 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18210
18211 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18212 file:
18213
18214 @itemize @bullet
18215 @item
18216 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18217 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18218 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18219 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18220 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18221 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18222 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18223 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18224
18225 @item
18226 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18227 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18228 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18229 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18230 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18231 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18232 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18233 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18234 below.
18235 @end itemize
18236
18237 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18238 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18239
18240 @itemize @bullet
18241 @item
18242 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18243 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18244 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18245 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18246 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18247
18248 @item
18249 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18250 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18251 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18252 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18253 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18254 hex characters, not 10.)
18255 @end itemize
18256
18257 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18258 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18259 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18260 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18261 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18262 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18263
18264 @itemize @minus
18265 @item
18266 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18267 @item
18268 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18269 @item
18270 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18271 @item
18272 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18273 @end itemize
18274
18275 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18276 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18277 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18278 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18279 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18280
18281 @table @code
18282
18283 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18284 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18285 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18286 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18287 concatenating them by a path separator.
18288
18289 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18290 @item show debug-file-directory
18291 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18292 information files.
18293
18294 @end table
18295
18296 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18297 @cindex debug link sections
18298 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18299 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18300
18301 @itemize
18302 @item
18303 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18304 a zero byte,
18305 @item
18306 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18307 boundary within the section, and
18308 @item
18309 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18310 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18311 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18312 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18313 @end itemize
18314
18315 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18316 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18317 described above.
18318
18319 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18320 @cindex build ID sections
18321 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18322 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18323 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18324 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18325 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18326 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18327 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18328 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18329 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18330
18331 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18332 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18333 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18334 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18335 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18336 in an ordinary executable.
18337
18338 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18339 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18340 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18341 following commands:
18342
18343 @smallexample
18344 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18345 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18346 @end smallexample
18347
18348 @noindent
18349 These commands remove the debugging
18350 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18351 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18352 two files:
18353
18354 @itemize @bullet
18355 @item
18356 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18357 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18358
18359 @smallexample
18360 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18361 @end smallexample
18362
18363 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
18364 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
18365 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
18366 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
18367
18368 @item
18369 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
18370 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
18371 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
18372 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
18373 @end itemize
18374
18375 @noindent
18376
18377 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
18378 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
18379 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
18380
18381 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
18382 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
18383 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
18384 @c different ways!
18385 @ifhtml
18386 @display
18387 @html
18388 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
18389 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
18390 @end html
18391 @end display
18392 @end ifhtml
18393 @ifnothtml
18394 @display
18395 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
18396 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
18397 @end display
18398 @end ifnothtml
18399
18400 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
18401 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
18402 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
18403 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
18404 CRC.
18405
18406 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
18407 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
18408 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
18409 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
18410 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
18411
18412 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
18413 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
18414 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
18415 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
18416 @code{0xffffffff}.
18417
18418 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
18419 @smallexample
18420 unsigned long
18421 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
18422 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
18423 @{
18424 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
18425 @{
18426 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
18427 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
18428 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
18429 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
18430 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
18431 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
18432 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
18433 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
18434 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
18435 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
18436 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
18437 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
18438 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
18439 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
18440 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
18441 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
18442 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
18443 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
18444 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
18445 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
18446 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
18447 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
18448 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
18449 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
18450 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
18451 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
18452 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
18453 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
18454 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
18455 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
18456 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
18457 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
18458 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
18459 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
18460 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
18461 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
18462 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
18463 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
18464 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
18465 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
18466 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
18467 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
18468 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
18469 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
18470 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
18471 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
18472 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
18473 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
18474 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
18475 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
18476 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
18477 0x2d02ef8d
18478 @};
18479 unsigned char *end;
18480
18481 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18482 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
18483 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
18484 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18485 @}
18486 @end smallexample
18487
18488 @noindent
18489 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
18490
18491 @node MiniDebugInfo
18492 @section Debugging information in a special section
18493 @cindex separate debug sections
18494 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
18495
18496 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
18497 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
18498 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
18499 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
18500
18501 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
18502 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
18503 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
18504 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
18505 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
18506 debugging information might be included in the section.
18507
18508 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
18509 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
18510 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
18511
18512 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
18513 standard utilities:
18514
18515 @smallexample
18516 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
18517 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
18518 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18519 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
18520
18521 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
18522 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
18523 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
18524 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18525 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
18526 | sort > funcsyms
18527
18528 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
18529 # table.
18530 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
18531
18532 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
18533 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
18534
18535 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
18536 # removing some unnecessary sections.
18537 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
18538 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
18539
18540 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
18541 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
18542
18543 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
18544 # original binary.
18545 xz mini_debuginfo
18546 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
18547 @end smallexample
18548
18549 @node Index Files
18550 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
18551 @cindex index files
18552 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
18553
18554 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
18555 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
18556 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
18557 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
18558 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
18559 startup.
18560
18561 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
18562 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
18563 using @command{objcopy}.
18564
18565 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
18566
18567 @table @code
18568 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
18569 @kindex save gdb-index
18570 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
18571 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
18572 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
18573 @var{directory}.
18574 @end table
18575
18576 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
18577 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
18578
18579 @smallexample
18580 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
18581 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
18582 @end smallexample
18583
18584 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
18585 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
18586 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
18587 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
18588 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
18589 The default is @code{off}.
18590 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
18591 @xref{Index Section Format}.
18592
18593 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
18594 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
18595
18596 @smallexample
18597 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18598 @end smallexample
18599
18600 Instead you must do, for example,
18601
18602 @smallexample
18603 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18604 @end smallexample
18605
18606 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
18607 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
18608 currently work for programs using Ada.
18609
18610 @node Symbol Errors
18611 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
18612
18613 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
18614 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
18615 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
18616 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
18617 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
18618 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
18619 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
18620 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
18621 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
18622 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18623 Messages}).
18624
18625 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
18626
18627 @table @code
18628 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
18629
18630 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
18631 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
18632 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
18633 in its outer scope blocks.
18634
18635 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
18636 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
18637 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
18638 function.
18639
18640 @item block at @var{address} out of order
18641
18642 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
18643 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
18644 do so.
18645
18646 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
18647 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
18648 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
18649 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18650 Messages}.)
18651
18652 @item bad block start address patched
18653
18654 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
18655 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
18656 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
18657
18658 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
18659 starting on the previous source line.
18660
18661 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
18662
18663 @cindex foo
18664 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
18665 larger than the size of the string table.
18666
18667 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
18668 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
18669 with this name.
18670
18671 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
18672
18673 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
18674 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
18675 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
18676
18677 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
18678 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
18679 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
18680 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
18681 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
18682 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
18683
18684 @item stub type has NULL name
18685
18686 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
18687
18688 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
18689 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
18690 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
18691 it.
18692
18693 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
18694
18695 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
18696
18697 @end table
18698
18699 @node Data Files
18700 @section GDB Data Files
18701
18702 @cindex prefix for data files
18703 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
18704 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
18705
18706 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
18707 is currently using.
18708
18709 @table @code
18710 @kindex set data-directory
18711 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
18712 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
18713 to @var{directory}.
18714
18715 @kindex show data-directory
18716 @item show data-directory
18717 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
18718 @end table
18719
18720 @cindex default data directory
18721 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
18722 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
18723 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
18724 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18725 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
18726 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18727 location.
18728
18729 The data directory may also be specified with the
18730 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
18731 @xref{Mode Options}.
18732
18733 @node Targets
18734 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
18735
18736 @cindex debugging target
18737 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
18738
18739 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
18740 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
18741 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
18742 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
18743 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
18744 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
18745 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
18746 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
18747
18748 @cindex target architecture
18749 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
18750 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
18751 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
18752 command.
18753
18754 @table @code
18755 @kindex set architecture
18756 @kindex show architecture
18757 @item set architecture @var{arch}
18758 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
18759 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
18760 supported architectures.
18761
18762 @item show architecture
18763 Show the current target architecture.
18764
18765 @item set processor
18766 @itemx processor
18767 @kindex set processor
18768 @kindex show processor
18769 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
18770 and @code{show architecture}.
18771 @end table
18772
18773 @menu
18774 * Active Targets:: Active targets
18775 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
18776 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
18777 @end menu
18778
18779 @node Active Targets
18780 @section Active Targets
18781
18782 @cindex stacking targets
18783 @cindex active targets
18784 @cindex multiple targets
18785
18786 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
18787 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
18788 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
18789 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
18790 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
18791 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
18792 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
18793 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
18794 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
18795
18796 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
18797 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
18798 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
18799 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
18800
18801 @node Target Commands
18802 @section Commands for Managing Targets
18803
18804 @table @code
18805 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
18806 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
18807 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
18808 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
18809 protocol of the target machine.
18810
18811 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
18812 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
18813 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
18814
18815 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
18816 after executing the command.
18817
18818 @kindex help target
18819 @item help target
18820 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
18821 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
18822 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
18823
18824 @item help target @var{name}
18825 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
18826 select it.
18827
18828 @kindex set gnutarget
18829 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
18830 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
18831 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
18832 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
18833 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
18834 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
18835
18836 @quotation
18837 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
18838 you must know the actual BFD name.
18839 @end quotation
18840
18841 @noindent
18842 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
18843
18844 @kindex show gnutarget
18845 @item show gnutarget
18846 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
18847 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
18848 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
18849 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
18850 @end table
18851
18852 @cindex common targets
18853 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
18854 configuration):
18855
18856 @table @code
18857 @kindex target
18858 @item target exec @var{program}
18859 @cindex executable file target
18860 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
18861 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
18862
18863 @item target core @var{filename}
18864 @cindex core dump file target
18865 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
18866 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
18867
18868 @item target remote @var{medium}
18869 @cindex remote target
18870 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
18871 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
18872 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
18873
18874 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
18875 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
18876
18877 @smallexample
18878 target remote /dev/ttya
18879 @end smallexample
18880
18881 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
18882 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
18883 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
18884 clobbered by the download.
18885
18886 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18887 @cindex built-in simulator target
18888 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
18889 In general,
18890 @smallexample
18891 target sim
18892 load
18893 run
18894 @end smallexample
18895 @noindent
18896 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
18897 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
18898 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
18899 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
18900 Processors}.
18901
18902 @item target native
18903 @cindex native target
18904 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
18905 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
18906 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
18907 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
18908
18909 @end table
18910
18911 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
18912 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
18913
18914 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
18915 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
18916 various aspects of this process.
18917
18918 @table @code
18919
18920 @item set hash
18921 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18922 @cindex hash mark while downloading
18923 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
18924 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
18925 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
18926 monitor.
18927
18928 @item show hash
18929 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18930 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
18931
18932 @item set debug monitor
18933 @kindex set debug monitor
18934 @cindex display remote monitor communications
18935 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
18936 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18937
18938 @item show debug monitor
18939 @kindex show debug monitor
18940 Show the current status of displaying communications between
18941 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18942 @end table
18943
18944 @table @code
18945
18946 @kindex load @var{filename}
18947 @item load @var{filename}
18948 @anchor{load}
18949 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
18950 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
18951 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
18952 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
18953 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
18954 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18955
18956 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
18957 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
18958 target is @dots{}}''
18959
18960 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
18961 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
18962 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
18963 specifies a fixed address.
18964 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
18965
18966 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
18967 load programs into flash memory.
18968
18969 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
18970 @end table
18971
18972 @node Byte Order
18973 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
18974
18975 @cindex choosing target byte order
18976 @cindex target byte order
18977
18978 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
18979 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
18980 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
18981 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
18982 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
18983 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
18984
18985 @table @code
18986 @kindex set endian
18987 @item set endian big
18988 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
18989
18990 @item set endian little
18991 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
18992
18993 @item set endian auto
18994 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
18995 executable.
18996
18997 @item show endian
18998 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
18999
19000 @end table
19001
19002 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19003 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19004 target system.
19005
19006
19007 @node Remote Debugging
19008 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19009 @cindex remote debugging
19010
19011 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19012 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19013 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19014 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19015 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19016
19017 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19018 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19019 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19020 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19021 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19022 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19023
19024 Other remote targets may be available in your
19025 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19026
19027 @menu
19028 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19029 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19030 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19031 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19032 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19033 @end menu
19034
19035 @node Connecting
19036 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19037
19038 @value{GDBN} needs an unstripped copy of your program to access symbol
19039 and debugging information. Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer
19040 executable filename read}, and @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow
19041 @value{GDBN} to access program files over the same connection used to
19042 communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a target, if the remote
19043 program is unstripped, the only command you need is @code{target
19044 remote}. Otherwise, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19045 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19046 @code{file} command.
19047
19048 @cindex @code{target remote}
19049 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19050 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19051 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19052 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
19053 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
19054 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
19055
19056 @table @code
19057
19058 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
19059 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19060 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
19061 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19062
19063 @smallexample
19064 target remote /dev/ttyb
19065 @end smallexample
19066
19067 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19068 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19069 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19070 @code{target} command.
19071
19072 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19073 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19074 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19075 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19076 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19077 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
19078 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19079 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19080 target.
19081
19082 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19083 @code{manyfarms}:
19084
19085 @smallexample
19086 target remote manyfarms:2828
19087 @end smallexample
19088
19089 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19090 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19091 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19092 port 1234 on your local machine:
19093
19094 @smallexample
19095 target remote :1234
19096 @end smallexample
19097 @noindent
19098
19099 Note that the colon is still required here.
19100
19101 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19102 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19103 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19104 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19105
19106 @smallexample
19107 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19108 @end smallexample
19109
19110 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19111 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19112 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19113 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19114
19115 @item target remote | @var{command}
19116 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19117 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19118 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19119 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19120 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19121 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19122 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19123 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19124
19125 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19126 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19127 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19128
19129 @end table
19130
19131 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
19132 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
19133 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
19134 need to use @kbd{run}.
19135
19136 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19137 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19138 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19139 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19140 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19141 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19142 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19143
19144 @smallexample
19145 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19146 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19147 @end smallexample
19148
19149 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
19150 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
19151 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
19152 goes back to waiting.
19153
19154 @table @code
19155 @kindex detach (remote)
19156 @item detach
19157 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19158 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19159 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19160 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19161 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
19162
19163 @kindex disconnect
19164 @item disconnect
19165 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
19166 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19167 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19168 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19169 another target.
19170
19171 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19172 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19173 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19174 @kindex monitor
19175 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19176 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19177 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19178 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19179 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19180 and implement.
19181 @end table
19182
19183 @node File Transfer
19184 @section Sending files to a remote system
19185 @cindex remote target, file transfer
19186 @cindex file transfer
19187 @cindex sending files to remote systems
19188
19189 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19190 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
19191 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19192 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
19193 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19194 the only way to upload or download files.
19195
19196 Not all remote targets support these commands.
19197
19198 @table @code
19199 @kindex remote put
19200 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19201 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19202 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19203
19204 @kindex remote get
19205 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
19206 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
19207 on the host system.
19208
19209 @kindex remote delete
19210 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
19211 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
19212
19213 @end table
19214
19215 @node Server
19216 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
19217
19218 @kindex gdbserver
19219 @cindex remote connection without stubs
19220 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
19221 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
19222 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
19223
19224 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
19225 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
19226 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
19227 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
19228 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
19229 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
19230 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
19231 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
19232 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
19233 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
19234 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
19235 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
19236 choice for debugging.
19237
19238 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
19239 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
19240 protocol.
19241
19242 @quotation
19243 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
19244 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
19245 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
19246 target system with the same privileges as the user running
19247 @code{gdbserver}.
19248 @end quotation
19249
19250 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
19251 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
19252 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
19253
19254 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
19255 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
19256 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
19257 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
19258 system does all the symbol handling.
19259
19260 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
19261 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
19262 syntax is:
19263
19264 @smallexample
19265 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
19266 @end smallexample
19267
19268 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
19269 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
19270 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
19271 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
19272 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
19273 @file{/dev/com1}:
19274
19275 @smallexample
19276 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
19277 @end smallexample
19278
19279 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
19280 with it.
19281
19282 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
19283
19284 @smallexample
19285 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
19286 @end smallexample
19287
19288 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
19289 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
19290 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
19291 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
19292 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
19293 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
19294 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
19295 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
19296 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
19297 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
19298 @code{target remote} command.
19299
19300 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
19301 with ssh:
19302
19303 @smallexample
19304 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
19305 @end smallexample
19306
19307 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
19308 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
19309 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
19310 You could elide it if you want to.
19311
19312 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
19313 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
19314 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
19315 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
19316
19317 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
19318 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
19319 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
19320
19321 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
19322 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
19323
19324 @smallexample
19325 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
19326 @end smallexample
19327
19328 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
19329 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
19330
19331 @pindex pidof
19332 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
19333 @code{pidof} utility:
19334
19335 @smallexample
19336 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
19337 @end smallexample
19338
19339 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
19340 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
19341 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
19342
19343 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
19344 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
19345 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
19346
19347 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
19348 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
19349 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
19350 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
19351
19352 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
19353 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
19354 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
19355 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
19356 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
19357 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
19358 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
19359 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
19360 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19361
19362 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19363 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19364 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
19365 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
19366 the program you want to debug.
19367
19368 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
19369 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
19370 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
19371 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
19372 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
19373 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19374
19375 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
19376
19377 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
19378
19379 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
19380 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
19381 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
19382 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
19383 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
19384 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
19385 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
19386 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
19387
19388 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
19389 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
19390 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
19391
19392 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
19393 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
19394 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
19395 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
19396 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
19397 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
19398 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
19399 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
19400 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
19401 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
19402 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
19403 instance closes its port after the first connection.
19404
19405 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
19406 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
19407
19408 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19409 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
19410 status information about the debugging process.
19411 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19412 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
19413 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
19414 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
19415
19416 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
19417 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
19418 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
19419 Possible options are:
19420
19421 @table @code
19422 @item none
19423 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19424 @item all
19425 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19426 @item timestamps
19427 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19428 @end table
19429
19430 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19431 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19432
19433 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
19434 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
19435 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
19436 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
19437 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
19438
19439 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
19440 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
19441 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
19442 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
19443
19444 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
19445 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
19446 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
19447 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
19448
19449 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
19450 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
19451 environment:
19452
19453 @smallexample
19454 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
19455 @end smallexample
19456
19457 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
19458
19459 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
19460
19461 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
19462 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
19463 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
19464 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
19465
19466 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19467 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19468 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19469 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19470 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19471 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19472 programs.
19473
19474 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19475 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
19476 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
19477 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
19478 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
19479 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
19480 already on the target.
19481
19482 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
19483 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
19484 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
19485
19486 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
19487 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
19488 Here are the available commands.
19489
19490 @table @code
19491 @item monitor help
19492 List the available monitor commands.
19493
19494 @item monitor set debug 0
19495 @itemx monitor set debug 1
19496 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
19497
19498 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
19499 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
19500 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
19501 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
19502
19503 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
19504 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
19505 Possible options are:
19506
19507 @table @code
19508 @item none
19509 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19510 @item all
19511 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19512 @item timestamps
19513 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19514 @end table
19515
19516 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19517 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19518
19519 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
19520 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
19521 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19522 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
19523 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
19524 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
19525
19526 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
19527 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
19528
19529 @item monitor exit
19530 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
19531 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
19532 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
19533 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
19534 of a multi-process mode debug session.
19535
19536 @end table
19537
19538 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19539 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19540
19541 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
19542 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
19543
19544 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
19545 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
19546 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
19547 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
19548 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
19549 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
19550 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
19551 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
19552 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
19553 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
19554 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
19555 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
19556
19557 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
19558
19559 @table @code
19560 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
19561
19562 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
19563 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
19564 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
19565
19566 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
19567
19568 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
19569 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
19570 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
19571 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
19572 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
19573 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
19574
19575 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
19576
19577 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
19578 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
19579 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
19580 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
19581 command for that. For example:
19582
19583 @smallexample
19584 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
19585 @end smallexample
19586
19587 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
19588 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
19589 @end table
19590
19591 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
19592 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
19593 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
19594 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
19595 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
19596 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
19597 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
19598 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
19599 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
19600 @code{gdbserver} like so:
19601
19602 @smallexample
19603 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
19604 @end smallexample
19605
19606 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
19607
19608 @smallexample
19609 $ gdb myprogram
19610 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
19611 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
19612 (@value{GDBP}) b main
19613 (@value{GDBP}) continue
19614 @end smallexample
19615
19616 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
19617 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
19618 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
19619 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
19620 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
19621 tracing.
19622
19623 @node Remote Configuration
19624 @section Remote Configuration
19625
19626 @kindex set remote
19627 @kindex show remote
19628 This section documents the configuration options available when
19629 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
19630 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
19631 system-call-allowed}.
19632
19633 @table @code
19634 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
19635 @cindex address size for remote targets
19636 @cindex bits in remote address
19637 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
19638 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
19639 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
19640 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
19641
19642 @item show remoteaddresssize
19643 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
19644
19645 @item set serial baud @var{n}
19646 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
19647 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
19648 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
19649 remote targets.
19650
19651 @item show serial baud
19652 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
19653
19654 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
19655 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
19656 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
19657
19658 @item show serial parity
19659 Show the current parity of the serial port.
19660
19661 @item set remotebreak
19662 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19663 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
19664 @anchor{set remotebreak}
19665 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
19666 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
19667 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
19668 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
19669 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
19670
19671 @item show remotebreak
19672 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
19673 interrupt the remote program.
19674
19675 @item set remoteflow on
19676 @itemx set remoteflow off
19677 @kindex set remoteflow
19678 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
19679 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
19680
19681 @item show remoteflow
19682 @kindex show remoteflow
19683 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
19684
19685 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
19686 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
19687 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
19688 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
19689 @code{ascii}.
19690
19691 @item show remotelogbase
19692 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
19693 protocol.
19694
19695 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
19696 @cindex record serial communications on file
19697 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
19698 default is not to record at all.
19699
19700 @item show remotelogfile.
19701 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
19702 serial communications.
19703
19704 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
19705 @cindex timeout for serial communications
19706 @cindex remote timeout
19707 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
19708 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
19709
19710 @item show remotetimeout
19711 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
19712 responses.
19713
19714 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
19715 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
19716 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
19717 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
19718 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
19719 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
19720 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
19721 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
19722
19723 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
19724 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
19725 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
19726 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
19727 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
19728 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
19729 as unlimited.
19730
19731 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
19732 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
19733 a remote hardware watchpoint.
19734
19735 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
19736 @itemx show remote exec-file
19737 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
19738 @cindex executable file, for remote target
19739 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
19740 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
19741 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
19742 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
19743
19744 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
19745 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19746 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
19747 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
19748 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
19749 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
19750 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
19751 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
19752 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
19753 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
19754
19755 @item show interrupt-sequence
19756 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
19757 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
19758 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
19759 also known as Magic SysRq g.
19760
19761 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
19762 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
19763 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
19764 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
19765 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
19766 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
19767
19768 @item show interrupt-on-connect
19769 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
19770 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
19771
19772 @kindex set tcp
19773 @kindex show tcp
19774 @item set tcp auto-retry on
19775 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
19776 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
19777 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
19778 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
19779 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
19780 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
19781 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
19782 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
19783
19784 @item set tcp auto-retry off
19785 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
19786
19787 @item show tcp auto-retry
19788 Show the current auto-retry setting.
19789
19790 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
19791 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
19792 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
19793 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
19794 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
19795 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
19796 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
19797 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
19798 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
19799 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
19800 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
19801
19802 @item show tcp connect-timeout
19803 Show the current connection timeout setting.
19804 @end table
19805
19806 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
19807 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
19808 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
19809 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
19810 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
19811 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
19812 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
19813 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
19814 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
19815
19816 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
19817 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
19818 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
19819 @value{GDBN} developers.
19820
19821 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
19822 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
19823 are:
19824
19825 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
19826 @item Command Name
19827 @tab Remote Packet
19828 @tab Related Features
19829
19830 @item @code{fetch-register}
19831 @tab @code{p}
19832 @tab @code{info registers}
19833
19834 @item @code{set-register}
19835 @tab @code{P}
19836 @tab @code{set}
19837
19838 @item @code{binary-download}
19839 @tab @code{X}
19840 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
19841
19842 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
19843 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
19844 @tab @code{info auxv}
19845
19846 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
19847 @tab @code{qSymbol}
19848 @tab Detecting multiple threads
19849
19850 @item @code{attach}
19851 @tab @code{vAttach}
19852 @tab @code{attach}
19853
19854 @item @code{verbose-resume}
19855 @tab @code{vCont}
19856 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
19857
19858 @item @code{run}
19859 @tab @code{vRun}
19860 @tab @code{run}
19861
19862 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
19863 @tab @code{Z0}
19864 @tab @code{break}
19865
19866 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
19867 @tab @code{Z1}
19868 @tab @code{hbreak}
19869
19870 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
19871 @tab @code{Z2}
19872 @tab @code{watch}
19873
19874 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
19875 @tab @code{Z3}
19876 @tab @code{rwatch}
19877
19878 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
19879 @tab @code{Z4}
19880 @tab @code{awatch}
19881
19882 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
19883 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
19884 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
19885
19886 @item @code{target-features}
19887 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
19888 @tab @code{set architecture}
19889
19890 @item @code{library-info}
19891 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
19892 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
19893
19894 @item @code{memory-map}
19895 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
19896 @tab @code{info mem}
19897
19898 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
19899 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
19900 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
19901
19902 @item @code{read-spu-object}
19903 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
19904 @tab @code{info spu}
19905
19906 @item @code{write-spu-object}
19907 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
19908 @tab @code{info spu}
19909
19910 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
19911 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
19912 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
19913
19914 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
19915 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
19916 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
19917
19918 @item @code{threads}
19919 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
19920 @tab @code{info threads}
19921
19922 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
19923 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
19924 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
19925
19926 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
19927 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
19928 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
19929
19930 @item @code{search-memory}
19931 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
19932 @tab @code{find}
19933
19934 @item @code{supported-packets}
19935 @tab @code{qSupported}
19936 @tab Remote communications parameters
19937
19938 @item @code{pass-signals}
19939 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
19940 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19941
19942 @item @code{program-signals}
19943 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
19944 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19945
19946 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
19947 @tab @code{vFile:close}
19948 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19949
19950 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
19951 @tab @code{vFile:open}
19952 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19953
19954 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
19955 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
19956 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19957
19958 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
19959 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
19960 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19961
19962 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
19963 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
19964 @tab @code{remote delete}
19965
19966 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
19967 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
19968 @tab Host I/O
19969
19970 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
19971 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
19972 @tab Host I/O
19973
19974 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
19975 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
19976 @tab Host I/O
19977
19978 @item @code{noack-packet}
19979 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
19980 @tab Packet acknowledgment
19981
19982 @item @code{osdata}
19983 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
19984 @tab @code{info os}
19985
19986 @item @code{query-attached}
19987 @tab @code{qAttached}
19988 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
19989
19990 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
19991 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
19992 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
19993
19994 @item @code{trace-status}
19995 @tab @code{qTStatus}
19996 @tab @code{tstatus}
19997
19998 @item @code{traceframe-info}
19999 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20000 @tab Traceframe info
20001
20002 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20003 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20004 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20005
20006 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20007 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20008 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20009
20010 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20011 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20012 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20013
20014 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
20015 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20016 @tab @code{break}
20017
20018 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20019 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20020 @tab @code{hbreak}
20021
20022 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
20023 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
20024 @tab @code{fork}
20025
20026 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20027 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20028 @tab @code{vfork}
20029
20030 @end multitable
20031
20032 @node Remote Stub
20033 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
20034
20035 @cindex debugging stub, example
20036 @cindex remote stub, example
20037 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
20038 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
20039 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
20040 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
20041 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
20042 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20043 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20044 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20045
20046 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20047 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20048 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20049 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
20050 program, you need:
20051
20052 @enumerate
20053 @item
20054 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20055 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
20056 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20057
20058 @item
20059 A C subroutine library to support your program's
20060 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20061
20062 @item
20063 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20064 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
20065 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20066 documentation.
20067 @end enumerate
20068
20069 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20070 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20071 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20072
20073 @table @emph
20074 @item On the host,
20075 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20076 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20077 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20078
20079 @item On the target,
20080 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20081 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
20082 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20083
20084 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20085 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20086 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20087 @end table
20088
20089 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20090 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20091 @sc{sparc} boards.
20092
20093 @cindex remote serial stub list
20094 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20095
20096 @table @code
20097
20098 @item i386-stub.c
20099 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20100 @cindex Intel
20101 @cindex i386
20102 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20103
20104 @item m68k-stub.c
20105 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20106 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20107 @cindex m680x0
20108 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20109
20110 @item sh-stub.c
20111 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20112 @cindex Renesas
20113 @cindex SH
20114 For Renesas SH architectures.
20115
20116 @item sparc-stub.c
20117 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20118 @cindex Sparc
20119 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20120
20121 @item sparcl-stub.c
20122 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20123 @cindex Fujitsu
20124 @cindex SparcLite
20125 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20126
20127 @end table
20128
20129 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20130 recently added stubs.
20131
20132 @menu
20133 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20134 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20135 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20136 @end menu
20137
20138 @node Stub Contents
20139 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20140
20141 @cindex remote serial stub
20142 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20143 subroutines:
20144
20145 @table @code
20146 @item set_debug_traps
20147 @findex set_debug_traps
20148 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20149 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20150 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20151 program's startup code.
20152
20153 @item handle_exception
20154 @findex handle_exception
20155 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20156 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20157 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20158 run when a trap is triggered.
20159
20160 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20161 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20162 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20163 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20164 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20165 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20166 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20167 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20168 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20169 machine.
20170
20171 @item breakpoint
20172 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20173 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20174 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20175 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20176 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20177 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20178 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20179 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20180 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20181 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20182 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
20183
20184 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20185 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20186 start of your debugging session.
20187 @end table
20188
20189 @node Bootstrapping
20190 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20191
20192 @cindex remote stub, support routines
20193 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20194 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20195 debugging target machine.
20196
20197 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20198 serial port.
20199
20200 @table @code
20201 @item int getDebugChar()
20202 @findex getDebugChar
20203 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
20204 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
20205 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20206
20207 @item void putDebugChar(int)
20208 @findex putDebugChar
20209 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
20210 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
20211 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20212 @end table
20213
20214 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
20215 @cindex interrupting remote targets
20216 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
20217 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
20218 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
20219 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
20220 remote system to stop.
20221
20222 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
20223 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
20224 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
20225 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
20226
20227 Other routines you need to supply are:
20228
20229 @table @code
20230 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
20231 @findex exceptionHandler
20232 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
20233 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
20234 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
20235 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
20236 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
20237 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
20238 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
20239 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
20240 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
20241 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
20242 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
20243 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
20244 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
20245
20246 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
20247 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
20248 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
20249 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
20250 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
20251
20252 @item void flush_i_cache()
20253 @findex flush_i_cache
20254 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
20255 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
20256 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
20257
20258 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
20259 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
20260 @end table
20261
20262 @noindent
20263 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
20264
20265 @table @code
20266 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
20267 @findex memset
20268 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
20269 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
20270 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
20271 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
20272 @end table
20273
20274 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
20275 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
20276 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
20277 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
20278
20279
20280 @node Debug Session
20281 @subsection Putting it All Together
20282
20283 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
20284 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
20285 steps.
20286
20287 @enumerate
20288 @item
20289 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
20290 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
20291 @display
20292 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
20293 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
20294 @end display
20295
20296 @item
20297 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
20298 procedure is called:
20299
20300 @smallexample
20301 set_debug_traps();
20302 breakpoint();
20303 @end smallexample
20304
20305 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
20306 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
20307 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
20308 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
20309 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
20310 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
20311 progress.
20312
20313 @item
20314 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
20315 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
20316
20317 @smallexample
20318 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
20319 @end smallexample
20320
20321 @noindent
20322 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
20323 function in your program, that function is called when
20324 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
20325 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
20326 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
20327
20328 @item
20329 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
20330 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
20331
20332 @item
20333 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
20334 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
20335
20336 @item
20337 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
20338 @c document that. FIXME.
20339 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
20340 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
20341
20342 @item
20343 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
20344 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20345
20346 @end enumerate
20347
20348 @node Configurations
20349 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
20350
20351 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
20352 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
20353 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
20354
20355 There are three major categories of configurations: native
20356 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
20357 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
20358 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
20359 are quite different from each other.
20360
20361 @menu
20362 * Native::
20363 * Embedded OS::
20364 * Embedded Processors::
20365 * Architectures::
20366 @end menu
20367
20368 @node Native
20369 @section Native
20370
20371 This section describes details specific to particular native
20372 configurations.
20373
20374 @menu
20375 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
20376 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
20377 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
20378 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
20379 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
20380 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
20381 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
20382 @end menu
20383
20384 @node HP-UX
20385 @subsection HP-UX
20386
20387 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
20388 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
20389 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
20390
20391
20392 @node BSD libkvm Interface
20393 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
20394
20395 @cindex libkvm
20396 @cindex kernel memory image
20397 @cindex kernel crash dump
20398
20399 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
20400 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
20401 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
20402 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
20403 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
20404 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
20405 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
20406 @code{kvm} target:
20407
20408 @smallexample
20409 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
20410 @end smallexample
20411
20412 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
20413 argument:
20414
20415 @smallexample
20416 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
20417 @end smallexample
20418
20419 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
20420 available:
20421
20422 @table @code
20423 @kindex kvm
20424 @item kvm pcb
20425 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
20426
20427 @item kvm proc
20428 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
20429 modern FreeBSD systems.
20430 @end table
20431
20432 @node SVR4 Process Information
20433 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
20434 @cindex /proc
20435 @cindex examine process image
20436 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
20437
20438 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
20439 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
20440 process using file-system subroutines.
20441
20442 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
20443 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
20444 information about the process running your program, or about any
20445 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
20446 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, but not HP-UX, for example.
20447
20448 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
20449 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
20450
20451 @table @code
20452 @kindex info proc
20453 @cindex process ID
20454 @item info proc
20455 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
20456 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
20457 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
20458 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
20459 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
20460 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
20461 executable file's absolute file name.
20462
20463 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
20464 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
20465 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
20466 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
20467 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
20468 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
20469
20470 @item info proc cmdline
20471 @cindex info proc cmdline
20472 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
20473 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20474
20475 @item info proc cwd
20476 @cindex info proc cwd
20477 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
20478 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20479
20480 @item info proc exe
20481 @cindex info proc exe
20482 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
20483 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20484
20485 @item info proc mappings
20486 @cindex memory address space mappings
20487 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
20488 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
20489 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
20490 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
20491 memory access rights to that range.
20492
20493 @item info proc stat
20494 @itemx info proc status
20495 @cindex process detailed status information
20496 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
20497 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
20498 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
20499 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
20500 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
20501 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
20502 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
20503
20504 @item info proc all
20505 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
20506 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
20507
20508 @ignore
20509 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
20510 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
20511 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
20512 @kindex info proc times
20513 @item info proc times
20514 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
20515 its children.
20516
20517 @kindex info proc id
20518 @item info proc id
20519 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
20520 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
20521 @end ignore
20522
20523 @item set procfs-trace
20524 @kindex set procfs-trace
20525 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
20526 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
20527
20528 @item show procfs-trace
20529 @kindex show procfs-trace
20530 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
20531
20532 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
20533 @kindex set procfs-file
20534 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
20535 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
20536 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
20537 standard output.
20538
20539 @item show procfs-file
20540 @kindex show procfs-file
20541 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
20542
20543 @item proc-trace-entry
20544 @itemx proc-trace-exit
20545 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
20546 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
20547 @kindex proc-trace-entry
20548 @kindex proc-trace-exit
20549 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
20550 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
20551 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
20552 from the @code{syscall} interface.
20553
20554 @item info pidlist
20555 @kindex info pidlist
20556 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
20557 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
20558 processes and all the threads within each process.
20559
20560 @item info meminfo
20561 @kindex info meminfo
20562 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
20563 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
20564 @end table
20565
20566 @node DJGPP Native
20567 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
20568 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
20569 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
20570 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
20571
20572 @cindex DPMI
20573 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
20574 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
20575 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
20576 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
20577
20578 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
20579 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
20580 subsection describes those commands.
20581
20582 @table @code
20583 @kindex info dos
20584 @item info dos
20585 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
20586 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20587
20588 @kindex sysinfo
20589 @cindex MS-DOS system info
20590 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
20591 @item info dos sysinfo
20592 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
20593 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
20594 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
20595
20596 @cindex GDT
20597 @cindex LDT
20598 @cindex IDT
20599 @cindex segment descriptor tables
20600 @cindex descriptor tables display
20601 @item info dos gdt
20602 @itemx info dos ldt
20603 @itemx info dos idt
20604 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
20605 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
20606 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
20607 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
20608 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
20609 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
20610 rights.
20611
20612 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
20613 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
20614 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
20615 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
20616 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
20617
20618 @cindex garbled pointers
20619 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
20620 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
20621 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
20622 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
20623 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
20624 debugged program's data segment:
20625
20626 @smallexample
20627 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
20628 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
20629 @end smallexample
20630
20631 @noindent
20632 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
20633 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
20634
20635 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
20636 @item info dos pde
20637 @itemx info dos pte
20638 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
20639 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
20640 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
20641 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
20642 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
20643 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
20644 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
20645 that is currently in use.
20646
20647 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
20648 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
20649 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
20650 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
20651 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
20652 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
20653 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
20654
20655 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
20656 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
20657 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
20658 controller.
20659
20660 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
20661
20662 @cindex physical address from linear address
20663 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
20664 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
20665 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
20666 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
20667 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
20668 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
20669 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
20670
20671 @smallexample
20672 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
20673 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
20674 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
20675 @end smallexample
20676
20677 @noindent
20678 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
20679 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
20680 attributes of that page.
20681
20682 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
20683 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
20684 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
20685 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
20686 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
20687 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
20688
20689 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
20690 transfer buffer:
20691
20692 @smallexample
20693 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
20694 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
20695 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
20696 @end smallexample
20697
20698 @noindent
20699 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
20700 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
20701 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
20702 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
20703 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
20704
20705 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
20706 @end table
20707
20708 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
20709 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
20710 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
20711 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
20712
20713 @table @code
20714 @kindex set com1base
20715 @kindex set com1irq
20716 @kindex set com2base
20717 @kindex set com2irq
20718 @kindex set com3base
20719 @kindex set com3irq
20720 @kindex set com4base
20721 @kindex set com4irq
20722 @item set com1base @var{addr}
20723 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
20724 port.
20725
20726 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
20727 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
20728 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
20729
20730 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
20731 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
20732 other 3 COM ports.
20733
20734 @kindex show com1base
20735 @kindex show com1irq
20736 @kindex show com2base
20737 @kindex show com2irq
20738 @kindex show com3base
20739 @kindex show com3irq
20740 @kindex show com4base
20741 @kindex show com4irq
20742 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
20743 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
20744 lines used by the COM ports.
20745
20746 @item info serial
20747 @kindex info serial
20748 @cindex DOS serial port status
20749 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
20750 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
20751 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
20752 counts of various errors encountered so far.
20753 @end table
20754
20755
20756 @node Cygwin Native
20757 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
20758 @cindex MS Windows debugging
20759 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
20760 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
20761
20762 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
20763 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
20764
20765 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
20766 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
20767 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
20768 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
20769 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
20770 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
20771 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
20772 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
20773
20774 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
20775 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
20776 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
20777
20778 @table @code
20779 @kindex info w32
20780 @item info w32
20781 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
20782 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20783
20784 @item info w32 selector
20785 This command displays information returned by
20786 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
20787 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
20788 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
20789 Without argument, this command displays information
20790 about the six segment registers.
20791
20792 @item info w32 thread-information-block
20793 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
20794 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
20795 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
20796
20797 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
20798 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
20799 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
20800 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
20801 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
20802 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
20803 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
20804 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
20805 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
20806 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
20807 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
20808
20809 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
20810 @item show cygwin-exceptions
20811 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
20812 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
20813
20814 @kindex set new-console
20815 @item set new-console @var{mode}
20816 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
20817 be started in a new console on next start.
20818 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
20819 be started in the same console as the debugger.
20820
20821 @kindex show new-console
20822 @item show new-console
20823 Displays whether a new console is used
20824 when the debuggee is started.
20825
20826 @kindex set new-group
20827 @item set new-group @var{mode}
20828 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
20829 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
20830 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
20831 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
20832
20833 @kindex show new-group
20834 @item show new-group
20835 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
20836
20837 @kindex set debugevents
20838 @item set debugevents
20839 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
20840 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
20841 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
20842 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
20843 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
20844
20845 @kindex set debugexec
20846 @item set debugexec
20847 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
20848 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
20849
20850 @kindex set debugexceptions
20851 @item set debugexceptions
20852 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
20853 debuggee seen by the debugger.
20854
20855 @kindex set debugmemory
20856 @item set debugmemory
20857 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
20858 and writes by the debugger.
20859
20860 @kindex set shell
20861 @item set shell
20862 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
20863 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
20864
20865 @kindex show shell
20866 @item show shell
20867 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
20868
20869 @end table
20870
20871 @menu
20872 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
20873 @end menu
20874
20875 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
20876 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
20877 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
20878 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
20879
20880 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
20881 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
20882 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
20883 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
20884 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
20885 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
20886 ``minimal symbols''.
20887
20888 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
20889 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
20890 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
20891 program run once to completion.
20892
20893 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
20894
20895 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
20896 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
20897 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
20898 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
20899 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
20900 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
20901 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
20902 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
20903 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
20904
20905 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
20906 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
20907 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
20908 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
20909 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
20910 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
20911
20912 @smallexample
20913 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
20914 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
20915
20916 Non-debugging symbols:
20917 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
20918 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
20919 @end smallexample
20920
20921 @smallexample
20922 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
20923 All functions matching regular expression "!":
20924
20925 Non-debugging symbols:
20926 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
20927 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
20928 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
20929 [etc...]
20930 @end smallexample
20931
20932 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
20933
20934 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
20935 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
20936 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
20937 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
20938 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
20939 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
20940 a function within a DLL without a running program.
20941
20942 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
20943 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
20944 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
20945 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
20946 problem:
20947
20948 @smallexample
20949 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
20950 $1 = 268572168
20951 @end smallexample
20952
20953 @smallexample
20954 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
20955 0x10021610: "\230y\""
20956 @end smallexample
20957
20958 And two possible solutions:
20959
20960 @smallexample
20961 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
20962 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20963 @end smallexample
20964
20965 @smallexample
20966 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
20967 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
20968 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
20969 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
20970 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
20971 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20972 @end smallexample
20973
20974 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
20975 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
20976 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
20977 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
20978 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
20979
20980 @smallexample
20981 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
20982 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
20983 @end smallexample
20984
20985 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
20986 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
20987 safe.
20988
20989 @node Hurd Native
20990 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
20991 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
20992
20993 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
20994 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
20995
20996 @table @code
20997 @item set signals
20998 @itemx set sigs
20999 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21000 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21001 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21002 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21003 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21004 @code{signals}.
21005
21006 @item show signals
21007 @itemx show sigs
21008 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
21009 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21010 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
21011
21012 @item set signal-thread
21013 @itemx set sigthread
21014 @kindex set signal-thread
21015 @kindex set sigthread
21016 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
21017 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
21018 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
21019 signal-thread}.
21020
21021 @item show signal-thread
21022 @itemx show sigthread
21023 @kindex show signal-thread
21024 @kindex show sigthread
21025 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
21026 delivered a signal.
21027
21028 @item set stopped
21029 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21030 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
21031 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
21032 continued by delivering a signal to it.
21033
21034 @item show stopped
21035 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21036 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
21037 stopped.
21038
21039 @item set exceptions
21040 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21041 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
21042 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21043 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
21044 trapping on.
21045
21046 @item show exceptions
21047 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21048 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21049
21050 @item set task pause
21051 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21052 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21053 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21054 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21055 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21056 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
21057 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
21058 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21059 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21060
21061 @item show task pause
21062 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21063 Show the current state of task suspension.
21064
21065 @item set task detach-suspend-count
21066 @cindex task suspend count
21067 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21068 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21069 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21070
21071 @item show task detach-suspend-count
21072 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21073
21074 @item set task exception-port
21075 @itemx set task excp
21076 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21077 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21078 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21079 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21080
21081 @item set noninvasive
21082 @cindex noninvasive task options
21083 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21084 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
21085 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21086 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21087
21088 @item info send-rights
21089 @itemx info receive-rights
21090 @itemx info port-rights
21091 @itemx info port-sets
21092 @itemx info dead-names
21093 @itemx info ports
21094 @itemx info psets
21095 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21096 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21097 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21098 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21099 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21100 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21101 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21102 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21103 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21104
21105 @item set thread pause
21106 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21107 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21108 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21109 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21110 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21111 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21112 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21113 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21114 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21115 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21116 only the current thread.
21117
21118 @item show thread pause
21119 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21120 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21121
21122 @item set thread run
21123 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21124
21125 @item show thread run
21126 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21127
21128 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21129 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21130 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21131 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21132 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21133 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21134 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21135
21136 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21137 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21138 detaching.
21139
21140 @item set thread exception-port
21141 @itemx set thread excp
21142 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21143 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21144 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21145
21146 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21147 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21148 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21149 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21150
21151 @item set thread default
21152 @itemx show thread default
21153 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21154 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21155 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21156 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21157 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21158 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21159 the non-default commands.
21160 @end table
21161
21162 @node Darwin
21163 @subsection Darwin
21164 @cindex Darwin
21165
21166 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21167
21168 @table @code
21169 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
21170 @kindex set debug darwin
21171 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21172 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
21173
21174 @item show debug darwin
21175 @kindex show debug darwin
21176 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21177
21178 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21179 @kindex set debug mach-o
21180 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
21181 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
21182 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
21183 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
21184 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
21185 usage.
21186
21187 @item show debug mach-o
21188 @kindex show debug mach-o
21189 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
21190
21191 @item set mach-exceptions on
21192 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
21193 @kindex set mach-exceptions
21194 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
21195 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
21196 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
21197 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
21198
21199 @item show mach-exceptions
21200 @kindex show mach-exceptions
21201 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21202 @end table
21203
21204
21205 @node Embedded OS
21206 @section Embedded Operating Systems
21207
21208 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
21209 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
21210 architectures.
21211
21212 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
21213 various real-time operating systems.
21214
21215 @node Embedded Processors
21216 @section Embedded Processors
21217
21218 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
21219 configurations.
21220
21221 @cindex send command to simulator
21222 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
21223 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
21224
21225 @table @code
21226 @item sim @var{command}
21227 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
21228 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
21229 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
21230 acceptable commands.
21231 @end table
21232
21233
21234 @menu
21235 * ARM:: ARM RDI
21236 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
21237 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
21238 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
21239 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
21240 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
21241 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
21242 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
21243 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
21244 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
21245 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
21246 * CRIS:: CRIS
21247 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
21248 @end menu
21249
21250 @node ARM
21251 @subsection ARM
21252 @cindex ARM RDI
21253
21254 @table @code
21255 @kindex target rdi
21256 @item target rdi @var{dev}
21257 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
21258 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
21259 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
21260
21261 @kindex target rdp
21262 @item target rdp @var{dev}
21263 ARM Demon monitor.
21264
21265 @end table
21266
21267 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
21268
21269 @table @code
21270 @item set arm disassembler
21271 @kindex set arm
21272 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
21273 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
21274
21275 @item show arm disassembler
21276 @kindex show arm
21277 Show the current disassembly style.
21278
21279 @item set arm apcs32
21280 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
21281 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
21282
21283 @item show arm apcs32
21284 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
21285
21286 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
21287 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
21288 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
21289
21290 @table @code
21291 @item auto
21292 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
21293 @item softfpa
21294 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
21295 processors.
21296 @item fpa
21297 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
21298 @item softvfp
21299 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
21300 @item vfp
21301 VFP co-processor.
21302 @end table
21303
21304 @item show arm fpu
21305 Show the current type of the FPU.
21306
21307 @item set arm abi
21308 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
21309
21310 @item show arm abi
21311 Show the currently used ABI.
21312
21313 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21314 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
21315 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
21316 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
21317 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
21318 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
21319 register).
21320
21321 @item show arm fallback-mode
21322 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
21323
21324 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21325 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
21326 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
21327 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
21328 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
21329
21330 @item show arm force-mode
21331 Show the current forced instruction mode.
21332
21333 @item set debug arm
21334 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
21335 target support subsystem.
21336
21337 @item show debug arm
21338 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
21339 @end table
21340
21341 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
21342 using the RDI interface:
21343
21344 @table @code
21345 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21346 @kindex rdilogfile
21347 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
21348 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
21349 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
21350 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
21351 @file{rdi.log}.
21352
21353 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
21354 @kindex rdilogenable
21355 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
21356 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
21357 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
21358 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
21359 are logged to a file.
21360
21361 @item set rdiromatzero
21362 @kindex set rdiromatzero
21363 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
21364 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
21365 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
21366 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
21367 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
21368
21369 @item show rdiromatzero
21370 @kindex show rdiromatzero
21371 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
21372
21373 @item set rdiheartbeat
21374 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
21375 @cindex RDI heartbeat
21376 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
21377 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
21378 well as the Angel monitor.
21379
21380 @item show rdiheartbeat
21381 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
21382 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
21383 @end table
21384
21385 @table @code
21386 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21387 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
21388
21389 @table @code
21390 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
21391 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
21392 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
21393 The default value is @code{all}.
21394
21395 @table @code
21396 @item none
21397 @item demon
21398 @item angel
21399 @item redboot
21400 @item all
21401 @end table
21402 @end table
21403 @end table
21404
21405 @node M32R/D
21406 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
21407
21408 @table @code
21409 @kindex target m32r
21410 @item target m32r @var{dev}
21411 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
21412
21413 @kindex target m32rsdi
21414 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
21415 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
21416 @end table
21417
21418 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
21419
21420 @table @code
21421 @item set download-path @var{path}
21422 @kindex set download-path
21423 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
21424 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
21425
21426 @item show download-path
21427 @kindex show download-path
21428 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
21429
21430 @item set board-address @var{addr}
21431 @kindex set board-address
21432 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
21433 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
21434
21435 @item show board-address
21436 @kindex show board-address
21437 Show the current IP address of the target board.
21438
21439 @item set server-address @var{addr}
21440 @kindex set server-address
21441 @cindex download server address (M32R)
21442 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
21443 host machine.
21444
21445 @item show server-address
21446 @kindex show server-address
21447 Display the IP address of the download server.
21448
21449 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21450 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
21451 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
21452 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
21453 executable file is uploaded.
21454
21455 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21456 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
21457 Test the @code{upload} command.
21458 @end table
21459
21460 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
21461
21462 @table @code
21463 @item sdireset
21464 @kindex sdireset
21465 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
21466 This command resets the SDI connection.
21467
21468 @item sdistatus
21469 @kindex sdistatus
21470 This command shows the SDI connection status.
21471
21472 @item debug_chaos
21473 @kindex debug_chaos
21474 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
21475 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
21476
21477 @item use_debug_dma
21478 @kindex use_debug_dma
21479 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
21480
21481 @item use_mon_code
21482 @kindex use_mon_code
21483 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
21484
21485 @item use_ib_break
21486 @kindex use_ib_break
21487 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
21488
21489 @item use_dbt_break
21490 @kindex use_dbt_break
21491 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
21492 @end table
21493
21494 @node M68K
21495 @subsection M68k
21496
21497 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
21498 target command for the following ROM monitor.
21499
21500 @table @code
21501
21502 @kindex target dbug
21503 @item target dbug @var{dev}
21504 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
21505
21506 @end table
21507
21508 @node MicroBlaze
21509 @subsection MicroBlaze
21510 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
21511 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
21512
21513 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
21514 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
21515 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
21516 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
21517 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
21518 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
21519 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
21520 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
21521 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
21522 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
21523 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
21524
21525 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
21526
21527 @table @code
21528 @item target remote :1234
21529 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
21530 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
21531
21532 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
21533 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
21534 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
21535
21536 @item load
21537 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
21538
21539 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
21540 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
21541
21542 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
21543 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
21544 @end table
21545
21546 @node MIPS Embedded
21547 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
21548
21549 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
21550 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
21551 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
21552 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
21553
21554 @need 1000
21555 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
21556
21557 @table @code
21558 @item target mips @var{port}
21559 @kindex target mips @var{port}
21560 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
21561 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
21562 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
21563 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
21564 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
21565 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
21566
21567 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
21568 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
21569 debugger:
21570
21571 @smallexample
21572 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
21573 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
21574 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
21575 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
21576 (@value{GDBP}) run
21577 @end smallexample
21578
21579 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
21580 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
21581 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
21582 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
21583 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
21584
21585 @item target pmon @var{port}
21586 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
21587 PMON ROM monitor.
21588
21589 @item target ddb @var{port}
21590 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
21591 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
21592
21593 @item target lsi @var{port}
21594 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
21595 LSI variant of PMON.
21596
21597 @kindex target r3900
21598 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
21599 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
21600
21601 @kindex target array
21602 @item target array @var{dev}
21603 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
21604
21605 @end table
21606
21607
21608 @noindent
21609 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
21610
21611 @table @code
21612 @item set mipsfpu double
21613 @itemx set mipsfpu single
21614 @itemx set mipsfpu none
21615 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
21616 @itemx show mipsfpu
21617 @kindex set mipsfpu
21618 @kindex show mipsfpu
21619 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
21620 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
21621 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
21622 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
21623 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
21624 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
21625 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
21626 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
21627 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
21628 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
21629 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
21630 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
21631 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
21632
21633 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
21634 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
21635 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
21636
21637 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
21638 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
21639
21640 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
21641 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
21642 @itemx show timeout
21643 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
21644 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21645 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21646 @kindex set timeout
21647 @kindex show timeout
21648 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
21649 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
21650 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
21651 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
21652 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
21653 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
21654 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
21655 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
21656 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
21657 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
21658
21659 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
21660 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
21661 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
21662 to run before stopping.
21663
21664 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
21665 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21666 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
21667 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
21668 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
21669 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
21670
21671 @item show syn-garbage-limit
21672 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21673 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
21674 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
21675
21676 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
21677 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21678 @cindex remote monitor prompt
21679 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
21680 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
21681 @table @asis
21682 @item pmon target
21683 @samp{PMON}
21684 @item ddb target
21685 @samp{NEC010}
21686 @item lsi target
21687 @samp{PMON>}
21688 @end table
21689
21690 @item show monitor-prompt
21691 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21692 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
21693 remote monitor.
21694
21695 @item set monitor-warnings
21696 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21697 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
21698 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
21699 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
21700 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
21701
21702 @item show monitor-warnings
21703 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21704 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21705
21706 @item pmon @var{command}
21707 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21708 @cindex send PMON command
21709 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21710 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21711 @end table
21712
21713 @node PowerPC Embedded
21714 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21715
21716 @cindex DVC register
21717 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21718 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21719
21720 @smallexample
21721 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21722 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21723 @end smallexample
21724
21725 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21726 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21727 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21728 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21729 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21730 or newer.
21731
21732 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21733 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21734 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21735 watching variables of scalar types.
21736
21737 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21738 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21739
21740 @smallexample
21741 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21742 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21743 @end smallexample
21744
21745 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21746 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21747
21748 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21749 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21750 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21751 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21752 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21753 use the @code{break-range} command.
21754
21755 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21756
21757 @table @code
21758 @kindex break-range
21759 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21760 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
21761 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
21762 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21763 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21764 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21765 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21766 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21767 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21768
21769 @kindex set powerpc
21770 @item set powerpc soft-float
21771 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21772 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21773 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21774 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21775
21776 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21777 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21778 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21779 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21780 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21781 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21782 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21783 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21784
21785 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21786 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21787 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21788 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21789 address of its first byte.
21790
21791 @kindex target dink32
21792 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
21793 DINK32 ROM monitor.
21794
21795 @kindex target ppcbug
21796 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
21797 @kindex target ppcbug1
21798 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
21799 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
21800
21801 @kindex target sds
21802 @item target sds @var{dev}
21803 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
21804 @end table
21805
21806 @cindex SDS protocol
21807 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
21808 by @value{GDBN}:
21809
21810 @table @code
21811 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
21812 @kindex set sdstimeout
21813 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
21814 default is 2 seconds.
21815
21816 @item show sdstimeout
21817 @kindex show sdstimeout
21818 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
21819
21820 @item sds @var{command}
21821 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
21822 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
21823 @end table
21824
21825
21826 @node PA
21827 @subsection HP PA Embedded
21828
21829 @table @code
21830
21831 @kindex target op50n
21832 @item target op50n @var{dev}
21833 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
21834
21835 @kindex target w89k
21836 @item target w89k @var{dev}
21837 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
21838
21839 @end table
21840
21841 @node Sparclet
21842 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
21843
21844 @cindex Sparclet
21845
21846 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
21847 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
21848 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
21849 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
21850 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
21851
21852 @table @code
21853 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
21854 @kindex remotetimeout
21855 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
21856 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
21857 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
21858 @end table
21859
21860 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
21861 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
21862 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
21863 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
21864 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
21865
21866 @smallexample
21867 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
21868 @end smallexample
21869
21870 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
21871
21872 @smallexample
21873 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
21874 @end smallexample
21875
21876 @cindex running, on Sparclet
21877 Once you have set
21878 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
21879 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
21880 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
21881
21882 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
21883
21884 @smallexample
21885 (gdbslet)
21886 @end smallexample
21887
21888 @menu
21889 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
21890 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
21891 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
21892 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
21893 @end menu
21894
21895 @node Sparclet File
21896 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
21897
21898 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
21899
21900 @smallexample
21901 (gdbslet) file prog
21902 @end smallexample
21903
21904 @need 1000
21905 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
21906 @value{GDBN} locates
21907 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
21908 path.
21909 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
21910 files will be searched as well.
21911 @value{GDBN} locates
21912 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
21913 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
21914 If it fails
21915 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
21916
21917 @smallexample
21918 prog: No such file or directory.
21919 @end smallexample
21920
21921 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
21922 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
21923 @code{target} command again.
21924
21925 @node Sparclet Connection
21926 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
21927
21928 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
21929 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
21930
21931 @smallexample
21932 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
21933 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
21934 main () at ../prog.c:3
21935 @end smallexample
21936
21937 @need 750
21938 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
21939
21940 @smallexample
21941 Connected to ttya.
21942 @end smallexample
21943
21944 @node Sparclet Download
21945 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
21946
21947 @cindex download to Sparclet
21948 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
21949 you can use the @value{GDBN}
21950 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
21951 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
21952 command.
21953 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
21954 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
21955 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
21956 of each of the file's sections.
21957 For instance, if the program
21958 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
21959 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
21960
21961 @smallexample
21962 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
21963 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
21964 @end smallexample
21965
21966 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
21967 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
21968 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
21969
21970 @node Sparclet Execution
21971 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
21972
21973 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
21974 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
21975 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
21976 manual for the list of commands.
21977
21978 @smallexample
21979 (gdbslet) b main
21980 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
21981 (gdbslet) run
21982 Starting program: prog
21983 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
21984 3 char *symarg = 0;
21985 (gdbslet) step
21986 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
21987 (gdbslet)
21988 @end smallexample
21989
21990 @node Sparclite
21991 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
21992
21993 @table @code
21994
21995 @kindex target sparclite
21996 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
21997 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
21998 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
21999 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
22000 remote protocol.
22001
22002 @end table
22003
22004 @node Z8000
22005 @subsection Zilog Z8000
22006
22007 @cindex Z8000
22008 @cindex simulator, Z8000
22009 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
22010
22011 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
22012 a Z8000 simulator.
22013
22014 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
22015 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
22016 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
22017 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
22018
22019 @table @code
22020 @item target sim @var{args}
22021 @kindex sim
22022 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
22023 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
22024 options, specify them via @var{args}.
22025 @end table
22026
22027 @noindent
22028 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
22029 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
22030 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
22031 to run your program, and so on.
22032
22033 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
22034 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
22035 additional items of information as specially named registers:
22036
22037 @table @code
22038
22039 @item cycles
22040 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
22041
22042 @item insts
22043 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
22044
22045 @item time
22046 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
22047
22048 @end table
22049
22050 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
22051 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
22052 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
22053 simulated clock ticks.
22054
22055 @node AVR
22056 @subsection Atmel AVR
22057 @cindex AVR
22058
22059 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22060 following AVR-specific commands:
22061
22062 @table @code
22063 @item info io_registers
22064 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22065 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22066 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22067 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22068 @end table
22069
22070 @node CRIS
22071 @subsection CRIS
22072 @cindex CRIS
22073
22074 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22075 following CRIS-specific commands:
22076
22077 @table @code
22078 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22079 @cindex CRIS version
22080 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22081 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22082 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22083
22084 @item show cris-version
22085 Show the current CRIS version.
22086
22087 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22088 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22089 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22090 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22091 @code{R59}.
22092
22093 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22094 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22095
22096 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22097 @cindex CRIS mode
22098 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22099 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22100 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22101
22102 @item show cris-mode
22103 Show the current CRIS mode.
22104 @end table
22105
22106 @node Super-H
22107 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22108 @cindex Super-H
22109
22110 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22111 commands:
22112
22113 @table @code
22114 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22115 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22116 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22117 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22118 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22119 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22120 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22121 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22122 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22123 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22124 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22125 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22126
22127 @item show sh calling-convention
22128 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22129 Show the current calling convention setting.
22130
22131 @end table
22132
22133
22134 @node Architectures
22135 @section Architectures
22136
22137 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22138 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22139
22140 @menu
22141 * AArch64::
22142 * i386::
22143 * Alpha::
22144 * MIPS::
22145 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22146 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22147 * PowerPC::
22148 * Nios II::
22149 @end menu
22150
22151 @node AArch64
22152 @subsection AArch64
22153 @cindex AArch64 support
22154
22155 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22156 following special commands:
22157
22158 @table @code
22159 @item set debug aarch64
22160 @kindex set debug aarch64
22161 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22162 messages are to be displayed.
22163
22164 @item show debug aarch64
22165 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22166
22167 @end table
22168
22169 @node i386
22170 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22171
22172 @table @code
22173 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22174 @kindex set struct-convention
22175 @cindex struct return convention
22176 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22177 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22178 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22179 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22180 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22181 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22182 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22183 be returned in a register.
22184
22185 @item show struct-convention
22186 @kindex show struct-convention
22187 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22188 from functions.
22189 @end table
22190
22191
22192 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22193 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22194
22195 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22196 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22197 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22198 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22199 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22200 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22201 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22202
22203 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22204 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22205 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22206 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22207 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22208 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22209
22210 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22211 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22212 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22213
22214 @smallexample
22215 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22216 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22217 @end smallexample
22218
22219 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22220 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22221 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22222 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22223 the pointer.
22224
22225 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22226 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22227 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22228 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22229 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22230
22231 @table @code
22232 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22233 @kindex show mpx bound
22234 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22235
22236 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22237 @kindex set mpx bound
22238 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22239 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22240 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22241 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22242 @end table
22243
22244 @node Alpha
22245 @subsection Alpha
22246
22247 See the following section.
22248
22249 @node MIPS
22250 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22251
22252 @cindex stack on Alpha
22253 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22254 @cindex Alpha stack
22255 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22256 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22257 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22258 find the beginning of a function.
22259
22260 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22261 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22262 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22263 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22264 commands:
22265
22266 @table @code
22267 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22268 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22269 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22270 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22271 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22272 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22273 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22274 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22275
22276 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22277 Display the current limit.
22278 @end table
22279
22280 @noindent
22281 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22282 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22283
22284 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22285 programs:
22286
22287 @table @code
22288 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22289 @kindex set mips abi
22290 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22291 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22292 values of @var{arg} are:
22293
22294 @table @samp
22295 @item auto
22296 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22297 default).
22298 @item o32
22299 @item o64
22300 @item n32
22301 @item n64
22302 @item eabi32
22303 @item eabi64
22304 @end table
22305
22306 @item show mips abi
22307 @kindex show mips abi
22308 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22309
22310 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22311 @kindex set mips compression
22312 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22313 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22314 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22315 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22316 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22317 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22318 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22319 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22320 provided by the executable.
22321
22322 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22323 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22324 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22325 identified as such.
22326
22327 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22328 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22329 implicitly from an executable.
22330
22331 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22332 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22333 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22334 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22335 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22336
22337 @item show mips compression
22338 @kindex show mips compression
22339 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22340 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22341
22342 @item set mipsfpu
22343 @itemx show mipsfpu
22344 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22345
22346 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22347 @kindex set mips mask-address
22348 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22349 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22350 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22351 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22352 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22353
22354 @item show mips mask-address
22355 @kindex show mips mask-address
22356 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22357 not.
22358
22359 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22360 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22361 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22362 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22363 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22364 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22365
22366 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22367 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22368 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22369
22370 @item set debug mips
22371 @kindex set debug mips
22372 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22373 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22374
22375 @item show debug mips
22376 @kindex show debug mips
22377 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22378 @end table
22379
22380
22381 @node HPPA
22382 @subsection HPPA
22383 @cindex HPPA support
22384
22385 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22386 following special commands:
22387
22388 @table @code
22389 @item set debug hppa
22390 @kindex set debug hppa
22391 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22392 messages are to be displayed.
22393
22394 @item show debug hppa
22395 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22396
22397 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22398 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22399 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22400 given @var{address}.
22401
22402 @end table
22403
22404
22405 @node SPU
22406 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22407 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22408 @cindex SPU
22409
22410 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22411 it provides the following special commands:
22412
22413 @table @code
22414 @item info spu event
22415 @kindex info spu
22416 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22417 and pending event status.
22418
22419 @item info spu signal
22420 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22421 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22422 notification channels.
22423
22424 @item info spu mailbox
22425 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22426 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22427 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22428
22429 @item info spu dma
22430 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22431 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22432 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22433
22434 @item info spu proxydma
22435 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22436 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22437 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22438
22439 @end table
22440
22441 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22442 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22443 special commands:
22444
22445 @table @code
22446 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22447 @kindex set spu
22448 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22449 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22450 function. The default is @code{off}.
22451
22452 @item show spu stop-on-load
22453 @kindex show spu
22454 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22455
22456 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22457 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22458 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22459 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22460 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22461 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22462
22463 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22464 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22465
22466 @end table
22467
22468 @node PowerPC
22469 @subsection PowerPC
22470 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22471
22472 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22473 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22474 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22475 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22476 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22477
22478 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22479 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22480 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22481
22482 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22483 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22484
22485 @node Nios II
22486 @subsection Nios II
22487 @cindex Nios II architecture
22488
22489 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22490 it provides the following special commands:
22491
22492 @table @code
22493
22494 @item set debug nios2
22495 @kindex set debug nios2
22496 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22497 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22498
22499 @item show debug nios2
22500 @kindex show debug nios2
22501 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22502 @end table
22503
22504 @node Controlling GDB
22505 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22506
22507 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22508 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22509 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22510 described here.
22511
22512 @menu
22513 * Prompt:: Prompt
22514 * Editing:: Command editing
22515 * Command History:: Command history
22516 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22517 * Numbers:: Numbers
22518 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22519 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22520 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22521 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22522 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22523 @end menu
22524
22525 @node Prompt
22526 @section Prompt
22527
22528 @cindex prompt
22529
22530 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22531 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22532 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22533 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22534 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22535 which one you are talking to.
22536
22537 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22538 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22539 or a prompt that does not.
22540
22541 @table @code
22542 @kindex set prompt
22543 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22544 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22545
22546 @kindex show prompt
22547 @item show prompt
22548 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22549 @end table
22550
22551 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22552 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22553 are:
22554
22555 @table @code
22556 @kindex set extended-prompt
22557 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22558 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22559 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22560 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22561 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22562 is displayed.
22563
22564 For example:
22565
22566 @smallexample
22567 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22568 @end smallexample
22569
22570 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22571 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22572
22573 @kindex show extended-prompt
22574 @item show extended-prompt
22575 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22576 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22577 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22578 @end table
22579
22580 @node Editing
22581 @section Command Editing
22582 @cindex readline
22583 @cindex command line editing
22584
22585 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22586 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22587 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22588 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22589 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22590 debugging sessions.
22591
22592 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22593 command @code{set}.
22594
22595 @table @code
22596 @kindex set editing
22597 @cindex editing
22598 @item set editing
22599 @itemx set editing on
22600 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22601
22602 @item set editing off
22603 Disable command line editing.
22604
22605 @kindex show editing
22606 @item show editing
22607 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22608 @end table
22609
22610 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22611 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22612 @end ifset
22613 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22614 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22615 @end ifclear
22616 for more details about the Readline
22617 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22618 encouraged to read that chapter.
22619
22620 @node Command History
22621 @section Command History
22622 @cindex command history
22623
22624 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22625 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22626 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22627 history facility.
22628
22629 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22630 package, to provide the history facility.
22631 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22632 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22633 @end ifset
22634 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22635 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22636 @end ifclear
22637 for the detailed description of the History library.
22638
22639 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22640 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22641 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22642 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22643 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22644 pressed on a line by itself.
22645
22646 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22647 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22648 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22649 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22650
22651 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22652 history.
22653
22654 @table @code
22655 @cindex history substitution
22656 @cindex history file
22657 @kindex set history filename
22658 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22659 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22660 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22661 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22662 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22663 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22664 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22665 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22666 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22667 is not set.
22668
22669 @cindex save command history
22670 @kindex set history save
22671 @item set history save
22672 @itemx set history save on
22673 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22674 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22675
22676 @item set history save off
22677 Stop recording command history in a file.
22678
22679 @cindex history size
22680 @kindex set history size
22681 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
22682 @item set history size @var{size}
22683 @itemx set history size unlimited
22684 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22685 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
22686 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
22687 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
22688 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
22689 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
22690
22691 @cindex remove duplicate history
22692 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
22693 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
22694 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
22695 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
22696 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
22697 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
22698 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
22699 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
22700 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
22701
22702 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
22703 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
22704
22705 @end table
22706
22707 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22708 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22709 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22710 @end ifset
22711 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22712 @xref{Event Designators},
22713 @end ifclear
22714 for more details.
22715
22716 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22717 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22718 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22719 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22720 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22721 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22722 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22723 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22724
22725 The commands to control history expansion are:
22726
22727 @table @code
22728 @item set history expansion on
22729 @itemx set history expansion
22730 @kindex set history expansion
22731 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22732
22733 @item set history expansion off
22734 Disable history expansion.
22735
22736 @c @group
22737 @kindex show history
22738 @item show history
22739 @itemx show history filename
22740 @itemx show history save
22741 @itemx show history size
22742 @itemx show history expansion
22743 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22744 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22745 @c @end group
22746 @end table
22747
22748 @table @code
22749 @kindex show commands
22750 @cindex show last commands
22751 @cindex display command history
22752 @item show commands
22753 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22754
22755 @item show commands @var{n}
22756 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22757
22758 @item show commands +
22759 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22760 @end table
22761
22762 @node Screen Size
22763 @section Screen Size
22764 @cindex size of screen
22765 @cindex screen size
22766 @cindex pagination
22767 @cindex page size
22768 @cindex pauses in output
22769
22770 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22771 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22772 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22773 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22774 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22775 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22776 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22777 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22778
22779 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22780 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22781 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22782 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22783 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22784 width} commands:
22785
22786 @table @code
22787 @kindex set height
22788 @kindex set width
22789 @kindex show width
22790 @kindex show height
22791 @item set height @var{lpp}
22792 @itemx set height unlimited
22793 @itemx show height
22794 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22795 @itemx set width unlimited
22796 @itemx show width
22797 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22798 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22799 commands display the current settings.
22800
22801 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22802 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22803 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22804 buffer.
22805
22806 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22807 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22808
22809 @item set pagination on
22810 @itemx set pagination off
22811 @kindex set pagination
22812 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22813 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22814 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22815 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22816
22817 @item show pagination
22818 @kindex show pagination
22819 Show the current pagination mode.
22820 @end table
22821
22822 @node Numbers
22823 @section Numbers
22824 @cindex number representation
22825 @cindex entering numbers
22826
22827 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22828 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22829 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22830 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22831 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22832 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22833 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22834 both input and output with the commands described below.
22835
22836 @table @code
22837 @kindex set input-radix
22838 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22839 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22840 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22841 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22842 example, any of
22843
22844 @smallexample
22845 set input-radix 012
22846 set input-radix 10.
22847 set input-radix 0xa
22848 @end smallexample
22849
22850 @noindent
22851 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22852 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22853 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22854 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22855 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22856 change the radix.
22857
22858 @kindex set output-radix
22859 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22860 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22861 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22862 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22863
22864 @kindex show input-radix
22865 @item show input-radix
22866 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22867
22868 @kindex show output-radix
22869 @item show output-radix
22870 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22871
22872 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22873 @itemx show radix
22874 @kindex set radix
22875 @kindex show radix
22876 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22877 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22878 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22879 default value of 10.
22880
22881 @end table
22882
22883 @node ABI
22884 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22885
22886 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22887 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22888 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22889 current ABI.
22890
22891 @cindex OS ABI
22892 @kindex set osabi
22893 @kindex show osabi
22894 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22895
22896 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22897 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22898 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22899 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22900 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22901 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22902 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22903 platform provides.
22904
22905 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22906 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22907 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22908 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22909
22910 @table @code
22911 @item show osabi
22912 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22913
22914 @item set osabi
22915 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22916
22917 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22918 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22919 @end table
22920
22921 @cindex float promotion
22922
22923 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22924 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22925 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22926 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22927 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22928 @code{double} and then passed.
22929
22930 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22931 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22932 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22933
22934 @table @code
22935 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22936 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22937 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22938 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22939 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22940
22941 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22942 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22943 functions.
22944
22945 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22946 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22947 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22948 @end table
22949
22950 @kindex set cp-abi
22951 @kindex show cp-abi
22952 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22953 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22954 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22955 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22956 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22957 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22958 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22959 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22960 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22961 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22962 ``auto''.
22963
22964 @table @code
22965 @item show cp-abi
22966 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22967
22968 @item set cp-abi
22969 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22970
22971 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22972 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22973 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22974 @end table
22975
22976 @node Auto-loading
22977 @section Automatically loading associated files
22978 @cindex auto-loading
22979
22980 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22981 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22982 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22983 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22984 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22985 sources).
22986
22987 @menu
22988 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22989 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22990
22991 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22992 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22993 @end menu
22994
22995 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22996 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22997 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22998
22999 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23000 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23001 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23002
23003 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23004 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23005
23006 @table @code
23007 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23008 @kindex set auto-load off
23009 @item set auto-load off
23010 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23011 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23012 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23013 @smallexample
23014 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23015 @end smallexample
23016
23017 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23018 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23019 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23020 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23021 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23022 @code{set auto-load no}.
23023
23024 @anchor{show auto-load}
23025 @kindex show auto-load
23026 @item show auto-load
23027 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23028 or disabled.
23029
23030 @smallexample
23031 (gdb) show auto-load
23032 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23033 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23034 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23035 is on.
23036 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23037 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23038 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23039 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23040 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23041 @end smallexample
23042
23043 @anchor{info auto-load}
23044 @kindex info auto-load
23045 @item info auto-load
23046 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23047 not.
23048
23049 @smallexample
23050 (gdb) info auto-load
23051 gdb-scripts:
23052 Loaded Script
23053 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23054 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23055 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23056 loaded.
23057 python-scripts:
23058 Loaded Script
23059 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23060 @end smallexample
23061 @end table
23062
23063 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23064
23065 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23066 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23067 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23068 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23069 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23070 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23071 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23072 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23073 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23074 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23075 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23076 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23077 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23078 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23079 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23080 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23081 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23082 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23083 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23084 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23085 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23086 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23087 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23088 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23089 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23090 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23091 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23092 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23093 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23094 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23095 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23096 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23097 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23098 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23099 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23100 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23101 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23102 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23103 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23104 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23105 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23106 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23107 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23108 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23109 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23110 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23111 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23112 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23113 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23114 @end multitable
23115
23116 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23117 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23118 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23119
23120 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23121 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23122 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23123
23124 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23125 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23126
23127 @table @code
23128 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23129 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23130 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23131 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23132 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23133
23134 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23135 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23136 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23137 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23138 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23139
23140 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23141 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23142 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23143 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23144 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23145 @end table
23146
23147 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23148 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23149 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23150
23151 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23152
23153 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23154 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23155
23156 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23157 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23158 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23159 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23160 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23161 library.
23162
23163 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23164 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23165
23166 @table @code
23167 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23168 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23169 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23170 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23171
23172 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23173 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23174 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23175 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23176 enabled or disabled.
23177
23178 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23179 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23180 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23181 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23182 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23183 @end table
23184
23185 @node Auto-loading safe path
23186 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23187 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23188
23189 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23190 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23191 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23192 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23193 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23194
23195 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23196 get loaded:
23197
23198 @smallexample
23199 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23200 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23201 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23202 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23203 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23204 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23205 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23206 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23207 @end smallexample
23208
23209 @noindent
23210 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23211 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23212
23213 @smallexample
23214 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23215 @end smallexample
23216
23217 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23218
23219 @table @code
23220 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23221 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23222 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23223 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23224 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23225 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23226 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23227 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23228 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23229 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23230
23231 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23232 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23233 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23234
23235 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23236 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23237 @item show auto-load safe-path
23238 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23239 scripts.
23240
23241 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23242 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23243 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23244 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23245 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23246 by the host platform path separator in use.
23247 @end table
23248
23249 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23250 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23251 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23252 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23253 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23254
23255 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23256 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23257 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23258 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23259 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23260 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23261 init file in the current directory
23262 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23263
23264 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23265 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23266
23267 @table @asis
23268 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23269 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23270 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23271 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23272
23273 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23274 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23275 @value{GDBN} session.
23276
23277 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23278 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23279 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23280 from trusted sources.
23281
23282 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23283 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23284 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23285 trusted sources.
23286 @end table
23287
23288 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23289 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23290
23291 @table @asis
23292 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23293 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23294
23295 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23296 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23297 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23298 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23299 @end table
23300
23301 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23302 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23303 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23304 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23305 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23306 recommended to be entered.
23307
23308 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23309 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23310 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23311
23312 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23313 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23314 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23315 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23316 be printed.
23317
23318 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23319 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23320 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23321
23322 @smallexample
23323 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23324 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23325 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23326 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23327 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23328 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23329 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23330 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23331 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23332 @end smallexample
23333
23334 @table @code
23335 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23336 @kindex set debug auto-load
23337 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23338 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23339
23340 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23341 @kindex show debug auto-load
23342 @item show debug auto-load
23343 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23344 on or off.
23345 @end table
23346
23347 @node Messages/Warnings
23348 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23349
23350 @cindex verbose operation
23351 @cindex optional warnings
23352 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23353 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23354 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23355 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23356
23357 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23358 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23359 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23360
23361 @table @code
23362 @kindex set verbose
23363 @item set verbose on
23364 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23365
23366 @item set verbose off
23367 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23368
23369 @kindex show verbose
23370 @item show verbose
23371 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23372 @end table
23373
23374 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23375 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23376 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23377 Symbol Files}).
23378
23379 @table @code
23380
23381 @kindex set complaints
23382 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23383 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23384 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23385 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23386 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23387
23388 @kindex show complaints
23389 @item show complaints
23390 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23391
23392 @end table
23393
23394 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23395 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23396 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23397 you try to run a program which is already running:
23398
23399 @smallexample
23400 (@value{GDBP}) run
23401 The program being debugged has been started already.
23402 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23403 @end smallexample
23404
23405 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23406 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23407
23408 @table @code
23409
23410 @kindex set confirm
23411 @cindex flinching
23412 @cindex confirmation
23413 @cindex stupid questions
23414 @item set confirm off
23415 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23416 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23417 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23418
23419 @item set confirm on
23420 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23421
23422 @kindex show confirm
23423 @item show confirm
23424 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23425
23426 @end table
23427
23428 @cindex command tracing
23429 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23430 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23431 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23432 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23433
23434 @table @code
23435 @kindex set trace-commands
23436 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23437 @item set trace-commands on
23438 Enable command tracing.
23439 @item set trace-commands off
23440 Disable command tracing.
23441 @item show trace-commands
23442 Display the current state of command tracing.
23443 @end table
23444
23445 @node Debugging Output
23446 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23447 @cindex optional debugging messages
23448
23449 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23450 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23451 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23452 section documents those commands.
23453
23454 @table @code
23455 @kindex set exec-done-display
23456 @item set exec-done-display
23457 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23458 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23459 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23460 @kindex show exec-done-display
23461 @item show exec-done-display
23462 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23463 notification.
23464 @kindex set debug
23465 @cindex ARM AArch64
23466 @item set debug aarch64
23467 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23468 The default is off.
23469 @kindex show debug
23470 @item show debug aarch64
23471 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23472 ARM AArch64.
23473 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23474 @cindex architecture debugging info
23475 @item set debug arch
23476 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23477 @item show debug arch
23478 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23479 @item set debug aix-solib
23480 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23481 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23482 support module. The default is off.
23483 @item show debug aix-thread
23484 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23485 @item set debug aix-thread
23486 @cindex AIX threads
23487 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23488 module.
23489 @item show debug aix-thread
23490 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23491 @item set debug check-physname
23492 @cindex physname
23493 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23494 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23495 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23496 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23497 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23498 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23499 @item show debug check-physname
23500 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23501 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23502 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23503 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23504 exported symbols. The default is off.
23505 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23506 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23507 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23508 @item set debug dwarf-die
23509 @cindex DWARF DIEs
23510 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23511 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23512 A value of zero turns off the display.
23513 @item show debug dwarf-die
23514 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23515 @item set debug dwarf-line
23516 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
23517 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23518 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
23519 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23520 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23521 @item show debug dwarf-line
23522 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23523 @item set debug dwarf-read
23524 @cindex DWARF Reading
23525 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23526 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23527 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23528 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23529 @item show debug dwarf-read
23530 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23531 @item set debug displaced
23532 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23533 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23534 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23535 @item show debug displaced
23536 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23537 related to displaced stepping.
23538 @item set debug event
23539 @cindex event debugging info
23540 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23541 default is off.
23542 @item show debug event
23543 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23544 info.
23545 @item set debug expression
23546 @cindex expression debugging info
23547 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23548 expression parsing. The default is off.
23549 @item show debug expression
23550 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23551 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23552 @item set debug frame
23553 @cindex frame debugging info
23554 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23555 default is off.
23556 @item show debug frame
23557 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23558 info.
23559 @item set debug gnu-nat
23560 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23561 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23562 @item show debug gnu-nat
23563 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23564 @item set debug infrun
23565 @cindex inferior debugging info
23566 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23567 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23568 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23569 @item show debug infrun
23570 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23571 @item set debug jit
23572 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23573 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23574 @item show debug jit
23575 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23576 @item set debug lin-lwp
23577 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23578 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23579 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23580 @item show debug lin-lwp
23581 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23582 @item set debug linux-namespaces
23583 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
23584 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
23585 @item show debug linux-namespaces
23586 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
23587 @item set debug mach-o
23588 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23589 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23590 processing. The default is off.
23591 @item show debug mach-o
23592 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23593 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23594 @item set debug notification
23595 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23596 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23597 The default is off.
23598 @item show debug notification
23599 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23600 @item set debug observer
23601 @cindex observer debugging info
23602 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23603 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23604 @item show debug observer
23605 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23606 @item set debug overload
23607 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23608 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23609 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23610 is off.
23611 @item show debug overload
23612 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23613 debugging info.
23614 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23615 @cindex debug expression parser
23616 @item set debug parser
23617 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23618 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23619 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23620 details. The default is off.
23621 @item show debug parser
23622 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23623 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23624 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23625 @cindex debug remote protocol
23626 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23627 @cindex display remote packets
23628 @item set debug remote
23629 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23630 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23631 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23632 @item show debug remote
23633 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23634 @item set debug serial
23635 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23636 default is off.
23637 @item show debug serial
23638 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23639 info.
23640 @item set debug solib-frv
23641 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23642 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23643 @item show debug solib-frv
23644 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23645 messages.
23646 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23647 @cindex symbol lookup
23648 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23649 The default is 0 (off).
23650 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23651 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23652 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23653 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23654 @item set debug symfile
23655 @cindex symbol file functions
23656 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23657 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23658 @item show debug symfile
23659 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23660 @item set debug symtab-create
23661 @cindex symbol table creation
23662 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23663 The default is 0 (off).
23664 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23665 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23666 @item show debug symtab-create
23667 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23668 @item set debug target
23669 @cindex target debugging info
23670 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23671 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23672 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23673 value of large memory transfers.
23674 @item show debug target
23675 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23676 info.
23677 @item set debug timestamp
23678 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23679 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23680 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23681 message.
23682 @item show debug timestamp
23683 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23684 debugging info.
23685 @item set debug varobj
23686 @cindex variable object debugging info
23687 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23688 info. The default is off.
23689 @item show debug varobj
23690 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23691 debugging info.
23692 @item set debug xml
23693 @cindex XML parser debugging
23694 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23695 @item show debug xml
23696 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23697 @end table
23698
23699 @node Other Misc Settings
23700 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23701 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23702
23703 @table @code
23704 @kindex set interactive-mode
23705 @item set interactive-mode
23706 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23707 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23708 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23709 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23710 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23711 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23712 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23713 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23714
23715 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23716 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23717 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23718 inside a cygwin window.
23719
23720 @kindex show interactive-mode
23721 @item show interactive-mode
23722 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23723 @end table
23724
23725 @node Extending GDB
23726 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23727 @cindex extending GDB
23728
23729 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23730 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23731 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23732 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23733 being debugged.
23734
23735 @menu
23736 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23737 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23738 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23739 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23740 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23741 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23742 @end menu
23743
23744 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23745 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23746 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23747 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23748 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23749 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23750
23751 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23752 setting:
23753
23754 @table @code
23755 @kindex set script-extension
23756 @kindex show script-extension
23757 @item set script-extension off
23758 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23759
23760 @item set script-extension soft
23761 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23762 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23763 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23764 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23765
23766 @item set script-extension strict
23767 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23768 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23769 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23770
23771 @item show script-extension
23772 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23773
23774 @end table
23775
23776 @node Sequences
23777 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23778
23779 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23780 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23781 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23782 files.
23783
23784 @menu
23785 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23786 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23787 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23788 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23789 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23790 @end menu
23791
23792 @node Define
23793 @subsection User-defined Commands
23794
23795 @cindex user-defined command
23796 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23797 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23798 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23799 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23800 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23801 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23802
23803 @smallexample
23804 define adder
23805 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23806 end
23807 @end smallexample
23808
23809 @noindent
23810 To execute the command use:
23811
23812 @smallexample
23813 adder 1 2 3
23814 @end smallexample
23815
23816 @noindent
23817 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23818 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23819 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23820 functions calls.
23821
23822 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23823 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23824 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23825 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23826
23827 @smallexample
23828 define adder
23829 if $argc == 2
23830 print $arg0 + $arg1
23831 end
23832 if $argc == 3
23833 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23834 end
23835 end
23836 @end smallexample
23837
23838 @table @code
23839
23840 @kindex define
23841 @item define @var{commandname}
23842 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23843 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23844 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23845 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23846 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23847 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23848
23849 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23850 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23851 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23852
23853 @kindex document
23854 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23855 @item document @var{commandname}
23856 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23857 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23858 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23859 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23860 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23861 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23862
23863 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23864 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23865 does not change the documentation.
23866
23867 @kindex dont-repeat
23868 @cindex don't repeat command
23869 @item dont-repeat
23870 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23871 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23872 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23873
23874 @kindex help user-defined
23875 @item help user-defined
23876 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23877 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23878 included (if any).
23879
23880 @kindex show user
23881 @item show user
23882 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23883 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23884 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23885 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23886 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23887
23888 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23889 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23890 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23891 @item show max-user-call-depth
23892 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23893 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23894 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23895 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23896 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23897 @end table
23898
23899 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23900 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23901
23902 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23903 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23904 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23905
23906 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23907 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23908 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23909 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23910
23911 @node Hooks
23912 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23913 @cindex command hooks
23914 @cindex hooks, for commands
23915 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23916
23917 @kindex hook
23918 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23919 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23920 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23921 before that command.
23922
23923 @cindex hooks, post-command
23924 @kindex hookpost
23925 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23926 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23927 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23928 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23929 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23930
23931 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23932 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23933
23934 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23935 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23936
23937 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23938 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23939 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23940 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23941 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23942
23943 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23944 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23945 you could define:
23946
23947 @smallexample
23948 define hook-stop
23949 handle SIGALRM nopass
23950 end
23951
23952 define hook-run
23953 handle SIGALRM pass
23954 end
23955
23956 define hook-continue
23957 handle SIGALRM pass
23958 end
23959 @end smallexample
23960
23961 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23962 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23963 you could define:
23964
23965 @smallexample
23966 define hook-echo
23967 echo <<<---
23968 end
23969
23970 define hookpost-echo
23971 echo --->>>\n
23972 end
23973
23974 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23975 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23976 (@value{GDBP})
23977
23978 @end smallexample
23979
23980 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23981 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23982 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23983 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23984 @c or not?
23985 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23986 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23987 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23988
23989 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23990 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23991 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23992
23993 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23994 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23995
23996 @node Command Files
23997 @subsection Command Files
23998
23999 @cindex command files
24000 @cindex scripting commands
24001 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24002 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24003 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24004 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24005 terminal.
24006
24007 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24008 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24009 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24010 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24011 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24012
24013 @table @code
24014 @kindex source
24015 @cindex execute commands from a file
24016 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24017 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24018 @end table
24019
24020 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24021 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24022 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24023 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24024 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24025
24026 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24027 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24028 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24029 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24030 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24031 is not relevant to scripts.
24032
24033 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24034 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24035 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24036 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24037 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24038 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24039 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24040 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24041 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24042 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24043 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24044 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24045 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24046 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24047
24048 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24049 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24050 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24051
24052 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24053 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24054 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24055 when called from command files.
24056
24057 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24058 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24059 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24060 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24061 the next command.
24062
24063 @smallexample
24064 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24065 @end smallexample
24066
24067 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24068 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24069 would be directed to @file{log}.
24070
24071 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24072 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24073 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24074 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24075 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24076 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24077 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24078 conditionally, etc.
24079
24080 @table @code
24081 @kindex if
24082 @kindex else
24083 @item if
24084 @itemx else
24085 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24086 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24087 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24088 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24089 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24090 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24091 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24092
24093 @kindex while
24094 @item while
24095 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24096 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24097 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24098 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24099 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24100 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24101
24102 @kindex loop_break
24103 @item loop_break
24104 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24105 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24106 line.
24107
24108 @kindex loop_continue
24109 @item loop_continue
24110 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24111 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24112 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24113 the controlling expression.
24114
24115 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24116 @item end
24117 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24118 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24119 @end table
24120
24121
24122 @node Output
24123 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24124
24125 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24126 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24127 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24128 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24129 want.
24130
24131 @table @code
24132 @kindex echo
24133 @item echo @var{text}
24134 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24135 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24136 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24137 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24138 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24139 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24140 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24141 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24142 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24143 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24144 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24145
24146 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24147 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24148
24149 @smallexample
24150 echo This is some text\n\
24151 which is continued\n\
24152 onto several lines.\n
24153 @end smallexample
24154
24155 produces the same output as
24156
24157 @smallexample
24158 echo This is some text\n
24159 echo which is continued\n
24160 echo onto several lines.\n
24161 @end smallexample
24162
24163 @kindex output
24164 @item output @var{expression}
24165 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24166 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24167 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24168 on expressions.
24169
24170 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24171 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24172 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24173 Formats}, for more information.
24174
24175 @kindex printf
24176 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24177 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24178 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24179 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24180 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24181 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24182 executing the code below:
24183
24184 @smallexample
24185 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24186 @end smallexample
24187
24188 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24189 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24190 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24191 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24192 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24193 printed.
24194
24195 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24196
24197 @smallexample
24198 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24199 @end smallexample
24200
24201 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24202 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24203 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24204
24205 @itemize @bullet
24206 @item
24207 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24208
24209 @item
24210 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24211 width.
24212
24213 @item
24214 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24215 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24216
24217 @item
24218 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24219 supported.
24220
24221 @item
24222 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24223
24224 @item
24225 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24226 @end itemize
24227
24228 @noindent
24229 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24230 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24231 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24232 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24233
24234 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24235 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24236 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24237 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24238 supported.
24239
24240 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24241 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24242 together with a floating point specifier.
24243 letters:
24244
24245 @itemize @bullet
24246 @item
24247 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24248
24249 @item
24250 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24251
24252 @item
24253 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24254 @end itemize
24255
24256 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24257 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24258 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24259
24260 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24261 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24262
24263 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24264 @smallexample
24265 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24266 @end smallexample
24267
24268 @kindex eval
24269 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24270 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24271 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24272
24273 @end table
24274
24275 @node Auto-loading sequences
24276 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24277 @cindex native script auto-loading
24278
24279 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24280 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24281 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24282 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24283
24284 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24285 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24286
24287 @table @code
24288 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24289 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24290 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24291 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24292
24293 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24294 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24295 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24296 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24297 disabled.
24298
24299 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24300 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24301 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24302 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24303 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24304 auto-loaded.
24305 @end table
24306
24307 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24308 matching names are printed.
24309
24310 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24311 @include python.texi
24312
24313 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24314 @include guile.texi
24315
24316 @node Auto-loading extensions
24317 @section Auto-loading extensions
24318 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24319
24320 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24321 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24322 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24323 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24324 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24325
24326 @menu
24327 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24328 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24329 * Which flavor to choose?::
24330 @end menu
24331
24332 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24333 debugging commands and features.
24334
24335 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24336 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24337 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24338 for more information.
24339 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24340 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24341
24342 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24343 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24344
24345 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24346 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24347 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24348 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24349 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24350
24351 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24352 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24353 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24354 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24355
24356 @table @code
24357 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24358 GDB's own command language
24359 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24360 Python
24361 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24362 Guile
24363 @end table
24364
24365 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24366 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24367 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24368 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24369 script in the specified extension language.
24370
24371 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24372 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24373
24374 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24375 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24376
24377 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24378 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24379 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24380 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24381 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24382 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24383
24384 @table @code
24385 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24386 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24387 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24388 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24389 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24390 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24391
24392 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24393 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24394
24395 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24396 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24397 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24398 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24399
24400 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24401 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24402 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24403 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24404 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24405 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24406 platform.
24407
24408 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24409 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24410 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24411
24412 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24413 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24414 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24415 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24416
24417 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24418 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24419 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24420 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24421 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24422 @end table
24423
24424 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24425 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24426 @var{objfile} is opened.
24427 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24428 is evaluated more than once.
24429
24430 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24431 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24432 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24433
24434 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24435 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24436 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24437 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24438 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24439 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24440 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24441
24442 The following entries are supported:
24443
24444 @table @code
24445 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24446 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24447 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24448 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24449 @end table
24450
24451 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24452
24453 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24454 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24455 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24456 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24457 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24458
24459 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24460 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24461
24462 @example
24463 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24464 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24465 asm("\
24466 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24467 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24468 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24469 .popsection \n\
24470 ");
24471 @end example
24472
24473 @noindent
24474 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24475 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24476
24477 @example
24478 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24479 @end example
24480
24481 The script name may include directories if desired.
24482
24483 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24484 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24485
24486 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24487 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24488 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24489 will remove duplicates.
24490
24491 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24492
24493 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24494 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24495 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24496 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24497 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24498 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24499 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24500 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24501 on its name.
24502
24503 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24504 testsuite.
24505
24506 @example
24507 #include "symcat.h"
24508 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24509 asm(
24510 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24511 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24512 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24513 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24514 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24515 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24516 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24517 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24518 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24519 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24520 ".byte 0\n"
24521 ".popsection\n"
24522 );
24523 @end example
24524
24525 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24526 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24527 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24528 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24529
24530 @node Which flavor to choose?
24531 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24532
24533 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24534 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24535
24536 @noindent
24537 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24538
24539 @itemize @bullet
24540 @item
24541 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24542
24543 @item
24544 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24545
24546 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24547 in the source search path.
24548 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24549 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24550
24551 @item
24552 Doesn't require source code additions.
24553 @end itemize
24554
24555 @noindent
24556 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24557
24558 @itemize @bullet
24559 @item
24560 Works with static linking.
24561
24562 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24563 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24564 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24565 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24566 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24567
24568 @item
24569 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24570
24571 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24572 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24573
24574 @item
24575 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24576
24577 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24578 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24579 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24580 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24581 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24582 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24583 @end itemize
24584
24585 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24586 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24587
24588 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24589 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24590 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24591
24592 @subsection Python comes first
24593
24594 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24595 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24596 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24597 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24598 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24599 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24600 pretty-printed form of a value).
24601 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24602 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24603 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24604
24605 @node Aliases
24606 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24607 @cindex aliases for commands
24608
24609 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24610 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24611 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24612 that involves less typing.
24613
24614 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24615 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24616 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24617
24618 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24619 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24620 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24621
24622 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24623
24624 @table @code
24625
24626 @kindex alias
24627 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24628
24629 @end table
24630
24631 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24632 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24633 underscores.
24634
24635 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24636 that is being aliased.
24637
24638 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24639 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24640 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24641
24642 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24643 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24644
24645 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24646 of a command so that there is less to type.
24647 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24648 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24649 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24650 The following will accomplish this.
24651
24652 @smallexample
24653 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24654 @end smallexample
24655
24656 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24657 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24658 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24659 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24660
24661 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24662 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24663 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24664 of a command.
24665
24666 @smallexample
24667 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24668 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24669 (gdb) set p elms 20
24670 (gdb) show p elms
24671 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24672 @end smallexample
24673
24674 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24675 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24676 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24677
24678 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24679 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24680
24681 @smallexample
24682 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24683 @end smallexample
24684
24685 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24686 alias for a more complex command.
24687 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24688
24689 @smallexample
24690 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24691 (gdb) spe 20
24692 @end smallexample
24693
24694 @node Interpreters
24695 @chapter Command Interpreters
24696 @cindex command interpreters
24697
24698 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24699 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24700 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24701
24702 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24703 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24704 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24705 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24706
24707 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24708 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24709 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24710 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24711
24712 @table @code
24713 @item console
24714 @cindex console interpreter
24715 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24716 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24717 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24718
24719 @item mi
24720 @cindex mi interpreter
24721 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24722 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24723 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24724 Interface}.
24725
24726 @item mi2
24727 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24728 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24729
24730 @item mi1
24731 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24732 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24733
24734 @end table
24735
24736 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24737 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24738 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24739 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24740 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24741 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24742 the IDE inoperable!
24743
24744 @kindex interpreter-exec
24745 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24746 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24747 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24748 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24749
24750 @smallexample
24751 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24752 @end smallexample
24753
24754 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24755 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24756
24757 @node TUI
24758 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24759 @cindex TUI
24760 @cindex Text User Interface
24761
24762 @menu
24763 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24764 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24765 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24766 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24767 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24768 @end menu
24769
24770 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24771 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24772 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24773 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24774 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24775 is available.
24776
24777 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24778 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24779 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24780 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
24781 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
24782 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24783
24784 @node TUI Overview
24785 @section TUI Overview
24786
24787 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24788
24789 @table @emph
24790 @item command
24791 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24792 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24793 managed using readline.
24794
24795 @item source
24796 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24797 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24798
24799 @item assembly
24800 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24801
24802 @item register
24803 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24804 when their values change.
24805 @end table
24806
24807 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24808 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24809 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24810 indicates the breakpoint type:
24811
24812 @table @code
24813 @item B
24814 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24815
24816 @item b
24817 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24818
24819 @item H
24820 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24821
24822 @item h
24823 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24824 @end table
24825
24826 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24827
24828 @table @code
24829 @item +
24830 Breakpoint is enabled.
24831
24832 @item -
24833 Breakpoint is disabled.
24834 @end table
24835
24836 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24837 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24838 changes.
24839
24840 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24841 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24842 layouts:
24843
24844 @itemize @bullet
24845 @item
24846 source only,
24847
24848 @item
24849 assembly only,
24850
24851 @item
24852 source and assembly,
24853
24854 @item
24855 source and registers, or
24856
24857 @item
24858 assembly and registers.
24859 @end itemize
24860
24861 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24862
24863 @table @emph
24864 @item target
24865 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24866 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24867
24868 @item process
24869 Gives the current process or thread number.
24870 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24871
24872 @item function
24873 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24874 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24875 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24876 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24877
24878 @item line
24879 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24880 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24881
24882 @item pc
24883 Indicates the current program counter address.
24884 @end table
24885
24886 @node TUI Keys
24887 @section TUI Key Bindings
24888 @cindex TUI key bindings
24889
24890 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24891 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24892 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24893 @end ifset
24894 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24895 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24896 @end ifclear
24897 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24898 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24899
24900 @table @kbd
24901 @kindex C-x C-a
24902 @item C-x C-a
24903 @kindex C-x a
24904 @itemx C-x a
24905 @kindex C-x A
24906 @itemx C-x A
24907 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24908 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24909 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24910 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24911 The screen is then refreshed.
24912
24913 @kindex C-x 1
24914 @item C-x 1
24915 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24916 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24917 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24918
24919 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24920
24921 @kindex C-x 2
24922 @item C-x 2
24923 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24924 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24925 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24926 previous layout and the new one.
24927
24928 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24929
24930 @kindex C-x o
24931 @item C-x o
24932 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24933 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24934 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24935
24936 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24937
24938 @kindex C-x s
24939 @item C-x s
24940 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24941 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24942 @end table
24943
24944 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24945
24946 @table @asis
24947 @kindex PgUp
24948 @item @key{PgUp}
24949 Scroll the active window one page up.
24950
24951 @kindex PgDn
24952 @item @key{PgDn}
24953 Scroll the active window one page down.
24954
24955 @kindex Up
24956 @item @key{Up}
24957 Scroll the active window one line up.
24958
24959 @kindex Down
24960 @item @key{Down}
24961 Scroll the active window one line down.
24962
24963 @kindex Left
24964 @item @key{Left}
24965 Scroll the active window one column left.
24966
24967 @kindex Right
24968 @item @key{Right}
24969 Scroll the active window one column right.
24970
24971 @kindex C-L
24972 @item @kbd{C-L}
24973 Refresh the screen.
24974 @end table
24975
24976 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24977 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24978 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24979 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24980 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24981
24982 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24983 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24984 @cindex TUI single key mode
24985
24986 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24987 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24988 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24989
24990 @table @kbd
24991 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24992 @item c
24993 continue
24994
24995 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24996 @item d
24997 down
24998
24999 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25000 @item f
25001 finish
25002
25003 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25004 @item n
25005 next
25006
25007 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25008 @item q
25009 exit the SingleKey mode.
25010
25011 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25012 @item r
25013 run
25014
25015 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25016 @item s
25017 step
25018
25019 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25020 @item u
25021 up
25022
25023 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25024 @item v
25025 info locals
25026
25027 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25028 @item w
25029 where
25030 @end table
25031
25032 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25033 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25034 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25035 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25036 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25037 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25038
25039
25040 @node TUI Commands
25041 @section TUI-specific Commands
25042 @cindex TUI commands
25043
25044 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25045 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25046 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25047 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25048
25049 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25050 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25051 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25052 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25053 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25054
25055 @table @code
25056 @item tui enable
25057 @kindex tui enable
25058 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25059 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25060 otherwise a default layout is used.
25061
25062 @item tui disable
25063 @kindex tui disable
25064 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25065
25066 @item info win
25067 @kindex info win
25068 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25069
25070 @item layout @var{name}
25071 @kindex layout
25072 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25073 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25074 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25075
25076 @table @code
25077 @item next
25078 Display the next layout.
25079
25080 @item prev
25081 Display the previous layout.
25082
25083 @item src
25084 Display the source and command windows.
25085
25086 @item asm
25087 Display the assembly and command windows.
25088
25089 @item split
25090 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25091
25092 @item regs
25093 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25094 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25095 register, assembler, and command windows.
25096 @end table
25097
25098 @item focus @var{name}
25099 @kindex focus
25100 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25101 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25102
25103 @table @code
25104 @item next
25105 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25106
25107 @item prev
25108 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25109
25110 @item src
25111 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25112
25113 @item asm
25114 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25115
25116 @item regs
25117 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25118
25119 @item cmd
25120 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25121 @end table
25122
25123 @item refresh
25124 @kindex refresh
25125 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25126
25127 @item tui reg @var{group}
25128 @kindex tui reg
25129 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25130 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25131 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25132 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25133 following groups are available on most targets:
25134 @table @code
25135 @item next
25136 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25137 through all of the available register groups.
25138
25139 @item prev
25140 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25141 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25142 @var{next}.
25143
25144 @item general
25145 Display the general registers.
25146 @item float
25147 Display the floating point registers.
25148 @item system
25149 Display the system registers.
25150 @item vector
25151 Display the vector registers.
25152 @item all
25153 Display all registers.
25154 @end table
25155
25156 @item update
25157 @kindex update
25158 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25159
25160 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25161 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25162 @kindex winheight
25163 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25164 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25165 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25166 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25167 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25168
25169 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25170 @kindex tabset
25171 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25172 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25173 assembly windows.
25174 @end table
25175
25176 @node TUI Configuration
25177 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25178 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25179
25180 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25181
25182 @table @code
25183 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25184 @kindex set tui border-kind
25185 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25186 The possible values are the following:
25187 @table @code
25188 @item space
25189 Use a space character to draw the border.
25190
25191 @item ascii
25192 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25193
25194 @item acs
25195 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25196 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25197 @end table
25198
25199 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25200 @kindex set tui border-mode
25201 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25202 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25203 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25204 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25205 @table @code
25206 @item normal
25207 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25208
25209 @item standout
25210 Use standout mode.
25211
25212 @item reverse
25213 Use reverse video mode.
25214
25215 @item half
25216 Use half bright mode.
25217
25218 @item half-standout
25219 Use half bright and standout mode.
25220
25221 @item bold
25222 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25223
25224 @item bold-standout
25225 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25226 @end table
25227 @end table
25228
25229 @node Emacs
25230 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25231
25232 @cindex Emacs
25233 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25234 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25235 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25236 @value{GDBN}.
25237
25238 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25239 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25240 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25241 created Emacs buffer.
25242 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25243
25244 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25245 things:
25246
25247 @itemize @bullet
25248 @item
25249 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25250 the GUD buffer.
25251
25252 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25253 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25254
25255 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25256 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25257 in this way.
25258
25259 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25260 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25261 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25262 stop.
25263
25264 @item
25265 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25266
25267 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25268 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25269 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25270 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25271 and the source.
25272
25273 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25274 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25275 @end itemize
25276
25277 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25278 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25279 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25280 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25281
25282 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25283 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25284 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25285 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25286 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25287 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25288 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25289 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25290 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25291
25292 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25293 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25294 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25295 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25296
25297 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25298 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25299 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25300 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25301 one you want.
25302
25303 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25304 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25305
25306 @table @kbd
25307 @item C-h m
25308 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25309
25310 @item C-c C-s
25311 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25312 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25313
25314 @item C-c C-n
25315 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25316 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25317 to show the current file and location.
25318
25319 @item C-c C-i
25320 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25321 display window accordingly.
25322
25323 @item C-c C-f
25324 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25325 @code{finish} command.
25326
25327 @item C-c C-r
25328 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25329 command.
25330
25331 @item C-c <
25332 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25333 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25334 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25335
25336 @item C-c >
25337 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25338 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25339 @end table
25340
25341 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25342 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25343
25344 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25345 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25346 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25347 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25348 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25349 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25350 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25351
25352 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25353 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25354 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25355 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25356 frame.
25357
25358 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25359 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25360 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25361 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25362 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25363 to correspond properly with the code.
25364
25365 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25366 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25367 Emacs Manual}).
25368
25369 @node GDB/MI
25370 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25371
25372 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25373
25374 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25375 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25376 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25377 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25378 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25379 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25380
25381 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25382 in the form of a reference manual.
25383
25384 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25385 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25386 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25387
25388 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25389
25390 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25391 This chapter uses the following notation:
25392
25393 @itemize @bullet
25394 @item
25395 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25396
25397 @item
25398 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25399 it may or may not be given.
25400
25401 @item
25402 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25403 may repeat zero or more times.
25404
25405 @item
25406 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25407 may repeat one or more times.
25408
25409 @item
25410 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25411 @end itemize
25412
25413 @ignore
25414 @heading Dependencies
25415 @end ignore
25416
25417 @menu
25418 * GDB/MI General Design::
25419 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25420 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25421 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25422 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25423 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25424 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25425 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25426 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25427 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25428 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25429 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25430 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25431 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25432 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25433 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25434 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25435 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25436 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25437 @ignore
25438 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25439 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25440 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25441 @end ignore
25442 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25443 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25444 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25445 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25446 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25447 @end menu
25448
25449 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25450 @node GDB/MI General Design
25451 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25452 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25453
25454 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25455 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25456 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25457 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25458 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25459 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25460 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25461 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25462 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25463 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25464
25465 The important examples of notifications are:
25466 @itemize @bullet
25467
25468 @item
25469 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25470 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25471 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25472 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25473 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25474 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25475 command itself was successfully executed.
25476
25477 @item
25478 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25479 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25480 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25481 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25482 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25483 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25484
25485 @item
25486 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25487 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25488 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25489 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25490 orthogonal frontend design.
25491
25492 @end itemize
25493
25494 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25495 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25496 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25497 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25498 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25499 the user interface.
25500
25501
25502 @menu
25503 * Context management::
25504 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25505 * Thread groups::
25506 @end menu
25507
25508 @node Context management
25509 @subsection Context management
25510
25511 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25512
25513 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25514 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25515 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25516 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25517 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25518 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25519 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25520 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25521 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25522
25523 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25524 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25525 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25526 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25527 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25528 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25529 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25530 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25531 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25532 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
25533 for thread and frame to operate on.
25534
25535 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25536 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25537 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25538 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25539 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25540 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25541 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25542 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25543 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25544 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25545
25546 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25547 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25548 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25549 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25550 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25551 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25552 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25553 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25554 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25555 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25556 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25557 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25558 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25559 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25560 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25561 @samp{--frame} options.
25562
25563 @subsubsection Language
25564
25565 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25566 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25567 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25568 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25569 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25570 For instance:
25571
25572 @smallexample
25573 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25574 ^done,value="4"
25575 (gdb)
25576 @end smallexample
25577
25578 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25579 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25580 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25581
25582 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25583 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25584
25585 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25586 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25587 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25588 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25589 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25590 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25591 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25592 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25593 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25594
25595 @table @code
25596 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25597 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25598 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25599
25600 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25601 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25602 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25603
25604 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25605 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25606 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25607 MI commands even while the target is running.
25608
25609 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25610 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25611 @end table
25612
25613 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25614 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25615 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25616 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25617 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25618 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25619
25620 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25621 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25622 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25623 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25624 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25625 are running.
25626
25627 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25628 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25629 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25630 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25631 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25632 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25633 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25634 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25635 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25636 @samp{--thread} option).
25637
25638 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25639 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25640 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25641 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25642
25643 @node Thread groups
25644 @subsection Thread groups
25645 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25646 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25647 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25648 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25649 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25650
25651 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25652 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25653 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25654 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25655 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25656 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25657 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25658 into processes.
25659
25660 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25661 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25662 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25663 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25664 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25665 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25666 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25667 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25668 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25669 the members of specific thread group.
25670
25671 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25672 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25673 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25674 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25675 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25676 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25677 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25678 after attaching to that thread group.
25679
25680 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25681 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25682 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25683 such thread groups.
25684
25685 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25686 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25687 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25688
25689 @menu
25690 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25691 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25692 @end menu
25693
25694 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25695 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25696
25697 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25698 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25699 @table @code
25700 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25701 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25702
25703 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25704 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25705 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25706
25707 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25708 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25709 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25710
25711 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25712 "any sequence of digits"
25713
25714 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25715 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25716
25717 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25718 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25719
25720 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25721 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25722
25723 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25724 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25725 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25726
25727 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25728 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25729
25730 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25731 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25732 @end table
25733
25734 @noindent
25735 Notes:
25736
25737 @itemize @bullet
25738 @item
25739 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25740 output is described below.
25741
25742 @item
25743 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25744 finishes.
25745
25746 @item
25747 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25748 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25749 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25750 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25751 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25752 @end itemize
25753
25754 Pragmatics:
25755
25756 @itemize @bullet
25757 @item
25758 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25759
25760 @item
25761 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25762 @end itemize
25763
25764 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25765 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25766
25767 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25768 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25769 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25770 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25771 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25772 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25773
25774 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25775 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
25776 @var{token}.
25777
25778 @table @code
25779 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
25780 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
25781
25782 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
25783 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25784
25785 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25786 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25787
25788 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25789 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25790
25791 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25792 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
25793
25794 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25795 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
25796
25797 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25798 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
25799
25800 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25801 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
25802
25803 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25804 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25805
25806 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25807 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25808 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25809
25810 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25811 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25812
25813 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25814 @code{ @var{string} }
25815
25816 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25817 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25818
25819 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25820 @code{@var{c-string}}
25821
25822 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
25823 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
25824
25825 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
25826 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
25827 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
25828
25829 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
25830 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
25831
25832 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
25833 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
25834
25835 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
25836 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
25837
25838 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
25839 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
25840
25841 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25842 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25843
25844 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25845 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
25846 @end table
25847
25848 @noindent
25849 Notes:
25850
25851 @itemize @bullet
25852 @item
25853 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
25854
25855 @item
25856 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
25857 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
25858 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
25859 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
25860 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
25861 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
25862 prior command.
25863
25864 @item
25865 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25866 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25867 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25868 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25869
25870 @item
25871 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25872 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25873 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25874 @samp{*}.
25875
25876 @item
25877 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25878 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25879 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25880 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25881
25882 @item
25883 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25884 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25885 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25886 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25887
25888 @item
25889 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25890 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25891 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25892
25893 @item
25894 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25895 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25896 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25897 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25898
25899 @item
25900 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25901 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25902 @var{values}.
25903
25904
25905 @end itemize
25906
25907 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25908 details about the various output records.
25909
25910 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25911 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25912 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25913
25914 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25915 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25916
25917 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25918 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25919 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25920 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25921 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25922 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25923
25924 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25925 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25926 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25927
25928 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25929 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25930 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25931 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25932
25933 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25934 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25935
25936 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25937 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25938 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25939 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25940 might change.
25941
25942 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25943 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25944 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25945 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25946
25947 @itemize @bullet
25948 @item
25949 New MI commands may be added.
25950
25951 @item
25952 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25953
25954 @item
25955 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25956 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25957
25958 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25959 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25960
25961 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25962 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25963 @end itemize
25964
25965 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25966 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25967 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25968 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25969 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25970
25971 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25972 @c version?
25973
25974 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25975 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25976 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25977 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25978 @cindex mailing lists
25979
25980 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25981 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25982 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25983
25984 @menu
25985 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25986 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25987 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25988 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
25989 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25990 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25991 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25992 @end menu
25993
25994 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25995 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25996
25997 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25998 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25999 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26000 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26001
26002 @table @code
26003 @findex ^done
26004 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26005 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26006 values.
26007
26008 @item "^running"
26009 @findex ^running
26010 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26011 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26012 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26013 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26014 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26015 which threads are resumed.
26016
26017 @item "^connected"
26018 @findex ^connected
26019 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26020
26021 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26022 @findex ^error
26023 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26024 the corresponding error message.
26025
26026 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26027 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26028 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26029
26030 @table @samp
26031 @item "undefined-command"
26032 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26033 @end table
26034
26035 @item "^exit"
26036 @findex ^exit
26037 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26038
26039 @end table
26040
26041 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26042 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26043
26044 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26045 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26046 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26047 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26048 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26049
26050 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26051 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26052 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26053 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26054 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26055
26056 @table @code
26057 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26058 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26059 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26060
26061 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26062 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26063 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26064 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26065
26066 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26067 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26068 internals.
26069 @end table
26070
26071 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26072 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26073
26074 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26075 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26076 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26077 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26078 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26079 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26080
26081 The following is the list of possible async records:
26082
26083 @table @code
26084
26085 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26086 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
26087 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
26088 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
26089 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
26090 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
26091 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
26092 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
26093 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
26094 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
26095
26096 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26097 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26098 following values:
26099
26100 @table @code
26101 @item breakpoint-hit
26102 A breakpoint was reached.
26103 @item watchpoint-trigger
26104 A watchpoint was triggered.
26105 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26106 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26107 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26108 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26109 @item function-finished
26110 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26111 @item location-reached
26112 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26113 @item watchpoint-scope
26114 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26115 @item end-stepping-range
26116 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26117 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26118 @item exited-signalled
26119 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26120 @item exited
26121 The inferior exited.
26122 @item exited-normally
26123 The inferior exited normally.
26124 @item signal-received
26125 A signal was received by the inferior.
26126 @item solib-event
26127 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26128 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26129 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26130 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26131 @item fork
26132 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26133 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26134 @item vfork
26135 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26136 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26137 @item syscall-entry
26138 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26139 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26140 @item syscall-return
26141 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26142 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26143 @item exec
26144 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26145 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26146 @end table
26147
26148 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
26149 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
26150 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26151 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26152 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26153 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26154 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26155 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26156 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26157 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26158 if such information is not available.
26159
26160 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26161 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26162 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26163 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26164 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26165 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26166 cannot be used in any way.
26167
26168 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26169 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26170 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26171 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26172 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26173 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26174
26175 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26176 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26177 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26178 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26179 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26180 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26181
26182 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26183 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26184 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26185 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26186 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26187
26188 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
26189 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
26190 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
26191 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
26192 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
26193 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
26194 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
26195
26196 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26197 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26198 that thread.
26199
26200 @item =library-loaded,...
26201 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26202 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26203 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26204 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26205 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26206 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26207 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26208 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26209 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26210 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26211 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26212 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26213 thread groups.
26214
26215 @item =library-unloaded,...
26216 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26217 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26218 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26219 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26220 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26221 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26222 thread groups.
26223
26224 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26225 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26226 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26227 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26228 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26229
26230 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26231 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26232 initial value @var{initial}.
26233
26234 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26235 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26236 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26237 trace state variables are deleted.
26238
26239 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26240 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26241 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26242 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26243 value of trace state variable is known.
26244
26245 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26246 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26247 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26248 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26249 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26250 user.
26251
26252 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26253 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26254 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26255
26256 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26257 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26258
26259 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
26260 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26261 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26262 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26263 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26264
26265 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26266 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26267 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26268 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26269 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26270 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26271
26272 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26273 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26274 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26275 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26276 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26277 executable code.
26278 @end table
26279
26280 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26281 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26282
26283 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26284 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26285 following fields:
26286
26287 @table @code
26288 @item number
26289 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26290 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26291 @samp{1.2}.
26292
26293 @item type
26294 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26295 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26296
26297 @item catch-type
26298 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26299 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26300
26301 @item disp
26302 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26303 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26304 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26305
26306 @item enabled
26307 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26308 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26309 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26310
26311 @item addr
26312 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26313 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26314 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26315 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26316 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26317
26318 @item func
26319 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26320 If not known, this field is not present.
26321
26322 @item filename
26323 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26324 If not known, this field is not present.
26325
26326 @item fullname
26327 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26328 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26329
26330 @item line
26331 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26332 If not known, this field is not present.
26333
26334 @item at
26335 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26336 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26337 by a symbol name.
26338
26339 @item pending
26340 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26341 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26342
26343 @item evaluated-by
26344 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26345 @samp{target}.
26346
26347 @item thread
26348 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26349 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26350
26351 @item task
26352 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26353 field will hold the task identifier.
26354
26355 @item cond
26356 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26357
26358 @item ignore
26359 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26360
26361 @item enable
26362 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26363
26364 @item traceframe-usage
26365 FIXME.
26366
26367 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26368 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26369
26370 @item mask
26371 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26372
26373 @item pass
26374 A tracepoint's pass count.
26375
26376 @item original-location
26377 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26378 This field is optional.
26379
26380 @item times
26381 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26382
26383 @item installed
26384 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26385 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26386 is not.
26387
26388 @item what
26389 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26390
26391 @end table
26392
26393 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26394 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26395
26396 @smallexample
26397 -> -break-insert main
26398 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26399 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26400 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26401 times="0"@}
26402 <- (gdb)
26403 @end smallexample
26404
26405 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26406 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26407
26408 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26409 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26410 fields:
26411
26412 @table @code
26413 @item level
26414 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26415 zero. This field is always present.
26416
26417 @item func
26418 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26419 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26420
26421 @item addr
26422 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26423
26424 @item file
26425 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26426 address. This field may be absent.
26427
26428 @item line
26429 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26430 may be absent.
26431
26432 @item from
26433 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26434 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26435
26436 @end table
26437
26438 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26439 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26440
26441 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26442 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26443
26444 @table @code
26445 @item id
26446 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26447 always present.
26448
26449 @item target-id
26450 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26451
26452 @item details
26453 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26454 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26455 frontend. This field is optional.
26456
26457 @item state
26458 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26459 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26460
26461 @item core
26462 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26463 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26464 @end table
26465
26466 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26467 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26468
26469 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26470 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26471 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26472 the @code{exception-name} field.
26473
26474 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26475 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26476 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26477 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26478
26479 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26480 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26481 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26482 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26483
26484 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26485 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26486
26487 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26488
26489 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26490 information of the breakpoint.
26491
26492 @smallexample
26493 -> -break-insert main
26494 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26495 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26496 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26497 times="0"@}
26498 <- (gdb)
26499 @end smallexample
26500
26501 @subheading Program Execution
26502
26503 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26504 reason that execution stopped.
26505
26506 @smallexample
26507 -> -exec-run
26508 <- ^running
26509 <- (gdb)
26510 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26511 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26512 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26513 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26514 <- (gdb)
26515 -> -exec-continue
26516 <- ^running
26517 <- (gdb)
26518 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26519 <- (gdb)
26520 @end smallexample
26521
26522 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26523
26524 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26525
26526 @smallexample
26527 -> (gdb)
26528 <- -gdb-exit
26529 <- ^exit
26530 @end smallexample
26531
26532 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26533 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26534 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26535 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26536 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26537 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26538
26539 @subheading A Bad Command
26540
26541 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26542
26543 @smallexample
26544 -> -rubbish
26545 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26546 <- (gdb)
26547 @end smallexample
26548
26549
26550 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26551 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26552 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26553
26554 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26555 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26556
26557 @subheading Motivation
26558
26559 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26560
26561 @subheading Introduction
26562
26563 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26564
26565 @subheading Commands
26566
26567 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26568
26569 @subsubheading Synopsis
26570
26571 @smallexample
26572 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26573 @end smallexample
26574
26575 @subsubheading Result
26576
26577 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26578
26579 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26580
26581 @subsubheading Example
26582
26583 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26584 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26585
26586
26587 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26588 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26589 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26590
26591 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26592 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26593 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26594 breakpoints.
26595
26596 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26597 @findex -break-after
26598
26599 @subsubheading Synopsis
26600
26601 @smallexample
26602 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26603 @end smallexample
26604
26605 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26606 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26607 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26608 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26609
26610 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26611
26612 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26613
26614 @subsubheading Example
26615
26616 @smallexample
26617 (gdb)
26618 -break-insert main
26619 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26620 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26621 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26622 times="0"@}
26623 (gdb)
26624 -break-after 1 3
26625 ~
26626 ^done
26627 (gdb)
26628 -break-list
26629 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26630 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26631 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26632 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26633 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26634 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26635 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26636 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26637 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26638 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26639 (gdb)
26640 @end smallexample
26641
26642 @ignore
26643 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26644 @findex -break-catch
26645 @end ignore
26646
26647 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26648 @findex -break-commands
26649
26650 @subsubheading Synopsis
26651
26652 @smallexample
26653 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26654 @end smallexample
26655
26656 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26657 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26658 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26659 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26660 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26661 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26662
26663 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26664
26665 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26666
26667 @subsubheading Example
26668
26669 @smallexample
26670 (gdb)
26671 -break-insert main
26672 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26673 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26674 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26675 times="0"@}
26676 (gdb)
26677 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26678 ^done
26679 (gdb)
26680 @end smallexample
26681
26682 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26683 @findex -break-condition
26684
26685 @subsubheading Synopsis
26686
26687 @smallexample
26688 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26689 @end smallexample
26690
26691 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26692 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26693 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26694 command below).
26695
26696 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26697
26698 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26699
26700 @subsubheading Example
26701
26702 @smallexample
26703 (gdb)
26704 -break-condition 1 1
26705 ^done
26706 (gdb)
26707 -break-list
26708 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26709 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26710 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26711 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26712 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26713 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26714 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26715 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26716 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26717 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26718 (gdb)
26719 @end smallexample
26720
26721 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26722 @findex -break-delete
26723
26724 @subsubheading Synopsis
26725
26726 @smallexample
26727 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26728 @end smallexample
26729
26730 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26731 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26732
26733 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26734
26735 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26736
26737 @subsubheading Example
26738
26739 @smallexample
26740 (gdb)
26741 -break-delete 1
26742 ^done
26743 (gdb)
26744 -break-list
26745 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26746 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26747 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26748 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26749 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26750 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26751 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26752 body=[]@}
26753 (gdb)
26754 @end smallexample
26755
26756 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26757 @findex -break-disable
26758
26759 @subsubheading Synopsis
26760
26761 @smallexample
26762 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26763 @end smallexample
26764
26765 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26766 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26767
26768 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26769
26770 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26771
26772 @subsubheading Example
26773
26774 @smallexample
26775 (gdb)
26776 -break-disable 2
26777 ^done
26778 (gdb)
26779 -break-list
26780 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26781 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26782 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26783 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26784 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26785 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26786 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26787 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26788 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26789 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26790 (gdb)
26791 @end smallexample
26792
26793 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26794 @findex -break-enable
26795
26796 @subsubheading Synopsis
26797
26798 @smallexample
26799 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26800 @end smallexample
26801
26802 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26803
26804 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26805
26806 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26807
26808 @subsubheading Example
26809
26810 @smallexample
26811 (gdb)
26812 -break-enable 2
26813 ^done
26814 (gdb)
26815 -break-list
26816 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26817 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26818 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26819 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26820 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26821 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26822 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26823 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26824 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26825 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26826 (gdb)
26827 @end smallexample
26828
26829 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
26830 @findex -break-info
26831
26832 @subsubheading Synopsis
26833
26834 @smallexample
26835 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
26836 @end smallexample
26837
26838 @c REDUNDANT???
26839 Get information about a single breakpoint.
26840
26841 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
26842 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
26843 table.
26844
26845 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26846
26847 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
26848
26849 @subsubheading Example
26850 N.A.
26851
26852 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
26853 @findex -break-insert
26854
26855 @subsubheading Synopsis
26856
26857 @smallexample
26858 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
26859 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26860 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
26861 @end smallexample
26862
26863 @noindent
26864 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26865
26866 @itemize @bullet
26867 @item function
26868 @c @item +offset
26869 @c @item -offset
26870 @c @item linenum
26871 @item filename:linenum
26872 @item filename:function
26873 @item *address
26874 @end itemize
26875
26876 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26877
26878 @table @samp
26879 @item -t
26880 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26881 @item -h
26882 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26883 @item -f
26884 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26885 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26886 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26887 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26888 cannot be parsed.
26889 @item -d
26890 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26891 @item -a
26892 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26893 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26894 @item -c @var{condition}
26895 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26896 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26897 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26898 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26899 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26900 @end table
26901
26902 @subsubheading Result
26903
26904 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26905 resulting breakpoint.
26906
26907 Note: this format is open to change.
26908 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26909
26910 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26911
26912 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26913 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26914
26915 @subsubheading Example
26916
26917 @smallexample
26918 (gdb)
26919 -break-insert main
26920 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26921 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26922 times="0"@}
26923 (gdb)
26924 -break-insert -t foo
26925 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26926 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26927 times="0"@}
26928 (gdb)
26929 -break-list
26930 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26931 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26932 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26933 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26934 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26935 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26936 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26937 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26938 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26939 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26940 times="0"@},
26941 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26942 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26943 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26944 times="0"@}]@}
26945 (gdb)
26946 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
26947 @c ~int foo(int, int);
26948 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26949 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26950 @c times="0"@}
26951 @c (gdb)
26952 @end smallexample
26953
26954 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
26955 @findex -dprintf-insert
26956
26957 @subsubheading Synopsis
26958
26959 @smallexample
26960 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
26961 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26962 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
26963 [ @var{argument} ]
26964 @end smallexample
26965
26966 @noindent
26967 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26968
26969 @itemize @bullet
26970 @item @var{function}
26971 @c @item +offset
26972 @c @item -offset
26973 @c @item @var{linenum}
26974 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
26975 @item @var{filename}:function
26976 @item *@var{address}
26977 @end itemize
26978
26979 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26980
26981 @table @samp
26982 @item -t
26983 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26984 @item -f
26985 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
26986 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26987 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26988 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26989 cannot be parsed.
26990 @item -d
26991 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26992 @item -c @var{condition}
26993 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26994 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26995 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
26996 to @var{ignore-count}.
26997 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26998 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26999 @end table
27000
27001 @subsubheading Result
27002
27003 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27004 resulting breakpoint.
27005
27006 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27007
27008 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27009
27010 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27011
27012 @subsubheading Example
27013
27014 @smallexample
27015 (gdb)
27016 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27017 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27018 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27019 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27020 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27021 original-location="foo"@}
27022 (gdb)
27023 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27024 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27025 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27026 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27027 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27028 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27029 (gdb)
27030 @end smallexample
27031
27032 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27033 @findex -break-list
27034
27035 @subsubheading Synopsis
27036
27037 @smallexample
27038 -break-list
27039 @end smallexample
27040
27041 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27042
27043 @table @samp
27044 @item Number
27045 number of the breakpoint
27046 @item Type
27047 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27048 @item Disposition
27049 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27050 or @samp{nokeep}
27051 @item Enabled
27052 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27053 @item Address
27054 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27055 @item What
27056 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27057 name, line number
27058 @item Thread-groups
27059 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27060 @item Times
27061 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27062 @end table
27063
27064 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27065 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27066
27067 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27068
27069 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27070
27071 @subsubheading Example
27072
27073 @smallexample
27074 (gdb)
27075 -break-list
27076 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27077 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27078 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27079 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27080 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27081 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27082 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27083 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27084 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27085 times="0"@},
27086 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27087 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27088 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27089 (gdb)
27090 @end smallexample
27091
27092 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27093
27094 @smallexample
27095 (gdb)
27096 -break-list
27097 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27098 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27099 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27100 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27101 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27102 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27103 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27104 body=[]@}
27105 (gdb)
27106 @end smallexample
27107
27108 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27109 @findex -break-passcount
27110
27111 @subsubheading Synopsis
27112
27113 @smallexample
27114 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27115 @end smallexample
27116
27117 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27118 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27119 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27120 command @samp{passcount}.
27121
27122 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27123 @findex -break-watch
27124
27125 @subsubheading Synopsis
27126
27127 @smallexample
27128 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27129 @end smallexample
27130
27131 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27132 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27133 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27134 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27135 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27136 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27137 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27138 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27139
27140 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27141 breakpoints inserted.
27142
27143 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27144
27145 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27146 @samp{rwatch}.
27147
27148 @subsubheading Example
27149
27150 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27151
27152 @smallexample
27153 (gdb)
27154 -break-watch x
27155 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27156 (gdb)
27157 -exec-continue
27158 ^running
27159 (gdb)
27160 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27161 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27162 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27163 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27164 (gdb)
27165 @end smallexample
27166
27167 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27168 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27169 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27170
27171 @smallexample
27172 (gdb)
27173 -break-watch C
27174 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27175 (gdb)
27176 -exec-continue
27177 ^running
27178 (gdb)
27179 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27180 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27181 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27182 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27183 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27184 (gdb)
27185 -exec-continue
27186 ^running
27187 (gdb)
27188 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27189 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27190 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27191 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27192 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27193 (gdb)
27194 @end smallexample
27195
27196 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27197 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27198 deleted.
27199
27200 @smallexample
27201 (gdb)
27202 -break-watch C
27203 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27204 (gdb)
27205 -break-list
27206 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27207 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27208 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27209 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27210 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27211 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27212 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27213 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27214 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27215 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27216 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27217 times="1"@},
27218 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27219 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27220 (gdb)
27221 -exec-continue
27222 ^running
27223 (gdb)
27224 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27225 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27226 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27227 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27228 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27229 (gdb)
27230 -break-list
27231 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27232 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27233 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27234 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27235 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27236 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27237 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27238 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27239 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27240 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27241 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27242 times="1"@},
27243 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27244 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27245 (gdb)
27246 -exec-continue
27247 ^running
27248 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27249 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27250 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27251 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27252 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27253 (gdb)
27254 -break-list
27255 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27256 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27257 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27258 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27259 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27260 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27261 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27262 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27263 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27264 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27265 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27266 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27267 (gdb)
27268 @end smallexample
27269
27270
27271 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27272 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27273 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27274
27275 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27276 catchpoints.
27277
27278 @menu
27279 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27280 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27281 @end menu
27282
27283 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27284 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27285
27286 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27287 @findex -catch-load
27288
27289 @subsubheading Synopsis
27290
27291 @smallexample
27292 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27293 @end smallexample
27294
27295 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27296 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27297 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27298 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27299 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27300
27301
27302 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27303
27304 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27305
27306 @subsubheading Example
27307
27308 @smallexample
27309 -catch-load -t foo.so
27310 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27311 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27312 (gdb)
27313 @end smallexample
27314
27315
27316 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27317 @findex -catch-unload
27318
27319 @subsubheading Synopsis
27320
27321 @smallexample
27322 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27323 @end smallexample
27324
27325 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27326 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27327 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27328 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27329 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27330
27331 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27332
27333 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27334
27335 @subsubheading Example
27336
27337 @smallexample
27338 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27339 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27340 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27341 (gdb)
27342 @end smallexample
27343
27344 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27345 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27346
27347 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27348 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27349
27350 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27351 @findex -catch-assert
27352
27353 @subsubheading Synopsis
27354
27355 @smallexample
27356 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27357 @end smallexample
27358
27359 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27360
27361 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27362
27363 @table @samp
27364 @item -c @var{condition}
27365 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27366 @item -d
27367 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27368 @item -t
27369 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27370 @end table
27371
27372 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27373
27374 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27375
27376 @subsubheading Example
27377
27378 @smallexample
27379 -catch-assert
27380 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27381 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27382 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27383 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27384 (gdb)
27385 @end smallexample
27386
27387 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27388 @findex -catch-exception
27389
27390 @subsubheading Synopsis
27391
27392 @smallexample
27393 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27394 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27395 @end smallexample
27396
27397 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27398 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27399 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27400 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27401 catchpoints.
27402
27403 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27404
27405 @table @samp
27406 @item -c @var{condition}
27407 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27408 @item -d
27409 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27410 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27411 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27412 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27413 @item -t
27414 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27415 @item -u
27416 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27417 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27418 @end table
27419
27420 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27421
27422 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27423 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27424
27425 @subsubheading Example
27426
27427 @smallexample
27428 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27429 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27430 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27431 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27432 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27433 (gdb)
27434 @end smallexample
27435
27436 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27437 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27438 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27439
27440 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27441 @findex -exec-arguments
27442
27443
27444 @subsubheading Synopsis
27445
27446 @smallexample
27447 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27448 @end smallexample
27449
27450 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27451 @samp{-exec-run}.
27452
27453 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27454
27455 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27456
27457 @subsubheading Example
27458
27459 @smallexample
27460 (gdb)
27461 -exec-arguments -v word
27462 ^done
27463 (gdb)
27464 @end smallexample
27465
27466
27467 @ignore
27468 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27469 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27470
27471 @subsubheading Synopsis
27472
27473 @smallexample
27474 -exec-show-arguments
27475 @end smallexample
27476
27477 Print the arguments of the program.
27478
27479 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27480
27481 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27482
27483 @subsubheading Example
27484 N.A.
27485 @end ignore
27486
27487
27488 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27489 @findex -environment-cd
27490
27491 @subsubheading Synopsis
27492
27493 @smallexample
27494 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27495 @end smallexample
27496
27497 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27498
27499 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27500
27501 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27502
27503 @subsubheading Example
27504
27505 @smallexample
27506 (gdb)
27507 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27508 ^done
27509 (gdb)
27510 @end smallexample
27511
27512
27513 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27514 @findex -environment-directory
27515
27516 @subsubheading Synopsis
27517
27518 @smallexample
27519 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27520 @end smallexample
27521
27522 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27523 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27524 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27525 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27526 occurs as normal.
27527 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27528 multiple directories in a single command
27529 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27530 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27531 If blanks are needed as
27532 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27533 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27534 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27535 character must not be used
27536 in any directory name.
27537 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27538
27539 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27540
27541 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27542
27543 @subsubheading Example
27544
27545 @smallexample
27546 (gdb)
27547 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27548 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27549 (gdb)
27550 -environment-directory ""
27551 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27552 (gdb)
27553 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27554 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27555 (gdb)
27556 -environment-directory -r
27557 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27558 (gdb)
27559 @end smallexample
27560
27561
27562 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27563 @findex -environment-path
27564
27565 @subsubheading Synopsis
27566
27567 @smallexample
27568 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27569 @end smallexample
27570
27571 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27572 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27573 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27574 supplied in addition to the
27575 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27576 occurs as normal.
27577 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27578 multiple directories in a single command
27579 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27580 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27581 If blanks are needed as
27582 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27583 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27584 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27585 character must not be used
27586 in any directory name.
27587 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27588
27589
27590 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27591
27592 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27593
27594 @subsubheading Example
27595
27596 @smallexample
27597 (gdb)
27598 -environment-path
27599 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27600 (gdb)
27601 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27602 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27603 (gdb)
27604 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27605 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27606 (gdb)
27607 @end smallexample
27608
27609
27610 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27611 @findex -environment-pwd
27612
27613 @subsubheading Synopsis
27614
27615 @smallexample
27616 -environment-pwd
27617 @end smallexample
27618
27619 Show the current working directory.
27620
27621 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27622
27623 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27624
27625 @subsubheading Example
27626
27627 @smallexample
27628 (gdb)
27629 -environment-pwd
27630 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27631 (gdb)
27632 @end smallexample
27633
27634 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27635 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27636 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27637
27638
27639 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27640 @findex -thread-info
27641
27642 @subsubheading Synopsis
27643
27644 @smallexample
27645 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27646 @end smallexample
27647
27648 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
27649 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
27650 threads. When printing information about all threads,
27651 also reports the current thread.
27652
27653 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27654
27655 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27656 about all threads.
27657
27658 @subsubheading Result
27659
27660 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27661 defined for a given thread:
27662
27663 @table @samp
27664 @item current
27665 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27666
27667 @item id
27668 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27669
27670 @item target-id
27671 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27672
27673 @item details
27674 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27675 field is optional.
27676
27677 @item name
27678 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27679 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27680 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27681 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27682 field is omitted.
27683
27684 @item frame
27685 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27686
27687 @item state
27688 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27689 values:
27690
27691 @table @code
27692 @item stopped
27693 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27694 threads.
27695
27696 @item running
27697 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27698 threads.
27699
27700 @end table
27701
27702 @item core
27703 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27704 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27705
27706 @end table
27707
27708 @subsubheading Example
27709
27710 @smallexample
27711 -thread-info
27712 ^done,threads=[
27713 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27714 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27715 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27716 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27717 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27718 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27719 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27720 state="running"@}],
27721 current-thread-id="1"
27722 (gdb)
27723 @end smallexample
27724
27725 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27726 @findex -thread-list-ids
27727
27728 @subsubheading Synopsis
27729
27730 @smallexample
27731 -thread-list-ids
27732 @end smallexample
27733
27734 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
27735 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
27736
27737 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27738 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27739
27740 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27741
27742 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27743
27744 @subsubheading Example
27745
27746 @smallexample
27747 (gdb)
27748 -thread-list-ids
27749 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27750 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27751 (gdb)
27752 @end smallexample
27753
27754
27755 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27756 @findex -thread-select
27757
27758 @subsubheading Synopsis
27759
27760 @smallexample
27761 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
27762 @end smallexample
27763
27764 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
27765 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
27766
27767 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
27768 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
27769
27770 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27771
27772 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
27773
27774 @subsubheading Example
27775
27776 @smallexample
27777 (gdb)
27778 -exec-next
27779 ^running
27780 (gdb)
27781 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
27782 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
27783 (gdb)
27784 -thread-list-ids
27785 ^done,
27786 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27787 number-of-threads="3"
27788 (gdb)
27789 -thread-select 3
27790 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27791 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27792 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27793 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27794 (gdb)
27795 @end smallexample
27796
27797 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27798 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27799 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27800
27801 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27802 @findex -ada-task-info
27803
27804 @subsubheading Synopsis
27805
27806 @smallexample
27807 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
27808 @end smallexample
27809
27810 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
27811 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
27812
27813 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27814
27815 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
27816 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
27817
27818 @subsubheading Result
27819
27820 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
27821 defined for each Ada task:
27822
27823 @table @samp
27824 @item current
27825 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27826
27827 @item id
27828 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
27829
27830 @item task-id
27831 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
27832
27833 @item thread-id
27834 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
27835
27836 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
27837 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
27838 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
27839
27840 @item parent-id
27841 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
27842 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
27843
27844 @item priority
27845 The base priority of the task.
27846
27847 @item state
27848 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
27849 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
27850
27851 @item name
27852 The name of the task.
27853
27854 @end table
27855
27856 @subsubheading Example
27857
27858 @smallexample
27859 -ada-task-info
27860 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
27861 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
27862 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
27863 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27864 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27865 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27866 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27867 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27868 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27869 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27870 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27871 (gdb)
27872 @end smallexample
27873
27874 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27875 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27876 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27877
27878 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27879 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27880 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27881 other cases.
27882
27883 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27884 @findex -exec-continue
27885
27886 @subsubheading Synopsis
27887
27888 @smallexample
27889 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27890 @end smallexample
27891
27892 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27893 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27894 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27895 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27896 @itemize @bullet
27897 @item
27898 breakpoints or watchpoints
27899 @item
27900 signals or exceptions
27901 @item
27902 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27903 @item
27904 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27905 @end itemize
27906 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27907 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27908 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27909 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27910 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27911 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27912
27913 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27914
27915 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27916
27917 @subsubheading Example
27918
27919 @smallexample
27920 -exec-continue
27921 ^running
27922 (gdb)
27923 @@Hello world
27924 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27925 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27926 line="13"@}
27927 (gdb)
27928 @end smallexample
27929
27930
27931 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27932 @findex -exec-finish
27933
27934 @subsubheading Synopsis
27935
27936 @smallexample
27937 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27938 @end smallexample
27939
27940 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27941 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27942 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27943 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27944 function was called.
27945
27946 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27947
27948 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27949
27950 @subsubheading Example
27951
27952 Function returning @code{void}.
27953
27954 @smallexample
27955 -exec-finish
27956 ^running
27957 (gdb)
27958 @@hello from foo
27959 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27960 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27961 (gdb)
27962 @end smallexample
27963
27964 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27965 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27966 value itself.
27967
27968 @smallexample
27969 -exec-finish
27970 ^running
27971 (gdb)
27972 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27973 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27974 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27975 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27976 (gdb)
27977 @end smallexample
27978
27979
27980 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27981 @findex -exec-interrupt
27982
27983 @subsubheading Synopsis
27984
27985 @smallexample
27986 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27987 @end smallexample
27988
27989 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27990 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27991 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27992 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27993 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27994
27995 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27996 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27997 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27998 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27999
28000 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28001 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28002 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28003 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28004
28005 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28006
28007 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28008
28009 @subsubheading Example
28010
28011 @smallexample
28012 (gdb)
28013 111-exec-continue
28014 111^running
28015
28016 (gdb)
28017 222-exec-interrupt
28018 222^done
28019 (gdb)
28020 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28021 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28022 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28023 (gdb)
28024
28025 (gdb)
28026 -exec-interrupt
28027 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28028 (gdb)
28029 @end smallexample
28030
28031 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28032 @findex -exec-jump
28033
28034 @subsubheading Synopsis
28035
28036 @smallexample
28037 -exec-jump @var{location}
28038 @end smallexample
28039
28040 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28041 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28042 different forms of @var{location}.
28043
28044 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28045
28046 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28047
28048 @subsubheading Example
28049
28050 @smallexample
28051 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28052 *running,thread-id="all"
28053 ^running
28054 @end smallexample
28055
28056
28057 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28058 @findex -exec-next
28059
28060 @subsubheading Synopsis
28061
28062 @smallexample
28063 -exec-next [--reverse]
28064 @end smallexample
28065
28066 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28067 of the next source line is reached.
28068
28069 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28070 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28071 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28072 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28073 source line where the function was called.
28074
28075
28076 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28077
28078 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28079
28080 @subsubheading Example
28081
28082 @smallexample
28083 -exec-next
28084 ^running
28085 (gdb)
28086 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28087 (gdb)
28088 @end smallexample
28089
28090
28091 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28092 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28093
28094 @subsubheading Synopsis
28095
28096 @smallexample
28097 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28098 @end smallexample
28099
28100 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28101 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28102 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28103 printed as well.
28104
28105 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28106 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28107 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28108 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28109 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28110
28111 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28112
28113 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28114
28115 @subsubheading Example
28116
28117 @smallexample
28118 (gdb)
28119 -exec-next-instruction
28120 ^running
28121
28122 (gdb)
28123 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28124 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28125 (gdb)
28126 @end smallexample
28127
28128
28129 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28130 @findex -exec-return
28131
28132 @subsubheading Synopsis
28133
28134 @smallexample
28135 -exec-return
28136 @end smallexample
28137
28138 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28139 Displays the new current frame.
28140
28141 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28142
28143 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28144
28145 @subsubheading Example
28146
28147 @smallexample
28148 (gdb)
28149 200-break-insert callee4
28150 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28151 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28152 (gdb)
28153 000-exec-run
28154 000^running
28155 (gdb)
28156 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28157 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28158 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28159 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28160 (gdb)
28161 205-break-delete
28162 205^done
28163 (gdb)
28164 111-exec-return
28165 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28166 args=[@{name="strarg",
28167 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28168 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28169 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28170 (gdb)
28171 @end smallexample
28172
28173
28174 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28175 @findex -exec-run
28176
28177 @subsubheading Synopsis
28178
28179 @smallexample
28180 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28181 @end smallexample
28182
28183 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28184 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28185 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28186 the program has exited exceptionally.
28187
28188 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28189 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28190 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28191 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28192 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28193
28194 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28195 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28196 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28197 (@pxref{Starting}).
28198
28199 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28200
28201 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28202
28203 @subsubheading Examples
28204
28205 @smallexample
28206 (gdb)
28207 -break-insert main
28208 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28209 (gdb)
28210 -exec-run
28211 ^running
28212 (gdb)
28213 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28214 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28215 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28216 (gdb)
28217 @end smallexample
28218
28219 @noindent
28220 Program exited normally:
28221
28222 @smallexample
28223 (gdb)
28224 -exec-run
28225 ^running
28226 (gdb)
28227 x = 55
28228 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28229 (gdb)
28230 @end smallexample
28231
28232 @noindent
28233 Program exited exceptionally:
28234
28235 @smallexample
28236 (gdb)
28237 -exec-run
28238 ^running
28239 (gdb)
28240 x = 55
28241 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28242 (gdb)
28243 @end smallexample
28244
28245 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28246 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28247
28248 @smallexample
28249 (gdb)
28250 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28251 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28252 @end smallexample
28253
28254
28255 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28256
28257
28258 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28259 @findex -exec-step
28260
28261 @subsubheading Synopsis
28262
28263 @smallexample
28264 -exec-step [--reverse]
28265 @end smallexample
28266
28267 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28268 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28269 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28270 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28271 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28272 previously executed source line.
28273
28274 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28275
28276 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28277
28278 @subsubheading Example
28279
28280 Stepping into a function:
28281
28282 @smallexample
28283 -exec-step
28284 ^running
28285 (gdb)
28286 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28287 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28288 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28289 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28290 (gdb)
28291 @end smallexample
28292
28293 Regular stepping:
28294
28295 @smallexample
28296 -exec-step
28297 ^running
28298 (gdb)
28299 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28300 (gdb)
28301 @end smallexample
28302
28303
28304 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28305 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28306
28307 @subsubheading Synopsis
28308
28309 @smallexample
28310 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28311 @end smallexample
28312
28313 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28314 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28315 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28316 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28317 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28318 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28319 as well.
28320
28321 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28322
28323 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28324
28325 @subsubheading Example
28326
28327 @smallexample
28328 (gdb)
28329 -exec-step-instruction
28330 ^running
28331
28332 (gdb)
28333 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28334 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28335 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28336 (gdb)
28337 -exec-step-instruction
28338 ^running
28339
28340 (gdb)
28341 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28342 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28343 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28344 (gdb)
28345 @end smallexample
28346
28347
28348 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28349 @findex -exec-until
28350
28351 @subsubheading Synopsis
28352
28353 @smallexample
28354 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28355 @end smallexample
28356
28357 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28358 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28359 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28360 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28361
28362 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28363
28364 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28365
28366 @subsubheading Example
28367
28368 @smallexample
28369 (gdb)
28370 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28371 ^running
28372 (gdb)
28373 x = 55
28374 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28375 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28376 (gdb)
28377 @end smallexample
28378
28379 @ignore
28380 @subheading -file-clear
28381 Is this going away????
28382 @end ignore
28383
28384 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28385 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28386 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28387
28388 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28389 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28390
28391 @smallexample
28392 -enable-frame-filters
28393 @end smallexample
28394
28395 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28396 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28397 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28398 request that this functionality be enabled.
28399
28400 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28401
28402 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28403 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28404
28405 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28406 @findex -stack-info-frame
28407
28408 @subsubheading Synopsis
28409
28410 @smallexample
28411 -stack-info-frame
28412 @end smallexample
28413
28414 Get info on the selected frame.
28415
28416 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28417
28418 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28419 (without arguments).
28420
28421 @subsubheading Example
28422
28423 @smallexample
28424 (gdb)
28425 -stack-info-frame
28426 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28427 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28428 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28429 (gdb)
28430 @end smallexample
28431
28432 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28433 @findex -stack-info-depth
28434
28435 @subsubheading Synopsis
28436
28437 @smallexample
28438 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28439 @end smallexample
28440
28441 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28442 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28443
28444 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28445
28446 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28447
28448 @subsubheading Example
28449
28450 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28451
28452 @smallexample
28453 (gdb)
28454 -stack-info-depth
28455 ^done,depth="12"
28456 (gdb)
28457 -stack-info-depth 4
28458 ^done,depth="4"
28459 (gdb)
28460 -stack-info-depth 12
28461 ^done,depth="12"
28462 (gdb)
28463 -stack-info-depth 11
28464 ^done,depth="11"
28465 (gdb)
28466 -stack-info-depth 13
28467 ^done,depth="12"
28468 (gdb)
28469 @end smallexample
28470
28471 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28472 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28473 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28474
28475 @subsubheading Synopsis
28476
28477 @smallexample
28478 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28479 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28480 @end smallexample
28481
28482 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28483 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28484 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28485 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28486 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28487 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28488 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28489 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28490
28491 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28492 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28493 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28494 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28495 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28496 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28497
28498 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28499 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28500 are still displayed, however.
28501
28502 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28503 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28504
28505 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28506
28507 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28508 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28509 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28510
28511 @subsubheading Example
28512
28513 @smallexample
28514 (gdb)
28515 -stack-list-frames
28516 ^done,
28517 stack=[
28518 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28519 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28520 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28521 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28522 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28523 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28524 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28525 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28526 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28527 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28528 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28529 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28530 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28531 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28532 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28533 (gdb)
28534 -stack-list-arguments 0
28535 ^done,
28536 stack-args=[
28537 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28538 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28539 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28540 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28541 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28542 (gdb)
28543 -stack-list-arguments 1
28544 ^done,
28545 stack-args=[
28546 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28547 frame=@{level="1",
28548 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28549 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28550 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28551 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28552 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28553 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28554 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28555 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28556 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28557 (gdb)
28558 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28559 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28560 (gdb)
28561 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28562 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28563 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28564 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28565 (gdb)
28566 @end smallexample
28567
28568 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28569
28570
28571 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28572 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28573 @findex -stack-list-frames
28574
28575 @subsubheading Synopsis
28576
28577 @smallexample
28578 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28579 @end smallexample
28580
28581 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28582 following info:
28583
28584 @table @samp
28585 @item @var{level}
28586 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28587 @item @var{addr}
28588 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28589 @item @var{func}
28590 Function name.
28591 @item @var{file}
28592 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28593 @item @var{fullname}
28594 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28595 @item @var{line}
28596 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28597 @item @var{from}
28598 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28599 if the frame's function is not known.
28600 @end table
28601
28602 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28603 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28604 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28605 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28606 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28607 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28608 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28609 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28610 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28611
28612 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28613
28614 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28615
28616 @subsubheading Example
28617
28618 Full stack backtrace:
28619
28620 @smallexample
28621 (gdb)
28622 -stack-list-frames
28623 ^done,stack=
28624 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28625 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28626 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28627 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28628 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28629 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28630 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28631 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28632 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28633 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28634 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28635 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28636 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28637 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28638 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28639 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28640 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28641 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28642 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28643 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28644 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28645 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28646 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28647 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28648 (gdb)
28649 @end smallexample
28650
28651 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28652
28653 @smallexample
28654 (gdb)
28655 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28656 ^done,stack=
28657 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28658 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28659 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28660 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28661 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28662 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28663 (gdb)
28664 @end smallexample
28665
28666 Show a single frame:
28667
28668 @smallexample
28669 (gdb)
28670 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28671 ^done,stack=
28672 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28673 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28674 (gdb)
28675 @end smallexample
28676
28677
28678 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28679 @findex -stack-list-locals
28680 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
28681
28682 @subsubheading Synopsis
28683
28684 @smallexample
28685 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28686 @end smallexample
28687
28688 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28689 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28690 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28691 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28692 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28693 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28694 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28695 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28696 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28697 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28698
28699 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28700 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
28701 variables are still displayed, however.
28702
28703 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28704 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28705
28706 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28707
28708 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
28709
28710 @subsubheading Example
28711
28712 @smallexample
28713 (gdb)
28714 -stack-list-locals 0
28715 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28716 (gdb)
28717 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28718 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28719 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28720 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28721 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28722 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28723 (gdb)
28724 @end smallexample
28725
28726 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
28727 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28728 @findex -stack-list-variables
28729
28730 @subsubheading Synopsis
28731
28732 @smallexample
28733 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28734 @end smallexample
28735
28736 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28737 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28738 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28739 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28740 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28741 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28742 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28743
28744 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28745 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
28746 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
28747
28748 @subsubheading Example
28749
28750 @smallexample
28751 (gdb)
28752 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28753 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28754 (gdb)
28755 @end smallexample
28756
28757
28758 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
28759 @findex -stack-select-frame
28760
28761 @subsubheading Synopsis
28762
28763 @smallexample
28764 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
28765 @end smallexample
28766
28767 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
28768 the stack.
28769
28770 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
28771 option to every command.
28772
28773 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28774
28775 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
28776 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
28777
28778 @subsubheading Example
28779
28780 @smallexample
28781 (gdb)
28782 -stack-select-frame 2
28783 ^done
28784 (gdb)
28785 @end smallexample
28786
28787 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28788 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28789 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28790
28791 @ignore
28792
28793 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28794
28795 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28796 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28797 used by @code{Insight}.
28798
28799 The two main reasons for that are:
28800
28801 @enumerate 1
28802 @item
28803 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28804
28805 @item
28806 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
28807 now).
28808 @end enumerate
28809
28810 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
28811 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
28812 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
28813 hints about their use.
28814
28815 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
28816 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
28817 least, the following operations:
28818
28819 @itemize @bullet
28820 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
28821 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
28822 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
28823 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
28824 @end itemize
28825
28826 @end ignore
28827
28828 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
28829
28830 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28831
28832 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
28833 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
28834 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
28835 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
28836 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
28837 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
28838 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
28839 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
28840 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
28841 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
28842 object, or to change display format.
28843
28844 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
28845 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
28846 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
28847 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
28848 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
28849 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
28850 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
28851 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
28852 child will be created.
28853
28854 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
28855 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
28856 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
28857 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
28858 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
28859
28860 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
28861 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
28862 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
28863 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28864 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28865 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28866 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28867 variables that frontend has created.
28868
28869 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28870 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28871 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28872 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28873 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28874 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28875 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28876 implicitly updated.
28877
28878 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28879 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28880 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28881 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28882 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28883 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28884 frame. Consider this example:
28885
28886 @smallexample
28887 void do_work(...)
28888 @{
28889 struct work_state state;
28890
28891 if (...)
28892 do_work(...);
28893 @}
28894 @end smallexample
28895
28896 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28897 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28898 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28899 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28900 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28901
28902 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28903 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28904 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28905 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28906 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28907 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28908
28909 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28910 access this functionality:
28911
28912 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28913 @item @strong{Operation}
28914 @tab @strong{Description}
28915
28916 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28917 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28918 @item @code{-var-create}
28919 @tab create a variable object
28920 @item @code{-var-delete}
28921 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28922 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28923 @tab set the display format of this variable
28924 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28925 @tab show the display format of this variable
28926 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28927 @tab tells how many children this object has
28928 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28929 @tab return a list of the object's children
28930 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28931 @tab show the type of this variable object
28932 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28933 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28934 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28935 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28936 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28937 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28938 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28939 @tab get the value of this variable
28940 @item @code{-var-assign}
28941 @tab set the value of this variable
28942 @item @code{-var-update}
28943 @tab update the variable and its children
28944 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28945 @tab set frozeness attribute
28946 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28947 @tab set range of children to display on update
28948 @end multitable
28949
28950 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28951 how it can be used.
28952
28953 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28954
28955 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28956 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28957
28958 @smallexample
28959 -enable-pretty-printing
28960 @end smallexample
28961
28962 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28963 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28964 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28965 request that this functionality be enabled.
28966
28967 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28968
28969 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28970 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28971
28972 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28973 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28974
28975 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28976 @findex -var-create
28977
28978 @subsubheading Synopsis
28979
28980 @smallexample
28981 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28982 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28983 @end smallexample
28984
28985 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28986 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28987 register.
28988
28989 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28990 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28991 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28992 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28993 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28994
28995 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28996 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28997 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28998 object must be created.
28999
29000 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29001 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29002
29003 @itemize @bullet
29004 @item
29005 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29006
29007 @item
29008 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29009
29010 @item
29011 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29012 @end itemize
29013
29014 @cindex dynamic varobj
29015 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29016 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29017 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29018 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29019 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29020 compatibility for existing clients.
29021
29022 @subsubheading Result
29023
29024 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29025 are:
29026
29027 @table @samp
29028 @item name
29029 The name of the varobj.
29030
29031 @item numchild
29032 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29033 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29034 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29035
29036 @item value
29037 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29038 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29039 will not be interesting.
29040
29041 @item type
29042 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29043 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29044 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29045 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29046 @emph{declared} one.
29047
29048 @item thread-id
29049 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29050 thread's identifier.
29051
29052 @item has_more
29053 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29054 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29055
29056 @item dynamic
29057 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29058 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29059 then this attribute will not be present.
29060
29061 @item displayhint
29062 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29063 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29064 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29065 @end table
29066
29067 Typical output will look like this:
29068
29069 @smallexample
29070 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29071 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29072 @end smallexample
29073
29074
29075 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29076 @findex -var-delete
29077
29078 @subsubheading Synopsis
29079
29080 @smallexample
29081 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29082 @end smallexample
29083
29084 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29085 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29086
29087 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29088
29089
29090 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29091 @findex -var-set-format
29092
29093 @subsubheading Synopsis
29094
29095 @smallexample
29096 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29097 @end smallexample
29098
29099 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29100 @var{format-spec}.
29101
29102 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29103 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29104
29105 @smallexample
29106 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29107 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
29108 @end smallexample
29109
29110 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29111 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29112 for pointers, etc.).
29113
29114 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29115 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29116
29117 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29118 @findex -var-show-format
29119
29120 @subsubheading Synopsis
29121
29122 @smallexample
29123 -var-show-format @var{name}
29124 @end smallexample
29125
29126 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29127
29128 @smallexample
29129 @var{format} @expansion{}
29130 @var{format-spec}
29131 @end smallexample
29132
29133
29134 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29135 @findex -var-info-num-children
29136
29137 @subsubheading Synopsis
29138
29139 @smallexample
29140 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29141 @end smallexample
29142
29143 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29144
29145 @smallexample
29146 numchild=@var{n}
29147 @end smallexample
29148
29149 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29150 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29151 be available.
29152
29153
29154 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29155 @findex -var-list-children
29156
29157 @subsubheading Synopsis
29158
29159 @smallexample
29160 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29161 @end smallexample
29162 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29163
29164 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29165 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29166 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29167 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29168 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29169 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29170 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29171 and unions.
29172
29173 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29174 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29175 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29176 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29177 reported.
29178
29179 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29180 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29181 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29182 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29183 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29184 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29185 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29186 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29187 the visible items.
29188
29189 For each child the following results are returned:
29190
29191 @table @var
29192
29193 @item name
29194 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29195
29196 @item exp
29197 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29198 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29199
29200 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29201 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29202
29203 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29204 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29205 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29206 type and value are not present.
29207
29208 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29209 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29210 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29211
29212 @item numchild
29213 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29214 0.
29215
29216 @item type
29217 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29218 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29219 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29220 @emph{declared} one.
29221
29222 @item value
29223 If values were requested, this is the value.
29224
29225 @item thread-id
29226 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
29227 Otherwise this result is not present.
29228
29229 @item frozen
29230 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29231
29232 @item displayhint
29233 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29234 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29235 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29236
29237 @item dynamic
29238 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29239 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29240 then this attribute will not be present.
29241
29242 @end table
29243
29244 The result may have its own attributes:
29245
29246 @table @samp
29247 @item displayhint
29248 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29249 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29250 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29251
29252 @item has_more
29253 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29254 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29255 @end table
29256
29257 @subsubheading Example
29258
29259 @smallexample
29260 (gdb)
29261 -var-list-children n
29262 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29263 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29264 (gdb)
29265 -var-list-children --all-values n
29266 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29267 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29268 @end smallexample
29269
29270
29271 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29272 @findex -var-info-type
29273
29274 @subsubheading Synopsis
29275
29276 @smallexample
29277 -var-info-type @var{name}
29278 @end smallexample
29279
29280 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29281 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29282 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29283
29284 @smallexample
29285 type=@var{typename}
29286 @end smallexample
29287
29288
29289 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29290 @findex -var-info-expression
29291
29292 @subsubheading Synopsis
29293
29294 @smallexample
29295 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29296 @end smallexample
29297
29298 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29299 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29300 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29301
29302 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29303 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29304
29305 @smallexample
29306 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29307 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29308 @end smallexample
29309
29310 @noindent
29311 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29312 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29313
29314 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29315 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29316 is of limited use.
29317
29318 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29319 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29320
29321 @subsubheading Synopsis
29322
29323 @smallexample
29324 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29325 @end smallexample
29326
29327 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29328 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29329 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29330 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29331 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29332 watchpoint from a variable object.
29333
29334 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29335 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29336
29337 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29338 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29339 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29340 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29341 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29342 @smallexample
29343 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29344 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29345 @end smallexample
29346
29347 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29348 @findex -var-show-attributes
29349
29350 @subsubheading Synopsis
29351
29352 @smallexample
29353 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29354 @end smallexample
29355
29356 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29357
29358 @smallexample
29359 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29360 @end smallexample
29361
29362 @noindent
29363 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29364
29365 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29366 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29367
29368 @subsubheading Synopsis
29369
29370 @smallexample
29371 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29372 @end smallexample
29373
29374 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29375 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29376 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29377 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29378 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29379 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29380 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29381
29382 @smallexample
29383 value=@var{value}
29384 @end smallexample
29385
29386 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29387 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29388
29389 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29390 @findex -var-assign
29391
29392 @subsubheading Synopsis
29393
29394 @smallexample
29395 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29396 @end smallexample
29397
29398 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29399 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29400 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29401 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29402
29403 @subsubheading Example
29404
29405 @smallexample
29406 (gdb)
29407 -var-assign var1 3
29408 ^done,value="3"
29409 (gdb)
29410 -var-update *
29411 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29412 (gdb)
29413 @end smallexample
29414
29415 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29416 @findex -var-update
29417
29418 @subsubheading Synopsis
29419
29420 @smallexample
29421 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29422 @end smallexample
29423
29424 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29425 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29426 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29427 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29428 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29429 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29430 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29431 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29432 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29433 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29434 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29435 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29436 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29437
29438 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29439 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29440 diagnostic.
29441
29442 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29443 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29444
29445 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29446 @samp{changelist}.
29447
29448 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29449
29450 @table @samp
29451 @item name
29452 The name of the varobj.
29453
29454 @item value
29455 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29456 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29457
29458 @item in_scope
29459 @anchor{-var-update}
29460 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29461
29462 @table @code
29463 @item "true"
29464 The variable object's current value is valid.
29465
29466 @item "false"
29467 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29468 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29469 scope.
29470
29471 @item "invalid"
29472 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29473 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29474 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29475 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29476 objects.
29477 @end table
29478
29479 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29480 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29481
29482 @item type_changed
29483 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29484 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29485 be @samp{false}.
29486
29487 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29488 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29489 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29490 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29491 unset.
29492
29493 @item new_type
29494 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29495 hold the new type.
29496
29497 @item new_num_children
29498 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29499 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29500
29501 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29502 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29503 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29504 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29505 children which may be available.
29506
29507 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29508 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29509 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29510 only happen at the end of the update range).
29511
29512 @item displayhint
29513 The display hint, if any.
29514
29515 @item has_more
29516 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29517 available outside the varobj's update range.
29518
29519 @item dynamic
29520 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29521 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29522 then this attribute will not be present.
29523
29524 @item new_children
29525 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29526 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29527 be listed in this attribute.
29528 @end table
29529
29530 @subsubheading Example
29531
29532 @smallexample
29533 (gdb)
29534 -var-assign var1 3
29535 ^done,value="3"
29536 (gdb)
29537 -var-update --all-values var1
29538 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29539 type_changed="false"@}]
29540 (gdb)
29541 @end smallexample
29542
29543 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29544 @findex -var-set-frozen
29545 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29546
29547 @subsubheading Synopsis
29548
29549 @smallexample
29550 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29551 @end smallexample
29552
29553 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29554 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29555 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29556 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29557 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29558 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29559 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29560 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29561 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29562 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29563 @code{-var-update} does.
29564
29565 @subsubheading Example
29566
29567 @smallexample
29568 (gdb)
29569 -var-set-frozen V 1
29570 ^done
29571 (gdb)
29572 @end smallexample
29573
29574 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29575 @findex -var-set-update-range
29576 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29577
29578 @subsubheading Synopsis
29579
29580 @smallexample
29581 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29582 @end smallexample
29583
29584 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29585 @code{-var-update}.
29586
29587 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29588 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29589 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29590 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29591
29592 @subsubheading Example
29593
29594 @smallexample
29595 (gdb)
29596 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29597 ^done
29598 @end smallexample
29599
29600 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29601 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29602 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29603
29604 @subsubheading Synopsis
29605
29606 @smallexample
29607 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29608 @end smallexample
29609
29610 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29611
29612 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29613 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29614
29615 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29616 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29617 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29618 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29619 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29620 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29621 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29622
29623 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29624 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29625 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29626 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29627
29628 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29629 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29630 can be used to check this.
29631
29632 @subsubheading Example
29633
29634 Resetting the visualizer:
29635
29636 @smallexample
29637 (gdb)
29638 -var-set-visualizer V None
29639 ^done
29640 @end smallexample
29641
29642 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29643
29644 @smallexample
29645 (gdb)
29646 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29647 ^done
29648 @end smallexample
29649
29650 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29651 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29652
29653 @smallexample
29654 (gdb)
29655 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29656 ^done
29657 @end smallexample
29658
29659 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29660 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29661 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29662
29663 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29664 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29665 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29666 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29667
29668 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
29669 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
29670
29671 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29672 @c @subheading -data-assign
29673 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29674 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29675 @c set variable
29676 @c @subsubheading Example
29677 @c N.A.
29678
29679 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29680 @findex -data-disassemble
29681
29682 @subsubheading Synopsis
29683
29684 @smallexample
29685 -data-disassemble
29686 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29687 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29688 -- @var{mode}
29689 @end smallexample
29690
29691 @noindent
29692 Where:
29693
29694 @table @samp
29695 @item @var{start-addr}
29696 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29697 @item @var{end-addr}
29698 is the end address
29699 @item @var{filename}
29700 is the name of the file to disassemble
29701 @item @var{linenum}
29702 is the line number to disassemble around
29703 @item @var{lines}
29704 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
29705 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
29706 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
29707 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
29708 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
29709 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
29710 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
29711 are displayed.
29712 @item @var{mode}
29713 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
29714 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
29715 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
29716 @end table
29717
29718 @subsubheading Result
29719
29720 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
29721 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
29722 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
29723
29724 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
29725 following fields:
29726
29727 @table @code
29728 @item address
29729 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
29730
29731 @item func-name
29732 The name of the function this instruction is within.
29733
29734 @item offset
29735 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
29736
29737 @item inst
29738 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
29739
29740 @item opcodes
29741 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
29742 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
29743
29744 @end table
29745
29746 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
29747 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
29748
29749 @table @code
29750 @item line
29751 The line number within @samp{file}.
29752
29753 @item file
29754 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
29755 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
29756 used.
29757
29758 @item fullname
29759 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
29760 using the source file search path
29761 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
29762 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
29763
29764 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
29765 present in the debug information.
29766
29767 @item line_asm_insn
29768 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
29769 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
29770 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
29771 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
29772 @samp{opcodes}.
29773
29774 @end table
29775
29776 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
29777 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
29778 adjust its format.
29779
29780 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29781
29782 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
29783
29784 @subsubheading Example
29785
29786 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
29787
29788 @smallexample
29789 (gdb)
29790 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
29791 ^done,
29792 asm_insns=[
29793 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29794 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29795 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29796 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29797 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
29798 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
29799 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
29800 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29801 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
29802 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
29803 (gdb)
29804 @end smallexample
29805
29806 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
29807 @code{main}.
29808
29809 @smallexample
29810 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
29811 ^done,asm_insns=[
29812 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29813 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29814 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29815 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29816 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29817 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29818 [@dots{}]
29819 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
29820 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
29821 (gdb)
29822 @end smallexample
29823
29824 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
29825
29826 @smallexample
29827 (gdb)
29828 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
29829 ^done,asm_insns=[
29830 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29831 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29832 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29833 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29834 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29835 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
29836 (gdb)
29837 @end smallexample
29838
29839 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
29840
29841 @smallexample
29842 (gdb)
29843 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
29844 ^done,asm_insns=[
29845 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
29846 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29847 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29848 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
29849 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
29850 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
29851 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29852 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29853 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
29854 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29855 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29856 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
29857 (gdb)
29858 @end smallexample
29859
29860
29861 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
29862 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
29863
29864 @subsubheading Synopsis
29865
29866 @smallexample
29867 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29868 @end smallexample
29869
29870 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29871 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29872 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29873
29874 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29875
29876 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29877 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29878 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29879
29880 @subsubheading Example
29881
29882 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29883 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29884 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29885 output.
29886
29887 @smallexample
29888 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29889 211^done,value="1"
29890 (gdb)
29891 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29892 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29893 (gdb)
29894 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29895 411^done,value="4"
29896 (gdb)
29897 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29898 511^done,value="4"
29899 (gdb)
29900 @end smallexample
29901
29902
29903 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29904 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29905
29906 @subsubheading Synopsis
29907
29908 @smallexample
29909 -data-list-changed-registers
29910 @end smallexample
29911
29912 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29913
29914 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29915
29916 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29917 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29918
29919 @subsubheading Example
29920
29921 On a PPC MBX board:
29922
29923 @smallexample
29924 (gdb)
29925 -exec-continue
29926 ^running
29927
29928 (gdb)
29929 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29930 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29931 line="5"@}
29932 (gdb)
29933 -data-list-changed-registers
29934 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29935 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29936 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29937 (gdb)
29938 @end smallexample
29939
29940
29941 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29942 @findex -data-list-register-names
29943
29944 @subsubheading Synopsis
29945
29946 @smallexample
29947 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29948 @end smallexample
29949
29950 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29951 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29952 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29953 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29954 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29955 include empty register names.
29956
29957 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29958
29959 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29960 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29961 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29962
29963 @subsubheading Example
29964
29965 For the PPC MBX board:
29966 @smallexample
29967 (gdb)
29968 -data-list-register-names
29969 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29970 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29971 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29972 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29973 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29974 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29975 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29976 (gdb)
29977 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29978 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29979 (gdb)
29980 @end smallexample
29981
29982 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29983 @findex -data-list-register-values
29984
29985 @subsubheading Synopsis
29986
29987 @smallexample
29988 -data-list-register-values
29989 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29990 @end smallexample
29991
29992 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
29993 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
29994 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
29995 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
29996 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
29997 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
29998
29999 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30000
30001 @table @code
30002 @item x
30003 Hexadecimal
30004 @item o
30005 Octal
30006 @item t
30007 Binary
30008 @item d
30009 Decimal
30010 @item r
30011 Raw
30012 @item N
30013 Natural
30014 @end table
30015
30016 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30017
30018 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30019 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30020
30021 @subsubheading Example
30022
30023 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30024 don't appear in the actual output):
30025
30026 @smallexample
30027 (gdb)
30028 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30029 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30030 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30031 (gdb)
30032 -data-list-register-values x
30033 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30034 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30035 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30036 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30037 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30038 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30039 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30040 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30041 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30042 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30043 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30044 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30045 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30046 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30047 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30048 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30049 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30050 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30051 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30052 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30053 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30054 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30055 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30056 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30057 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30058 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30059 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30060 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30061 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30062 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30063 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30064 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30065 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30066 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30067 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30068 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30069 (gdb)
30070 @end smallexample
30071
30072
30073 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30074 @findex -data-read-memory
30075
30076 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30077
30078 @subsubheading Synopsis
30079
30080 @smallexample
30081 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30082 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30083 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30084 @end smallexample
30085
30086 @noindent
30087 where:
30088
30089 @table @samp
30090 @item @var{address}
30091 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30092 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30093 quoted using the C convention.
30094
30095 @item @var{word-format}
30096 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30097 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30098 ,Output Formats}).
30099
30100 @item @var{word-size}
30101 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30102
30103 @item @var{nr-rows}
30104 The number of rows in the output table.
30105
30106 @item @var{nr-cols}
30107 The number of columns in the output table.
30108
30109 @item @var{aschar}
30110 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30111 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30112 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30113 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30114
30115 @item @var{byte-offset}
30116 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30117 @end table
30118
30119 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30120 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30121 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30122 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30123 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30124 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30125 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30126 @samp{addr}.
30127
30128 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30129 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30130 @samp{prev-page}.
30131
30132 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30133
30134 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30135 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30136
30137 @subsubheading Example
30138
30139 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30140 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30141 word. Display each word in hex.
30142
30143 @smallexample
30144 (gdb)
30145 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30146 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30147 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30148 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30149 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30150 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30151 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30152 (gdb)
30153 @end smallexample
30154
30155 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30156 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30157
30158 @smallexample
30159 (gdb)
30160 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30161 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30162 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30163 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30164 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30165 (gdb)
30166 @end smallexample
30167
30168 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30169 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30170 used as the non-printable character.
30171
30172 @smallexample
30173 (gdb)
30174 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30175 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30176 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30177 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30178 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30179 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30180 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30181 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30182 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30183 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30184 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30185 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30186 (gdb)
30187 @end smallexample
30188
30189 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30190 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30191
30192 @subsubheading Synopsis
30193
30194 @smallexample
30195 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30196 @var{address} @var{count}
30197 @end smallexample
30198
30199 @noindent
30200 where:
30201
30202 @table @samp
30203 @item @var{address}
30204 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30205 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30206 quoted using the C convention.
30207
30208 @item @var{count}
30209 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30210 literal.
30211
30212 @item @var{offset}
30213 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30214 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30215 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30216 arithmetics itself.
30217
30218 @end table
30219
30220 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30221 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30222 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30223 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30224 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30225 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30226
30227 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30228 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30229 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30230 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30231 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30232 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30233 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30234 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30235
30236 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30237 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30238 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30239 and has the following fields:
30240
30241 @table @code
30242 @item begin
30243 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30244
30245 @item end
30246 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30247
30248 @item offset
30249 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30250 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30251
30252 @item contents
30253 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30254
30255 @end table
30256
30257
30258
30259 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30260
30261 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30262
30263 @subsubheading Example
30264
30265 @smallexample
30266 (gdb)
30267 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30268 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30269 end="0xbffff15e",
30270 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30271 (gdb)
30272 @end smallexample
30273
30274
30275 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30276 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30277
30278 @subsubheading Synopsis
30279
30280 @smallexample
30281 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30282 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30283 @end smallexample
30284
30285 @noindent
30286 where:
30287
30288 @table @samp
30289 @item @var{address}
30290 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30291 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30292 be quoted using the C convention.
30293
30294 @item @var{contents}
30295 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30296 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30297
30298 @item @var{count}
30299 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30300 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30301 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30302 @var{count} memory units.
30303
30304 @end table
30305
30306 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30307
30308 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30309
30310 @subsubheading Example
30311
30312 @smallexample
30313 (gdb)
30314 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30315 ^done
30316 (gdb)
30317 @end smallexample
30318
30319 @smallexample
30320 (gdb)
30321 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30322 ^done
30323 (gdb)
30324 @end smallexample
30325
30326 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30327 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30328 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30329
30330 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30331 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30332
30333 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30334 @findex -trace-find
30335
30336 @subsubheading Synopsis
30337
30338 @smallexample
30339 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30340 @end smallexample
30341
30342 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30343 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30344 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30345
30346 @table @samp
30347
30348 @item none
30349 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30350
30351 @item frame-number
30352 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30353 that index.
30354
30355 @item tracepoint-number
30356 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30357 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30358
30359 @item pc
30360 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30361 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30362 address.
30363
30364 @item pc-inside-range
30365 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30366 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30367 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30368
30369 @item pc-outside-range
30370 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30371 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30372 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30373
30374 @item line
30375 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30376 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30377 the specified location.
30378
30379 @end table
30380
30381 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30382 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30383
30384 @table @samp
30385 @item found
30386 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30387 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30388
30389 @item traceframe
30390 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30391 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30392
30393 @item tracepoint
30394 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30395 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30396
30397 @item frame
30398 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30399 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30400 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30401
30402 @end table
30403
30404 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30405
30406 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30407
30408 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30409 @findex -trace-define-variable
30410
30411 @subsubheading Synopsis
30412
30413 @smallexample
30414 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30415 @end smallexample
30416
30417 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30418 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30419 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30420 with the @samp{$} character.
30421
30422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30423
30424 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30425
30426 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30427 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30428
30429 @subsubheading Synopsis
30430
30431 @smallexample
30432 -trace-frame-collected
30433 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30434 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30435 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30436 [--memory-contents]
30437 @end smallexample
30438
30439 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30440 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30441 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30442 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30443 See the output description table below for more details.
30444
30445 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30446 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30447 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30448 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30449 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30450
30451 For instance, if the actions were
30452 @smallexample
30453 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30454 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30455 @end smallexample
30456
30457 @noindent
30458 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30459 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30460 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30461 objects would be computed expressions.
30462
30463 An example output would be:
30464
30465 @smallexample
30466 (gdb)
30467 -trace-frame-collected
30468 ^done,
30469 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30470 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30471 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30472 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30473 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30474 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30475 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30476 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30477 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30478 ...
30479 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30480 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30481 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30482 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30483 (gdb)
30484 @end smallexample
30485
30486 Where:
30487
30488 @table @code
30489 @item explicit-variables
30490 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30491 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30492 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30493 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30494 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30495 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30496 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30497 arrays, structures and unions.
30498
30499 @item computed-expressions
30500 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30501 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30502 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30503 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30504
30505 @item registers
30506 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30507 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30508 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30509 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30510 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30511
30512 @item tvars
30513 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30514 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30515 current value are returned.
30516
30517 @item memory
30518 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30519 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30520 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30521
30522 @table @code
30523 @item address
30524 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30525
30526 @item length
30527 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30528
30529 @item contents
30530 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30531 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30532
30533 @end table
30534
30535 @end table
30536
30537 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30538
30539 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30540
30541 @subsubheading Example
30542
30543 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30544 @findex -trace-list-variables
30545
30546 @subsubheading Synopsis
30547
30548 @smallexample
30549 -trace-list-variables
30550 @end smallexample
30551
30552 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30553 table has the following fields:
30554
30555 @table @samp
30556 @item name
30557 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30558
30559 @item initial
30560 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30561 field is always present.
30562
30563 @item current
30564 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30565 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30566 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30567 presently running.
30568
30569 @end table
30570
30571 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30572
30573 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30574
30575 @subsubheading Example
30576
30577 @smallexample
30578 (gdb)
30579 -trace-list-variables
30580 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30581 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30582 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30583 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30584 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30585 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30586 (gdb)
30587 @end smallexample
30588
30589 @subheading -trace-save
30590 @findex -trace-save
30591
30592 @subsubheading Synopsis
30593
30594 @smallexample
30595 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
30596 @end smallexample
30597
30598 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30599 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30600 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30601 to perform the save.
30602
30603 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30604
30605 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30606
30607
30608 @subheading -trace-start
30609 @findex -trace-start
30610
30611 @subsubheading Synopsis
30612
30613 @smallexample
30614 -trace-start
30615 @end smallexample
30616
30617 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
30618 have any fields.
30619
30620 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30621
30622 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30623
30624 @subheading -trace-status
30625 @findex -trace-status
30626
30627 @subsubheading Synopsis
30628
30629 @smallexample
30630 -trace-status
30631 @end smallexample
30632
30633 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30634 the following fields:
30635
30636 @table @samp
30637
30638 @item supported
30639 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30640 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30641 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30642 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30643 started. This field is always present.
30644
30645 @item running
30646 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30647 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30648 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30649
30650 @item stop-reason
30651 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30652 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30653 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30654 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
30655 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30656 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30657 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30658 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30659 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30660
30661 @item stopping-tracepoint
30662 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
30663 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30664 @samp{passcount}.
30665
30666 @item frames
30667 @itemx frames-created
30668 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30669 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30670 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30671 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
30672
30673 @item buffer-size
30674 @itemx buffer-free
30675 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30676 remaining space. These fields are optional.
30677
30678 @item circular
30679 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
30680 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30681 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30682 and may fill up.
30683
30684 @item disconnected
30685 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
30686 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
30687 that the trace run will stop.
30688
30689 @item trace-file
30690 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
30691 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
30692
30693 @end table
30694
30695 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30696
30697 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
30698
30699 @subheading -trace-stop
30700 @findex -trace-stop
30701
30702 @subsubheading Synopsis
30703
30704 @smallexample
30705 -trace-stop
30706 @end smallexample
30707
30708 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
30709 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
30710 @samp{running} fields are not output.
30711
30712 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30713
30714 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
30715
30716
30717 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30718 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
30719 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
30720
30721
30722 @ignore
30723 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
30724 @findex -symbol-info-address
30725
30726 @subsubheading Synopsis
30727
30728 @smallexample
30729 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
30730 @end smallexample
30731
30732 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
30733
30734 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30735
30736 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
30737
30738 @subsubheading Example
30739 N.A.
30740
30741
30742 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
30743 @findex -symbol-info-file
30744
30745 @subsubheading Synopsis
30746
30747 @smallexample
30748 -symbol-info-file
30749 @end smallexample
30750
30751 Show the file for the symbol.
30752
30753 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30754
30755 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
30756 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
30757
30758 @subsubheading Example
30759 N.A.
30760
30761
30762 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
30763 @findex -symbol-info-function
30764
30765 @subsubheading Synopsis
30766
30767 @smallexample
30768 -symbol-info-function
30769 @end smallexample
30770
30771 Show which function the symbol lives in.
30772
30773 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30774
30775 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
30776
30777 @subsubheading Example
30778 N.A.
30779
30780
30781 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
30782 @findex -symbol-info-line
30783
30784 @subsubheading Synopsis
30785
30786 @smallexample
30787 -symbol-info-line
30788 @end smallexample
30789
30790 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
30791
30792 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30793
30794 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
30795 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
30796
30797 @subsubheading Example
30798 N.A.
30799
30800
30801 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
30802 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
30803
30804 @subsubheading Synopsis
30805
30806 @smallexample
30807 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
30808 @end smallexample
30809
30810 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
30811
30812 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30813
30814 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
30815
30816 @subsubheading Example
30817 N.A.
30818
30819
30820 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
30821 @findex -symbol-list-functions
30822
30823 @subsubheading Synopsis
30824
30825 @smallexample
30826 -symbol-list-functions
30827 @end smallexample
30828
30829 List the functions in the executable.
30830
30831 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30832
30833 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
30834 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30835
30836 @subsubheading Example
30837 N.A.
30838 @end ignore
30839
30840
30841 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
30842 @findex -symbol-list-lines
30843
30844 @subsubheading Synopsis
30845
30846 @smallexample
30847 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
30848 @end smallexample
30849
30850 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
30851 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
30852 ascending PC order.
30853
30854 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30855
30856 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30857
30858 @subsubheading Example
30859 @smallexample
30860 (gdb)
30861 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
30862 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
30863 (gdb)
30864 @end smallexample
30865
30866
30867 @ignore
30868 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
30869 @findex -symbol-list-types
30870
30871 @subsubheading Synopsis
30872
30873 @smallexample
30874 -symbol-list-types
30875 @end smallexample
30876
30877 List all the type names.
30878
30879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30880
30881 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30882 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30883
30884 @subsubheading Example
30885 N.A.
30886
30887
30888 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30889 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30890
30891 @subsubheading Synopsis
30892
30893 @smallexample
30894 -symbol-list-variables
30895 @end smallexample
30896
30897 List all the global and static variable names.
30898
30899 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30900
30901 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30902
30903 @subsubheading Example
30904 N.A.
30905
30906
30907 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30908 @findex -symbol-locate
30909
30910 @subsubheading Synopsis
30911
30912 @smallexample
30913 -symbol-locate
30914 @end smallexample
30915
30916 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30917
30918 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30919
30920 @subsubheading Example
30921 N.A.
30922
30923
30924 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30925 @findex -symbol-type
30926
30927 @subsubheading Synopsis
30928
30929 @smallexample
30930 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30931 @end smallexample
30932
30933 Show type of @var{variable}.
30934
30935 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30936
30937 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30938 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30939
30940 @subsubheading Example
30941 N.A.
30942 @end ignore
30943
30944
30945 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30946 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30947 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30948
30949 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30950 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30951
30952 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30953 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30954
30955 @subsubheading Synopsis
30956
30957 @smallexample
30958 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30959 @end smallexample
30960
30961 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30962 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30963 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30964 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30965 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30966 notification.
30967
30968 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30969
30970 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30971
30972 @subsubheading Example
30973
30974 @smallexample
30975 (gdb)
30976 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30977 ^done
30978 (gdb)
30979 @end smallexample
30980
30981
30982 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30983 @findex -file-exec-file
30984
30985 @subsubheading Synopsis
30986
30987 @smallexample
30988 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30989 @end smallexample
30990
30991 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30992 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30993 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30994 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30995 notification.
30996
30997 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30998
30999 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31000
31001 @subsubheading Example
31002
31003 @smallexample
31004 (gdb)
31005 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31006 ^done
31007 (gdb)
31008 @end smallexample
31009
31010
31011 @ignore
31012 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31013 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31014
31015 @subsubheading Synopsis
31016
31017 @smallexample
31018 -file-list-exec-sections
31019 @end smallexample
31020
31021 List the sections of the current executable file.
31022
31023 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31024
31025 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31026 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31027 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31028
31029 @subsubheading Example
31030 N.A.
31031 @end ignore
31032
31033
31034 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31035 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31036
31037 @subsubheading Synopsis
31038
31039 @smallexample
31040 -file-list-exec-source-file
31041 @end smallexample
31042
31043 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31044 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31045 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31046 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31047
31048 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31049
31050 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31051
31052 @subsubheading Example
31053
31054 @smallexample
31055 (gdb)
31056 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31057 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31058 (gdb)
31059 @end smallexample
31060
31061
31062 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31063 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31064
31065 @subsubheading Synopsis
31066
31067 @smallexample
31068 -file-list-exec-source-files
31069 @end smallexample
31070
31071 List the source files for the current executable.
31072
31073 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31074 name) of a source file.
31075
31076 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31077
31078 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31079 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31080
31081 @subsubheading Example
31082 @smallexample
31083 (gdb)
31084 -file-list-exec-source-files
31085 ^done,files=[
31086 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31087 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31088 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31089 (gdb)
31090 @end smallexample
31091
31092 @ignore
31093 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31094 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31095
31096 @subsubheading Synopsis
31097
31098 @smallexample
31099 -file-list-shared-libraries
31100 @end smallexample
31101
31102 List the shared libraries in the program.
31103
31104 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31105
31106 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
31107
31108 @subsubheading Example
31109 N.A.
31110
31111
31112 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31113 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31114
31115 @subsubheading Synopsis
31116
31117 @smallexample
31118 -file-list-symbol-files
31119 @end smallexample
31120
31121 List symbol files.
31122
31123 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31124
31125 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31126
31127 @subsubheading Example
31128 N.A.
31129 @end ignore
31130
31131
31132 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31133 @findex -file-symbol-file
31134
31135 @subsubheading Synopsis
31136
31137 @smallexample
31138 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31139 @end smallexample
31140
31141 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31142 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31143 produced, except for a completion notification.
31144
31145 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31146
31147 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31148
31149 @subsubheading Example
31150
31151 @smallexample
31152 (gdb)
31153 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31154 ^done
31155 (gdb)
31156 @end smallexample
31157
31158 @ignore
31159 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31160 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31161 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31162
31163 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31164
31165 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31166
31167 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31168
31169 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31170
31171 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31172
31173 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31174
31175 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31176
31177 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31178
31179 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31180 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31181 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31182
31183 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31184
31185 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31186
31187 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31188
31189 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31190 @end ignore
31191
31192
31193 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31194 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31195 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31196
31197
31198 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31199 @findex -target-attach
31200
31201 @subsubheading Synopsis
31202
31203 @smallexample
31204 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31205 @end smallexample
31206
31207 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31208 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31209 group, the id previously returned by
31210 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31211
31212 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31213
31214 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31215
31216 @subsubheading Example
31217 @smallexample
31218 (gdb)
31219 -target-attach 34
31220 =thread-created,id="1"
31221 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31222 ^done
31223 (gdb)
31224 @end smallexample
31225
31226 @ignore
31227 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31228 @findex -target-compare-sections
31229
31230 @subsubheading Synopsis
31231
31232 @smallexample
31233 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31234 @end smallexample
31235
31236 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31237 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31238
31239 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31240
31241 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31242
31243 @subsubheading Example
31244 N.A.
31245 @end ignore
31246
31247
31248 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31249 @findex -target-detach
31250
31251 @subsubheading Synopsis
31252
31253 @smallexample
31254 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31255 @end smallexample
31256
31257 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31258 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31259 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31260
31261 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31262
31263 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31264
31265 @subsubheading Example
31266
31267 @smallexample
31268 (gdb)
31269 -target-detach
31270 ^done
31271 (gdb)
31272 @end smallexample
31273
31274
31275 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31276 @findex -target-disconnect
31277
31278 @subsubheading Synopsis
31279
31280 @smallexample
31281 -target-disconnect
31282 @end smallexample
31283
31284 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31285 generally not resumed.
31286
31287 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31288
31289 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31290
31291 @subsubheading Example
31292
31293 @smallexample
31294 (gdb)
31295 -target-disconnect
31296 ^done
31297 (gdb)
31298 @end smallexample
31299
31300
31301 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31302 @findex -target-download
31303
31304 @subsubheading Synopsis
31305
31306 @smallexample
31307 -target-download
31308 @end smallexample
31309
31310 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31311 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31312
31313 @table @samp
31314 @item section
31315 The name of the section.
31316 @item section-sent
31317 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31318 @item section-size
31319 The size of the section.
31320 @item total-sent
31321 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31322 @item total-size
31323 The size of the overall executable to download.
31324 @end table
31325
31326 @noindent
31327 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31328 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31329
31330 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31331 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31332
31333 @table @samp
31334 @item section
31335 The name of the section.
31336 @item section-size
31337 The size of the section.
31338 @item total-size
31339 The size of the overall executable to download.
31340 @end table
31341
31342 @noindent
31343 At the end, a summary is printed.
31344
31345 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31346
31347 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31348
31349 @subsubheading Example
31350
31351 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31352 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31353
31354 @smallexample
31355 (gdb)
31356 -target-download
31357 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31358 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31359 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31360 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31361 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31362 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31363 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31364 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31365 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31366 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31367 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31368 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31369 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31370 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31371 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31372 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31373 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31374 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31375 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31376 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31377 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31378 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31379 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31380 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31381 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31382 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31383 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31384 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31385 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31386 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31387 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31388 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31389 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31390 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31391 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31392 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31393 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31394 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31395 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31396 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31397 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31398 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31399 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31400 write-rate="429"
31401 (gdb)
31402 @end smallexample
31403
31404
31405 @ignore
31406 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31407 @findex -target-exec-status
31408
31409 @subsubheading Synopsis
31410
31411 @smallexample
31412 -target-exec-status
31413 @end smallexample
31414
31415 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31416 not, for instance).
31417
31418 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31419
31420 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31421
31422 @subsubheading Example
31423 N.A.
31424
31425
31426 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31427 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31428
31429 @subsubheading Synopsis
31430
31431 @smallexample
31432 -target-list-available-targets
31433 @end smallexample
31434
31435 List the possible targets to connect to.
31436
31437 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31438
31439 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31440
31441 @subsubheading Example
31442 N.A.
31443
31444
31445 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31446 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31447
31448 @subsubheading Synopsis
31449
31450 @smallexample
31451 -target-list-current-targets
31452 @end smallexample
31453
31454 Describe the current target.
31455
31456 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31457
31458 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31459 other things).
31460
31461 @subsubheading Example
31462 N.A.
31463
31464
31465 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31466 @findex -target-list-parameters
31467
31468 @subsubheading Synopsis
31469
31470 @smallexample
31471 -target-list-parameters
31472 @end smallexample
31473
31474 @c ????
31475 @end ignore
31476
31477 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31478
31479 No equivalent.
31480
31481 @subsubheading Example
31482 N.A.
31483
31484
31485 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31486 @findex -target-select
31487
31488 @subsubheading Synopsis
31489
31490 @smallexample
31491 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31492 @end smallexample
31493
31494 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31495
31496 @table @samp
31497 @item @var{type}
31498 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31499 @item @var{parameters}
31500 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31501 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31502 @end table
31503
31504 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31505 which the target program is, in the following form:
31506
31507 @smallexample
31508 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31509 args=[@var{arg list}]
31510 @end smallexample
31511
31512 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31513
31514 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31515
31516 @subsubheading Example
31517
31518 @smallexample
31519 (gdb)
31520 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31521 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31522 (gdb)
31523 @end smallexample
31524
31525 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31526 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31527 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31528
31529
31530 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31531 @findex -target-file-put
31532
31533 @subsubheading Synopsis
31534
31535 @smallexample
31536 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31537 @end smallexample
31538
31539 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31540 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31541
31542 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31543
31544 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31545
31546 @subsubheading Example
31547
31548 @smallexample
31549 (gdb)
31550 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31551 ^done
31552 (gdb)
31553 @end smallexample
31554
31555
31556 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31557 @findex -target-file-get
31558
31559 @subsubheading Synopsis
31560
31561 @smallexample
31562 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31563 @end smallexample
31564
31565 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31566 on the host system.
31567
31568 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31569
31570 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31571
31572 @subsubheading Example
31573
31574 @smallexample
31575 (gdb)
31576 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31577 ^done
31578 (gdb)
31579 @end smallexample
31580
31581
31582 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31583 @findex -target-file-delete
31584
31585 @subsubheading Synopsis
31586
31587 @smallexample
31588 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31589 @end smallexample
31590
31591 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31592
31593 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31594
31595 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31596
31597 @subsubheading Example
31598
31599 @smallexample
31600 (gdb)
31601 -target-file-delete remotefile
31602 ^done
31603 (gdb)
31604 @end smallexample
31605
31606
31607 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31608 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31609 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31610
31611 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31612 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31613
31614 @subsubheading Synopsis
31615
31616 @smallexample
31617 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31618 @end smallexample
31619
31620 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31621 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31622 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31623
31624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31625
31626 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31627
31628 @subsubheading Result
31629
31630 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
31631 defined for each exception:
31632
31633 @table @samp
31634 @item name
31635 The name of the exception.
31636
31637 @item address
31638 The address of the exception.
31639
31640 @end table
31641
31642 @subsubheading Example
31643
31644 @smallexample
31645 -info-ada-exceptions aint
31646 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31647 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31648 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31649 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31650 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31651 @end smallexample
31652
31653 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
31654
31655 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
31656 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
31657 Catchpoint Commands}.
31658
31659
31660 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31661 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
31662 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
31663
31664 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
31665 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
31666 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
31667 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
31668
31669 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
31670 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
31671 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
31672
31673 @subsubheading Synopsis
31674
31675 @smallexample
31676 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
31677 @end smallexample
31678
31679 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
31680
31681 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
31682 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
31683 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
31684 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
31685 dash.
31686
31687 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31688
31689 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31690
31691 @subsubheading Result
31692
31693 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
31694
31695 @table @samp
31696 @item exists
31697 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
31698 @code{"false"} otherwise.
31699
31700 @end table
31701
31702 @subsubheading Example
31703
31704 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
31705
31706 @smallexample
31707 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
31708 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
31709 @end smallexample
31710
31711 @noindent
31712 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
31713 to the debugger:
31714
31715 @smallexample
31716 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
31717 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
31718 @end smallexample
31719
31720 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31721 @findex -list-features
31722 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
31723
31724 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31725 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31726 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31727 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31728 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31729 startup.
31730
31731 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31732 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31733 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31734 is given below.
31735
31736 Example output:
31737
31738 @smallexample
31739 (gdb) -list-features
31740 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
31741 @end smallexample
31742
31743 The current list of features is:
31744
31745 @ftable @samp
31746 @item frozen-varobjs
31747 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
31748 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
31749 of @code{-varobj-create}.
31750 @item pending-breakpoints
31751 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
31752 command.
31753 @item python
31754 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
31755 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
31756 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
31757 @item thread-info
31758 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
31759 @item data-read-memory-bytes
31760 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
31761 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
31762 @item breakpoint-notifications
31763 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
31764 CLI will be announced via async records.
31765 @item ada-task-info
31766 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
31767 @item language-option
31768 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
31769 option (@pxref{Context management}).
31770 @item info-gdb-mi-command
31771 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
31772 @item undefined-command-error-code
31773 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
31774 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
31775 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
31776 @item exec-run-start-option
31777 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
31778 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
31779 @end ftable
31780
31781 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
31782 @findex -list-target-features
31783
31784 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
31785 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
31786 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
31787 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
31788 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
31789 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
31790 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
31791 Example output:
31792
31793 @smallexample
31794 (gdb) -list-target-features
31795 ^done,result=["async"]
31796 @end smallexample
31797
31798 The current list of features is:
31799
31800 @table @samp
31801 @item async
31802 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
31803 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
31804 while the target is running.
31805
31806 @item reverse
31807 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
31808 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31809
31810 @end table
31811
31812 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31813 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
31814 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31815
31816 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
31817
31818 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
31819 @findex -gdb-exit
31820
31821 @subsubheading Synopsis
31822
31823 @smallexample
31824 -gdb-exit
31825 @end smallexample
31826
31827 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
31828
31829 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31830
31831 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
31832
31833 @subsubheading Example
31834
31835 @smallexample
31836 (gdb)
31837 -gdb-exit
31838 ^exit
31839 @end smallexample
31840
31841
31842 @ignore
31843 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
31844 @findex -exec-abort
31845
31846 @subsubheading Synopsis
31847
31848 @smallexample
31849 -exec-abort
31850 @end smallexample
31851
31852 Kill the inferior running program.
31853
31854 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31855
31856 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
31857
31858 @subsubheading Example
31859 N.A.
31860 @end ignore
31861
31862
31863 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
31864 @findex -gdb-set
31865
31866 @subsubheading Synopsis
31867
31868 @smallexample
31869 -gdb-set
31870 @end smallexample
31871
31872 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
31873 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
31874
31875 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31876
31877 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
31878
31879 @subsubheading Example
31880
31881 @smallexample
31882 (gdb)
31883 -gdb-set $foo=3
31884 ^done
31885 (gdb)
31886 @end smallexample
31887
31888
31889 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31890 @findex -gdb-show
31891
31892 @subsubheading Synopsis
31893
31894 @smallexample
31895 -gdb-show
31896 @end smallexample
31897
31898 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31899
31900 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31901
31902 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31903
31904 @subsubheading Example
31905
31906 @smallexample
31907 (gdb)
31908 -gdb-show annotate
31909 ^done,value="0"
31910 (gdb)
31911 @end smallexample
31912
31913 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31914
31915
31916 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31917 @findex -gdb-version
31918
31919 @subsubheading Synopsis
31920
31921 @smallexample
31922 -gdb-version
31923 @end smallexample
31924
31925 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31926
31927 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31928
31929 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31930 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31931
31932 @subsubheading Example
31933
31934 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31935 @c box in TeX.
31936 @smallexample
31937 (gdb)
31938 -gdb-version
31939 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31940 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31941 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31942 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31943 ~ certain conditions.
31944 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31945 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31946 ~ details.
31947 ~This GDB was configured as
31948 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31949 ^done
31950 (gdb)
31951 @end smallexample
31952
31953 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31954 @findex -list-thread-groups
31955
31956 @subheading Synopsis
31957
31958 @smallexample
31959 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31960 @end smallexample
31961
31962 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31963 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31964 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31965 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31966 top-level thread groups.
31967
31968 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31969 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31970 available on the target.
31971
31972 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31973 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31974 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31975 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31976 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31977 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31978 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31979 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31980
31981 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31982 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31983 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31984 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31985 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31986 @samp{threads} field.
31987
31988 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31989 the following caveats:
31990
31991 @itemize @bullet
31992 @item
31993 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31994 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31995 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31996
31997 @item
31998 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31999 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32000 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32001 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32002 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32003 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32004
32005 @end itemize
32006
32007 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32008 have the following fields:
32009
32010 @table @code
32011 @item id
32012 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32013 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32014 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32015
32016 @item type
32017 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32018 valid type.
32019
32020 @item pid
32021 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32022 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32023
32024 @item exit-code
32025 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32026 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32027 only if the process is not running.
32028
32029 @item num_children
32030 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32031 absent for an available thread group.
32032
32033 @item threads
32034 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32035 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32036 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32037
32038 @item cores
32039 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32040 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32041 such information is not available.
32042
32043 @item executable
32044 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32045 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32046 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32047
32048 @end table
32049
32050 @subheading Example
32051
32052 @smallexample
32053 @value{GDBP}
32054 -list-thread-groups
32055 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32056 -list-thread-groups 17
32057 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32058 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32059 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32060 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32061 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32062 -list-thread-groups --available
32063 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32064 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32065 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32066 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32067 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32068 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32069 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32070 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32071 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32072 @end smallexample
32073
32074 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32075 @findex -info-os
32076
32077 @subsubheading Synopsis
32078
32079 @smallexample
32080 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32081 @end smallexample
32082
32083 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32084 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32085 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32086 of data of that type.
32087
32088 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32089 system.
32090
32091 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32092
32093 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32094
32095 @subsubheading Example
32096
32097 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32098 like this:
32099
32100 @smallexample
32101 @value{GDBP}
32102 -info-os
32103 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32104 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32105 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32106 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32107 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32108 col2="CPUs"@},
32109 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32110 col2="File descriptors"@},
32111 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32112 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32113 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32114 col2="Message queues"@},
32115 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32116 col2="Processes"@},
32117 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32118 col2="Process groups"@},
32119 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32120 col2="Semaphores"@},
32121 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32122 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32123 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32124 col2="Sockets"@},
32125 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32126 col2="Threads"@}]
32127 @value{GDBP}
32128 -info-os processes
32129 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32130 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32131 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32132 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32133 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32134 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32135 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32136 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32137 ...
32138 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32139 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32140 (gdb)
32141 @end smallexample
32142
32143 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32144 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32145 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32146 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32147 @code{info os} omits it.)
32148
32149 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32150 @findex -add-inferior
32151
32152 @subheading Synopsis
32153
32154 @smallexample
32155 -add-inferior
32156 @end smallexample
32157
32158 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32159 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32160 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32161 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32162 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32163 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32164
32165 @subheading Example
32166
32167 @smallexample
32168 @value{GDBP}
32169 -add-inferior
32170 ^done,inferior="i3"
32171 @end smallexample
32172
32173 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32174 @findex -interpreter-exec
32175
32176 @subheading Synopsis
32177
32178 @smallexample
32179 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32180 @end smallexample
32181 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32182
32183 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32184
32185 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32186
32187 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32188
32189 @subheading Example
32190
32191 @smallexample
32192 (gdb)
32193 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32194 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32195 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32196 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32197 ^done
32198 (gdb)
32199 @end smallexample
32200
32201 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32202 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32203
32204 @subheading Synopsis
32205
32206 @smallexample
32207 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32208 @end smallexample
32209
32210 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32211
32212 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32213
32214 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32215
32216 @subheading Example
32217
32218 @smallexample
32219 (gdb)
32220 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32221 ^done
32222 (gdb)
32223 @end smallexample
32224
32225 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32226 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32227
32228 @subheading Synopsis
32229
32230 @smallexample
32231 -inferior-tty-show
32232 @end smallexample
32233
32234 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32235
32236 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32237
32238 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32239
32240 @subheading Example
32241
32242 @smallexample
32243 (gdb)
32244 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32245 ^done
32246 (gdb)
32247 -inferior-tty-show
32248 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32249 (gdb)
32250 @end smallexample
32251
32252 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32253 @findex -enable-timings
32254
32255 @subheading Synopsis
32256
32257 @smallexample
32258 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32259 @end smallexample
32260
32261 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32262 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32263 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32264 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32265
32266 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32267
32268 No equivalent.
32269
32270 @subheading Example
32271
32272 @smallexample
32273 (gdb)
32274 -enable-timings
32275 ^done
32276 (gdb)
32277 -break-insert main
32278 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32279 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32280 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32281 times="0"@},
32282 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32283 (gdb)
32284 -enable-timings no
32285 ^done
32286 (gdb)
32287 -exec-run
32288 ^running
32289 (gdb)
32290 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32291 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32292 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32293 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32294 (gdb)
32295 @end smallexample
32296
32297 @node Annotations
32298 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32299
32300 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32301 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32302 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32303 relatively high level.
32304
32305 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32306 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32307
32308 @ignore
32309 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32310 @end ignore
32311
32312 @menu
32313 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32314 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32315 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32316 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32317 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32318 * Annotations for Running::
32319 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32320 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32321 @end menu
32322
32323 @node Annotations Overview
32324 @section What is an Annotation?
32325 @cindex annotations
32326
32327 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32328 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32329 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32330 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32331 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32332 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32333 cannot contain newline characters.
32334
32335 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32336 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32337 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32338 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32339 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32340 means those three characters as output.
32341
32342 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32343 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32344 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32345 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32346 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32347 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32348 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32349 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32350 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32351
32352 @table @code
32353 @kindex set annotate
32354 @item set annotate @var{level}
32355 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32356 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32357
32358 @item show annotate
32359 @kindex show annotate
32360 Show the current annotation level.
32361 @end table
32362
32363 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32364
32365 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32366
32367 @smallexample
32368 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32369 GNU gdb 6.0
32370 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32371 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32372 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32373 under certain conditions.
32374 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32375 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32376 for details.
32377 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32378
32379 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32380 (@value{GDBP})
32381 ^Z^Zprompt
32382 @kbd{quit}
32383
32384 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32385 $
32386 @end smallexample
32387
32388 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32389 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32390 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32391 output from @value{GDBN}.
32392
32393 @node Server Prefix
32394 @section The Server Prefix
32395 @cindex server prefix
32396
32397 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32398 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32399 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32400 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32401 a transparent manner.
32402
32403 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32404 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32405 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32406 @code{print} command.
32407
32408 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32409 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32410
32411 @node Prompting
32412 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32413
32414 @cindex annotations for prompts
32415 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32416 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32417 over, etc.
32418
32419 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32420 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32421 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32422 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32423 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32424 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32425 features the following annotations:
32426
32427 @smallexample
32428 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32429 ^Z^Zprompt
32430 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32431 @end smallexample
32432
32433 The input types are
32434
32435 @table @code
32436 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32437 @findex prompt annotation
32438 @findex post-prompt annotation
32439 @item prompt
32440 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32441
32442 @findex pre-commands annotation
32443 @findex commands annotation
32444 @findex post-commands annotation
32445 @item commands
32446 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32447 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32448
32449 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32450 @findex overload-choice annotation
32451 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32452 @item overload-choice
32453 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32454
32455 @findex pre-query annotation
32456 @findex query annotation
32457 @findex post-query annotation
32458 @item query
32459 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32460
32461 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32462 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32463 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32464 @item prompt-for-continue
32465 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32466 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32467 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32468 presence of annotations.
32469 @end table
32470
32471 @node Errors
32472 @section Errors
32473 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32474
32475 @findex quit annotation
32476 @smallexample
32477 ^Z^Zquit
32478 @end smallexample
32479
32480 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32481
32482 @findex error annotation
32483 @smallexample
32484 ^Z^Zerror
32485 @end smallexample
32486
32487 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32488
32489 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32490 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32491 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32492 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32493 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32494 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32495 to the top level.
32496
32497 @findex error-begin annotation
32498 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32499
32500 @smallexample
32501 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32502 @end smallexample
32503
32504 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32505 message.
32506
32507 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32508 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32509 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32510
32511 @node Invalidation
32512 @section Invalidation Notices
32513
32514 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32515 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32516 changed.
32517
32518 @table @code
32519 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32520 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32521
32522 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32523 have changed.
32524
32525 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32526 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32527
32528 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32529 deleted a breakpoint.
32530 @end table
32531
32532 @node Annotations for Running
32533 @section Running the Program
32534 @cindex annotations for running programs
32535
32536 @findex starting annotation
32537 @findex stopping annotation
32538 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32539 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32540
32541 @smallexample
32542 ^Z^Zstarting
32543 @end smallexample
32544
32545 is output. When the program stops,
32546
32547 @smallexample
32548 ^Z^Zstopped
32549 @end smallexample
32550
32551 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32552 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32553
32554 @table @code
32555 @findex exited annotation
32556 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32557 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32558 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32559
32560 @findex signalled annotation
32561 @findex signal-name annotation
32562 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32563 @findex signal-string annotation
32564 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32565 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32566 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32567 annotation continues:
32568
32569 @smallexample
32570 @var{intro-text}
32571 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32572 @var{name}
32573 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32574 @var{middle-text}
32575 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32576 @var{string}
32577 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32578 @var{end-text}
32579 @end smallexample
32580
32581 @noindent
32582 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32583 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32584 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32585 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32586 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32587
32588 @findex signal annotation
32589 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32590 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32591 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32592 terminated with it.
32593
32594 @findex breakpoint annotation
32595 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32596 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32597
32598 @findex watchpoint annotation
32599 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32600 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32601 @end table
32602
32603 @node Source Annotations
32604 @section Displaying Source
32605 @cindex annotations for source display
32606
32607 @findex source annotation
32608 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32609
32610 @smallexample
32611 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32612 @end smallexample
32613
32614 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32615 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32616 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32617 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32618 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32619 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32620 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32621 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32622 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32623 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32624 depend on the language).
32625
32626 @node JIT Interface
32627 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32628 @cindex just-in-time compilation
32629 @cindex JIT compilation interface
32630
32631 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32632 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32633 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32634 performance while maintaining platform independence.
32635
32636 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32637 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32638 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32639 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32640 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32641 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32642
32643 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32644 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
32645 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32646 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32647 LLVM JIT.
32648
32649 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
32650 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32651 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
32652 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32653 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
32654 out about additional code.
32655
32656 @menu
32657 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
32658 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
32659 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
32660 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
32661 @end menu
32662
32663 @node Declarations
32664 @section JIT Declarations
32665
32666 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
32667 implement the interface:
32668
32669 @smallexample
32670 typedef enum
32671 @{
32672 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
32673 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
32674 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
32675 @} jit_actions_t;
32676
32677 struct jit_code_entry
32678 @{
32679 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
32680 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
32681 const char *symfile_addr;
32682 uint64_t symfile_size;
32683 @};
32684
32685 struct jit_descriptor
32686 @{
32687 uint32_t version;
32688 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
32689 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
32690 uint32_t action_flag;
32691 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
32692 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
32693 @};
32694
32695 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
32696 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
32697
32698 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
32699 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
32700 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
32701 @end smallexample
32702
32703 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
32704 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
32705 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
32706
32707 @node Registering Code
32708 @section Registering Code
32709
32710 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
32711
32712 @itemize @bullet
32713 @item
32714 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
32715 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
32716
32717 @item
32718 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
32719 file.
32720
32721 @item
32722 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
32723
32724 @item
32725 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
32726
32727 @item
32728 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
32729 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32730 @end itemize
32731
32732 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
32733 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
32734 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
32735 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
32736
32737 @node Unregistering Code
32738 @section Unregistering Code
32739
32740 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
32741
32742 @itemize @bullet
32743 @item
32744 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
32745
32746 @item
32747 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
32748
32749 @item
32750 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
32751 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32752 @end itemize
32753
32754 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
32755 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
32756
32757 @node Custom Debug Info
32758 @section Custom Debug Info
32759 @cindex custom JIT debug info
32760 @cindex JIT debug info reader
32761
32762 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
32763 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
32764 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
32765 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
32766 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
32767 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
32768 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
32769 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
32770 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
32771
32772 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
32773 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
32774 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
32775 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
32776 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
32777 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
32778 compiler.
32779
32780 @menu
32781 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
32782 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
32783 @end menu
32784
32785 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32786 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32787 @kindex jit-reader-load
32788 @kindex jit-reader-unload
32789
32790 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
32791 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
32792
32793 @table @code
32794 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
32795 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
32796 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
32797 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
32798 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
32799 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
32800 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
32801
32802 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
32803 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
32804 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
32805 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
32806 @code{jit-reader-load}.
32807
32808 @item jit-reader-unload
32809 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
32810
32811 @end table
32812
32813 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32814 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32815 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
32816
32817 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
32818 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
32819
32820 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
32821 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
32822 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
32823 the system include directory.
32824
32825 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
32826 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
32827 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
32828
32829 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
32830 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
32831
32832 @findex gdb_init_reader
32833 @smallexample
32834 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
32835 @end smallexample
32836
32837 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
32838
32839 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
32840 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
32841 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
32842 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
32843 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
32844 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
32845
32846 @smallexample
32847 struct gdb_reader_funcs
32848 @{
32849 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
32850 int reader_version;
32851
32852 /* For use by the reader. */
32853 void *priv_data;
32854
32855 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
32856 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
32857 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
32858 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
32859 @};
32860 @end smallexample
32861
32862 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
32863 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
32864
32865 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
32866 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
32867 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
32868 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
32869 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
32870 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
32871 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
32872 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
32873 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
32874 target's address space.
32875
32876 @node In-Process Agent
32877 @chapter In-Process Agent
32878 @cindex debugging agent
32879 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
32880 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
32881 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
32882 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
32883 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
32884 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
32885 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
32886 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
32887 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
32888 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
32889 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
32890 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
32891 behavior without interrupting it.
32892
32893 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
32894 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32895 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32896 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32897 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32898 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32899 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32900 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32901 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32902
32903 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32904 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32905 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32906 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32907
32908 @anchor{Control Agent}
32909 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32910 debugging with the following commands:
32911
32912 @table @code
32913 @kindex set agent on
32914 @item set agent on
32915 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32916 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32917 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32918 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32919 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
32920 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
32921
32922 @kindex set agent off
32923 @item set agent off
32924 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
32925 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
32926
32927 @kindex show agent
32928 @item show agent
32929 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
32930 the in-process agent.
32931 @end table
32932
32933 @menu
32934 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
32935 @end menu
32936
32937 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
32938 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
32939 @cindex in-process agent protocol
32940
32941 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
32942 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
32943 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
32944 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
32945 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
32946 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
32947 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
32948 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
32949 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
32950
32951 @menu
32952 * IPA Protocol Objects::
32953 * IPA Protocol Commands::
32954 @end menu
32955
32956 @node IPA Protocol Objects
32957 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
32958 @cindex ipa protocol objects
32959
32960 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
32961 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
32962
32963 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
32964 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
32965 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
32966 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
32967
32968 @enumerate
32969 @item
32970 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
32971 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
32972 @item
32973 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
32974 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
32975 the other one.
32976 @end enumerate
32977
32978 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
32979
32980 @enumerate
32981 @item
32982 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
32983 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
32984 @anchor{agent expression object}
32985 @item
32986 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
32987 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
32988 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
32989 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
32990 @item
32991 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32992 @anchor{tracepoint object}
32993
32994 @end enumerate
32995
32996 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
32997 object:
32998
32999 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33000 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33001 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33002 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33003 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33004 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33005 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33006 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33007 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33008 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33009 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33010 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33011 memory address for collecting.
33012 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33013 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33014 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33015 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33016 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33017 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33018 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33019 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33020 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33021 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33022 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33023 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33024 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33025 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33026 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33027 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33028 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33029 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33030 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33031 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33032 @ref{agent expression object}
33033 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33034 @ref{agent expression object}
33035 @item actions @tab variable
33036 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33037 @end multitable
33038
33039 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33040 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33041 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33042
33043 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33044 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33045
33046 @table @samp
33047
33048 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33049 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33050 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33051 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33052 in IPA finally.
33053
33054 Replies:
33055 @table @samp
33056 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33057 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33058 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33059 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33060 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33061 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33062 @item E @var{NN}
33063 for an error
33064
33065 @end table
33066
33067 @item close
33068 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33069 is about to kill inferiors.
33070
33071 @item qTfSTM
33072 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33073 @item qTsSTM
33074 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33075 @item qTSTMat
33076 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33077 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33078 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33079
33080 Replies:
33081 @table @samp
33082 @item E @var{NN}
33083 for an error
33084 @end table
33085 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33086 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33087 @end table
33088
33089 @node GDB Bugs
33090 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33091 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33092 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33093
33094 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33095
33096 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33097 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33098 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33099 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33100
33101 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33102 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33103
33104 @menu
33105 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33106 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33107 @end menu
33108
33109 @node Bug Criteria
33110 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33111 @cindex bug criteria
33112
33113 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33114
33115 @itemize @bullet
33116 @cindex fatal signal
33117 @cindex debugger crash
33118 @cindex crash of debugger
33119 @item
33120 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33121 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33122
33123 @cindex error on valid input
33124 @item
33125 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33126 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33127 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33128
33129 @cindex invalid input
33130 @item
33131 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33132 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33133 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33134 for traditional practice''.
33135
33136 @item
33137 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33138 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33139 @end itemize
33140
33141 @node Bug Reporting
33142 @section How to Report Bugs
33143 @cindex bug reports
33144 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33145
33146 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33147 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33148 contact that organization first.
33149
33150 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33151 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33152 distribution.
33153 @c should add a web page ref...
33154
33155 @ifset BUGURL
33156 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33157 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33158 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33159 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33160 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33161 be used.
33162
33163 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33164 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33165 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33166 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33167
33168 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33169 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33170 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33171 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33172 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33173 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33174 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33175 bug reports to the mailing list.
33176 @end ifset
33177 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33178 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33179 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33180 @end ifclear
33181 @end ifset
33182
33183 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33184 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33185 fact or leave it out, state it!
33186
33187 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33188 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33189 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33190 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33191 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33192 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33193 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33194 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33195 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33196
33197 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33198 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33199 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33200 self-contained.
33201
33202 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33203 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33204 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33205 bugs properly.
33206
33207 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33208
33209 @itemize @bullet
33210 @item
33211 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33212 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33213 version}.
33214
33215 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33216 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33217
33218 @item
33219 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33220 version number.
33221
33222 @item
33223 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33224 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33225 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33226 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33227
33228 @item
33229 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33230 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33231
33232 @item
33233 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33234 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33235 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33236 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33237 those compilers.
33238
33239 @item
33240 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33241 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33242 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33243 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33244
33245 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33246 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33247
33248 @item
33249 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33250 reproduce the bug.
33251
33252 @item
33253 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33254 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33255
33256 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33257 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33258 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33259 a chance to make a mistake.
33260
33261 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33262 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33263 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33264 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33265 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33266 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33267 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33268 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33269
33270 @pindex script
33271 @cindex recording a session script
33272 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33273 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33274 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33275 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33276
33277 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33278 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33279
33280 @item
33281 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33282 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33283 it by context, not by line number.
33284
33285 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33286 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33287
33288 @end itemize
33289
33290 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33291
33292 @itemize @bullet
33293 @item
33294 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33295
33296 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33297 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33298 changes will not affect it.
33299
33300 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33301 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33302 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33303 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33304
33305 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33306 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33307 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33308 less time, and so on.
33309
33310 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33311 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33312
33313 @item
33314 A patch for the bug.
33315
33316 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33317 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33318 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33319 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33320
33321 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33322 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33323 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33324 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33325
33326 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33327 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33328 help us to understand.
33329
33330 @item
33331 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33332
33333 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33334 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33335 @end itemize
33336
33337 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33338 @c and consists of the two following files:
33339 @c rluser.texi
33340 @c hsuser.texi
33341 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33342 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33343 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33344 @include rluser.texi
33345 @include hsuser.texi
33346 @end ifclear
33347
33348 @node In Memoriam
33349 @appendix In Memoriam
33350
33351 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33352 contributors:
33353
33354 @table @code
33355 @item Fred Fish
33356 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33357 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33358 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33359
33360 @item Michael Snyder
33361 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33362 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33363 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33364 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33365 @end table
33366
33367 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33368 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33369
33370 @node Formatting Documentation
33371 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33372
33373 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33374 @cindex reference card
33375 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33376 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33377 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33378 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33379 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33380 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33381
33382 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33383 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33384
33385 @smallexample
33386 make refcard.dvi
33387 @end smallexample
33388
33389 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33390 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33391 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33392 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33393 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33394
33395 @cindex documentation
33396
33397 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33398 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33399 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33400 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33401 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33402 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33403
33404 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33405 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33406 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33407 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33408 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33409 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33410 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33411 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33412
33413 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33414 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33415 @code{makeinfo}.
33416
33417 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33418 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33419 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33420
33421 @smallexample
33422 cd gdb
33423 make gdb.info
33424 @end smallexample
33425
33426 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33427 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33428 Texinfo definitions file.
33429
33430 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33431 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33432 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33433 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33434 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33435 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33436 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33437
33438 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33439 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33440 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33441 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33442 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33443 directory.
33444
33445 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33446 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33447 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33448 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33449
33450 @smallexample
33451 make gdb.dvi
33452 @end smallexample
33453
33454 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33455
33456 @node Installing GDB
33457 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33458 @cindex installation
33459
33460 @menu
33461 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33462 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33463 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33464 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33465 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33466 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33467 @end menu
33468
33469 @node Requirements
33470 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33471 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33472
33473 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33474 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33475
33476 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33477 @table @asis
33478 @item ISO C90 compiler
33479 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33480 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33481
33482 @end table
33483
33484 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33485 @table @asis
33486 @item Expat
33487 @anchor{Expat}
33488 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33489 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33490 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33491 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33492 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33493 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33494
33495 Expat is used for:
33496
33497 @itemize @bullet
33498 @item
33499 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33500 @item
33501 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33502 @item
33503 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33504 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33505 @item
33506 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33507 @item
33508 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33509 @item
33510 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33511 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33512 @end itemize
33513
33514 @item zlib
33515 @cindex compressed debug sections
33516 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33517 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33518 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33519 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33520 information in such binaries.
33521
33522 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33523 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33524 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33525
33526 @item iconv
33527 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33528 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33529 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33530 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33531
33532 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33533 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33534 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33535 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33536
33537 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33538 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33539 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33540
33541 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33542 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33543 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33544 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33545 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33546 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33547 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33548 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33549 @end table
33550
33551 @node Running Configure
33552 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33553 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33554 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33555 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33556 build the @code{gdb} program.
33557 @iftex
33558 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33559 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33560 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33561 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33562 @end iftex
33563
33564 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33565 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33566 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33567
33568 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33569 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33570
33571 @table @code
33572 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33573 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33574
33575 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33576 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33577
33578 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33579 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33580
33581 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33582 @sc{gnu} include files
33583
33584 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33585 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33586
33587 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33588 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33589
33590 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33591 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33592
33593 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33594 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33595
33596 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33597 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33598 @end table
33599
33600 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33601 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33602 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33603
33604 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33605 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33606 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33607 argument.
33608
33609 For example:
33610
33611 @smallexample
33612 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33613 ./configure @var{host}
33614 make
33615 @end smallexample
33616
33617 @noindent
33618 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33619 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33620 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33621 correct value by examining your system.)
33622
33623 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33624 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33625 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33626 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33627
33628 @need 750
33629 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33630 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33631 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33632
33633 @smallexample
33634 sh configure @var{host}
33635 @end smallexample
33636
33637 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33638 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33639 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33640 @file{configure}
33641 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33642 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33643
33644 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33645 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
33646 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33647 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
33648 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33649 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33650 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33651 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
33652 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33653
33654 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
33655 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
33656 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
33657 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
33658 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
33659
33660 @node Separate Objdir
33661 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
33662
33663 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
33664 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
33665 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
33666 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
33667 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
33668 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
33669 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
33670 program specified there.
33671
33672 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
33673 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
33674 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
33675 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
33676 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
33677 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
33678
33679 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
33680 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
33681
33682 @smallexample
33683 @group
33684 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33685 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
33686 cd ../gdb-sun4
33687 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
33688 make
33689 @end group
33690 @end smallexample
33691
33692 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
33693 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
33694 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
33695 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
33696 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
33697 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
33698
33699 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
33700 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
33701 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
33702 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
33703 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33704
33705 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
33706 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
33707 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
33708 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
33709 You specify a cross-debugging target by
33710 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
33711
33712 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
33713 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
33714 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
33715
33716 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
33717 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
33718 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
33719 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
33720 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
33721
33722 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
33723 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
33724 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
33725 with each other.
33726
33727 @node Config Names
33728 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
33729
33730 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
33731 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
33732 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
33733 of information in the following pattern:
33734
33735 @smallexample
33736 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
33737 @end smallexample
33738
33739 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
33740 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
33741 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
33742
33743 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
33744 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
33745 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
33746 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
33747 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
33748 abbreviations---for example:
33749
33750 @smallexample
33751 % sh config.sub i386-linux
33752 i386-pc-linux-gnu
33753 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
33754 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
33755 % sh config.sub hp9k700
33756 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
33757 % sh config.sub sun4
33758 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
33759 % sh config.sub sun3
33760 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
33761 % sh config.sub i986v
33762 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
33763 @end smallexample
33764
33765 @noindent
33766 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
33767 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
33768
33769 @node Configure Options
33770 @section @file{configure} Options
33771
33772 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
33773 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
33774 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
33775 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
33776
33777 @smallexample
33778 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
33779 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33780 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33781 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
33782 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
33783 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
33784 @var{host}
33785 @end smallexample
33786
33787 @noindent
33788 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
33789 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
33790 @samp{--}.
33791
33792 @table @code
33793 @item --help
33794 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
33795
33796 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
33797 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
33798 @file{@var{dir}}.
33799
33800 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
33801 Configure the source to install programs under directory
33802 @file{@var{dir}}.
33803
33804 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
33805 @need 2000
33806 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
33807 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
33808 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
33809 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
33810 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
33811 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
33812 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
33813 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
33814 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
33815 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
33816 @var{dirname}.
33817
33818 @item --norecursion
33819 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
33820 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
33821
33822 @item --target=@var{target}
33823 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
33824 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
33825 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
33826
33827 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
33828
33829 @item @var{host} @dots{}
33830 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
33831
33832 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
33833 @end table
33834
33835 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
33836 needed for special purposes only.
33837
33838 @node System-wide configuration
33839 @section System-wide configuration and settings
33840 @cindex system-wide init file
33841
33842 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
33843 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
33844 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
33845
33846 Here is the corresponding configure option:
33847
33848 @table @code
33849 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
33850 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
33851 @var{file}.
33852 @end table
33853
33854 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
33855 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
33856
33857 @itemize @bullet
33858 @item
33859 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
33860 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
33861 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
33862 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
33863 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
33864 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
33865
33866 @item
33867 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
33868 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
33869 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33870 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33871 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
33872 @end itemize
33873
33874 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
33875 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
33876 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
33877 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
33878 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
33879 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
33880 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
33881 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
33882 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
33883 reread.
33884
33885 @menu
33886 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33887 @end menu
33888
33889 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
33890 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33891 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
33892
33893 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
33894 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
33895 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33896 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33897 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33898 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33899
33900 The following scripts are currently available:
33901 @itemize @bullet
33902
33903 @item @file{elinos.py}
33904 @pindex elinos.py
33905 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33906 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33907 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33908 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33909 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33910 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33911
33912 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33913 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33914 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33915 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33916 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33917 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33918
33919 @end itemize
33920
33921 @node Maintenance Commands
33922 @appendix Maintenance Commands
33923 @cindex maintenance commands
33924 @cindex internal commands
33925
33926 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
33927 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
33928 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
33929 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
33930 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
33931
33932 @table @code
33933 @kindex maint agent
33934 @kindex maint agent-eval
33935 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33936 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33937 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
33938 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
33939 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
33940 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
33941 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
33942 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
33943 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
33944 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
33945 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
33946 addition and return the sum.
33947 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
33948 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
33949
33950 @kindex maint agent-printf
33951 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
33952 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
33953 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
33954 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
33955 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
33956
33957 @kindex maint info breakpoints
33958 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
33959 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
33960 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
33961 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
33962 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
33963 is shown:
33964
33965 @table @code
33966 @item breakpoint
33967 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
33968
33969 @item watchpoint
33970 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
33971
33972 @item longjmp
33973 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
33974 @code{longjmp} calls.
33975
33976 @item longjmp resume
33977 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
33978
33979 @item until
33980 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
33981
33982 @item finish
33983 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
33984
33985 @item shlib events
33986 Shared library events.
33987
33988 @end table
33989
33990 @kindex maint info bfds
33991 @item maint info bfds
33992 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
33993 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
33994
33995 @kindex maint info btrace
33996 @item maint info btrace
33997 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
33998
33999 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34000 @item maint btrace packet-history
34001 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34002 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34003 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34004 recording format.
34005
34006 @table @code
34007 @item bts
34008 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34009 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34010
34011 @table @asis
34012 @item Block number
34013 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34014 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34015 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34016 @end table
34017
34018 @item pt
34019 For the Intel(R) Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34020 Intel(R) Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34021 information is printed:
34022
34023 @table @asis
34024 @item Packet number
34025 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34026 @item Trace offset
34027 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34028 @item Packet opcode and payload
34029 @end table
34030 @end table
34031
34032 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34033 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34034 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34035 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34036 needed.
34037
34038 @kindex maint btrace clear
34039 @item maint btrace clear
34040 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34041 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34042
34043 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34044 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34045 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34046 buffer.
34047
34048 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34049 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34050 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34051 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34052 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34053 packet history.
34054
34055 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34056 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34057 @cindex displaced stepping support
34058 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34059 @item set displaced-stepping
34060 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34061 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34062 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34063 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34064 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34065 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34066
34067 @table @code
34068 @item set displaced-stepping on
34069 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34070 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34071
34072 @item set displaced-stepping off
34073 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34074 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34075
34076 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34077 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34078 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34079 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34080 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34081 @end table
34082
34083 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34084 @item maint check-psymtabs
34085 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34086 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34087
34088 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34089 @item maint check-symtabs
34090 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34091
34092 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34093 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34094 Expand symbol tables.
34095 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34096 names matching @var{regexp}.
34097
34098 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34099 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34100 @cindex demangler crashes
34101 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34102 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34103 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34104 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34105 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34106 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34107 option to terminate the current session.
34108
34109 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34110 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34111 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34112
34113 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34114 @item maint cplus namespace
34115 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34116
34117 @kindex maint deprecate
34118 @kindex maint undeprecate
34119 @cindex deprecated commands
34120 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34121 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34122 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34123 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34124 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34125 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34126 the replacement as part of the warning.
34127
34128 @kindex maint dump-me
34129 @item maint dump-me
34130 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34131 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34132 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34133 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34134
34135 @kindex maint internal-error
34136 @kindex maint internal-warning
34137 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34138 @cindex demangler crashes
34139 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34140 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34141 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34142
34143 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34144 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34145 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34146 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34147 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34148 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34149 @value{GDBN} session.
34150
34151 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34152 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34153
34154 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34155
34156 @smallexample
34157 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34158 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34159 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34160 debugging may prove unreliable.
34161 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34162 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34163 (@value{GDBP})
34164 @end smallexample
34165
34166 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34167 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34168 @cindex demangler crashes
34169
34170 @kindex maint set internal-error
34171 @kindex maint show internal-error
34172 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34173 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34174 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34175 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34176 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34177 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34178 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34179 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34180 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34181 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34182 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34183 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34184 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34185 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34186 described in the table below.
34187
34188 @table @samp
34189 @item quit
34190 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34191 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34192
34193 @item corefile
34194 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34195 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34196 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34197 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34198 disabled.
34199 @end table
34200
34201 @kindex maint packet
34202 @item maint packet @var{text}
34203 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34204 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34205 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34206 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34207 checksum.
34208
34209 @kindex maint print architecture
34210 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34211 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34212 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34213
34214 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
34215 @item maint print c-tdesc
34216 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34217 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34218 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34219
34220 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34221 @item maint print dummy-frames
34222 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34223
34224 @smallexample
34225 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34226 @dots{}
34227 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34228 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34229 58 return (a + b);
34230 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34231 @dots{}
34232 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34233 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34234 (@value{GDBP})
34235 @end smallexample
34236
34237 Takes an optional file parameter.
34238
34239 @kindex maint print registers
34240 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34241 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34242 @kindex maint print register-groups
34243 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34244 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34245 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34246 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34247 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34248 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34249 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34250
34251 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34252 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34253 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34254 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34255 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34256 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34257 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34258 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34259
34260 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34261 write the information.
34262
34263 @kindex maint print reggroups
34264 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34265 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34266 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34267 information.
34268
34269 The register groups info looks like this:
34270
34271 @smallexample
34272 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34273 Group Type
34274 general user
34275 float user
34276 all user
34277 vector user
34278 system user
34279 save internal
34280 restore internal
34281 @end smallexample
34282
34283 @kindex flushregs
34284 @item flushregs
34285 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34286
34287 @kindex maint print objfiles
34288 @cindex info for known object files
34289 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34290 Print a dump of all known object files.
34291 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34292 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34293 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34294
34295 @kindex maint print user-registers
34296 @cindex user registers
34297 @item maint print user-registers
34298 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34299 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34300 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34301 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34302 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34303 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34304 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34305
34306 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34307 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34308 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34309 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34310 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34311 matching @var{regexp}.
34312 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34313 and the full path if known.
34314 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34315
34316 @kindex maint print statistics
34317 @cindex bcache statistics
34318 @item maint print statistics
34319 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34320 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34321 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34322 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34323 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34324 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34325 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34326 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34327 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34328 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34329 lengths.
34330
34331 @kindex maint print target-stack
34332 @cindex target stack description
34333 @item maint print target-stack
34334 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34335 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34336 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34337 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34338 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34339 address.
34340
34341 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34342 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34343
34344 @kindex maint print type
34345 @cindex type chain of a data type
34346 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34347 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34348 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34349 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34350 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34351 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34352
34353 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34354 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34355 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34356 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34357 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34358 information.
34359
34360 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34361 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34362 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34363 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34364 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34365 always see the disassembly form.
34366
34367 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34368
34369 @smallexample
34370 (gdb) info addr argc
34371 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34372 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34373 @end smallexample
34374
34375 For more information on these expressions, see
34376 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34377
34378 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34379 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34380 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34381 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34382 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34383
34384 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34385 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34386 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34387 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34388 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34389 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34390 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34391 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34392 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34393
34394 @kindex maint set profile
34395 @kindex maint show profile
34396 @cindex profiling GDB
34397 @item maint set profile
34398 @itemx maint show profile
34399 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34400
34401 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34402 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34403 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34404 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34405 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34406 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34407 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34408
34409 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34410 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34411
34412 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34413 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34414 @cindex hardware debug registers
34415 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34416 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34417 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34418 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34419 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34420 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34421 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34422
34423 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34424 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34425 @item maint set show-all-tib
34426 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34427 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34428 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34429 command.
34430
34431 @kindex maint set target-async
34432 @kindex maint show target-async
34433 @item maint set target-async
34434 @itemx maint show target-async
34435 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34436 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34437 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34438 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34439
34440 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
34441 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
34442 @item maint set target-non-stop
34443 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
34444
34445 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
34446 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
34447 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
34448 if supported by the target.
34449
34450 @table @code
34451 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
34452 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
34453 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
34454
34455 @item maint set target-non-stop on
34456 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
34457 does not indicate support.
34458
34459 @item maint set target-non-stop off
34460 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
34461 target supports it.
34462 @end table
34463
34464 @kindex maint set per-command
34465 @kindex maint show per-command
34466 @item maint set per-command
34467 @itemx maint show per-command
34468 @cindex resources used by commands
34469
34470 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34471 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34472
34473 @table @code
34474 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34475 @itemx maint show per-command space
34476 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34477 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34478 took, following the command's own output.
34479 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34480 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34481
34482 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34483 @itemx maint show per-command time
34484 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34485 for each command.
34486 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34487 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34488 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34489 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34490 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34491 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34492 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34493 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34494 spent by the program been debugged.
34495 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34496 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34497
34498 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34499 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34500 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34501 for each command.
34502 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34503
34504 @enumerate a
34505 @item
34506 number of symbol tables
34507 @item
34508 number of primary symbol tables
34509 @item
34510 number of blocks in the blockvector
34511 @end enumerate
34512 @end table
34513
34514 @kindex maint space
34515 @cindex memory used by commands
34516 @item maint space @var{value}
34517 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34518 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34519
34520 @kindex maint time
34521 @cindex time of command execution
34522 @item maint time @var{value}
34523 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34524 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34525
34526 @kindex maint translate-address
34527 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34528 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34529 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34530 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34531 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34532 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34533 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34534
34535 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34536 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34537 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34538
34539 @end table
34540
34541 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34542 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34543
34544 @table @code
34545 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34546 @kindex set watchdog
34547 @cindex watchdog timer
34548 @cindex timeout for commands
34549 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34550 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34551 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34552
34553 @item show watchdog
34554 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34555 @end table
34556
34557 @node Remote Protocol
34558 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34559
34560 @menu
34561 * Overview::
34562 * Packets::
34563 * Stop Reply Packets::
34564 * General Query Packets::
34565 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34566 * Tracepoint Packets::
34567 * Host I/O Packets::
34568 * Interrupts::
34569 * Notification Packets::
34570 * Remote Non-Stop::
34571 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34572 * Examples::
34573 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34574 * Library List Format::
34575 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34576 * Memory Map Format::
34577 * Thread List Format::
34578 * Traceframe Info Format::
34579 * Branch Trace Format::
34580 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34581 @end menu
34582
34583 @node Overview
34584 @section Overview
34585
34586 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34587 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34588 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34589 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34590
34591 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34592 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34593
34594 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34595 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34596 @cindex remote serial protocol
34597 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34598 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34599 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34600 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34601 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34602
34603 @smallexample
34604 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34605 @end smallexample
34606 @noindent
34607
34608 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34609 @noindent
34610 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34611 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34612 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34613
34614 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34615 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34616
34617 @smallexample
34618 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34619 @end smallexample
34620
34621 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34622 @noindent
34623 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34624 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34625 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34626
34627 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34628 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34629 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34630 retransmission):
34631
34632 @smallexample
34633 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34634 <- @code{+}
34635 @end smallexample
34636 @noindent
34637
34638 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34639 once a connection is established.
34640 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34641
34642 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34643 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
34644 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34645 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34646 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
34647 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34648 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34649
34650 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34651 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34652 exceptions).
34653
34654 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
34655 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
34656 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
34657 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
34658
34659 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
34660 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
34661 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
34662
34663 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
34664 @anchor{Binary Data}
34665 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
34666 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
34667 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
34668 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
34669 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
34670 binary data.
34671
34672 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
34673 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
34674 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
34675 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
34676 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
34677 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
34678 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
34679 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
34680 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
34681 (described next).
34682
34683 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
34684 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
34685 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
34686 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
34687 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
34688 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
34689 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
34690 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
34691 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
34692 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
34693 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
34694 3}} more times.
34695
34696 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
34697 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
34698 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
34699 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
34700 @samp{0*"00}.
34701
34702 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
34703 error number. That number is not well defined.
34704
34705 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
34706 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
34707 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
34708 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
34709 on that response.
34710
34711 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
34712 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
34713 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
34714 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
34715 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
34716 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
34717
34718 @node Packets
34719 @section Packets
34720
34721 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
34722 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
34723 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
34724 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
34725
34726 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
34727 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
34728 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
34729 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
34730 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
34731 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
34732 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
34733 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
34734 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
34735 @var{baz}.
34736
34737 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
34738 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
34739 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
34740 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
34741 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
34742 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
34743 pick any thread.
34744
34745 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
34746 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
34747 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
34748 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
34749 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
34750 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
34751 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
34752 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
34753 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
34754 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
34755 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
34756 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
34757 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
34758
34759 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
34760 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
34761 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
34762 more information.
34763
34764 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
34765 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
34766
34767 Here are the packet descriptions.
34768
34769 @table @samp
34770
34771 @item !
34772 @cindex @samp{!} packet
34773 @anchor{extended mode}
34774 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
34775 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
34776 debugged.
34777
34778 Reply:
34779 @table @samp
34780 @item OK
34781 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
34782 @end table
34783
34784 @item ?
34785 @cindex @samp{?} packet
34786 @anchor{? packet}
34787 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
34788 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
34789 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
34790
34791 Reply:
34792 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34793
34794 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
34795 @cindex @samp{A} packet
34796 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
34797 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
34798 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
34799
34800 Reply:
34801 @table @samp
34802 @item OK
34803 The arguments were set.
34804 @item E @var{NN}
34805 An error occurred.
34806 @end table
34807
34808 @item b @var{baud}
34809 @cindex @samp{b} packet
34810 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
34811 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
34812
34813 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
34814 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
34815 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
34816
34817 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
34818 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
34819 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
34820 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
34821 of view, nothing actually happened.}
34822
34823 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
34824 @cindex @samp{B} packet
34825 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
34826 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
34827
34828 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
34829 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
34830
34831 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
34832 @anchor{bc}
34833 @item bc
34834 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
34835 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34836
34837 Reply:
34838 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34839
34840 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
34841 @anchor{bs}
34842 @item bs
34843 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
34844 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34845
34846 Reply:
34847 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34848
34849 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34850 @cindex @samp{c} packet
34851 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
34852 is omitted, resume at current address.
34853
34854 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34855 packet}.
34856
34857 Reply:
34858 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34859
34860 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34861 @cindex @samp{C} packet
34862 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
34863 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
34864
34865 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34866 packet}.
34867
34868 Reply:
34869 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34870
34871 @item d
34872 @cindex @samp{d} packet
34873 Toggle debug flag.
34874
34875 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
34876 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
34877
34878 @item D
34879 @itemx D;@var{pid}
34880 @cindex @samp{D} packet
34881 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
34882 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
34883 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
34884
34885 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
34886 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
34887 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
34888 big-endian hex string.
34889
34890 Reply:
34891 @table @samp
34892 @item OK
34893 for success
34894 @item E @var{NN}
34895 for an error
34896 @end table
34897
34898 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
34899 @cindex @samp{F} packet
34900 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
34901 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
34902 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
34903
34904 @item g
34905 @anchor{read registers packet}
34906 @cindex @samp{g} packet
34907 Read general registers.
34908
34909 Reply:
34910 @table @samp
34911 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34912 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
34913 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
34914 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
34915 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
34916 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
34917 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
34918
34919 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
34920 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
34921 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
34922 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
34923 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
34924 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
34925 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
34926 have been collected, and both have zero value:
34927
34928 @smallexample
34929 -> @code{g}
34930 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
34931 @end smallexample
34932
34933 @item E @var{NN}
34934 for an error.
34935 @end table
34936
34937 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
34938 @cindex @samp{G} packet
34939 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
34940 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
34941
34942 Reply:
34943 @table @samp
34944 @item OK
34945 for success
34946 @item E @var{NN}
34947 for an error
34948 @end table
34949
34950 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
34951 @cindex @samp{H} packet
34952 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
34953 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
34954 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
34955 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
34956 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
34957 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
34958 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34959
34960 Reply:
34961 @table @samp
34962 @item OK
34963 for success
34964 @item E @var{NN}
34965 for an error
34966 @end table
34967
34968 @c FIXME: JTC:
34969 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
34970 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
34971 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
34972 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
34973 @c described. For example:
34974 @c
34975 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34976 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
34977 @c otherwise returns current registers.
34978 @c
34979 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34980 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
34981 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
34982
34983 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
34984 @anchor{cycle step packet}
34985 @cindex @samp{i} packet
34986 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
34987 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
34988 step starting at that address.
34989
34990 @item I
34991 @cindex @samp{I} packet
34992 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
34993 step packet}.
34994
34995 @item k
34996 @cindex @samp{k} packet
34997 Kill request.
34998
34999 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35000
35001 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35002 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35003
35004 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35005
35006 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35007 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35008 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35009
35010 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35011 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35012 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35013
35014 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35015 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35016 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35017 (@pxref{? packet}).
35018
35019 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35020 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35021 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35022 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35023 any particular boundary.
35024
35025 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35026 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35027 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35028 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35029 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35030 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35031 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35032 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35033
35034 Reply:
35035 @table @samp
35036 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35037 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35038 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35039 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35040 @item E @var{NN}
35041 @var{NN} is errno
35042 @end table
35043
35044 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35045 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35046 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35047 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35048 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35049
35050 Reply:
35051 @table @samp
35052 @item OK
35053 for success
35054 @item E @var{NN}
35055 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35056 written).
35057 @end table
35058
35059 @item p @var{n}
35060 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35061 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35062 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35063 register value is encoded.
35064
35065 Reply:
35066 @table @samp
35067 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35068 the register's value
35069 @item E @var{NN}
35070 for an error
35071 @item @w{}
35072 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35073 @end table
35074
35075 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35076 @anchor{write register packet}
35077 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35078 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35079 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35080 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35081
35082 Reply:
35083 @table @samp
35084 @item OK
35085 for success
35086 @item E @var{NN}
35087 for an error
35088 @end table
35089
35090 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35091 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35092 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35093 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35094 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35095 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35096
35097 @item r
35098 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35099 Reset the entire system.
35100
35101 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35102
35103 @item R @var{XX}
35104 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35105 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35106 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35107
35108 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35109
35110 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35111 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35112 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35113 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35114
35115 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35116 packet}.
35117
35118 Reply:
35119 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35120
35121 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35122 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35123 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35124 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35125 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35126
35127 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35128 packet}.
35129
35130 Reply:
35131 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35132
35133 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35134 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35135 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35136 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35137 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35138
35139 @item T @var{thread-id}
35140 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35141 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35142
35143 Reply:
35144 @table @samp
35145 @item OK
35146 thread is still alive
35147 @item E @var{NN}
35148 thread is dead
35149 @end table
35150
35151 @item v
35152 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35153 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35154
35155 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35156 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35157 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35158 The process ID is a
35159 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35160 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35161 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35162
35163 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35164 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35165 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35166 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35167 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35168 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35169 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35170 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35171
35172 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35173
35174 Reply:
35175 @table @samp
35176 @item E @var{nn}
35177 for an error
35178 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35179 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35180 @item OK
35181 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35182 @end table
35183
35184 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35185 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35186 @anchor{vCont packet}
35187 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35188 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
35189 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
35190 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
35191 in their current state in non-stop mode.
35192 Specifying multiple
35193 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
35194 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35195
35196 Currently supported actions are:
35197
35198 @table @samp
35199 @item c
35200 Continue.
35201 @item C @var{sig}
35202 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35203 @item s
35204 Step.
35205 @item S @var{sig}
35206 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35207 @item t
35208 Stop.
35209 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35210 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35211 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35212 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35213 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35214 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35215
35216 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35217 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35218 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35219 jumps to @var{start}).
35220
35221 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35222 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35223 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35224
35225 @end table
35226
35227 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35228 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35229 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35230
35231 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35232 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35233 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35234 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35235 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35236 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35237 as an implementation detail.
35238
35239 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35240 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
35241 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
35242 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
35243 @var{thread-id}.
35244
35245 Reply:
35246 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35247
35248 @item vCont?
35249 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35250 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35251
35252 Reply:
35253 @table @samp
35254 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35255 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35256 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35257 @item @w{}
35258 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35259 @end table
35260
35261 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35262 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35263 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
35264 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35265
35266 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35267 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35268 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35269 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35270 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35271 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35272 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35273 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35274 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35275 packet is received.
35276
35277 Reply:
35278 @table @samp
35279 @item OK
35280 for success
35281 @item E @var{NN}
35282 for an error
35283 @end table
35284
35285 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35286 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35287 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35288 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35289 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35290 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35291 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35292 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35293 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35294 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35295 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35296 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35297
35298
35299 Reply:
35300 @table @samp
35301 @item OK
35302 for success
35303 @item E.memtype
35304 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35305 @item E @var{NN}
35306 for an error
35307 @end table
35308
35309 @item vFlashDone
35310 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35311 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35312 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35313 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35314 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35315 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35316 request is completed.
35317
35318 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35319 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35320 @anchor{vKill packet}
35321 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35322 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35323 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35324 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35325
35326 Reply:
35327 @table @samp
35328 @item E @var{nn}
35329 for an error
35330 @item OK
35331 for success
35332 @end table
35333
35334 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35335 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35336 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35337 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35338 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35339 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35340 state.
35341
35342 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35343
35344 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35345
35346 Reply:
35347 @table @samp
35348 @item E @var{nn}
35349 for an error
35350 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35351 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35352 @end table
35353
35354 @item vStopped
35355 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35356 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35357
35358 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35359 @anchor{X packet}
35360 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35361 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35362 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35363 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35364 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35365
35366 Reply:
35367 @table @samp
35368 @item OK
35369 for success
35370 @item E @var{NN}
35371 for an error
35372 @end table
35373
35374 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35375 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35376 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35377 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35378 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35379 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35380 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35381
35382 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35383 separately.
35384
35385 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35386 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35387 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35388 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35389 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35390 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35391
35392 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35393 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35394 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35395 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35396 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
35397 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35398
35399 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35400 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35401 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
35402 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
35403 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35404 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
35405 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
35406 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
35407 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
35408 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
35409
35410 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35411 for how to best report a memory breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35412
35413 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35414 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35415
35416 @table @samp
35417
35418 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35419 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35420 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35421
35422 @end table
35423
35424 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35425 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35426 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35427 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35428 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35429 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35430 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35431
35432 @table @samp
35433
35434 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35435 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35436 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35437
35438 @end table
35439
35440 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
35441
35442 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35443 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35444 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35445 target, is not defined.}
35446
35447 Reply:
35448 @table @samp
35449 @item OK
35450 success
35451 @item @w{}
35452 not supported
35453 @item E @var{NN}
35454 for an error
35455 @end table
35456
35457 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35458 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35459 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35460 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35461 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35462 address @var{addr}.
35463
35464 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35465 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
35466 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35467
35468 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35469 movement.}
35470
35471 Reply:
35472 @table @samp
35473 @item OK
35474 success
35475 @item @w{}
35476 not supported
35477 @item E @var{NN}
35478 for an error
35479 @end table
35480
35481 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35482 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35483 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35484 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35485 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35486 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35487
35488 Reply:
35489 @table @samp
35490 @item OK
35491 success
35492 @item @w{}
35493 not supported
35494 @item E @var{NN}
35495 for an error
35496 @end table
35497
35498 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35499 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35500 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35501 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35502 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35503 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35504
35505 Reply:
35506 @table @samp
35507 @item OK
35508 success
35509 @item @w{}
35510 not supported
35511 @item E @var{NN}
35512 for an error
35513 @end table
35514
35515 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35516 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35517 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35518 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35519 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35520 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35521
35522 Reply:
35523 @table @samp
35524 @item OK
35525 success
35526 @item @w{}
35527 not supported
35528 @item E @var{NN}
35529 for an error
35530 @end table
35531
35532 @end table
35533
35534 @node Stop Reply Packets
35535 @section Stop Reply Packets
35536 @cindex stop reply packets
35537
35538 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35539 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35540 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35541 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35542 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35543 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35544 @value{GDBN} source code.
35545
35546 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35547 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35548 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35549 components.
35550
35551 @table @samp
35552
35553 @item S @var{AA}
35554 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35555 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35556 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35557
35558 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35559 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35560 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35561 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35562 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35563 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35564 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35565 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35566
35567 @itemize @bullet
35568 @item
35569 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35570 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35571 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35572 two-digit hex number.
35573
35574 @item
35575 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35576 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35577
35578 @item
35579 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35580 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35581
35582 @item
35583 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35584 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35585 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35586 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35587
35588 @item
35589 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35590 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35591 future.
35592 @end itemize
35593
35594 The currently defined stop reasons are:
35595
35596 @table @samp
35597 @item watch
35598 @itemx rwatch
35599 @itemx awatch
35600 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35601 hex.
35602
35603 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
35604 @item library
35605 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35606 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35607 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
35608
35609 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
35610 @item replaylog
35611 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35612 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35613 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
35614 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
35615 for more information.
35616
35617 @item swbreak
35618 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
35619 The packet indicates a memory breakpoint instruction was executed,
35620 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
35621 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
35622 part must be left empty.
35623
35624 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
35625 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
35626 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
35627 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
35628 address.
35629
35630 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35631 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35632 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35633 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35634 indicating support.
35635
35636 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
35637
35638 @item hwbreak
35639 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
35640 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
35641
35642 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
35643 apply.
35644
35645 @cindex fork events, remote reply
35646 @item fork
35647 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
35648 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35649 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35650 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35651 fork events.
35652
35653 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35654 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35655 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35656 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35657 indicating support.
35658
35659 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
35660 @item vfork
35661 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
35662 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35663 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35664 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35665 vfork events.
35666
35667 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35668 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35669 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35670 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35671 indicating support.
35672
35673 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
35674 @item vforkdone
35675 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
35676 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
35677 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
35678 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
35679 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
35680
35681 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35682 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35683 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35684 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35685 indicating support.
35686
35687 @end table
35688
35689 @item W @var{AA}
35690 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35691 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
35692 applicable to certain targets.
35693
35694 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
35695 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
35696 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35697 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35698
35699 @item X @var{AA}
35700 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35701 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
35702
35703 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
35704 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
35705 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
35706 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35707
35708 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
35709 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
35710 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
35711 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
35712 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
35713
35714 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
35715 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
35716 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
35717 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
35718 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
35719 system calls.
35720
35721 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
35722 this very system call.
35723
35724 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
35725 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
35726 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
35727 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
35728 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
35729 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
35730
35731 @end table
35732
35733 @node General Query Packets
35734 @section General Query Packets
35735 @cindex remote query requests
35736
35737 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
35738 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
35739 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
35740 sending information to and from the stub.
35741
35742 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
35743 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
35744 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
35745 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
35746 conventions:
35747
35748 @itemize @bullet
35749 @item
35750 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
35751 @item
35752 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
35753 letter.
35754 @item
35755 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
35756 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
35757 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
35758 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
35759 @end itemize
35760
35761 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
35762 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
35763 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
35764 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
35765 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
35766 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
35767 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
35768 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
35769 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
35770 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
35771 packet.}.
35772
35773 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
35774 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
35775 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
35776 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
35777 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
35778
35779 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
35780
35781 @table @samp
35782
35783 @item QAgent:1
35784 @itemx QAgent:0
35785 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
35786 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
35787
35788 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
35789 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
35790 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
35791 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
35792 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
35793 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
35794 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
35795 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
35796 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
35797 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
35798 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
35799
35800 @item qC
35801 @cindex current thread, remote request
35802 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
35803 Return the current thread ID.
35804
35805 Reply:
35806 @table @samp
35807 @item QC @var{thread-id}
35808 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
35809 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35810 @item @r{(anything else)}
35811 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
35812 @end table
35813
35814 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
35815 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
35816 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
35817 @anchor{qCRC packet}
35818 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
35819 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
35820 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
35821 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
35822
35823 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
35824 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
35825 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
35826 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
35827 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
35828 detect trailing zeros.
35829
35830 Reply:
35831 @table @samp
35832 @item E @var{NN}
35833 An error (such as memory fault)
35834 @item C @var{crc32}
35835 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
35836 @end table
35837
35838 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
35839 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
35840 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
35841 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
35842 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
35843 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
35844 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
35845 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
35846 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
35847 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
35848 randomization.
35849
35850 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35851
35852 Reply:
35853 @table @samp
35854 @item OK
35855 The request succeeded.
35856
35857 @item E @var{nn}
35858 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35859
35860 @item @w{}
35861 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
35862 by the stub.
35863 @end table
35864
35865 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35866 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35867 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
35868 address space randomization.
35869
35870 @item qfThreadInfo
35871 @itemx qsThreadInfo
35872 @cindex list active threads, remote request
35873 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
35874 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
35875 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
35876 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
35877 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
35878 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
35879 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
35880 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
35881
35882 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
35883
35884 Reply:
35885 @table @samp
35886 @item m @var{thread-id}
35887 A single thread ID
35888 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
35889 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
35890 @item l
35891 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
35892 @end table
35893
35894 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
35895 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
35896 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
35897 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
35898 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
35899 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35900 fields.
35901
35902 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
35903 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
35904 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
35905 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
35906 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
35907
35908 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
35909 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
35910 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
35911 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
35912 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
35913
35914 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
35915 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35916
35917 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
35918 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
35919 information associated with the variable.)
35920
35921 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
35922 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
35923 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
35924 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
35925 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
35926 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
35927
35928 Reply:
35929 @table @samp
35930 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35931 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
35932 local storage requested.
35933
35934 @item E @var{nn}
35935 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35936
35937 @item @w{}
35938 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35939 @end table
35940
35941 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
35942 @cindex get thread information block address
35943 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
35944 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
35945
35946 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
35947
35948 Reply:
35949 @table @samp
35950 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35951 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
35952 thread information block.
35953
35954 @item E @var{nn}
35955 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
35956 address could not be retrieved.
35957
35958 @item @w{}
35959 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35960 @end table
35961
35962 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
35963 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
35964 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
35965 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
35966 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
35967 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
35968 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
35969
35970 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
35971
35972 Reply:
35973 @table @samp
35974 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
35975 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
35976 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
35977 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
35978 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
35979 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
35980 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
35981 @end table
35982
35983 @item qOffsets
35984 @cindex section offsets, remote request
35985 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
35986 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
35987 image.
35988
35989 Reply:
35990 @table @samp
35991 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
35992 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
35993 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
35994 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
35995 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
35996 segments by the supplied offsets.
35997
35998 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
35999 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36000 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36001
36002 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36003 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36004 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36005 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36006 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36007 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36008 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36009 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
36010 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36011 @end table
36012
36013 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36014 @cindex thread information, remote request
36015 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
36016 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36017 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36018 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36019
36020 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36021 (see below).
36022
36023 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36024
36025 @item QNonStop:1
36026 @itemx QNonStop:0
36027 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36028 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36029 @anchor{QNonStop}
36030 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36031 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36032
36033 Reply:
36034 @table @samp
36035 @item OK
36036 The request succeeded.
36037
36038 @item E @var{nn}
36039 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36040
36041 @item @w{}
36042 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36043 the stub.
36044 @end table
36045
36046 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36047 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36048 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
36049 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
36050
36051 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36052 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
36053 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36054 @anchor{QPassSignals}
36055 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
36056 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36057 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36058 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
36059 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
36060 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
36061 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
36062 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
36063 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
36064
36065 Reply:
36066 @table @samp
36067 @item OK
36068 The request succeeded.
36069
36070 @item E @var{nn}
36071 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36072
36073 @item @w{}
36074 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
36075 the stub.
36076 @end table
36077
36078 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
36079 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
36080 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36081 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36082
36083 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36084 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
36085 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
36086 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
36087 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
36088 Others should be silently discarded.
36089
36090 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
36091 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
36092 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
36093 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
36094 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
36095 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
36096 signals.
36097
36098 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36099 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36100
36101 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36102 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36103 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
36104 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36105 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36106
36107 Reply:
36108 @table @samp
36109 @item OK
36110 The request succeeded.
36111
36112 @item E @var{nn}
36113 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36114
36115 @item @w{}
36116 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36117 by the stub.
36118 @end table
36119
36120 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36121 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36122 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36123 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36124
36125 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
36126 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
36127 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36128 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36129 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36130 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36131 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36132 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36133 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36134
36135 Reply:
36136 @table @samp
36137 @item OK
36138 A command response with no output.
36139 @item @var{OUTPUT}
36140 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36141 @item E @var{NN}
36142 Indicate a badly formed request.
36143 @item @w{}
36144 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36145 @end table
36146
36147 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36148 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36149 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36150 packets.)
36151
36152 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36153 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36154 @ifnotinfo
36155 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36156 @end ifnotinfo
36157 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36158 @anchor{qSearch memory}
36159 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36160 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36161 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36162
36163 Reply:
36164 @table @samp
36165 @item 0
36166 The pattern was not found.
36167 @item 1,address
36168 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36169 @item E @var{NN}
36170 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36171 @item @w{}
36172 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36173 @end table
36174
36175 @item QStartNoAckMode
36176 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36177 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36178 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36179 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36180
36181 Reply:
36182 @table @samp
36183 @item OK
36184 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36185 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36186 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36187 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36188 @item @w{}
36189 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36190 @end table
36191
36192 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36193 @cindex supported packets, remote query
36194 @cindex features of the remote protocol
36195 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36196 @anchor{qSupported}
36197 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36198 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
36199 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36200 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36201 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36202 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36203 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
36204 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36205 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
36206 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
36207 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
36208 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36209 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36210 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36211
36212 Reply:
36213 @table @samp
36214 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36215 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36216 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36217 possible forms).
36218 @item @w{}
36219 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36220 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36221 @end table
36222
36223 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36224 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36225 are:
36226
36227 @table @samp
36228 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
36229 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36230 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
36231 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36232 @item @var{name}+
36233 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36234 need an associated value.
36235 @item @var{name}-
36236 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36237 @item @var{name}?
36238 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36239 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36240 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36241 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36242 @end table
36243
36244 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36245 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36246 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36247 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36248 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36249
36250 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36251 are defined:
36252
36253 @table @samp
36254 @item multiprocess
36255 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36256 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36257 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36258 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36259 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36260
36261 @item xmlRegisters
36262 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36263 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36264 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36265 description.
36266
36267 @item qRelocInsn
36268 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36269 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36270 instruction reply packet}).
36271
36272 @item swbreak
36273 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
36274 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36275
36276 @item hwbreak
36277 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
36278 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36279
36280 @item fork-events
36281 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
36282 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36283 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36284 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36285
36286 @item vfork-events
36287 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
36288 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36289 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36290 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36291 @end table
36292
36293 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36294 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36295 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36296 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
36297 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36298 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36299 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36300 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
36301 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36302 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36303 all the features it supports.
36304
36305 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36306 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36307
36308 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
36309 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
36310 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36311 form response.
36312
36313 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36314 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36315 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
36316 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36317
36318 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36319 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36320 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36321 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
36322 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36323
36324 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36325
36326 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36327 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36328 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36329 @item Feature Name
36330 @tab Value Required
36331 @tab Default
36332 @tab Probe Allowed
36333
36334 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36335 @tab Yes
36336 @tab @samp{-}
36337 @tab No
36338
36339 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36340 @tab No
36341 @tab @samp{-}
36342 @tab Yes
36343
36344 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36345 @tab No
36346 @tab @samp{-}
36347 @tab Yes
36348
36349 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36350 @tab No
36351 @tab @samp{-}
36352 @tab Yes
36353
36354 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
36355 @tab No
36356 @tab @samp{-}
36357 @tab Yes
36358
36359 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36360 @tab No
36361 @tab @samp{-}
36362 @tab Yes
36363
36364 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36365 @tab No
36366 @tab @samp{-}
36367 @tab Yes
36368
36369 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36370 @tab No
36371 @tab @samp{-}
36372 @tab Yes
36373
36374 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36375 @tab No
36376 @tab @samp{-}
36377 @tab No
36378
36379 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36380 @tab No
36381 @tab @samp{-}
36382 @tab Yes
36383
36384 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36385 @tab No
36386 @tab @samp{-}
36387 @tab Yes
36388
36389 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36390 @tab No
36391 @tab @samp{-}
36392 @tab Yes
36393
36394 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36395 @tab No
36396 @tab @samp{-}
36397 @tab Yes
36398
36399 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36400 @tab No
36401 @tab @samp{-}
36402 @tab Yes
36403
36404 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36405 @tab No
36406 @tab @samp{-}
36407 @tab Yes
36408
36409 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36410 @tab No
36411 @tab @samp{-}
36412 @tab Yes
36413
36414 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36415 @tab No
36416 @tab @samp{-}
36417 @tab Yes
36418
36419 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36420 @tab No
36421 @tab @samp{-}
36422 @tab Yes
36423
36424 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36425 @tab No
36426 @tab @samp{-}
36427 @tab Yes
36428
36429 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
36430 @tab Yes
36431 @tab @samp{-}
36432 @tab Yes
36433
36434 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
36435 @tab Yes
36436 @tab @samp{-}
36437 @tab Yes
36438
36439 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
36440 @tab Yes
36441 @tab @samp{-}
36442 @tab Yes
36443
36444 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
36445 @tab Yes
36446 @tab @samp{-}
36447 @tab Yes
36448
36449 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
36450 @tab Yes
36451 @tab @samp{-}
36452 @tab Yes
36453
36454 @item @samp{QNonStop}
36455 @tab No
36456 @tab @samp{-}
36457 @tab Yes
36458
36459 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
36460 @tab No
36461 @tab @samp{-}
36462 @tab Yes
36463
36464 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
36465 @tab No
36466 @tab @samp{-}
36467 @tab Yes
36468
36469 @item @samp{multiprocess}
36470 @tab No
36471 @tab @samp{-}
36472 @tab No
36473
36474 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
36475 @tab No
36476 @tab @samp{-}
36477 @tab No
36478
36479 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
36480 @tab No
36481 @tab @samp{-}
36482 @tab No
36483
36484 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
36485 @tab No
36486 @tab @samp{-}
36487 @tab No
36488
36489 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
36490 @tab No
36491 @tab @samp{-}
36492 @tab No
36493
36494 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
36495 @tab No
36496 @tab @samp{-}
36497 @tab No
36498
36499 @item @samp{QAgent}
36500 @tab No
36501 @tab @samp{-}
36502 @tab No
36503
36504 @item @samp{QAllow}
36505 @tab No
36506 @tab @samp{-}
36507 @tab No
36508
36509 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
36510 @tab No
36511 @tab @samp{-}
36512 @tab No
36513
36514 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
36515 @tab No
36516 @tab @samp{-}
36517 @tab No
36518
36519 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
36520 @tab No
36521 @tab @samp{-}
36522 @tab No
36523
36524 @item @samp{tracenz}
36525 @tab No
36526 @tab @samp{-}
36527 @tab No
36528
36529 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
36530 @tab No
36531 @tab @samp{-}
36532 @tab No
36533
36534 @item @samp{swbreak}
36535 @tab No
36536 @tab @samp{-}
36537 @tab No
36538
36539 @item @samp{hwbreak}
36540 @tab No
36541 @tab @samp{-}
36542 @tab No
36543
36544 @item @samp{fork-events}
36545 @tab No
36546 @tab @samp{-}
36547 @tab No
36548
36549 @item @samp{vfork-events}
36550 @tab No
36551 @tab @samp{-}
36552 @tab No
36553
36554 @end multitable
36555
36556 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
36557
36558 @table @samp
36559 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
36560 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
36561 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
36562 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
36563 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
36564 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
36565 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
36566 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
36567 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
36568 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
36569
36570 @item qXfer:auxv:read
36571 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
36572 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
36573
36574 @item qXfer:btrace:read
36575 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36576 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
36577
36578 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
36579 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36580 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
36581
36582 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
36583 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
36584 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
36585
36586 @item qXfer:features:read
36587 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
36588 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
36589
36590 @item qXfer:libraries:read
36591 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
36592 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
36593
36594 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
36595 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36596 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36597
36598 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
36599 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
36600 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36601 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36602
36603 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
36604 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
36605 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
36606
36607 @item qXfer:sdata:read
36608 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
36609 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
36610
36611 @item qXfer:spu:read
36612 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
36613 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
36614
36615 @item qXfer:spu:write
36616 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
36617 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
36618
36619 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
36620 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
36621 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
36622
36623 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
36624 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
36625 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
36626
36627 @item qXfer:threads:read
36628 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
36629 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
36630
36631 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
36632 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36633 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
36634
36635 @item qXfer:uib:read
36636 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36637 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
36638
36639 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
36640 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36641 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
36642
36643 @item QNonStop
36644 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
36645 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
36646
36647 @item QPassSignals
36648 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36649 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
36650
36651 @item QStartNoAckMode
36652 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
36653 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
36654
36655 @item multiprocess
36656 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
36657 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
36658 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
36659 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
36660 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
36661 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
36662 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
36663 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
36664 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
36665 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
36666 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
36667
36668 @item qXfer:osdata:read
36669 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
36670 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
36671
36672 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
36673 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
36674 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
36675 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
36676
36677 @item ConditionalTracepoints
36678 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
36679 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
36680
36681 @item ReverseContinue
36682 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
36683 (@pxref{bc}).
36684
36685 @item ReverseStep
36686 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
36687 (@pxref{bs}).
36688
36689 @item TracepointSource
36690 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
36691 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
36692
36693 @item QAgent
36694 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
36695
36696 @item QAllow
36697 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
36698
36699 @item QDisableRandomization
36700 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
36701
36702 @item StaticTracepoint
36703 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
36704 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
36705
36706 @item InstallInTrace
36707 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
36708 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
36709
36710 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
36711 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
36712 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
36713 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
36714
36715 @item QTBuffer:size
36716 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
36717 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
36718
36719 @item tracenz
36720 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
36721 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
36722 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
36723
36724 @item BreakpointCommands
36725 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
36726 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
36727 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
36728
36729 @item Qbtrace:off
36730 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
36731
36732 @item Qbtrace:bts
36733 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
36734
36735 @item Qbtrace:pt
36736 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
36737
36738 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
36739 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
36740
36741 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
36742 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
36743
36744 @item swbreak
36745 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
36746 breakpoints.
36747
36748 @item hwbreak
36749 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
36750 breakpoints.
36751
36752 @item fork-events
36753 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
36754
36755 @item vfork-events
36756 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
36757 and vforkdone events.
36758
36759 @end table
36760
36761 @item qSymbol::
36762 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
36763 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
36764 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
36765 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
36766
36767 Reply:
36768 @table @samp
36769 @item OK
36770 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36771 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36772 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
36773 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
36774 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
36775 below.
36776 @end table
36777
36778 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
36779 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
36780
36781 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
36782 target has previously requested.
36783
36784 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
36785 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
36786 will be empty.
36787
36788 Reply:
36789 @table @samp
36790 @item OK
36791 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36792 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36793 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
36794 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
36795 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
36796 @end table
36797
36798 @item qTBuffer
36799 @itemx QTBuffer
36800 @itemx QTDisconnected
36801 @itemx QTDP
36802 @itemx QTDPsrc
36803 @itemx QTDV
36804 @itemx qTfP
36805 @itemx qTfV
36806 @itemx QTFrame
36807 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
36808
36809 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
36810
36811 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
36812 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
36813 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
36814 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
36815 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
36816 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
36817 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
36818 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
36819 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
36820 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
36821 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
36822
36823 Reply:
36824 @table @samp
36825 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36826 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
36827 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
36828 the thread's attributes.
36829 @end table
36830
36831 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
36832 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36833 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36834 packets.)
36835
36836 @item QTNotes
36837 @itemx qTP
36838 @itemx QTSave
36839 @itemx qTsP
36840 @itemx qTsV
36841 @itemx QTStart
36842 @itemx QTStop
36843 @itemx QTEnable
36844 @itemx QTDisable
36845 @itemx QTinit
36846 @itemx QTro
36847 @itemx qTStatus
36848 @itemx qTV
36849 @itemx qTfSTM
36850 @itemx qTsSTM
36851 @itemx qTSTMat
36852 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
36853
36854 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36855 @cindex read special object, remote request
36856 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
36857 @anchor{qXfer read}
36858 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
36859 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
36860 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
36861 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
36862 additional details about what data to access.
36863
36864 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
36865 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
36866 formats, listed below.
36867
36868 @table @samp
36869 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36870 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
36871 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
36872 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
36873
36874 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36875 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36876
36877 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36878 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
36879
36880 Return a description of the current branch trace.
36881 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
36882 packet may have one of the following values:
36883
36884 @table @code
36885 @item all
36886 Returns all available branch trace.
36887
36888 @item new
36889 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
36890 the last read request.
36891
36892 @item delta
36893 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
36894 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
36895 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
36896 used to stitch traces together.
36897
36898 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
36899 @end table
36900
36901 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
36902 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36903
36904 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36905 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
36906
36907 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
36908 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
36909
36910 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
36911 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36912
36913 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36914 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
36915 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
36916 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
36917 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
36918 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
36919 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
36920
36921 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36922 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36923
36924 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36925 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
36926 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
36927 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
36928 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
36929
36930 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36931 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36932
36933 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36934 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
36935 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
36936 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36937 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36938
36939 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
36940 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
36941 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
36942
36943 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36944 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36945
36946 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36947 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
36948 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
36949 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
36950 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
36951 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
36952 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36953 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
36954
36955 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
36956 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
36957
36958 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36959 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36960
36961 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
36962 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
36963 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
36964 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
36965
36966 @table @code
36967 @item start=@var{address}
36968 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
36969 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
36970 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
36971 chosen as the starting point.
36972
36973 @item prev=@var{address}
36974 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
36975 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
36976 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
36977 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
36978 exists prior to the starting point.
36979
36980 @end table
36981
36982 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
36983 ignored.
36984
36985 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36986 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
36987 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
36988 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36989 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36990
36991 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36992 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36993
36994 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36995 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
36996
36997 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
36998 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
36999 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
37000 Action Lists}.
37001
37002 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37003 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37004 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37005
37006 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37007 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
37008 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
37009 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37010 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37011
37012 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37013 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37014 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37015
37016 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37017 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
37018 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37019 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
37020 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37021 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37022 in that context to be accessed.
37023
37024 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37025 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37026 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37027
37028 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37029 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
37030 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
37031 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37032 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37033
37034 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37035 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37036
37037 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37038 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37039
37040 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37041 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
37042 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37043
37044 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37045 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37046
37047 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37048 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37049
37050 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
37051 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37052
37053 This packet is not probed by default.
37054
37055 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37056 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37057 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
37058 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37059 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37060
37061 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37062 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37063
37064 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37065 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37066 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37067 @xref{Operating System Information}.
37068
37069 @end table
37070
37071 Reply:
37072 @table @samp
37073 @item m @var{data}
37074 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37075 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37076 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37077 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37078 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37079 request.
37080
37081 @item l @var{data}
37082 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37083 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37084 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37085
37086 @item l
37087 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37088 There is no more data to be read.
37089
37090 @item E00
37091 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37092
37093 @item E @var{nn}
37094 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37095 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37096
37097 @item @w{}
37098 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37099 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37100 @end table
37101
37102 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37103 @cindex write data into object, remote request
37104 @anchor{qXfer write}
37105 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37106 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37107 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
37108 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37109 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37110 to access.
37111
37112 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
37113 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37114 formats, listed below.
37115
37116 @table @samp
37117 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37118 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37119 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37120 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37121 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37122
37123 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37124 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37125 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37126
37127 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37128 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
37129 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37130 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37131 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37132 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37133 in that context to be accessed.
37134
37135 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37136 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37137 @end table
37138
37139 Reply:
37140 @table @samp
37141 @item @var{nn}
37142 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37143 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37144
37145 @item E00
37146 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37147
37148 @item E @var{nn}
37149 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37150 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37151
37152 @item @w{}
37153 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37154 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37155 @end table
37156
37157 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37158 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
37159 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37160 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37161 must respond with an empty packet.
37162
37163 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
37164 @cindex query attached, remote request
37165 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
37166 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
37167 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
37168 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
37169 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
37170 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
37171 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
37172
37173 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37174 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37175 the @code{quit} command.
37176
37177 Reply:
37178 @table @samp
37179 @item 1
37180 The remote server attached to an existing process.
37181 @item 0
37182 The remote server created a new process.
37183 @item E @var{NN}
37184 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37185 @end table
37186
37187 @item Qbtrace:bts
37188 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
37189
37190 Reply:
37191 @table @samp
37192 @item OK
37193 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37194 @item E.errtext
37195 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37196 @end table
37197
37198 @item Qbtrace:pt
37199 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel(R) Processor Trace.
37200
37201 Reply:
37202 @table @samp
37203 @item OK
37204 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37205 @item E.errtext
37206 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37207 @end table
37208
37209 @item Qbtrace:off
37210 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
37211
37212 Reply:
37213 @table @samp
37214 @item OK
37215 Branch tracing has been disabled.
37216 @item E.errtext
37217 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37218 @end table
37219
37220 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
37221 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37222 btrace recording method in bts format.
37223
37224 Reply:
37225 @table @samp
37226 @item OK
37227 The ring buffer size has been set.
37228 @item E.errtext
37229 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37230 @end table
37231
37232 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
37233 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37234 btrace recording method in pt format.
37235
37236 Reply:
37237 @table @samp
37238 @item OK
37239 The ring buffer size has been set.
37240 @item E.errtext
37241 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37242 @end table
37243
37244 @end table
37245
37246 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37247 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37248
37249 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37250 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37251 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37252
37253 @menu
37254 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37255 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37256 @end menu
37257
37258 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37259 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37260
37261 @menu
37262 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37263 @end menu
37264
37265 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37266 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37267 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37268
37269 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37270
37271 @table @r
37272
37273 @item 2
37274 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37275
37276 @item 3
37277 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37278
37279 @item 4
37280 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37281
37282 @end table
37283
37284 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37285 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37286
37287 @menu
37288 * MIPS Register packet Format::
37289 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37290 @end menu
37291
37292 @node MIPS Register packet Format
37293 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37294 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37295
37296 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37297 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37298 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37299 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
37300 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
37301 most-significant -- least-significant.
37302
37303 @table @r
37304
37305 @item MIPS32
37306 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
37307 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
37308 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
37309
37310 @item MIPS64
37311 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
37312 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
37313 as @code{MIPS32}.
37314
37315 @end table
37316
37317 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
37318 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
37319 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
37320
37321 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37322
37323 @table @r
37324
37325 @item 2
37326 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
37327
37328 @item 3
37329 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37330
37331 @item 4
37332 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
37333
37334 @item 5
37335 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37336
37337 @end table
37338
37339 @node Tracepoint Packets
37340 @section Tracepoint Packets
37341 @cindex tracepoint packets
37342 @cindex packets, tracepoint
37343
37344 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
37345 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
37346
37347 @table @samp
37348
37349 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
37350 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
37351 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
37352 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
37353 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
37354 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
37355 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
37356 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
37357 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
37358 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
37359 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
37360 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
37361 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
37362 actions.
37363
37364 Replies:
37365 @table @samp
37366 @item OK
37367 The packet was understood and carried out.
37368 @item qRelocInsn
37369 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37370 @item @w{}
37371 The packet was not recognized.
37372 @end table
37373
37374 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
37375 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
37376 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
37377 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
37378 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
37379 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
37380 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
37381
37382 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
37383 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
37384 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
37385 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
37386 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
37387 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
37388 tracepoint actions.
37389
37390 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
37391 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
37392 following forms:
37393
37394 @table @samp
37395
37396 @item R @var{mask}
37397 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
37398 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
37399 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
37400 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
37401 not fit in a 32-bit word.
37402
37403 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
37404 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
37405 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
37406 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
37407 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
37408 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
37409 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
37410
37411 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37412 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
37413 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
37414 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37415 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37416 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37417 packet).
37418
37419 @end table
37420
37421 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
37422 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
37423 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
37424 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
37425 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
37426 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
37427 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
37428 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
37429
37430 Replies:
37431 @table @samp
37432 @item OK
37433 The packet was understood and carried out.
37434 @item qRelocInsn
37435 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37436 @item @w{}
37437 The packet was not recognized.
37438 @end table
37439
37440 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
37441 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
37442 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
37443 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
37444 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
37445 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
37446 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
37447 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
37448
37449 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
37450 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
37451 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
37452 fit in a single packet.
37453 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
37454 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
37455
37456 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
37457 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
37458 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
37459 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
37460
37461 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
37462 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
37463 query packets.
37464
37465 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
37466 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
37467 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
37468 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
37469 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
37470 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
37471 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
37472 be found.
37473
37474 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
37475 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
37476 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
37477 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
37478 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
37479 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
37480 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
37481 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
37482 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
37483 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
37484 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
37485 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
37486 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
37487 variable.
37488
37489 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
37490 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
37491 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
37492 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
37493 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
37494
37495 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
37496 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
37497 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
37498 one of the following forms:
37499
37500 @table @samp
37501 @item F @var{f}
37502 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
37503 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
37504 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
37505
37506 @item T @var{t}
37507 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
37508 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
37509
37510 @end table
37511
37512 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
37513 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37514 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
37515 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
37516
37517 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
37518 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37519 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
37520 is a hexadecimal number.
37521
37522 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
37523 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37524 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
37525 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
37526 numbers.
37527
37528 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
37529 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
37530 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
37531
37532 @item qTMinFTPILen
37533 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
37534 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
37535 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
37536 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
37537 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
37538 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
37539 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
37540 arrange for that.
37541
37542 Replies:
37543
37544 @table @samp
37545 @item 0
37546 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
37547 @item @var{length}
37548 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
37549 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
37550 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
37551 regardless of size.
37552 @item E
37553 An error has occurred.
37554 @item @w{}
37555 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
37556 @end table
37557
37558 @item QTStart
37559 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
37560 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
37561 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
37562 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37563 instruction reply packet}).
37564
37565 @item QTStop
37566 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
37567 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
37568
37569 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37570 @anchor{QTEnable}
37571 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
37572 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37573 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
37574 of data from it will resume.
37575
37576 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37577 @anchor{QTDisable}
37578 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
37579 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37580 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
37581 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
37582
37583 @item QTinit
37584 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
37585 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
37586
37587 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
37588 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
37589 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
37590 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
37591 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
37592
37593 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
37594 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
37595 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
37596 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
37597
37598 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
37599 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
37600 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
37601 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
37602 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
37603 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
37604
37605 @item qTStatus
37606 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
37607 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
37608
37609 The reply has the form:
37610
37611 @table @samp
37612
37613 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
37614 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
37615 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
37616 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
37617
37618 @end table
37619
37620 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
37621 explanations as one of the optional fields:
37622
37623 @table @samp
37624
37625 @item tnotrun:0
37626 No trace has been run yet.
37627
37628 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
37629 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
37630 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
37631 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
37632 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
37633
37634 @item tfull:0
37635 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
37636
37637 @item tdisconnected:0
37638 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
37639
37640 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
37641 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
37642
37643 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
37644 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
37645 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
37646 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
37647 is hex encoded.
37648
37649 @item tunknown:0
37650 The trace stopped for some other reason.
37651
37652 @end table
37653
37654 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
37655 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
37656 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
37657 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
37658 trace.
37659
37660 @table @samp
37661
37662 @item tframes:@var{n}
37663 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
37664
37665 @item tcreated:@var{n}
37666 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
37667 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
37668
37669 @item tsize:@var{n}
37670 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
37671
37672 @item tfree:@var{n}
37673 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
37674
37675 @item circular:@var{n}
37676 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
37677 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
37678 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
37679 and may fill up.
37680
37681 @item disconn:@var{n}
37682 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
37683 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
37684 that the trace run will stop.
37685
37686 @end table
37687
37688 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
37689 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
37690 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
37691 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
37692 address @var{addr}.
37693
37694 Replies:
37695 @table @samp
37696 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
37697 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
37698 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
37699 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
37700 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
37701
37702 @end table
37703
37704 @item qTV:@var{var}
37705 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
37706 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
37707 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
37708
37709 Replies:
37710 @table @samp
37711 @item V@var{value}
37712 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
37713 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
37714 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
37715 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
37716 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
37717 program is running.
37718
37719 @item U
37720 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
37721 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
37722 was not collected.
37723 @end table
37724
37725 @item qTfP
37726 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
37727 @itemx qTsP
37728 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
37729 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
37730 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
37731 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
37732 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
37733 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
37734
37735 @item qTfV
37736 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
37737 @itemx qTsV
37738 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
37739 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
37740 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
37741 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
37742 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
37743 trace state variables.
37744
37745 @item qTfSTM
37746 @itemx qTsSTM
37747 @anchor{qTfSTM}
37748 @anchor{qTsSTM}
37749 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
37750 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
37751 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
37752 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
37753 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
37754 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
37755
37756 Reply:
37757 @table @samp
37758 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
37759 A single marker
37760 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
37761 a comma-separated list of markers
37762 @item l
37763 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37764 @item E @var{nn}
37765 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37766 @item @w{}
37767 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
37768 stub.
37769 @end table
37770
37771 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
37772 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
37773
37774 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37775 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
37776 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
37777 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
37778 @dfn{last}).
37779
37780 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
37781 @anchor{qTSTMat}
37782 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
37783 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
37784 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
37785 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
37786 tracepoint markers.
37787
37788 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
37789 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
37790 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
37791 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
37792 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
37793 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
37794
37795 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
37796 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
37797 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
37798 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
37799 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
37800 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
37801 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
37802 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
37803 available.
37804
37805 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
37806 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
37807 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
37808
37809 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
37810 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
37811 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
37812 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
37813 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
37814 use whatever size it prefers.
37815
37816 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
37817 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
37818 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
37819 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
37820 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
37821
37822 @end table
37823
37824 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
37825 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
37826 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
37827 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
37828 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
37829 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
37830 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
37831 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
37832 it had executed in the original location.
37833
37834 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
37835 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
37836 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
37837 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
37838 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
37839 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
37840 format of the request is:
37841
37842 @table @samp
37843 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
37844
37845 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
37846 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
37847 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
37848 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
37849 memory starting at @var{to}.
37850 @end table
37851
37852 Replies:
37853 @table @samp
37854 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
37855 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
37856 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
37857 @item E @var{NN}
37858 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
37859 relocating the instruction.
37860 @end table
37861
37862 @node Host I/O Packets
37863 @section Host I/O Packets
37864 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
37865 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
37866
37867 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
37868 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
37869 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
37870 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
37871 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
37872 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
37873 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
37874 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
37875 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
37876 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
37877
37878 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
37879 its arguments. They have this format:
37880
37881 @table @samp
37882
37883 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
37884 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
37885 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
37886 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
37887 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
37888 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
37889 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
37890 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
37891 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37892
37893 @end table
37894
37895 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
37896
37897 @table @samp
37898
37899 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
37900 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
37901 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
37902 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
37903 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
37904 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
37905 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
37906 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
37907 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
37908 @var{attachment}.
37909
37910 @item @w{}
37911 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
37912
37913 @end table
37914
37915 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
37916
37917 @table @samp
37918 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
37919 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
37920 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
37921 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
37922 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
37923 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
37924 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
37925
37926 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
37927 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
37928 -1 if an error occurs.
37929
37930 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
37931 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
37932 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
37933 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
37934 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
37935 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
37936 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
37937 @var{count} was zero.
37938
37939 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
37940 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
37941 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
37942 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
37943 some characters were escaped.
37944
37945 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
37946 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
37947 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
37948 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
37949 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
37950 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
37951 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
37952 error occurred.
37953
37954 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
37955 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
37956 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
37957 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
37958 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
37959 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
37960
37961 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
37962 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
37963 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
37964
37965 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
37966 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
37967 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
37968
37969 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
37970 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
37971 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
37972 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
37973 some characters were escaped.
37974
37975 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
37976 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
37977 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
37978 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
37979 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
37980 inferior(s).
37981
37982 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
37983 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
37984 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
37985 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
37986 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
37987 operation.
37988
37989 @end table
37990
37991 @node Interrupts
37992 @section Interrupts
37993 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
37994
37995 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
37996 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
37997 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
37998 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
37999
38000 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
38001 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
38002 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
38003 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
38004 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
38005
38006 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
38007 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
38008 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
38009 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
38010 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
38011 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
38012 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
38013 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
38014
38015 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
38016 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
38017 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
38018
38019 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38020 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38021 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
38022 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38023 currently-executing threads and processes.
38024 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38025 running program, it should send one of the stop
38026 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38027 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38028 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38029 Interrupts received while the
38030 program is stopped are discarded.
38031
38032 @node Notification Packets
38033 @section Notification Packets
38034 @cindex notification packets
38035 @cindex packets, notification
38036
38037 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38038 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
38039 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38040 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
38041 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38042 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38043 is not a problem.
38044
38045 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38046 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38047 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38048 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
38049 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
38050 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38051 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38052
38053 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38054 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38055
38056 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38057 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
38058 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38059 not they understand it.
38060
38061 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38062 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
38063 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38064 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38065 recipients.
38066
38067 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38068 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38069 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
38070 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38071 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38072
38073 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
38074 @table @samp
38075 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
38076 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
38077 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
38078 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
38079 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
38080 @item @var{ack}
38081 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
38082 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
38083 @end table
38084
38085 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
38086 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
38087
38088 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
38089 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
38090 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
38091 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
38092 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38093 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38094 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
38095 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38096 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
38097 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
38098
38099 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
38100 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
38101 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38102 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38103 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38104 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38105
38106 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
38107 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
38108 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
38109 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
38110 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
38111
38112 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
38113 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38114 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
38115 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
38116 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
38117 normally.
38118
38119 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
38120 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
38121 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
38122 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
38123 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
38124 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
38125 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
38126 the process shall be repeated.
38127
38128 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
38129 following example:
38130 @smallexample
38131 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
38132 @code{...}
38133 -> @code{vStopped}
38134 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
38135 -> @code{vStopped}
38136 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
38137 -> @code{vStopped}
38138 <- @code{OK}
38139 @end smallexample
38140
38141 The following notifications are defined:
38142 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
38143
38144 @item Notification
38145 @tab Ack
38146 @tab Event
38147 @tab Description
38148
38149 @item Stop
38150 @tab vStopped
38151 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38152 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38153 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38154 @value{GDBN}.
38155 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
38156
38157 @end multitable
38158
38159 @node Remote Non-Stop
38160 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
38161
38162 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
38163 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
38164 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
38165 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38166
38167 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
38168 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
38169 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
38170 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
38171 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
38172 probe the target state after a mode change.
38173
38174 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
38175 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
38176 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
38177 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
38178 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
38179 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
38180 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
38181 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
38182 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
38183 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
38184 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
38185
38186 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
38187 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
38188 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
38189 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
38190 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
38191 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
38192 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
38193 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
38194 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
38195 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
38196 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38197 @samp{OK}.
38198
38199 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
38200 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
38201 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
38202 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
38203 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
38204 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
38205 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
38206 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
38207 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
38208 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
38209 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
38210 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
38211 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
38212
38213 @node Packet Acknowledgment
38214 @section Packet Acknowledgment
38215
38216 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38217 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38218 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38219 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38220 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38221 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38222 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38223
38224 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38225 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38226 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38227 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
38228 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38229
38230 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38231 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
38232 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38233 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38234
38235 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38236 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38237 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38238 @pxref{qSupported}.
38239 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38240 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38241 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38242 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38243 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38244 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38245 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38246
38247 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38248 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38249 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38250 connection.
38251 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38252 new connection is established,
38253 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38254 for the current connection, once disabled.
38255
38256 @node Examples
38257 @section Examples
38258
38259 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
38260 does not get any direct output:
38261
38262 @smallexample
38263 -> @code{R00}
38264 <- @code{+}
38265 @emph{target restarts}
38266 -> @code{?}
38267 <- @code{+}
38268 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38269 -> @code{+}
38270 @end smallexample
38271
38272 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38273
38274 @smallexample
38275 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38276 <- @code{+}
38277 -> @code{s}
38278 <- @code{+}
38279 @emph{time passes}
38280 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38281 -> @code{+}
38282 -> @code{g}
38283 <- @code{+}
38284 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
38285 -> @code{+}
38286 @end smallexample
38287
38288 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38289 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38290 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38291
38292 @menu
38293 * File-I/O Overview::
38294 * Protocol Basics::
38295 * The F Request Packet::
38296 * The F Reply Packet::
38297 * The Ctrl-C Message::
38298 * Console I/O::
38299 * List of Supported Calls::
38300 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
38301 * Constants::
38302 * File-I/O Examples::
38303 @end menu
38304
38305 @node File-I/O Overview
38306 @subsection File-I/O Overview
38307 @cindex file-i/o overview
38308
38309 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
38310 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
38311 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
38312 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
38313 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
38314 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
38315
38316 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
38317 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
38318 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
38319 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
38320 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
38321
38322 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
38323 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38324 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
38325 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
38326 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
38327 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
38328 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
38329
38330 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
38331 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
38332 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
38333 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
38334 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
38335
38336 @smallexample
38337 (@value{GDBP}) continue
38338 <- target requests 'system call X'
38339 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
38340 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
38341 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
38342 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
38343 @end smallexample
38344
38345 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
38346 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
38347 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
38348 system are not supported by this protocol.
38349
38350 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
38351
38352 @node Protocol Basics
38353 @subsection Protocol Basics
38354 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
38355
38356 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
38357 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
38358 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
38359 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
38360 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
38361 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
38362 to call the appropriate host system call:
38363
38364 @itemize @bullet
38365 @item
38366 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
38367
38368 @item
38369 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
38370 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
38371 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
38372 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
38373
38374 @end itemize
38375
38376 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
38377
38378 @itemize @bullet
38379 @item
38380 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
38381 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
38382 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
38383 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
38384 packet.
38385
38386 @item
38387 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
38388 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
38389
38390 @item
38391 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
38392
38393 @item
38394 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
38395
38396 @item
38397 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
38398 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
38399 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
38400 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
38401 packet.
38402
38403 @end itemize
38404
38405 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
38406 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
38407
38408 @itemize @bullet
38409 @item
38410 Return value.
38411
38412 @item
38413 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
38414
38415 @item
38416 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
38417
38418 @end itemize
38419
38420 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
38421 the latest continue or step action.
38422
38423 @node The F Request Packet
38424 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
38425 @cindex file-i/o request packet
38426 @cindex @code{F} request packet
38427
38428 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
38429
38430 @table @samp
38431 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
38432
38433 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
38434 This is just the name of the function.
38435
38436 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
38437 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
38438 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
38439 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
38440 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
38441 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
38442 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
38443
38444 @end table
38445
38446
38447
38448 @node The F Reply Packet
38449 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
38450 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
38451 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
38452
38453 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
38454
38455 @table @samp
38456
38457 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
38458
38459 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
38460
38461 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
38462 representation.
38463 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
38464
38465 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
38466 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
38467 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
38468
38469 @smallexample
38470 F0,0,C
38471 @end smallexample
38472
38473 @noindent
38474 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
38475
38476 @smallexample
38477 F-1,4,C
38478 @end smallexample
38479
38480 @noindent
38481 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
38482
38483 @end table
38484
38485
38486 @node The Ctrl-C Message
38487 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
38488 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
38489
38490 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
38491 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
38492 the target should behave as if it had
38493 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
38494 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
38495 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
38496 packet.
38497
38498 It's important for the target to know in which
38499 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
38500
38501 @itemize @bullet
38502 @item
38503 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
38504
38505 @item
38506 The system call on the host has been finished.
38507
38508 @end itemize
38509
38510 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
38511 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
38512 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
38513 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
38514 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
38515 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
38516
38517 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
38518 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
38519 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
38520 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
38521 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
38522 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
38523 or the full action has been completed.
38524
38525 @node Console I/O
38526 @subsection Console I/O
38527 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
38528
38529 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
38530 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
38531 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
38532 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
38533 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
38534 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
38535 conditions is met:
38536
38537 @itemize @bullet
38538 @item
38539 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
38540 @code{read}
38541 system call is treated as finished.
38542
38543 @item
38544 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
38545 newline.
38546
38547 @item
38548 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
38549 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
38550
38551 @end itemize
38552
38553 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
38554 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
38555 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
38556 is stopped at the user's request.
38557
38558
38559 @node List of Supported Calls
38560 @subsection List of Supported Calls
38561 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
38562
38563 @menu
38564 * open::
38565 * close::
38566 * read::
38567 * write::
38568 * lseek::
38569 * rename::
38570 * unlink::
38571 * stat/fstat::
38572 * gettimeofday::
38573 * isatty::
38574 * system::
38575 @end menu
38576
38577 @node open
38578 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
38579 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
38580
38581 @table @asis
38582 @item Synopsis:
38583 @smallexample
38584 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
38585 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
38586 @end smallexample
38587
38588 @item Request:
38589 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
38590
38591 @noindent
38592 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38593
38594 @table @code
38595 @item O_CREAT
38596 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
38597 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
38598 are concerned.
38599
38600 @item O_EXCL
38601 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
38602 an error and open() fails.
38603
38604 @item O_TRUNC
38605 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
38606 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
38607 truncated to zero length.
38608
38609 @item O_APPEND
38610 The file is opened in append mode.
38611
38612 @item O_RDONLY
38613 The file is opened for reading only.
38614
38615 @item O_WRONLY
38616 The file is opened for writing only.
38617
38618 @item O_RDWR
38619 The file is opened for reading and writing.
38620 @end table
38621
38622 @noindent
38623 Other bits are silently ignored.
38624
38625
38626 @noindent
38627 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38628
38629 @table @code
38630 @item S_IRUSR
38631 User has read permission.
38632
38633 @item S_IWUSR
38634 User has write permission.
38635
38636 @item S_IRGRP
38637 Group has read permission.
38638
38639 @item S_IWGRP
38640 Group has write permission.
38641
38642 @item S_IROTH
38643 Others have read permission.
38644
38645 @item S_IWOTH
38646 Others have write permission.
38647 @end table
38648
38649 @noindent
38650 Other bits are silently ignored.
38651
38652
38653 @item Return value:
38654 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
38655 occurred.
38656
38657 @item Errors:
38658
38659 @table @code
38660 @item EEXIST
38661 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
38662
38663 @item EISDIR
38664 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
38665
38666 @item EACCES
38667 The requested access is not allowed.
38668
38669 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38670 @var{pathname} was too long.
38671
38672 @item ENOENT
38673 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38674
38675 @item ENODEV
38676 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
38677
38678 @item EROFS
38679 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
38680 write access was requested.
38681
38682 @item EFAULT
38683 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
38684
38685 @item ENOSPC
38686 No space on device to create the file.
38687
38688 @item EMFILE
38689 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
38690
38691 @item ENFILE
38692 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
38693 has been reached.
38694
38695 @item EINTR
38696 The call was interrupted by the user.
38697 @end table
38698
38699 @end table
38700
38701 @node close
38702 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
38703 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
38704
38705 @table @asis
38706 @item Synopsis:
38707 @smallexample
38708 int close(int fd);
38709 @end smallexample
38710
38711 @item Request:
38712 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
38713
38714 @item Return value:
38715 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
38716
38717 @item Errors:
38718
38719 @table @code
38720 @item EBADF
38721 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
38722
38723 @item EINTR
38724 The call was interrupted by the user.
38725 @end table
38726
38727 @end table
38728
38729 @node read
38730 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
38731 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
38732
38733 @table @asis
38734 @item Synopsis:
38735 @smallexample
38736 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
38737 @end smallexample
38738
38739 @item Request:
38740 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38741
38742 @item Return value:
38743 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
38744 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
38745 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
38746
38747 @item Errors:
38748
38749 @table @code
38750 @item EBADF
38751 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38752 reading.
38753
38754 @item EFAULT
38755 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38756
38757 @item EINTR
38758 The call was interrupted by the user.
38759 @end table
38760
38761 @end table
38762
38763 @node write
38764 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
38765 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
38766
38767 @table @asis
38768 @item Synopsis:
38769 @smallexample
38770 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
38771 @end smallexample
38772
38773 @item Request:
38774 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38775
38776 @item Return value:
38777 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
38778 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
38779 is returned.
38780
38781 @item Errors:
38782
38783 @table @code
38784 @item EBADF
38785 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38786 writing.
38787
38788 @item EFAULT
38789 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38790
38791 @item EFBIG
38792 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
38793 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
38794
38795 @item ENOSPC
38796 No space on device to write the data.
38797
38798 @item EINTR
38799 The call was interrupted by the user.
38800 @end table
38801
38802 @end table
38803
38804 @node lseek
38805 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
38806 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
38807
38808 @table @asis
38809 @item Synopsis:
38810 @smallexample
38811 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
38812 @end smallexample
38813
38814 @item Request:
38815 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
38816
38817 @var{flag} is one of:
38818
38819 @table @code
38820 @item SEEK_SET
38821 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
38822
38823 @item SEEK_CUR
38824 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
38825 bytes.
38826
38827 @item SEEK_END
38828 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
38829 bytes.
38830 @end table
38831
38832 @item Return value:
38833 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
38834 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
38835 value of -1 is returned.
38836
38837 @item Errors:
38838
38839 @table @code
38840 @item EBADF
38841 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
38842
38843 @item ESPIPE
38844 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
38845
38846 @item EINVAL
38847 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
38848
38849 @item EINTR
38850 The call was interrupted by the user.
38851 @end table
38852
38853 @end table
38854
38855 @node rename
38856 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
38857 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
38858
38859 @table @asis
38860 @item Synopsis:
38861 @smallexample
38862 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
38863 @end smallexample
38864
38865 @item Request:
38866 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
38867
38868 @item Return value:
38869 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38870
38871 @item Errors:
38872
38873 @table @code
38874 @item EISDIR
38875 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
38876 directory.
38877
38878 @item EEXIST
38879 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
38880
38881 @item EBUSY
38882 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
38883 process.
38884
38885 @item EINVAL
38886 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
38887 of itself.
38888
38889 @item ENOTDIR
38890 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
38891 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
38892 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
38893
38894 @item EFAULT
38895 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
38896
38897 @item EACCES
38898 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38899
38900 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38901
38902 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
38903
38904 @item ENOENT
38905 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
38906
38907 @item EROFS
38908 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
38909
38910 @item ENOSPC
38911 The device containing the file has no room for the new
38912 directory entry.
38913
38914 @item EINTR
38915 The call was interrupted by the user.
38916 @end table
38917
38918 @end table
38919
38920 @node unlink
38921 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
38922 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
38923
38924 @table @asis
38925 @item Synopsis:
38926 @smallexample
38927 int unlink(const char *pathname);
38928 @end smallexample
38929
38930 @item Request:
38931 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
38932
38933 @item Return value:
38934 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38935
38936 @item Errors:
38937
38938 @table @code
38939 @item EACCES
38940 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38941
38942 @item EPERM
38943 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
38944
38945 @item EBUSY
38946 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
38947 being used by another process.
38948
38949 @item EFAULT
38950 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38951
38952 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38953 @var{pathname} was too long.
38954
38955 @item ENOENT
38956 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38957
38958 @item ENOTDIR
38959 A component of the path is not a directory.
38960
38961 @item EROFS
38962 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
38963
38964 @item EINTR
38965 The call was interrupted by the user.
38966 @end table
38967
38968 @end table
38969
38970 @node stat/fstat
38971 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
38972 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
38973 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
38974
38975 @table @asis
38976 @item Synopsis:
38977 @smallexample
38978 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
38979 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
38980 @end smallexample
38981
38982 @item Request:
38983 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
38984 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
38985
38986 @item Return value:
38987 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38988
38989 @item Errors:
38990
38991 @table @code
38992 @item EBADF
38993 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
38994
38995 @item ENOENT
38996 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
38997 path is an empty string.
38998
38999 @item ENOTDIR
39000 A component of the path is not a directory.
39001
39002 @item EFAULT
39003 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39004
39005 @item EACCES
39006 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39007
39008 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39009 @var{pathname} was too long.
39010
39011 @item EINTR
39012 The call was interrupted by the user.
39013 @end table
39014
39015 @end table
39016
39017 @node gettimeofday
39018 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39019 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39020
39021 @table @asis
39022 @item Synopsis:
39023 @smallexample
39024 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39025 @end smallexample
39026
39027 @item Request:
39028 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39029
39030 @item Return value:
39031 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39032
39033 @item Errors:
39034
39035 @table @code
39036 @item EINVAL
39037 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39038
39039 @item EFAULT
39040 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39041 @end table
39042
39043 @end table
39044
39045 @node isatty
39046 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39047 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39048
39049 @table @asis
39050 @item Synopsis:
39051 @smallexample
39052 int isatty(int fd);
39053 @end smallexample
39054
39055 @item Request:
39056 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39057
39058 @item Return value:
39059 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39060
39061 @item Errors:
39062
39063 @table @code
39064 @item EINTR
39065 The call was interrupted by the user.
39066 @end table
39067
39068 @end table
39069
39070 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
39071 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39072 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
39073 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39074 needed.
39075
39076
39077 @node system
39078 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
39079 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
39080
39081 @table @asis
39082 @item Synopsis:
39083 @smallexample
39084 int system(const char *command);
39085 @end smallexample
39086
39087 @item Request:
39088 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39089
39090 @item Return value:
39091 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39092 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39093 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39094 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
39095 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39096 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
39097 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39098
39099 @item Errors:
39100
39101 @table @code
39102 @item EINTR
39103 The call was interrupted by the user.
39104 @end table
39105
39106 @end table
39107
39108 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39109 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
39110 the host is simplified before it's returned
39111 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
39112 is discarded, and the return value consists
39113 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39114
39115 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39116 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39117 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39118
39119 @table @code
39120 @item set remote system-call-allowed
39121 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39122 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39123 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
39124
39125 @item show remote system-call-allowed
39126 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39127 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39128 protocol.
39129 @end table
39130
39131 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39132 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39133 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39134
39135 @menu
39136 * Integral Datatypes::
39137 * Pointer Values::
39138 * Memory Transfer::
39139 * struct stat::
39140 * struct timeval::
39141 @end menu
39142
39143 @node Integral Datatypes
39144 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39145 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39146
39147 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39148 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39149 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39150
39151 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39152 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39153
39154 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
39155
39156 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
39157 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
39158
39159 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
39160
39161 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
39162 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
39163 byte order.
39164
39165 @node Pointer Values
39166 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
39167 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
39168
39169 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
39170 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
39171 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
39172 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
39173
39174 @smallexample
39175 @code{1aaf/12}
39176 @end smallexample
39177
39178 @noindent
39179 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
39180 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
39181 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
39182 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
39183
39184 @smallexample
39185 @code{123456/d}
39186 @end smallexample
39187
39188 @node Memory Transfer
39189 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
39190 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
39191
39192 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
39193 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
39194 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
39195 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
39196 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39197 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
39198 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39199
39200
39201 @node struct stat
39202 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39203 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39204
39205 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39206 is defined as follows:
39207
39208 @smallexample
39209 struct stat @{
39210 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
39211 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
39212 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
39213 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
39214 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
39215 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
39216 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
39217 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
39218 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39219 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
39220 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
39221 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
39222 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
39223 @};
39224 @end smallexample
39225
39226 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39227 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39228 structure is of size 64 bytes.
39229
39230 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39231 range of values.
39232
39233 @table @code
39234
39235 @item st_dev
39236 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39237
39238 @item st_ino
39239 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39240
39241 @item st_mode
39242 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
39243 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39244
39245 @item st_uid
39246 @itemx st_gid
39247 @itemx st_rdev
39248 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39249
39250 @item st_atime
39251 @itemx st_mtime
39252 @itemx st_ctime
39253 These values have a host and file system dependent
39254 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39255 support exact timing values.
39256 @end table
39257
39258 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39259 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39260 continuing.
39261
39262 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39263 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39264 get truncated on the target.
39265
39266 @node struct timeval
39267 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39268 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39269
39270 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39271 is defined as follows:
39272
39273 @smallexample
39274 struct timeval @{
39275 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
39276 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39277 @};
39278 @end smallexample
39279
39280 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39281 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39282 structure is of size 8 bytes.
39283
39284 @node Constants
39285 @subsection Constants
39286 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39287
39288 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39289 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39290 values before and after the call as needed.
39291
39292 @menu
39293 * Open Flags::
39294 * mode_t Values::
39295 * Errno Values::
39296 * Lseek Flags::
39297 * Limits::
39298 @end menu
39299
39300 @node Open Flags
39301 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
39302 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
39303
39304 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
39305
39306 @smallexample
39307 O_RDONLY 0x0
39308 O_WRONLY 0x1
39309 O_RDWR 0x2
39310 O_APPEND 0x8
39311 O_CREAT 0x200
39312 O_TRUNC 0x400
39313 O_EXCL 0x800
39314 @end smallexample
39315
39316 @node mode_t Values
39317 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
39318 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
39319
39320 All values are given in octal representation.
39321
39322 @smallexample
39323 S_IFREG 0100000
39324 S_IFDIR 040000
39325 S_IRUSR 0400
39326 S_IWUSR 0200
39327 S_IXUSR 0100
39328 S_IRGRP 040
39329 S_IWGRP 020
39330 S_IXGRP 010
39331 S_IROTH 04
39332 S_IWOTH 02
39333 S_IXOTH 01
39334 @end smallexample
39335
39336 @node Errno Values
39337 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
39338 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
39339
39340 All values are given in decimal representation.
39341
39342 @smallexample
39343 EPERM 1
39344 ENOENT 2
39345 EINTR 4
39346 EBADF 9
39347 EACCES 13
39348 EFAULT 14
39349 EBUSY 16
39350 EEXIST 17
39351 ENODEV 19
39352 ENOTDIR 20
39353 EISDIR 21
39354 EINVAL 22
39355 ENFILE 23
39356 EMFILE 24
39357 EFBIG 27
39358 ENOSPC 28
39359 ESPIPE 29
39360 EROFS 30
39361 ENAMETOOLONG 91
39362 EUNKNOWN 9999
39363 @end smallexample
39364
39365 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
39366 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
39367
39368 @node Lseek Flags
39369 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
39370 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
39371
39372 @smallexample
39373 SEEK_SET 0
39374 SEEK_CUR 1
39375 SEEK_END 2
39376 @end smallexample
39377
39378 @node Limits
39379 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
39380 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
39381
39382 All values are given in decimal representation.
39383
39384 @smallexample
39385 INT_MIN -2147483648
39386 INT_MAX 2147483647
39387 UINT_MAX 4294967295
39388 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
39389 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
39390 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
39391 @end smallexample
39392
39393 @node File-I/O Examples
39394 @subsection File-I/O Examples
39395 @cindex file-i/o examples
39396
39397 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39398 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
39399
39400 @smallexample
39401 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
39402 @emph{request memory read from target}
39403 -> @code{m1234,6}
39404 <- XXXXXX
39405 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
39406 -> @code{F6}
39407 @end smallexample
39408
39409 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39410 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
39411
39412 @smallexample
39413 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39414 @emph{request memory write to target}
39415 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39416 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
39417 -> @code{F6}
39418 @end smallexample
39419
39420 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
39421 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
39422
39423 @smallexample
39424 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39425 -> @code{F-1,9}
39426 @end smallexample
39427
39428 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
39429 host is called:
39430
39431 @smallexample
39432 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39433 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
39434 <- @code{T02}
39435 @end smallexample
39436
39437 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
39438 host is called:
39439
39440 @smallexample
39441 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39442 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39443 <- @code{T02}
39444 @end smallexample
39445
39446 @node Library List Format
39447 @section Library List Format
39448 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39449
39450 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
39451 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
39452 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
39453 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
39454 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
39455 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
39456 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39457 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
39458 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
39459 are loaded.
39460
39461 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
39462 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
39463 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
39464 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
39465
39466 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
39467 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
39468 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
39469 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
39470 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
39471 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
39472
39473 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39474 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39475
39476 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
39477 offset, looks like this:
39478
39479 @smallexample
39480 <library-list>
39481 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
39482 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
39483 </library>
39484 </library-list>
39485 @end smallexample
39486
39487 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
39488 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
39489
39490 @smallexample
39491 <library-list>
39492 <library name="sharedlib.o">
39493 <section address="0x10000000"/>
39494 <section address="0x20000000"/>
39495 <section address="0x30000000"/>
39496 </library>
39497 </library-list>
39498 @end smallexample
39499
39500 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
39501
39502 @smallexample
39503 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
39504 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
39505 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39506 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
39507 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39508 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
39509 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39510 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
39511 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39512 @end smallexample
39513
39514 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
39515 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
39516 section for each library.
39517
39518 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39519 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39520 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39521
39522 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
39523 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
39524 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
39525 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
39526
39527 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
39528 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
39529 target, the following parameters are reported:
39530
39531 @itemize @minus
39532 @item
39533 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
39534 @code{struct link_map}.
39535 @item
39536 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
39537 (Thread Local Storage) access.
39538 @item
39539 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
39540 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
39541 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
39542 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
39543 @item
39544 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
39545 @end itemize
39546
39547 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
39548 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
39549 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
39550
39551 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39552 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39553
39554 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
39555 looks like this:
39556
39557 @smallexample
39558 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
39559 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
39560 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
39561 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
39562 l_ld="0x152350"/>
39563 </library-list-svr>
39564 @end smallexample
39565
39566 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
39567
39568 @smallexample
39569 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
39570 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
39571 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39572 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
39573 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
39574 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39575 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
39576 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
39577 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
39578 @end smallexample
39579
39580 @node Memory Map Format
39581 @section Memory Map Format
39582 @cindex memory map format
39583
39584 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
39585 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
39586 memory map.
39587
39588 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
39589 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
39590 lists memory regions.
39591
39592 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39593 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
39594
39595 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39596
39597 @smallexample
39598 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39599 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
39600 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39601 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
39602 <memory-map>
39603 region...
39604 </memory-map>
39605 @end smallexample
39606
39607 Each region can be either:
39608
39609 @itemize
39610
39611 @item
39612 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
39613 bytes from there:
39614
39615 @smallexample
39616 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39617 @end smallexample
39618
39619
39620 @item
39621 A region of read-only memory:
39622
39623 @smallexample
39624 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39625 @end smallexample
39626
39627
39628 @item
39629 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
39630 bytes in length:
39631
39632 @smallexample
39633 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
39634 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
39635 </memory>
39636 @end smallexample
39637
39638 @end itemize
39639
39640 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
39641 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
39642 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
39643
39644 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
39645
39646 @smallexample
39647 <!-- ................................................... -->
39648 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
39649 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
39650 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
39651 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
39652 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
39653 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
39654 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
39655 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
39656 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
39657 and its type, or device. -->
39658 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
39659 start CDATA #REQUIRED
39660 length CDATA #REQUIRED
39661 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
39662 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
39663 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
39664 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39665 @end smallexample
39666
39667 @node Thread List Format
39668 @section Thread List Format
39669 @cindex thread list format
39670
39671 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
39672 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39673 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
39674 the following structure:
39675
39676 @smallexample
39677 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39678 <threads>
39679 <thread id="id" core="0">
39680 ... description ...
39681 </thread>
39682 </threads>
39683 @end smallexample
39684
39685 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
39686 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
39687 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
39688 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
39689 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
39690
39691 @node Traceframe Info Format
39692 @section Traceframe Info Format
39693 @cindex traceframe info format
39694
39695 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
39696 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
39697 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
39698 collected in a traceframe.
39699
39700 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39701 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
39702
39703 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39704 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39705
39706 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39707
39708 @smallexample
39709 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39710 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
39711 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39712 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
39713 <traceframe-info>
39714 block...
39715 </traceframe-info>
39716 @end smallexample
39717
39718 Each traceframe block can be either:
39719
39720 @itemize
39721
39722 @item
39723 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
39724 @var{length} bytes from there:
39725
39726 @smallexample
39727 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39728 @end smallexample
39729
39730 @item
39731 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
39732 collected:
39733
39734 @smallexample
39735 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
39736 @end smallexample
39737
39738 @end itemize
39739
39740 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
39741
39742 @smallexample
39743 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
39744 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39745
39746 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
39747 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
39748 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
39749 <!ELEMENT tvar>
39750 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
39751 @end smallexample
39752
39753 @node Branch Trace Format
39754 @section Branch Trace Format
39755 @cindex branch trace format
39756
39757 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
39758 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
39759 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
39760 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
39761
39762 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39763 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
39764
39765 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39766 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39767
39768 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39769
39770 @smallexample
39771 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39772 <!DOCTYPE btrace
39773 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
39774 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
39775 <btrace>
39776 block...
39777 </btrace>
39778 @end smallexample
39779
39780 @itemize
39781
39782 @item
39783 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
39784 and ending at @var{end}:
39785
39786 @smallexample
39787 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
39788 @end smallexample
39789
39790 @end itemize
39791
39792 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
39793
39794 @smallexample
39795 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
39796 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39797
39798 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
39799 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
39800 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
39801
39802 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
39803
39804 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
39805
39806 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
39807 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
39808 family CDATA #REQUIRED
39809 model CDATA #REQUIRED
39810 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
39811
39812 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
39813 @end smallexample
39814
39815 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
39816 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
39817 @cindex branch trace configuration format
39818
39819 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
39820 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39821 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
39822
39823 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
39824 settings for that format. The following information is described:
39825
39826 @table @code
39827 @item bts
39828 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
39829 @table @code
39830 @item size
39831 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
39832 @end table
39833 @item pt
39834 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel(R) Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel(R)
39835 PT}) format.
39836 @table @code
39837 @item size
39838 The size of the @acronym{Intel(R) PT} ring buffer in bytes.
39839 @end table
39840 @end table
39841
39842 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39843 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39844
39845 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
39846
39847 @smallexample
39848 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
39849 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39850
39851 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
39852 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
39853
39854 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
39855 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
39856 @end smallexample
39857
39858 @include agentexpr.texi
39859
39860 @node Target Descriptions
39861 @appendix Target Descriptions
39862 @cindex target descriptions
39863
39864 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
39865 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
39866 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
39867 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
39868 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
39869 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
39870 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
39871
39872 @itemize @bullet
39873 @item
39874 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
39875 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
39876 @item
39877 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
39878 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
39879 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
39880 @item
39881 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
39882 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
39883 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
39884 @end itemize
39885
39886 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
39887 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
39888 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
39889 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
39890 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
39891
39892 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39893 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
39894
39895 @menu
39896 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
39897 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
39898 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
39899 descriptions.
39900 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
39901 @end menu
39902
39903 @node Retrieving Descriptions
39904 @section Retrieving Descriptions
39905
39906 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
39907 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
39908 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
39909 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
39910 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
39911 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
39912 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
39913 Format}.
39914
39915 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
39916 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
39917 specify a file are:
39918
39919 @table @code
39920 @cindex set tdesc filename
39921 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
39922 Read the target description from @var{path}.
39923
39924 @cindex unset tdesc filename
39925 @item unset tdesc filename
39926 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
39927 will use the description supplied by the current target.
39928
39929 @cindex show tdesc filename
39930 @item show tdesc filename
39931 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
39932 @end table
39933
39934
39935 @node Target Description Format
39936 @section Target Description Format
39937 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
39938
39939 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
39940 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
39941 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
39942 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
39943 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
39944 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
39945 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
39946
39947 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
39948 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
39949 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
39950 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
39951 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
39952
39953 Here is a simple target description:
39954
39955 @smallexample
39956 <target version="1.0">
39957 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
39958 </target>
39959 @end smallexample
39960
39961 @noindent
39962 This minimal description only says that the target uses
39963 the x86-64 architecture.
39964
39965 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
39966 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
39967 are explained further below.
39968
39969 @smallexample
39970 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39971 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
39972 <target version="1.0">
39973 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
39974 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
39975 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
39976 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
39977 </target>
39978 @end smallexample
39979
39980 @noindent
39981 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
39982 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
39983 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
39984 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
39985 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
39986 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
39987 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
39988 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
39989 the version mismatch.
39990
39991 @subsection Inclusion
39992 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
39993 @cindex XInclude
39994 @ifnotinfo
39995 @cindex <xi:include>
39996 @end ifnotinfo
39997
39998 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
39999 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
40000 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
40001 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
40002 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
40003
40004 @smallexample
40005 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
40006 @end smallexample
40007
40008 @noindent
40009 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
40010 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
40011 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
40012 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
40013 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
40014 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
40015 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
40016 original description.
40017
40018 @subsection Architecture
40019 @cindex <architecture>
40020
40021 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
40022
40023 @smallexample
40024 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
40025 @end smallexample
40026
40027 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40028 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40029
40030 @subsection OS ABI
40031 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
40032
40033 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40034 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40035
40036 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
40037
40038 @smallexample
40039 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
40040 @end smallexample
40041
40042 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40043 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40044
40045 @subsection Compatible Architecture
40046 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
40047
40048 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40049 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40050
40051 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40052
40053 @smallexample
40054 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40055 @end smallexample
40056
40057 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40058 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40059
40060 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40061 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40062 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
40063 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40064 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40065 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
40066 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40067
40068 @smallexample
40069 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40070 <compatible>spu</compatible>
40071 @end smallexample
40072
40073 @subsection Features
40074 @cindex <feature>
40075
40076 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40077 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40078 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
40079 has this form:
40080
40081 @smallexample
40082 <feature name="@var{name}">
40083 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40084 @var{reg}@dots{}
40085 </feature>
40086 @end smallexample
40087
40088 @noindent
40089 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
40090 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40091 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40092 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40093
40094 @subsection Types
40095
40096 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40097 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40098 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40099 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40100 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
40101
40102 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40103 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40104 Types must be defined before they are used.
40105
40106 @cindex <vector>
40107 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40108 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40109 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40110 @var{count}:
40111
40112 @smallexample
40113 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40114 @end smallexample
40115
40116 @cindex <union>
40117 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40118 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
40119 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40120 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40121
40122 @smallexample
40123 <union id="@var{id}">
40124 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40125 @dots{}
40126 </union>
40127 @end smallexample
40128
40129 @cindex <struct>
40130 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40131 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
40132 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
40133 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
40134 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
40135 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
40136 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
40137 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
40138
40139 @smallexample
40140 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40141 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
40142 @dots{}
40143 </struct>
40144 @end smallexample
40145
40146 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
40147 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
40148
40149 @smallexample
40150 <struct id="@var{id}">
40151 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40152 @dots{}
40153 </struct>
40154 @end smallexample
40155
40156 @cindex <flags>
40157 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
40158 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
40159 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
40160 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
40161 are supported.
40162
40163 @smallexample
40164 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40165 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
40166 @dots{}
40167 </flags>
40168 @end smallexample
40169
40170 @subsection Registers
40171 @cindex <reg>
40172
40173 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
40174
40175 @smallexample
40176 <reg name="@var{name}"
40177 bitsize="@var{size}"
40178 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
40179 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
40180 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
40181 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
40182 @end smallexample
40183
40184 @noindent
40185 The components are as follows:
40186
40187 @table @var
40188
40189 @item name
40190 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
40191
40192 @item bitsize
40193 The register's size, in bits.
40194
40195 @item regnum
40196 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
40197 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
40198 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
40199 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
40200 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
40201 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
40202 in order of increasing register number.
40203
40204 @item save-restore
40205 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
40206 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
40207 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
40208 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
40209 ABI.
40210
40211 @item type
40212 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
40213 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
40214 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
40215 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
40216 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
40217 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
40218
40219 @item group
40220 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
40221 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
40222 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40223 in @code{info registers}.
40224
40225 @end table
40226
40227 @node Predefined Target Types
40228 @section Predefined Target Types
40229 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40230
40231 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40232 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
40233 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40234 types. The currently supported types are:
40235
40236 @table @code
40237
40238 @item int8
40239 @itemx int16
40240 @itemx int32
40241 @itemx int64
40242 @itemx int128
40243 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40244
40245 @item uint8
40246 @itemx uint16
40247 @itemx uint32
40248 @itemx uint64
40249 @itemx uint128
40250 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40251
40252 @item code_ptr
40253 @itemx data_ptr
40254 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
40255 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
40256 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
40257 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
40258 may be marked as data pointers.
40259
40260 @item ieee_single
40261 Single precision IEEE floating point.
40262
40263 @item ieee_double
40264 Double precision IEEE floating point.
40265
40266 @item arm_fpa_ext
40267 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
40268
40269 @item i387_ext
40270 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
40271
40272 @item i386_eflags
40273 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
40274
40275 @item i386_mxcsr
40276 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
40277
40278 @end table
40279
40280 @node Standard Target Features
40281 @section Standard Target Features
40282 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
40283
40284 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
40285 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
40286 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
40287 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
40288 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
40289 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
40290 can recognize them.
40291
40292 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
40293 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
40294 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
40295 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
40296 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
40297 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
40298 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
40299 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
40300
40301 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
40302 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
40303 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
40304
40305 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
40306 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
40307 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
40308 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
40309
40310 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
40311 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
40312 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
40313
40314 @menu
40315 * AArch64 Features::
40316 * ARM Features::
40317 * i386 Features::
40318 * MicroBlaze Features::
40319 * MIPS Features::
40320 * M68K Features::
40321 * Nios II Features::
40322 * PowerPC Features::
40323 * S/390 and System z Features::
40324 * TIC6x Features::
40325 @end menu
40326
40327
40328 @node AArch64 Features
40329 @subsection AArch64 Features
40330 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
40331
40332 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
40333 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
40334 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40335
40336 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
40337 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
40338 and @samp{fpcr}.
40339
40340 @node ARM Features
40341 @subsection ARM Features
40342 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
40343
40344 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
40345 ARM targets.
40346 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
40347 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40348
40349 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
40350 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
40351 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
40352 and @samp{xpsr}.
40353
40354 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
40355 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
40356
40357 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
40358 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
40359 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
40360 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
40361
40362 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
40363 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
40364 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
40365 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
40366 halves of the double-precision registers.
40367
40368 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
40369 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
40370 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
40371 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
40372 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
40373 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
40374
40375 @node i386 Features
40376 @subsection i386 Features
40377 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
40378
40379 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
40380 targets. It should describe the following registers:
40381
40382 @itemize @minus
40383 @item
40384 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
40385 @item
40386 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
40387 @item
40388 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
40389 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
40390 @item
40391 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
40392 @item
40393 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
40394 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
40395 @end itemize
40396
40397 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
40398
40399 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
40400 describe registers:
40401
40402 @itemize @minus
40403 @item
40404 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
40405 @item
40406 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
40407 @item
40408 @samp{mxcsr}
40409 @end itemize
40410
40411 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
40412 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
40413 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
40414
40415 @itemize @minus
40416 @item
40417 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
40418 @item
40419 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
40420 @end itemize
40421
40422 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
40423 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
40424
40425 @itemize @minus
40426 @item
40427 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
40428 @item
40429 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
40430 @end itemize
40431
40432 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
40433 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
40434
40435 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
40436 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
40437 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
40438
40439 @itemize @minus
40440 @item
40441 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40442 @end itemize
40443
40444 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
40445
40446 @itemize @minus
40447 @item
40448 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40449 @end itemize
40450
40451 It should
40452 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
40453
40454 @itemize @minus
40455 @item
40456 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
40457 @item
40458 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
40459 @end itemize
40460
40461 It should
40462 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
40463
40464 @itemize @minus
40465 @item
40466 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40467 @end itemize
40468
40469 @node MicroBlaze Features
40470 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
40471 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
40472
40473 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
40474 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40475 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
40476 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
40477 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
40478
40479 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
40480 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
40481
40482 @node MIPS Features
40483 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
40484 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
40485
40486 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
40487 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
40488 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
40489 on the target.
40490
40491 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
40492 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
40493 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40494
40495 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
40496 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
40497 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
40498 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40499
40500 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
40501 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
40502 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
40503 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40504
40505 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
40506 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
40507 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
40508
40509 @node M68K Features
40510 @subsection M68K Features
40511 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
40512
40513 @table @code
40514 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
40515 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
40516 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
40517 One of those features must be always present.
40518 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
40519 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
40520 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
40521 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
40522
40523 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
40524 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
40525 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
40526 @samp{fpiaddr}.
40527 @end table
40528
40529 @node Nios II Features
40530 @subsection Nios II Features
40531 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
40532
40533 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
40534 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
40535 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
40536 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
40537 @samp{mpuacc}).
40538
40539 @node PowerPC Features
40540 @subsection PowerPC Features
40541 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
40542
40543 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
40544 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40545 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
40546 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40547
40548 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
40549 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
40550
40551 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
40552 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
40553 and @samp{vrsave}.
40554
40555 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
40556 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
40557 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
40558 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
40559 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
40560 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
40561
40562 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
40563 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
40564 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
40565 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
40566 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
40567 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
40568 user.
40569
40570 @node S/390 and System z Features
40571 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
40572 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
40573 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
40574
40575 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
40576 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
40577 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
40578 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
40579 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
40580 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
40581 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
40582 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
40583 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
40584
40585 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
40586 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
40587 @samp{fpc}.
40588
40589 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
40590 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
40591
40592 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
40593 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
40594 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
40595 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
40596 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
40597 32-bit wide.
40598
40599 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
40600 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
40601 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
40602
40603 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
40604 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
40605 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
40606 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
40607 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
40608 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
40609 @samp{v31}.
40610
40611 @node TIC6x Features
40612 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
40613 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
40614 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
40615 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
40616 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
40617 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
40618
40619 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
40620 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
40621 through @samp{B31}.
40622
40623 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
40624 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
40625
40626 @node Operating System Information
40627 @appendix Operating System Information
40628 @cindex operating system information
40629
40630 @menu
40631 * Process list::
40632 @end menu
40633
40634 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
40635 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
40636 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
40637 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
40638 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
40639 on a different aspect of target.
40640
40641 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
40642 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
40643 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
40644 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
40645
40646 @node Process list
40647 @appendixsection Process list
40648 @cindex operating system information, process list
40649
40650 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
40651 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
40652 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
40653 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
40654
40655 An example document is:
40656
40657 @smallexample
40658 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40659 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
40660 <osdata type="processes">
40661 <item>
40662 <column name="pid">1</column>
40663 <column name="user">root</column>
40664 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
40665 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
40666 </item>
40667 </osdata>
40668 @end smallexample
40669
40670 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
40671 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
40672 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
40673 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
40674 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
40675 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
40676 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
40677
40678 @node Trace File Format
40679 @appendix Trace File Format
40680 @cindex trace file format
40681
40682 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
40683 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
40684
40685 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
40686 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
40687 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
40688 in the future.
40689
40690 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
40691 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
40692 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
40693 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
40694 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
40695 of this section.
40696
40697 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
40698
40699 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
40700 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
40701 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
40702 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
40703 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
40704 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
40705 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
40706 endianness.
40707
40708 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
40709
40710 @table @code
40711 @item R @var{bytes}
40712 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
40713 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
40714 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
40715 hexadecimal encoding.
40716
40717 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
40718 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
40719 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
40720 @var{length} bytes.
40721
40722 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
40723 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
40724 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
40725
40726 @end table
40727
40728 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
40729 of blocks.
40730
40731 @node Index Section Format
40732 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
40733 @cindex .gdb_index section format
40734 @cindex index section format
40735
40736 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
40737 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
40738 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
40739 description.
40740
40741 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
40742 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
40743 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
40744 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
40745 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
40746 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
40747
40748 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
40749
40750 @enumerate
40751 @item
40752 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
40753 unless otherwise noted:
40754
40755 @enumerate
40756 @item
40757 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
40758 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
40759 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
40760 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
40761 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
40762 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
40763 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
40764
40765 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
40766 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
40767 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
40768 currently not flagged as deprecated.
40769
40770 @item
40771 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
40772
40773 @item
40774 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
40775 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
40776 to the next offset.
40777
40778 @item
40779 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
40780
40781 @item
40782 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
40783
40784 @item
40785 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
40786 @end enumerate
40787
40788 @item
40789 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
40790 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
40791 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
40792 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
40793 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
40794 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
40795 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
40796 CU indices.
40797
40798 @item
40799 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
40800 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
40801 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
40802 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
40803
40804 @item
40805 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
40806 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
40807
40808 @enumerate
40809 @item
40810 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
40811
40812 @item
40813 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
40814 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
40815
40816 @item
40817 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
40818 @end enumerate
40819
40820 @item
40821 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
40822 the hash table is always a power of 2.
40823
40824 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
40825 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
40826 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
40827 constant pool.
40828
40829 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
40830 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
40831 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
40832
40833 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
40834 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
40835 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
40836 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
40837 index version:
40838
40839 @table @asis
40840 @item Version 4
40841 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
40842
40843 @item Versions 5 to 7
40844 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
40845 @end table
40846
40847 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
40848
40849 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
40850 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
40851 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
40852 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
40853 collision.
40854
40855 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
40856 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
40857 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
40858 the code.
40859
40860 @item
40861 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
40862 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
40863 strings.
40864
40865 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
40866 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
40867 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
40868 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
40869 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
40870 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
40871
40872 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
40873 @end enumerate
40874
40875 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
40876 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
40877 CU index+attributes value for each use.
40878
40879 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
40880 (bit 0 = LSB):
40881
40882 @table @asis
40883
40884 @item Bits 0-23
40885 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
40886 @item Bits 24-27
40887 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
40888 @item Bits 28-30
40889 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
40890
40891 @table @asis
40892 @item 0
40893 This value is reserved and should not be used.
40894 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
40895 with previous versions of the index.
40896 @item 1
40897 The symbol is a type.
40898 @item 2
40899 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
40900 @item 3
40901 The symbol is a function.
40902 @item 4
40903 Any other kind of symbol.
40904 @item 5,6,7
40905 These values are reserved.
40906 @end table
40907
40908 @item Bit 31
40909 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
40910
40911 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
40912 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
40913 @value{GDBN} sources.
40914
40915 @end table
40916
40917 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
40918 global/static attributes in the index.
40919
40920 @smallexample
40921 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
40922 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
40923 switch (die->tag)
40924 @{
40925 case DW_TAG_typedef:
40926 case DW_TAG_base_type:
40927 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
40928 kind = TYPE;
40929 is_static = 1;
40930 break;
40931 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
40932 kind = VARIABLE;
40933 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40934 break;
40935 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
40936 kind = FUNCTION;
40937 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
40938 break;
40939 case DW_TAG_constant:
40940 kind = VARIABLE;
40941 is_static = ! is_external;
40942 break;
40943 case DW_TAG_variable:
40944 kind = VARIABLE;
40945 is_static = ! is_external;
40946 break;
40947 case DW_TAG_namespace:
40948 kind = TYPE;
40949 is_static = 0;
40950 break;
40951 case DW_TAG_class_type:
40952 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
40953 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
40954 case DW_TAG_union_type:
40955 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
40956 kind = TYPE;
40957 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40958 break;
40959 default:
40960 assert (0);
40961 @}
40962 @end smallexample
40963
40964 @node Man Pages
40965 @appendix Manual pages
40966 @cindex Man pages
40967
40968 @menu
40969 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
40970 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
40971 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
40972 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
40973 @end menu
40974
40975 @node gdb man
40976 @heading gdb man
40977
40978 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
40979
40980 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
40981 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
40982 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
40983 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
40984 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
40985 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
40986 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
40987 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
40988 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
40989 @c man end
40990
40991 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
40992 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
40993 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
40994 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
40995
40996 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
40997 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
40998
40999 @itemize @bullet
41000 @item
41001 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
41002
41003 @item
41004 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
41005
41006 @item
41007 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
41008
41009 @item
41010 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
41011 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
41012 @end itemize
41013
41014 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
41015 Modula-2.
41016
41017 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
41018 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
41019 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
41020 by using the command @code{help}.
41021
41022 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
41023 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
41024 executable program as the argument:
41025
41026 @smallexample
41027 gdb program
41028 @end smallexample
41029
41030 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
41031
41032 @smallexample
41033 gdb program core
41034 @end smallexample
41035
41036 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
41037 to debug a running process:
41038
41039 @smallexample
41040 gdb program 1234
41041 gdb -p 1234
41042 @end smallexample
41043
41044 @noindent
41045 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
41046 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
41047 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
41048
41049 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
41050
41051 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
41052 @table @env
41053 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
41054 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
41055
41056 @item run [@var{arglist}]
41057 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
41058
41059 @item bt
41060 Backtrace: display the program stack.
41061
41062 @item print @var{expr}
41063 Display the value of an expression.
41064
41065 @item c
41066 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
41067
41068 @item next
41069 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
41070 function calls in the line.
41071
41072 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41073 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
41074
41075 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41076 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
41077
41078 @item step
41079 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
41080 function calls in the line.
41081
41082 @item help [@var{name}]
41083 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
41084 about using @value{GDBN}.
41085
41086 @item quit
41087 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
41088 @end table
41089
41090 @ifset man
41091 For full details on @value{GDBN},
41092 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41093 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
41094 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
41095 @end ifset
41096 @c man end
41097
41098 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
41099 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
41100 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
41101 encountered with no
41102 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
41103 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
41104 Many options have
41105 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
41106 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
41107 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
41108 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
41109 more usual convention.)
41110
41111 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
41112 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
41113 option is used.
41114
41115 @table @env
41116 @item -help
41117 @itemx -h
41118 List all options, with brief explanations.
41119
41120 @item -symbols=@var{file}
41121 @itemx -s @var{file}
41122 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
41123
41124 @item -write
41125 Enable writing into executable and core files.
41126
41127 @item -exec=@var{file}
41128 @itemx -e @var{file}
41129 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
41130 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
41131 dump.
41132
41133 @item -se=@var{file}
41134 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
41135 file.
41136
41137 @item -core=@var{file}
41138 @itemx -c @var{file}
41139 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
41140
41141 @item -command=@var{file}
41142 @itemx -x @var{file}
41143 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
41144
41145 @item -ex @var{command}
41146 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
41147
41148 @item -directory=@var{directory}
41149 @itemx -d @var{directory}
41150 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
41151
41152 @item -nh
41153 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
41154
41155 @item -nx
41156 @itemx -n
41157 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
41158
41159 @item -quiet
41160 @itemx -q
41161 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
41162 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
41163
41164 @item -batch
41165 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
41166 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
41167 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
41168 commands in the command files.
41169
41170 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
41171 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
41172 more useful, the message
41173
41174 @smallexample
41175 Program exited normally.
41176 @end smallexample
41177
41178 @noindent
41179 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
41180 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
41181
41182 @item -cd=@var{directory}
41183 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
41184 instead of the current directory.
41185
41186 @item -fullname
41187 @itemx -f
41188 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
41189 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
41190 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
41191 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
41192 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
41193 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
41194 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
41195 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
41196
41197 @item -b @var{bps}
41198 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
41199 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
41200
41201 @item -tty=@var{device}
41202 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
41203 @end table
41204 @c man end
41205
41206 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
41207 @ifset man
41208 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41209 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41210 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41211
41212 @smallexample
41213 info gdb
41214 @end smallexample
41215
41216 @noindent
41217 should give you access to the complete manual.
41218
41219 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41220 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41221 @end ifset
41222 @c man end
41223
41224 @node gdbserver man
41225 @heading gdbserver man
41226
41227 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
41228 @format
41229 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
41230 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41231
41232 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41233
41234 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41235 @c man end
41236 @end format
41237
41238 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
41239 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
41240 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
41241
41242 @ifclear man
41243 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
41244 @end ifclear
41245 @ifset man
41246 Usage (server (target) side):
41247 @end ifset
41248
41249 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
41250 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
41251 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
41252 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
41253
41254 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
41255 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
41256 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
41257
41258 @smallexample
41259 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
41260 @end smallexample
41261
41262 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
41263
41264 @smallexample
41265 @ifset man
41266 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
41267 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
41268 @end ifset
41269 @ifclear man
41270 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
41271 @end ifclear
41272 @end smallexample
41273
41274 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
41275 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
41276 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
41277
41278 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
41279
41280 @smallexample
41281 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
41282 @end smallexample
41283
41284 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
41285 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
41286 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
41287 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
41288 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
41289 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
41290 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
41291 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
41292 print an error message and exit.
41293
41294 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
41295 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
41296
41297 @smallexample
41298 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41299 @end smallexample
41300
41301 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41302 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41303
41304 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41305 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
41306 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
41307 the program you want to debug.
41308
41309 @smallexample
41310 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41311 @end smallexample
41312
41313 @ifclear man
41314 @subheading Usage (host side)
41315 @end ifclear
41316 @ifset man
41317 Usage (host side):
41318 @end ifset
41319
41320 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
41321 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
41322 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
41323 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
41324 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
41325 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
41326 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
41327 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
41328 descriptor. For example:
41329
41330 @smallexample
41331 @ifset man
41332 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
41333 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
41334 @end ifset
41335 @ifclear man
41336 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
41337 @end ifclear
41338 @end smallexample
41339
41340 @noindent
41341 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
41342
41343 @smallexample
41344 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
41345 @end smallexample
41346
41347 @noindent
41348 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
41349 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
41350 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
41351 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
41352 `Connection refused'.
41353
41354 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
41355 described in
41356 @ifset man
41357 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
41358 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
41359 @end ifset
41360 @ifclear man
41361 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
41362 @end ifclear
41363 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
41364
41365 @smallexample
41366 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
41367 @end smallexample
41368
41369 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
41370 case.
41371 @c man end
41372
41373 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
41374 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
41375
41376 @itemize @bullet
41377
41378 @item
41379 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
41380
41381 @smallexample
41382 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41383 @end smallexample
41384
41385 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
41386 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
41387 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
41388 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
41389 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
41390 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
41391 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41392
41393 @item
41394 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
41395 program:
41396
41397 @smallexample
41398 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41399 @end smallexample
41400
41401 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
41402 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
41403 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
41404 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41405
41406 @item
41407 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
41408
41409 @smallexample
41410 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41411 @end smallexample
41412
41413 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
41414 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
41415 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
41416 debug several processes in the same session.
41417 @end itemize
41418
41419 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
41420
41421 @table @env
41422
41423 @item --help
41424 List all options, with brief explanations.
41425
41426 @item --version
41427 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
41428
41429 @item --attach
41430 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
41431
41432 @smallexample
41433 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41434 @end smallexample
41435
41436 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41437 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41438
41439 @item --multi
41440 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41441 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
41442 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
41443 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
41444
41445 @smallexample
41446 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41447 @end smallexample
41448
41449 @item --debug
41450 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
41451 process.
41452 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41453 the developers.
41454
41455 @item --remote-debug
41456 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
41457 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41458 the developers.
41459
41460 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
41461 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
41462 of debugging output.
41463 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
41464
41465 @item --wrapper
41466 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
41467 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
41468 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
41469 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
41470
41471 @item --once
41472 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
41473 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
41474 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
41475 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
41476
41477 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
41478
41479 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
41480 @c QDisableRandomization.
41481
41482 @end table
41483 @c man end
41484
41485 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
41486 @ifset man
41487 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41488 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41489 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41490
41491 @smallexample
41492 info gdb
41493 @end smallexample
41494
41495 should give you access to the complete manual.
41496
41497 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41498 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41499 @end ifset
41500 @c man end
41501
41502 @node gcore man
41503 @heading gcore
41504
41505 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
41506
41507 @format
41508 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
41509 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
41510 @c man end
41511 @end format
41512
41513 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
41514 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
41515 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
41516 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
41517 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
41518 running without any change.
41519 @c man end
41520
41521 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
41522 @table @env
41523 @item -o @var{filename}
41524 The optional argument
41525 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
41526 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
41527 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
41528 @end table
41529 @c man end
41530
41531 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
41532 @ifset man
41533 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41534 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41535 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41536
41537 @smallexample
41538 info gdb
41539 @end smallexample
41540
41541 @noindent
41542 should give you access to the complete manual.
41543
41544 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41545 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41546 @end ifset
41547 @c man end
41548
41549 @node gdbinit man
41550 @heading gdbinit
41551
41552 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
41553
41554 @format
41555 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
41556 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41557 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41558 @end ifset
41559
41560 ~/.gdbinit
41561
41562 ./.gdbinit
41563 @c man end
41564 @end format
41565
41566 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
41567 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
41568 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
41569 described in
41570 @ifset man
41571 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
41572 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
41573 @end ifset
41574 @ifclear man
41575 @ref{Sequences}.
41576 @end ifclear
41577
41578 Please read more in
41579 @ifset man
41580 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
41581 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
41582 @end ifset
41583 @ifclear man
41584 @ref{Startup}.
41585 @end ifclear
41586
41587 @table @env
41588 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41589 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41590 @end ifset
41591 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41592 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
41593 @end ifclear
41594 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41595 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
41596 See more in
41597 @ifset man
41598 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
41599 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
41600 @end ifset
41601 @ifclear man
41602 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
41603 @end ifclear
41604
41605 @item ~/.gdbinit
41606 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41607 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
41608
41609 @item ./.gdbinit
41610 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
41611 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
41612 See more in
41613 @ifset man
41614 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
41615 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
41616 @end ifset
41617 @ifclear man
41618 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
41619 @end ifclear
41620 @end table
41621 @c man end
41622
41623 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
41624 @ifset man
41625 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
41626
41627 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41628 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41629 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41630
41631 @smallexample
41632 info gdb
41633 @end smallexample
41634
41635 should give you access to the complete manual.
41636
41637 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41638 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41639 @end ifset
41640 @c man end
41641
41642 @include gpl.texi
41643
41644 @node GNU Free Documentation License
41645 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
41646 @include fdl.texi
41647
41648 @node Concept Index
41649 @unnumbered Concept Index
41650
41651 @printindex cp
41652
41653 @node Command and Variable Index
41654 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
41655
41656 @printindex fn
41657
41658 @tex
41659 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
41660 % meantime:
41661 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
41662 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
41663 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
41664 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
41665 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
41666 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
41667 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
41668 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
41669 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
41670 \page\colophon
41671 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
41672 @end tex
41673
41674 @bye